Quarterlytics / Real Estate / REIT - Hotel & Motel / Funding Circle Holdings plc

Funding Circle Holdings plc

fch · LSE Real Estate
Claim this profile
Ticker fch
Exchange LSE
Sector Real Estate
Industry REIT - Hotel & Motel
Employees 501-1000
← All annual reports
FY2024 Annual Report · Funding Circle Holdings plc
Sign in to download
Loading PDF…
Business 
finance that
Annual Report and 
Accounts 2024
backs you

Overview and highlights 
Powering UK 
businesses 
We’re the UK’s leading SME finance platform, backing 
small businesses with the funding they need to win. 
From coffee roasters and bakeries to furniture 
manufacturers and estate agents, our customers 
are the nation’s small and medium-sized businesses. 
Our products
Enabled by data and technology, 
our expanded product suite allows 
businesses to borrow, pay later and 
spend – supporting them at every 
stage of their finance journey. 
More detail on page 18 
Spend 
Daily 
Borrow 
Longer term 
Pay later 
Monthly 
Our customers
We’re building a great 
business for our customers, 
who are the backbone of the 
economy. We provide the fuel 
to power SMEs, enabling them 
to build their businesses that 
create jobs, bring economic 
growth and support their 
communities. 
More detail on page 14 
Front cover image: Laird Hatters.

Our financial performance 
Revenue 
£160.1m
 
2024
160.1 
2023
130.1 
Profit before tax 
(before exceptional items) 
£3.4m 
2024
3.4 
2023
(9.9) 
Credit extended 
£1.9bn 
2024
1.9 
2023
1.3 
Balances outstanding 
£2.8bn 
2024
2.8 
2023
2.9 
More detail on page 44 
Contents 
Strategic report 
01 
Overview and highlights 
02 Chair’s statement 
05 Chief Executive Officer’s statement 
08 Our business model 
10 
Our strategy 
12 
Key performance indicators 
14 
Our customers 
16 
Technology and data 
18 
Our products 
20 Our people 
24 Environment, social and governance 
(“ESG”) 
39 Non-financial and sustainability 
information statement 
40 Engaging our stakeholders 
44 Financial review 
51 
Risk management 
55 Principal risks and uncertainties 
63 Viability statement 
Corporate governance 
66 Chair’s introduction 
67 Governance at a glance 
68 Board of Directors 
70 Corporate governance report 
78 Report of the Nomination Committee 
82 Report of the Audit and Risk 
Committee 
88 Report of the ESG Committee 
90 Directors’ remuneration report 
101 Annual report on remuneration 
112 Report of the Directors 
115 Statement of Directors’ 
responsibilities in respect 
of the financial statements 
Financial statements 
117 Independent auditors’ report 
124 Consolidated statement of 
comprehensive income 
125 Consolidated balance sheet 
126 Consolidated statement of 
changes in equity 
127 Consolidated statement 
of cash flows 
128 Notes forming part of the 
consolidated financial statements 
180 Company balance sheet 
181 Company statement of changes 
in equity 
182 Company statement of cash flows 
183 Notes forming part of the Company 
financial statements 
193 Alternative performance measures 
194 Glossary 
197 Shareholder information 
198 Company information 
The Strategic report was approved by the Board on 06 March 2025. 
Lisa Jacobs 
Chief Executive Officer
STRATEGIC REPORT
01
Funding Circle Holdings plc | Annual Report and Accounts 2024
CORPORATE GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

Chair’s statement 
A remarkable 
year of evolution, 
and serving 
more SMEs
 
 
Andrew Learoyd 
Chair 
“
2024 was a remarkable year 
for Funding Circle, a year of major 
decisions and change. I feel more 
confident about Funding Circle’s 
future than ever before.”
corporate.fundingcircle.com 
Review of the year 
2024 was a remarkable year, a year of major decisions 
and change. 
In last year’s report I wrote about our decision to seek 
an exit of our US business which we had owned and 
developed almost since start-up. This was a hard 
decision made after we won the licence to distribute SBA 
loans in 2023. We received several approaches for the 
business and, following the Board decision to proceed, 
the team executed a seamless sale despite our emotional 
connection to all the team and all we had achieved 
in the US. 
Over a period of years, we had invested heavily in 
talent, having built expected economic recovery into 
our budgets. However by the end of 2023 we stopped 
building in such recovery in our budget process. The 
decision to press ahead with cost reductions during 
2024 was another hard but necessary decision. I am 
pleased that this was done fairly and properly with 
a significant reduction in our cost base but a culture 
largely unscathed. 
These two major decisions were also driven by a 
prioritisation of shareholder value. In 2023, I referenced 
the value of the operational and financial leverage in our 
business model, “we can hope and expect that the share 
price will reflect that value in due course”, I wrote. It is at 
last pleasing that Funding Circle Holdings was one of the 
best performing shares in the UK market in 2024.
STRATEGIC REPORT
CORPORATE GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
Funding Circle Holdings plc | Annual Report and Accounts 2024
02

Strategy 
In 2022, we began our strategic pivot from a single 
to a wider product offering, and in 2024 we completed 
the shift to a single geography focus. We now offer UK 
SMEs more ways to borrow, pay later and spend and 
we will continue to bring more flexibility and value to our 
existing customers and also say “yes” to a broader range 
of customers. 
While the Board has made a conscious decision to 
demonstrate the underlying profitability of our core 
business, we do not want to do this at the expense of 
growth. New products require research, development and 
investment and we will use our balance sheet strength 
and cash generative core business to fuel the longer-
term growth. FlexiPay is a good demonstration of how 
much growth we can deliver with this strategy and since 
launching in 2022, FlexiPay is now facilitating almost 
£45 million payments per month. Our newly launched 
Cashback Business Credit Card (“Cashback credit 
card”) is next, and we have high hopes this will drive 
further growth. 
Board and people 
Last March, I said there would be changes to the Board 
over the year as some of our Non-Executive Directors 
were nearing the end of their tenure, and that we would 
use this opportunity to ensure we have the right size 
and composition of Board for our revised strategy. In 
May 2024, our Risk and Compliance Committee Chair, 
Eric Daniels stepped down after almost eight years on 
the Board. In October 2024, founder Samir Desai CBE 
stepped down from the Board as he was coming to the 
end of his three years as a Non-Executive Director, and 
Matthew King recently retired from the Group Board 
having spent many years chairing the Board of our 
regulated subsidiary. We also announced in May 2024 
that CFO Oliver White would stand down at the end 
of the year. 
To our departing Directors, I give thanks for your 
commitment, your support and for leaving Funding Circle 
in the strong position it is in today. Samir, especially to 
you, none of this would have been possible without you 
and your co-founders. 
The Nomination Committee had much to do in 2024 and 
the work is ongoing. We appointed Tony Nicol as CFO and 
Ken Stannard has joined as Non-Executive Director and 
Chair Designate to replace me following the AGM in May 
2025. We plan to appoint at least two new Non-Executive 
Directors in the coming months. 
In Tony Nicol we have a trusted colleague who 
understands our business intimately. We are excited to 
have Ken Stannard join us, together with the additional 
Non-Executive Director hires that we are seeking, we will 
have a new Board replete with the skills and experience 
to drive Funding Circle forward as the champion of SMEs 
in the UK. 
Introducing our new Chair 
Excited to be joining Funding 
Circle on its next chapter 
I am delighted to join Funding Circle as the 
Independent Non-Executive Director and Chair 
Designate. In 2025 and beyond, I look forward to 
working with the Board, the executive team and 
Circlers to drive forward the Group’s strategy and 
ensuring that it continues to create significant 
value for all stakeholders. 
Assuming the role of Chair Designate is a 
significant responsibility. However, with over three 
decades of experience and expertise in credit, 
lending, and payments, I am eager to contribute 
and continue bringing the Company’s vision to 
life, and ensuring more small businesses get the 
funding they need to win. 
I look forward to my election to the Board and role 
of Chair at the Annual General Meeting in May 2025, 
where our shareholders will have the opportunity to 
ask me and the Board about our vision. 
I am confident that 2025 will be a year of 
excitement and opportunity for Funding Circle 
to grow and maintain its position in the market. 
Ken Stannard 
Chair Designate
STRATEGIC REPORT
CORPORATE GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
Funding Circle Holdings plc | Annual Report and Accounts 2024
03

Board and people continued
While 2024 has been a year of great successes, some 
of the changes have been difficult for our Circlers such 
as the sale of the US business, and the restructuring in 
the UK. I pay full respect to the whole team who have 
together delivered an exceptional year of growth with 
almost no blip in the culture that defines Funding Circle. 
The future 
With my final report to shareholders, I feel more confident 
about Funding Circle’s future than ever before. No longer 
“unproven through the cycle”, the attractive financial 
model and cash generation of our core business will 
become obvious, while our newer products will provide 
the turbo charge to growth. 
Our new strategic direction has given us a more simplified 
focus, but a wider product offering also raises challenges 
that we have not previously faced. For example, it has 
dramatically increased the velocity and frequency of our 
customer interactions and the need for us to offer the 
right product with the simplest messaging. Having spent 
many years offering a single product, we will need to 
offer a different and improved customer experience in the 
future. We need to be best in class to ensure that SMEs 
come to us and stay with us for an increasing number of 
their financial needs. 
As part of this process, there are skills we need to learn 
and resources to hire. We have recently set up a team of 
AI experts who will harness the technology to support 
this. For many years, we have used machine learning 
to develop the market leading SME credit technology. 
Adding AI will allow us to become the go-to supplier of 
financial products for the vast army of SMEs that are the 
bedrock of the British economy. 
Thank you 
Our journey since 2010 has not always been easy. The 
sector that we helped to create, peer-to-peer finance, 
is said no longer to exist, but here we are with much the 
same platform-based model that we started with. We 
have faced a series of economic and political headwinds, 
but we have faced these challenges with great purpose, 
based on a mission that has always remained constant, to 
support SMEs with the funding they need to win. 
“
It has been an honour, 
a privilege and a pleasure 
to serve on the Board of 
Funding Circle for the 
nearly 15 years since it 
was founded.” 
With that mission, there have been some extraordinary 
achievements. We knew the demand from SME borrowers 
would be there, but how could we ensure there would 
always be a steady supply of investor lending. We have 
proven after 14 successive years delivering positive net 
returns for institutional investors on our platform that we 
have indeed invented a new asset class. An asset class 
that has been endorsed by the Bank of England, which 
recently approved our securitised loans as eligible bonds 
for collateral. 
It is an asset class which feeds capital and jobs to the 
real economy, and we have secured a market position 
that is so important to that asset class that when the 
State needed to provide government-guaranteed loans 
to British businesses, we became a significant part of 
the British Business Bank’s programme. I once told a 
shareholder that I would not leave Funding Circle until 
we were regarded as essential to the health and funding 
of a large swathe of SMEs in the UK economy. I believe 
that Funding Circle is now in that position, I truly believe 
that with Funding Circle around, British business is in a 
better place! 
It has been an honour, a privilege and a pleasure to serve 
on the Board of Funding Circle for the 15 years since it 
was founded, and I wish all who will now take it forward 
great fulfilment, success and fun. 
Andrew Learoyd 
Chair 
6 March 2025
Chair’s statement continued
STRATEGIC REPORT
CORPORATE GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
Funding Circle Holdings plc | Annual Report and Accounts 2024
04

Chief Executive Officer’s statement  
A year of change 
and significant 
progress
 
Lisa Jacobs 
Chief Executive Officer 
“
We provide the fuel to power 
SMEs up and down the country. 
We enable these entrepreneurs to 
build great businesses that create 
jobs, bring economic growth and 
support their communities.” 
corporate.fundingcircle.com 
2024 was a successful year of change and transformation 
as we executed against our plan to deliver a simpler, 
leaner business. 
I am proud of the progress we have made. We have 
delivered strong revenue growth and profitability ahead 
of market expectations. Our business is in a strong 
position as the market leader in online SME lending. We 
have leveraged our data and technology strengths to 
expand our product set to serve more of our customers’ 
needs. We have delivered robust, attractive loan returns 
to our institutional investors through the cycle. We have 
an attractive go forward plan, driving sustained revenue 
growth and expanding our margins. 
Borrow, Pay Later and Spend: Our multi-product 
transformation 
Three years ago, when I stepped into the CEO role, I set 
an ambition to be a multi-product business, one that 
enabled businesses to not only borrow for the longer 
term, but to also pay later and spend, becoming a more 
important part of our customers’ lives and providing further 
growth opportunities. Over the last three years, we have 
delivered against this plan. Today, businesses can borrow 
with our Term Loan, for longer term investment; pay later, 
managing their cash flow through FlexiPay; or spend on 
our Cashback credit card. 
This shift is reaping strong rewards for our business. First, 
we have seen strong growth. In 2024, more than a quarter 
of our credit extended was via FlexiPay and FlexiPay 
revenue grew threefold. Secondly, we are seeing an 
increase in our share of our customers’ financing as over 
70% of FlexiPay revenue came from existing Term Loan 
customers. Finally, we have increased our interactions 
and engagement with our customers. Three years ago, 
we interacted with a customer approximately every half an 
hour, today we interact with a customer every 92 seconds 
as they take a loan, FlexiPay a supplier or spend on their 
Cashback credit card. 
STRATEGIC REPORT
CORPORATE GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
Funding Circle Holdings plc | Annual Report and Accounts 2024
05

Our competitive advantage: data and technology 
at the heart of everything we do 
We’ve delivered this by leveraging our credit, data 
and technology advantage, delivering the same great 
customer experience. SMEs want fast, easy access to 
credit. We provide that with a six minute application form, 
an instant decision for 77% of applicants and funding in 
businesses’ accounts in as little as 24 hours. This drives 
strong customer satisfaction with an NPS of 79 and 
enables our busy customers to get back to what they 
do best, running their business. 
Our AI powered risk models are trained with data 
from public sources alongside proprietary data on our 
hundreds of thousands of loans and transactions and are 
three times better at discriminating risk than the bureau 
scores alone. Despite the challenging macroeconomic 
environment of the last several years, our business 
has delivered well through the cycle. Loan returns have 
been robust and attractive, attracting further institutional 
investor demand and we have continued to attract and 
serve SME demand. 
Fuelling the nation’s SMEs 
We’re passionate about our mission. We provide the 
fuel to power SMEs up and down the country. We enable 
these entrepreneurs to build great businesses that 
create jobs, bring economic growth and support their 
communities. They are not the high growth venture-
backed rocket ships, but they are the backbone of 
the economy – the florists, the manufacturers, the 
restaurateurs, the builders and countless others. 
They have a huge impact on the economy, but they 
have historically been underserved. For the last 
15 years, we have been changing that with fast, 
easy finance that backs small businesses. 
As we continue to back these businesses, we’re 
also backing the economy. In 2024, lending through 
Funding Circle supported over 87,000 jobs, £7.2 billion 
in GDP contribution and £2 billion in tax receipts. We 
lent to businesses in every one of the country’s 650 
constituencies. That is pretty remarkable and I am 
reminded of the impact we have whenever I meet 
one of our borrowers and hear their stories. This year, 
I have had the pleasure of meeting Tina from the French 
bakery, Croissant D’Or, and Debi from the flooring 
business, Springfield Carpets, in Leeds; and husband 
and wife team, Brian and Kerry, from Powderhall Bronze, 
an Edinburgh based foundry, fine art producer and 
gallery. They each have wonderful stories of running 
and building their businesses with plenty of ups and 
downs. It’s a privilege to know that our loans have 
been part of those journeys. 
2024: a simpler, leaner, high growth, profitable 
business 
In 2024, we executed well. We delivered £3.4 million 
in PBT, above market expectations and up from a loss 
of £9.9 million in 2023. Revenue grew by 23% to £160 
million. Alongside this, our credit extended grew 47% to 
£1.9 billion. We have a strong balance sheet and despite 
£33.7 million of share buybacks in 2024, we finished 
the year with a healthy unrestricted cash position of 
£151 million. 
Our core Term Loans business grew strongly with 
33% origination growth, reaching £19 million in PBT, a 
margin of 13.3% as we attracted more businesses and 
enhanced our product offering, launching government-
backed Growth Guarantee Scheme loans and a broader 
Marketplace offering. 
FlexiPay, our pay later proposition, continued to show 
strong growth with revenue tripling over the course of the 
year. Businesses have now FlexiPaid more than 280,000 
times. When we launched FlexiPay, we had a hypothesis 
that this would be a product that would attract both 
existing and new to Funding Circle customers, and I am 
pleased to say that this is the case, with approximately 30% of our 
2024 FlexiPay revenue from new customers. We continue 
to see strong usage from existing FlexiPay customers, 
once a customer starts using FlexiPay it becomes part 
of their day-to-day cash flow management tools. In 
2024, over 70% of revenue was from customers who had 
opened their FlexiPay account before 2024. In H2 2024, 
we launched our Cashback credit card, completing our 
“borrow, pay later and spend” proposition. It is still early 
days for our credit card but initial metrics are in line with 
our expectations and we look forward to seeing further 
growth in 2025 and beyond. 
2024 was a year of change and progress as we executed 
against our plan of delivering a simpler, leaner business. 
I am proud of the progress we have made, delivering 
strong growth, expanding our product set and delivering 
profit ahead of market expectations. 
We executed the plan I laid out to be a simpler, leaner 
business. We sold the US business in July for a gain on sale 
of £10 million and restructured the UK business, to deliver 
£15 million in annualised cost savings from 2025. These 
were not easy decisions to make. We said goodbye to some 
talented Circlers who were vital in our business’s journey. 
However, these decisions were essential to position us for 
long term success, and they have placed the business in a 
strong position to deliver against our medium-term plan with 
continued growth and profitability trajectory. 
“
Over the last three years, 
we have transformed our 
business. We see a future 
where Funding Circle is at the 
heart of SMEs’ financial lives.”
Chief Executive Officer’s statement continued
STRATEGIC REPORT
CORPORATE GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
Funding Circle Holdings plc | Annual Report and Accounts 2024
06

People & culture 
Our performance this year is down to the hard work of 
our Circlers. We are a technology business, but we are 
also a people business, driven by the passion, innovation 
and delivery of our team. I want to thank them all for 
their dedication and commitment to helping SMEs thrive. 
Our culture is something that we nurture and celebrate. 
We pride ourselves on being a great place to work and 
develop careers. In 2024, we have held various team 
events and socials, including our first ever CircleIN. Our 
Circler groups have been active and we have had an 
office refresh to upgrade the space, foster collaboration 
and work seamlessly for a hybrid working environment. 
We were delighted to be awarded the Transformation of 
the Year at the PLC Awards in recognition of the changes 
we have made and the team’s strong execution. 
I would like to thank Oliver White, our departing CFO, who 
has had a significant impact in his four years at Funding 
Circle, and our departing Board members, particularly 
Samir Desai and Andrew Learoyd, whose leadership 
and vision have built this business from the start. I am 
delighted to have Tony Nicol step into the CFO role, after 
six years at Funding Circle, and Ken Stannard bringing 
his vast experience and energy as he steps into the 
Chair role. 
Looking ahead 
2024 was a strong year, but I believe the best is yet to 
come. The market opportunity is vast, with over £80 billion 
in SME loans outstanding, over £1 trillion in SME B2B 
payments and over £80 billion in SME card transactions. 
We are in a strong position to capitalise on this opportunity 
with high customer satisfaction rates driven by proprietary 
and defensible data and technology advantages. 
Our four strategic priorities are focused on profitable, 
customer-led growth: 
• Get to Yes: continuing credit innovation and 
product enhancements will enable us to get to yes for 
more businesses as we bring the right product to the 
right customer. 
• Expand our audience: expanding our audience 
by targeting new segments with our newer 
products whilst also deepening and expanding 
our distribution channels. 
• Scale our product offering: scaling our products 
and adding new features, capitalising on the 
significant market opportunity to drive growth 
and margin expansion. 
• Build a seamless lifetime customer experience: 
delivering an exceptional experience throughout our 
customers’ journey as their trusted financial partner. 
We have a strong, mission-driven team, a clear vision and 
plan. As we execute this plan, we’ll become an even more 
integral part of our customers’ lives, fuelling the success 
stories of hundreds of thousands more businesses and 
creating countless jobs. We see a future where Funding 
Circle is at the heart of SMEs’ financial lives, providing the 
tools and resources they need to thrive. 
Lisa Jacobs 
Chief Executive Officer 
6 March 2025 
Key actions 
from 2024. 
Simpler 
Sold US business for 
a gain on sale of £10 million 
In July, we sold our US business to iBusiness 
Funding for a gain on sale of £10 million in order 
to focus on nearer term profitability and cash 
generation in the UK. 
Leaner 
Restructuring announced 
to deliver an annualised 
benefit of approximately £15 million in 2025 
In May, we announced a restructuring 
programme to reduce our total head count 
by c.120, delivering an annualised benefit 
of c.£15 million in 2025. This focused on 
management layers, business prioritisation 
and productivity, supported by GenAI tools. 
Profitable 
Delivered PBT margins of 
13.3%, in line with profit 
guidance 
The actions that we have progressed this year 
have meant that the business has delivered 
£3.4 million PBT, following an upgrade to our 
profit guidance in September. In our more 
mature Term Loans business, we delivered PBT 
margins of 13.3%.
STRATEGIC REPORT
CORPORATE GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
Funding Circle Holdings plc | Annual Report and Accounts 2024
07

Our business model 
We’re proud of our impact in powering the nation’s SMEs, which supports jobs and 
economic and community prosperity. Small businesses are the backbone of the 
economy. Since 2010 we have been fuelling small businesses with the funding they 
need using our data and technology advantage to drive a superior, fast and hassle-free 
customer experience. 
Our capital light model enables scale and growth whilst our superior risk and analytic 
capabilities deliver robust and attractive returns for institutional investors. 
Our addressable 
market  
£84bn
 
addressable SME 
loans market
 
1 
£1.3trn
 
SME B2B 
payments
 
2 
£80bn 
SME card 
transactions
 
2 
1. Funding Circle addressable market research July 2022 
2. Visa SME market sizing July 2022 
Our 
customers 
Small business 
borrowers 
• Access to affordable finance 
• Fast, convenient applications 
• Instant automated decisions for 77% of applications 
• Superior customer experience with a 79 Group 
Net Promoter Score 
Our business model
Institutional 
investors 
• Access to hard-to-reach asset class at scale with 
diversified loan book 
• Robust and attractive returns 
• Forward flow agreements with £2.1 billion future 
funding in place 
STRATEGIC REPORT
Funding Circle Holdings plc | Annual Report and Accounts 2024
08
CORPORATE GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

For details on how we generate revenue, see page 46 
Our competitive 
advantage 
Superior customer 
experience 
79
 
NPS 
4.6
 
Trustpilot 
Data and technology 
advantage 
3 times 
better risk 
discrimination 
 
77% 
instant 
decisions 
 
Wide product suite 
More detail on page 16 
The value 
we create 
>111,000
 
small businesses 
supported 
£7.2bn
 
contribution to GDP 
87,000+
 
jobs supported 
approximately 5% 
annualised returns to 
institutional investors 
171 
Impact Days taken in 
2024
Borrow
Spend
Pay later
STRATEGIC REPORT
09
Funding Circle Holdings plc | Annual Report and Accounts 2024
CORPORATE GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

Our strategy 
We delivered against 
our ambitious strategy in 2024 
Our strategic pillars
How we delivered in 2024 
1
 
Attract more 
businesses 
Our product expansion and growth 
have enabled us to increase 
applications, open up new 
marketing channels and attract a 
broader set of businesses. 
In addition to our product evolution, 
we have continued to invest in our 
brand with our second and third 
season sponsoring Premiership 
Rugby. We expanded our sponsorship 
by welcoming Jamie George, England 
Captain and Funding Circle borrower, 
as our brand ambassador. 
Along with our regular marketing 
channels, the sponsorship has 
driven increased brand visibility and 
helped us reach an even wider pool 
of customers. Our Season 2 content 
series amassed 43 million views 
across online media platforms and 
11 million in print and radio, driving 
increased spontaneous brand 
awareness and brand consideration. 
2 
Say yes to more 
businesses 
In 2024 we grew our credit 
extended by 47%. 
Throughout the course of the year, we 
continued to use our credit analytics 
and product innovation capabilities to 
say yes to more businesses. 
In July 2024, we launched 
our lending under the Growth 
Guarantee Scheme, expanding 
our offering to a new segment of 
SME borrowers. 
Through Marketplace, we expanded 
the number of partners we work 
with and the products we provide so 
we can say yes to businesses even 
if we don’t have a Funding Circle 
product to meet their needs. Our 
Marketplace now accounts for ~11% 
of our loan originations, an increase 
of 1% in 2023, enabling us to deliver 
a great outcome for our SME 
customers and further monetise our 
distribution capabilities. 
3 
#1 in new 
products 
We have continued to expand and 
diversify our Funding Circle product 
offering, scaling our FlexiPay pay 
later product and launching our 
Cashback credit card. In doing so, 
we have expanded the ways we can 
serve customers and increased our 
share of wallet with our customers, 
whilst leveraging our strengths in 
credit, data and distribution. 
We have enhanced our FlexiPay 
offering, adding new product 
features throughout the year, 
including enabling businesses to 
buy now and pay later in 1, 3, 6, 9 or 
12 months. FlexiPay revenue grew 
by 3.4 times in 2024. 
In Q3 2024, we launched our 
Cashback credit card, initially in 
beta. This enables us to attract 
a broader set of customers, and 
interact with them on a daily basis. 
See our KPIs on page 12
STRATEGIC REPORT
CORPORATE GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
Funding Circle Holdings plc | Annual Report and Accounts 2024
10

Evolution of our 
strategic framework 
 
Over the course of the last three years, we have transformed our business offering 
from a single product to one that enables businesses to borrow, pay later and spend. 
We now have deeper relationships with customers as we meet more of their needs and 
have increased our interaction with them from every few years to every few days. 
As we continue to scale our business, our evolved strategic framework is focused on 
customer-centric profitable growth. 
Get to ‘Yesʼ 
When our customers win, we win. We will leverage 
our credit and product innovation capabilities to 
enhance our products and open new segments to 
serve a broad customer base. 
Expand our audience 
Enhanced product offerings to new customer 
segments through new marketing channels will 
expand our audience, attracting more businesses to 
Funding Circle. 
Scale our product offering 
Our product suite is wide and meets most of the 
needs of our customers, but some products are 
nascent whilst the market opportunity is large. Over 
the coming years, we will scale our newer products, 
innovating and unlocking new product features to 
drive profitable growth. 
Deliver a seamless lifetime 
customer experience 
Our customers have a broad range of finance needs 
and we now have the right products to meet them. 
Through our broader product set we will deliver a 
great lifetime customer experience serving them 
with our renowned superior customer experience 
and the right product at the right time.
STRATEGIC REPORT
CORPORATE GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
Funding Circle Holdings plc | Annual Report and Accounts 2024
11

Key performance indicators 
How we measure our performance  
Financial 
Net income (£m) 
£160.1m 
2024
160.1 
2023
130.1 
2022
119.5 
Definition 
The Group generates net income 
principally from: transaction fees earned 
from originating loans with borrowers; 
servicing fees from servicing of loans 
under management; interest income 
from FlexiPay and cash balances; and 
investment income net of investment 
expense and after fair value gains/
(losses) and cost of funds. 
 
Links to strategy: 
Profit/(loss) before tax (£m) 
(before exceptional items) 
£3.4m 
2024
3.4 
2023
(9.9) 
2022
(3.1) 
Definition 
Profit/(loss) before tax is defined as 
net income after taking into account 
all operating expenses and finance 
income, costs and share of (loss)/profit 
of associates. It is presented above 
before the impact of exceptional items. 
Links to strategy: 
Basic earnings/(loss) per share (p) 
(before exceptional items) 
0.8p 
2024
0.8 
2023
(2.4) 
2022
(0.9) 
Definition 
Basic earnings/(loss) per share is 
defined as the profit/(loss) for the year 
attributable to ordinary equity holders 
of the Parent Company divided by the 
weighted average number of ordinary 
shares in issue during the year. It is 
presented above before the impact of 
exceptional items. 
1  2  3
1  2  3
Links to strategy: 
1  2  3
Operational 
Originations (£m) 
Term Loans originations 
£1,407m 
2024
1,407 
2023
1,060 
2022
1,095 
FlexiPay transactions 
£492m 
2024
492 
2023
234 
2022
59 
Definition 
This represents the monetary value of loans originated through the Group’s platform or 
through Marketplace referrals in any given year as well as drawdowns on the FlexiPay 
lines of credit and Cashback credit card spend. These are key drivers of transaction 
and servicing fees for the Term Loans business and the upfront fee for the FlexiPay 
business. These are presented above for continuing operations only in both the 
current and comparative periods. 
Links to strategy:
1  2  3
STRATEGIC REPORT
CORPORATE GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
Funding Circle Holdings plc | Annual Report and Accounts 2024
12

Operational continued
Balances outstanding (£m) 
Term Loans under management 
£2,714m 
2024
2,714 
2023
2,853 
2022
3,311 
End of month balances 
£119m 
2024
119 
2023
58 
2022
18 
Definition 
This represents the total value of outstanding principal of borrower loans, lines of credit and credit card balances. 
It includes amounts that are overdue but excludes loans that have defaulted and loans originated through 
Marketplace referrals to other lenders. These are presented above for continuing operations only in both the 
current and comparative periods. 
Links to strategy: 
1
2
3
Financial Alternative performance measures (“APMs”) 
Adjusted EBITDA (£m) 
£24.5m 
2024
24.5 
2023
6.7 
2022
12.6 
Definition 
Adjusted EBITDA represents the profit/(loss) for the year 
before finance costs (the discount unwind on lease liabilities), 
taxation, depreciation and amortisation, and impairment, 
and additionally excludes share-based payment charges 
and associated social security costs, foreign exchange and 
exceptional items. 
Links to strategy: 
1
2
3
Free cash flow1 (£m) 
£(1.2)m 
2024
(1.2) 
2023
(27.9) 
2022
(13.3) 
Definition 
Free cash flow represents the net cash flows from operating 
activities less the cost of purchasing intangible assets, 
property, plant and equipment, lease payments and interest 
received. It excludes the warehouse and securitisation 
financing and funding cash flows and lines of credit cash 
flows. The Directors view this as a key liquidity measure. 
1.Note 1.  Free cash flow excludes restricted cash movement due to the 
payment of guarantee fees. 
Links to strategy: 
1
2
3
Key to strategic objectives 
1  Attract more businesses
2  Say yes to more businesses
3  #1 in new products
STRATEGIC REPORT
CORPORATE GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
Funding Circle Holdings plc | Annual Report and Accounts 2024
13

Our customers
Five years after the pandemic, SMEs 
continue to show their resilience
The pandemic has fundamentally changed SME Britain, with 
92% small business owners who pivoted during Covid-19, 
making these strategic changes permanent.
£7.2bn 
contribution to GDP
>87k 
jobs supported
£2bn 
generated in tax receipts
Details of Funding 
Circle’s impact 
in 2024 can be 
found here
SMEs remain resilient and 
competitive in an evolving market
With 2025 marking five years since the pandemic, 
small businesses are more resilient than ever. The latest 
research published by Oxford Economics in partnership 
with Funding Circle in 2024 shows that over three in five 
(65%) SMEs are expecting their business to grow in 2025, 
highlighting their long-term confidence.
The pandemic accelerated digital adoption, and 
the research demonstrates that it was not just a 
temporary measure, it has fundamentally reshaped how 
SMEs operate.
SMEs are increasingly prioritising digital transformation 
and technology investment over physical expansion, 
while maintaining a strong appetite for growth. This trend 
signifies a lasting change in business strategies that 
began as a response to the Covid-19 pandemic.
Making up 99% of the business population, small 
businesses create jobs, boost the economy, and support 
local communities. In 2024, Funding Circle’s Term Loans 
and FlexiPay lending not only contributed £7.2 billion 
to the UK’s gross domestic product (“GDP”) but also 
played a pivotal role in supporting over 87,000 jobs. 
Additionally, the economic activity supported by these 
loans generated £2 billion in tax receipts.
Investing in the future
Despite macroeconomic headwinds, the findings highlight 
that SMEs are investing for the future, rather than pulling 
back. The continued prioritisation of technology investment 
and hiring suggests that businesses are focusing on 
productivity, operational efficiency, and adaptability to 
remain competitive in a post-pandemic world.
SME access to finance
To support this momentum, access to capital remains 
crucial. While SMEs are demonstrating strong resilience, 
many will require continued financial support to unlock 
growth opportunities. Ensuring that businesses have the 
right tools to fund expansion is key in shaping the next 
stage of business recovery and innovation.
Despite tougher credit conditions, the research also 
showed that Funding Circle remained committed to 
providing loans to SMEs with businesses in every one 
of the UK’s 650 parliamentary constituencies, with an 
average of £1.9 million in Term Loans per constituency.
STRATEGIC REPORT
CORPORATE GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
Funding Circle Holdings plc | Annual Report and Accounts 2024
14

Our customers’ stories, investing 
in growth and innovation
We’re proud to support businesses across the country with agile, 
competitive finance. Whether it’s long-term investment through 
a Term Loan or everyday cash flow management using FlexiPay 
or our Cashback credit card, we’re helping businesses seize 
opportunities like never before.
Building up
Constructive & Co Ltd are a team of 
makers who design, create and fit 
bespoke furniture. 
Having attracted more customers in 
their local area, they used their loan 
to invest in new machinery for their 
workshop – so they could take on the 
additional demand in house, and get 
more headspace with their cash flow. 
“
We found borrowing 
to be an essential part 
of taking us to the 
next level.”
Scan to learn more
Reaching more
Powderhall Bronze Editions, a fine 
art foundry in Edinburgh, tried to 
get a loan from their bank but found 
the process slow and painful. 
Instead, they turned to us for help, 
and really appreciated the speed 
and service. Their loans have 
since allowed them to reach more 
customers, and set up a stand at the 
Chelsea Flower Show. 
“
We’d use Funding 
Circle again and again 
thanks to the great 
service and ease.”
Scan to learn more
Looking ahead
England rugby captain Jamie George 
and his business partner Rhys Carter 
started The Carter & George Practice 
to deliver elite physiotherapy 
services to the public.
With big plans to grow, they took 
out a loan to fund acquisitions of 
other physio businesses, while using 
FlexiPay to protect their cash flow.
“
Once we’d been 
approved, the funds 
were in our account 
in 24 hours or so.”
Scan to learn more
STRATEGIC REPORT
CORPORATE GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
Funding Circle Holdings plc | Annual Report and Accounts 2024
15

Technology and data
Reinventing 
SME lending
Our cutting-edge technology and data platform is 
constantly evolving, enabling more small businesses 
to access the funding they need to win.
We combine our unique behavioural and performance data from over 
150,000 Term Loans and nearly 230,000 FlexiPay transactions with publicly 
available sources over nearly 15 years to give us a deeper understanding  
of SMEs.
Our approach to SME credit risk, using machine learning tools and approaches 
and combining public and proprietary data, gives us a competitive edge. Our 
ability to discriminate risk better than the bureau scores enables us to deliver 
superior customer outcomes and launch new products.
Learn more about 
our technology 
and data
Our performance data so far
150,000 
Term Loans
228,000 
FlexiPay transactions
Risk model evolution
Building on over ten years’ worth of data, our ninth-generation risk models outperform bureau scores by a 
factor of three. This allows us to streamline the customer journey and balance risk insights with a frictionless 
customer experience.
Open banking
Commercial Credit Data Sharing
Bank statement
Application
Financials
Internal behaviour
Consumer bureau
Commercial bureau
Gen 3 
2015
Gen 4/5 
2016
Gen 6 
2017
Gen 7 
2018
Gen 8 
2019
Gen 9 
2023
STRATEGIC REPORT
Funding Circle Holdings plc | Annual Report and Accounts 2024
16
CORPORATE GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

Our proprietary technology platform 
is designed to provide customers with 
quick and easy access to finance. 
Built-in flexibility and scale enable us 
to successfully expand our product 
range and continually improve the 
digital customer experience. Today, we 
see customers engage more frequently 
with our broader range of products.
3 times 
better risk 
discrimination 
77% 
instant 
decision 
6 min 
application time 24 hrs 
funds in account 
79 
NPS
Use of AI
AI is at the core of our lending and we are 
investing in the transformative potential of 
Generative AI (“GenAI”) to benefit both our 
customers and employees.
• We have implemented GenAI tools to enhance 
employee productivity.
• We are actively exploring further opportunities 
to streamline and improve the customer 
experience, from loan origination to ongoing 
customer service.
• In 2024, we established technical and 
governance frameworks to ensure the ethical, 
secure, and effective use of GenAI as we expand 
its applications in 2025.
2024 highlights: scalable 
platform with ongoing 
product releases
• Scalable platform managing 36% loan 
application growth.
• >100% transaction growth and 3 times growth in 
monthly active users on our app.
• Deployment of improved product features and 
customer experience such as an increase of 20% 
engineering productivity.
• Launch of Cashback credit card and Growth 
Guarantee Scheme loans.
See our Technology risk on page 62
STRATEGIC REPORT
17
Funding Circle Holdings plc | Annual Report and Accounts 2024
CORPORATE GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

Our products
Our diverse product range enables businesses to borrow, 
pay later and spend. We meet a broad range of finance 
needs through our product suite, all with our trademark 
ease, speed and instant decision technology.
Borrow
Term Loans
Loans for long-term investment or working 
capital purposes to support business growth 
or long-term cash flow management.
• Loan sizes of £10,000 to £750,000.
• Available from six months to six years.
• Amortises monthly.
• Marketplace offering for SMEs, opening 
the door to finance solutions from across 
the market.
Case studies
• ANNA Cake Couture used their 
loan to grow by expanding their 
kitchen, creating more jobs and 
opening a new office.
• Studio Gauthier used their loan 
to expand their restaurant by 
renovating and refurbishing.
Scan for 
product details
STRATEGIC REPORT
Funding Circle Holdings plc | Annual Report and Accounts 2024
18
CORPORATE GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

Pay later
FlexiPay line of credit
Flexible line of credit for paying bills, supplier invoices 
and managing cash flow using bank transfer or card.
• Businesses can pay bills directly to suppliers or into 
their bank accounts for a fixed fee.
• With flexible terms and billing, small businesses can 
repay in 1, 3, 6, 9 or 12 months.
• Credit limit up to £250,000.
Case studies
• Carter & George were able to protect their cash 
flow and do acquisitions of SMEs.
• Beauty Boutique were able to invest in medical 
machinery as the line of credit helped with their 
cash flow.
Scan for 
product details
Spend
NEW
Cashback Business 
Credit Card 
Cashback credit card for everyday 
business spending.
• Launched the Cashback credit card 
in Q3 (beta), with full roll-out in Q4, 
following customer feedback pointing 
us in the direction of a credit card for 
everyday transactions.
Scan for 
product details
STRATEGIC REPORT
19
Funding Circle Holdings plc | Annual Report and Accounts 2024
CORPORATE GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

Our people
Backing our 
people’s growth
Gender pay gap
Mean pay gap
Median pay gap 
Women in leadership
42%
25%
37.5%
43%
57%
58%
75%
62.5%
27.1%
35%
26.1%
34%
30.5%
32%
27.1%
34%
32.2%
31%
2024
2024
2023
2023
2022
2022
2021
2021
2020
2020
2024
20.4%
2023
17.4%
2022
22.4%
2021
18.5%
2020
21.4%
Female 
Male 
Gender breakdown 
(as at 31 December 2024)
All Circlers
Executive Committee
ExCo and direct reports  Note 1 
Group Board
Other metrics 
91% 
aligned to values
84% 
equal opportunities
81% 
bring their authentic self to work
51 
Circler events and initiatives
171 
Impact Days taken
1,364 
volunteering hours in 2024
Our values
Obsess over the customer
Think smart
Stand together
Live the adventure
Be open
Make it happen
1. Includes those in levels CEO negative 3
STRATEGIC REPORT
CORPORATE GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
Funding Circle Holdings plc | Annual Report and Accounts 2024
20

Our people (“Circlers”) are central to all that we do 
at Funding Circle. 2024 was a significant year for our 
business, as we undertook a number of large strategic 
changes, which tested our resilience. Thanks to the 
contributions of everyone working at Funding Circle, 
we continue to build a better, stronger business together, 
as the wider social and economic environment has 
shifted in the post-pandemic years.
As we evolve our business strategy, we have come a long 
way and made big strides under our strategic people 
core foundation, “High Performing Teams Executing 
Brilliantly”. We have continued to nurture a strong, diverse 
and unique culture underpinned by our values. We remain 
fully committed to our hybrid model, balancing flexibility 
with in-person collaboration to enable our teams to 
collaborate, be productive and develop at Funding Circle.
Backing high performance
We believe in excellence and challenging ourselves to 
set new standards. We believe it is possible to create 
an inclusive environment and a supportive culture, but 
equally one where we can challenge each other to set 
new standards and push ourselves to achieve more. 
This is the core philosophy underpinning “High Performing 
Teams Executing Brilliantly”. We continue to place a 
strong focus on developing a high performance company, 
embedding performance, ownership and accountability 
further into our culture. Sitting alongside the Company’s 
Objectives and Key Results (OKRs) framework, we have a 
well established cadence of goal setting for all Circlers, 
anchored in our business context and personal growth 
journey. Performance is assessed through an individual’s 
impact on the business on a biannual basis, alongside our 
value-based behaviours to measure how we achieve 
our goals.
Similarly, our tools and data for helping us calibrate 
how we measure performance consistently and through 
multiple lenses are applied rigorously and equitably 
across all parts of the business. Our ambition is high 
performance, and we reward those who stretch 
themselves to go further.
Looking ahead, in 2025 we will be investing further in 
resources to enhance our high performance philosophy, 
both in how we feed back to each other and how we 
recognise Circlers for their efforts. We will also be 
focusing on continuing to build our career frameworks, 
to ensure consistency of standards and progression 
pathways across teams.
Backing personal growth
We embraced a “best of both” philosophy as we emerged 
from the pandemic and entered the world of hybrid 
work. Now into our fifth year, we continue to operate a 
model which provides all Circlers with flexibility whilst 
retaining the best of what we know and love about 
working together in person. To support this, we invested 
in a 100 day refurbishment programme to redesign our 
office space in 2024. We remain fully committed to a 
flexible and hybrid approach, but we strongly believe that 
in-person collaboration is an important element to enable 
our teams to achieve more.
We continued to empower Circlers with resources to 
support their growth and development. To support 
newly promoted or hired managers at Funding Circle, 
we launched the Emerge programme. Emerge is a 
blended development offering designed to give our 
managers the tools and knowledge they need to 
successfully manage and coach for high performance. 
We also invested in our leadership with the launch of 
Elevate, a development initiative to support our senior 
leaders, enhance their leadership capabilities and further 
embed our leadership commitments.
More widely, backing growth and development remains 
a core foundation of our Circler experience. Throughout 
2024 we hosted 230 training events and 610 Circlers 
(84%) took the opportunity to further their professional 
growth. 2024 saw Funding Circle’s first Growth Week 
as part of a dedicated month-long development 
series. Anchored around the pillars of ownership, 
entrepreneurship and commercial mindset, Circlers 
engaged with live sessions and curated content to 
enhance their future performance. 
CircleIN
It is vitally important to invest in our people, their 
understanding of the business, our customers and 
our products, and their personal development. 
To reconnect Circlers and reinforce our mission, 
strategy and culture, we brought our team 
together for our first ever CircleIN event.
Hosted on site in our newly refurbished office 
space, Circlers spent an afternoon hearing from 
our leaders on our strategy, mission and evolving 
product suite, meeting our customers, and learning 
more about other parts of the business. Alongside 
this, we shared information on our development 
programmes and our Circler groups, and gave an 
opportunity for Circlers from across the business 
to connect.
STRATEGIC REPORT
CORPORATE GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
Funding Circle Holdings plc | Annual Report and Accounts 2024
21

Our people continued
Diversity, equity and inclusion 
Technology apprenticeships 
In 2024, we sponsored our third cohort of technology 
apprentices, in line with our ambition to create opportunities 
for all and our commitment to building an inclusive and 
diverse workforce. We welcome all backgrounds and 
experiences from those looking to start their career in 
technology, whether that be an early career technologist 
seeking out a training opportunity and a place to put 
their knowledge into practice, a career changer with 
significant experience in another field looking to kick-start 
their professional journey within a technical environment, 
or an existing Circler looking for an opportunity to pivot 
their career into technology and transfer their skills and 
experience to further serve our customers.
Technology apprenticeships have provided us with the 
opportunity to build stronger gender and ethnicity equity 
in our teams and create a pipeline of future female and 
ethnically diverse talent in technology. 
“
It’s amazing 
to see how far 
you’ve come 
at the end.”
Ella Bastian, Engineer 
Graduate apprentice
Q&A with Jennie Woods, VP, Engineering
Q
 What drives you to lead our Engineering 
teams at Funding Circle? 
I’m driven by the opportunity to lead diverse teams 
that build products which enable SMEs to thrive – it’s 
incredibly rewarding.
Q
 What do we do to change the under-
representation of women in technology?
We take a multi-faceted approach to increase female 
representation. We attract diverse talent through 
initiatives like our apprenticeship scheme, which 
provides an alternative route into the industry for 
people from a variety of backgrounds. We ensure 
fair hiring practices by using gender-neutral job 
descriptions, diverse interview panels, and bias 
training for interviewers. To retain female talent, 
we offer flexible work arrangements, provide 
development programmes, and foster a supportive 
environment through employee resource groups.
Q
 Why is building a female future talent 
pipeline important?
Diversity and inclusion are core to our culture. We 
believe diverse teams are more innovative, make 
better decisions, and better represent our customers. 
By fostering a supportive environment and building 
a strong female talent pipeline, we ensure continued 
innovation and success for Funding Circle.
Q
 What are the biggest successes or learnings 
you’ve seen from Funding Circle’s hiring and 
development of technology apprentices?
The programme has successfully attracted and 
developed diverse talent, fostering a more inclusive 
and innovative workplace. 
Apprenticeships have 
proven to be an effective 
way to identify and 
develop high potential 
individuals with strong 
technical skills and a 
passion for technology. Many 
apprentices have gone on to have 
successful careers within Funding Circle.
Recognising the importance of continuous 
improvement, we have introduced the Apprentice 
Academy to provide dedicated mentorship and 
ongoing support for apprentices throughout 
their journey.
Q
 What initiatives in technology have helped 
ensure there is time available for ongoing 
professional development?
Last year, our Engineering team achieved a notable 
increase in its productivity. A key contributor to this 
success was the implementation of an AI Copilot. By 
automating low complexity tasks, the Copilot empowers 
engineers to concentrate on higher value business 
challenges supporting their continued development.
This tool has proven particularly beneficial 
for entry-level engineers, including apprentices. 
They receive real-time code feedback and 
explanations, facilitating a smoother onboarding 
process and accelerating their professional growth. 
These insights help them understand existing code 
and improve their coding skills.
STRATEGIC REPORT
CORPORATE GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
Funding Circle Holdings plc | Annual Report and Accounts 2024
22

Of our technology apprenticeship cohorts:
85% 
identify as 
female
69% 
are of Black, 
Asian or multiple 
ethnicity heritage
23–52 
age range
We have created a robust framework for the development 
and support of apprentices in our technical teams making 
the required time, resource and training available to 
ensure successful completion of their apprenticeship, 
and that they are set up for success in their onward 
career. To date, 100% of apprentice Circlers have 
received a distinction grade in their formal qualification, 
the highest available level, and have proven to be able to 
operate above the expected level at time of completion.
Circler-led groups
Our Circler-led groups remain at the forefront of our 
culture as a driving force for positive change. Across our 
six Circler-led groups there were events and initiatives in 
2024, with highlights including 1,364 volunteering hours 
taken. Circlers are given two paid “Impact Days” per year 
for charitable contributions to causes important to them. 
Women @ FC 
• Building a community where women connect, 
thrive and win. 
Parents @ FC 
• Providing a supportive space and a network for 
working parents and carers.
Neurodiversity @ FC 
• Spearheading the discussion about how neurological 
differences add value, and building the infrastructure 
for an equitable and accessible workplace. 
Let’s Talk About Heritage 
• Educating on the experiences of minorities, celebrating 
racial diversity, and creating a safe space to continue 
engaging in dialogue. 
FC Impact 
• Coming together and giving back to communities in 
need, raising awareness for worthy causes, and making 
an impact through charity and volunteering projects.
Circle of Pride
• Championing inclusion for all by building an open 
community and celebrating LGBTQIA+ contributions. 
Awards in 2024
• Luke Santon – recognised as one of LGBT’s 
Great 2024 30 Under 30 Role Model.
• Kate Turgoose – named in Innovate Finance’s 
Pride in FinTech Powerlist.
• Antje Bustamante Mena – won HotTopic’s Global 
CDO 100 Award.
To further champion flexible working in support of the 
wellbeing of our Circlers, we joined Working Families, 
a charity for parents and carers. We have worked with 
the charity to advance our policies and practices to 
better recognise and empower our Circlers to achieve 
their full potential alongside their parenting and caring 
responsibilities. We continue to drive a culture of 
productivity that embraces individual and personal needs. 
Each year we run reverse mentoring initiatives and we 
focused on neurodiversity in 2024. Circlers volunteered 
throughout Q4 to reverse mentor managers on 
neurodiversity to further bolster our manager population 
in its ability to manage neurodivergent individuals and 
educate our individual contributors on the importance of 
making the necessary accommodations when working 
with neurodivergent teammates. We launched several 
other mentorship schemes and have established a 
certification programme. Currently we have 52 internally 
certified mentors across departments and of varying 
seniority whose experience can be called upon. The 
Mentoring in Tech (“MinT”) scheme, a programme 
connecting women and gender minorities in technology 
with mentors across Funding Circle, specifically aims to 
support female Circlers in achieving their individual goals.
Diversity, equity and inclusion (“DEI”) statement
Our recruitment process is designed to ensure 
all applications, including those from disabled 
persons, are treated equally and fairly.
We’re here to build the incredible at Funding 
Circle. We know we can only achieve this through 
an inclusive and diverse culture where Circlers 
of all backgrounds feel confident in bringing their 
whole selves to work, where they can contribute 
their ideas, have opportunities to be successful, 
and have their talents nurtured. Through 
empowering our people we are not only building 
something incredible for our customers, but an 
incredible place to work too. 
We live by our Company values and cherish 
our diversity; be that culture, gender, race or 
ethnicity, sexual orientation, 
gender identity and expression, 
disability, marital status, age, 
nationality, religion, of thought, 
belief, experience or expression. 
We stand together, as one.
STRATEGIC REPORT
CORPORATE GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
Funding Circle Holdings plc | Annual Report and Accounts 2024
23
85%
identify as 
female
Of our technology apprenticeship cohorts:
69%
are of Black, 
Asian or multiple 
ethnicity heritage
23–52
age range
We have created a robust framework for the development 
and support of apprentices in our technical teams making 
the required time, resource and training available to 
ensure successful completion of their apprenticeship, 
and that they are set up for success in their onward 
career. To date, 100% of apprentice Circlers have 
received a distinction grade in their formal qualification, 
the highest available level, and have proven to be able to 
operate above the expected level at time of completion.
Circler-led groups
Our Circler-led groups remain at the forefront of our 
culture as a driving force for positive change. Across our 
six Circler-led groups there were events and initiatives in 
2024, with highlights including 1,364 volunteering hours 
taken. Circlers are given two paid “Impact Days” per year 
for charitable contributions to causes important to them. 
Women @ FC 
 
• Building a community where women connect, 
thrive and win. 
Parents @ FC 
 
• Providing a supportive space and a network for 
working parents and carers.
Neurodiversity @ FC 
 
• Spearheading the discussion about how neurological 
differences add value, and building the infrastructure 
for an equitable and accessible workplace. 
Let’s Talk About Heritage 
 
• Educating on the experiences of minorities, celebrating 
racial diversity, and creating a safe space to continue 
engaging in dialogue. 
FC Impact 
 
• Coming together and giving back to communities in 
need, raising awareness for worthy causes, and making 
an impact through charity and volunteering projects.
Circle of Pride
 
• Championing inclusion for all by building an open 
community and celebrating LGBTQIA+ contributions. 
To further champion flexible working in support of the 
wellbeing of our Circlers, we joined Working Families, 
a charity for parents and carers. We have worked with 
the charity to advance our policies and practices to 
better recognise and empower our Circlers to achieve 
their full potential alongside their parenting and caring 
responsibilities. We continue to drive a culture of 
productivity that embraces individual and personal needs. 
Each year we run reverse mentoring initiatives and we 
focused on neurodiversity in 2024. Circlers volunteered 
throughout Q4 to reverse mentor managers on 
neurodiversity to further bolster our manager population 
in its ability to manage neurodivergent individuals and 
educate our individual contributors on the importance of 
making the necessary accommodations when working 
with neurodivergent teammates. We launched several 
other mentorship schemes and have established a 
certification programme. Currently we have 52 internally 
certified mentors across departments and of varying 
seniority whose experience can be called upon. The 
Mentoring in Tech (“MinT”) scheme, a programme 
connecting women and gender minorities in technology 
with mentors across Funding Circle, specifically aims to 
support female Circlers in achieving their individual goals.
Diversity, equity and inclusion (“DEI”) statement
Our recruitment process is designed to ensure 
all applications, including those from disabled 
persons, are treated equally and fairly.
We’re here to build the incredible at Funding 
Circle. We know we can only achieve this through 
an inclusive and diverse culture where Circlers 
of all backgrounds feel confident in bringing their 
whole selves to work, where they can contribute 
their ideas, have opportunities to be successful, 
and have their talents nurtured. Through 
empowering our people we are not only building 
something incredible for our customers, but an 
incredible place to work too. 
We live by our Company values and cherish 
our diversity; be that culture, gender, race or 
ethnicity, sexual orientation, 
gender identity and expression, 
disability, marital status, age, 
nationality, religion, of thought, 
belief, experience or expression. 
We stand together, as one.
Awards in 2024
 
• Luke Santon – recognised as one of LGBT’s 
Great 2024 30 Under 30 Role Model.
 
• Kate Turgoose – named in Innovate Finance’s 
Pride in FinTech Powerlist.
 
• Antje Bustamante Mena – won HotTopic’s Global 
CDO 100 Award.
STRATEGIC REPORT
CORPORATE GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
Funding Circle Holdings plc | Annual Report and Accounts 2024
23

Environment, social and governance (“ESG”)
Delivering on our 
commitments
At Funding Circle we are committed to contributing positively to our 
communities; we do this through the business finance we provide 
to our SME customers who are often underserved by mainstream 
finance, and through sound and responsible ESG practices that 
support broader societal and environmental efforts. 
Our approach to ESG considers relevant risks and 
opportunities, and is informed by our engagement 
with our strategic stakeholders. For more detail on 
corporate governance and risk management, and our 
climate-related disclosures, please refer to the sections 
referenced below.
• More detail on corporate governance is set 
out on page 70
• More detail on risk management is set out 
on page 51
• Our Non-Financial and Sustainability Information 
Statement is set out on page 39
• Our climate disclosures consistent with the 
Task Force on Climate-related Financial 
Disclosures (“TCFD”) are set out on pages 28 to 38
Relevant policies 
can be found on 
the Company’s 
Sustainability 
webpage
STRATEGIC REPORT
CORPORATE GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
Funding Circle Holdings plc | Annual Report and Accounts 2024
24

Our ESG framework sets out our goals and 
roadmap for each strategic pillar
DEI
Our ambition and 
commitment
To be best in class and 
live by our DEI statement, 
building an inclusive and 
diverse culture.
Achievements in 2024
• Stable key metrics in 2024, with 
continued strong sentiment for inclusion 
and belonging expressed in our 2024 
engagement survey. 
• Delivery of all-Company CircleIN internal 
event, celebrating our culture and 
spotlighting Circler-led groups, alongside 
a knowledge-sharing networking event 
to celebrate inclusivity and diversity, led 
and delivered by employee groups across 
the business. 
• Delivery of 51 Circler group initiatives over 
the course of 2024, including the MinT 
scheme by Women@FC, and representing 
Funding Circle at the annual London 
Pride celebrations. 
• Partnered with Working Families, the 
UK’s national charity for working parents 
and carers.
Goals and roadmap for 2025
• Continue to make progress against key DEI 
metrics and targets, including women in 
leadership and the gender pay gap.
• In Q1 2025, we plan to undertake a review 
of our approach, plan and goals for DEI, to 
ensure we continue to focus on building a 
diverse and inclusive culture. 
For more please see the 
Our People section on page 20
Social impact
Our ambition and 
commitment
To back a diverse and 
thriving SME customer base 
– creating jobs, fostering 
financial inclusion and having 
a positive impact on UK 
SMEs, entrepreneurs and 
their wider communities.
Achievements in 2024
• As outlined in Our Customers on page 14, our 
lending supported 87,500 jobs, £7.2 billion in 
GDP, and helped businesses in every one 
of the 650 parliamentary constituencies.
• We renewed our partnership with Thrive 
Mental Wellbeing, providing free or 
discounted access to its NHS-trusted 
mental health app to all SMEs in the UK.
• We continued to back underserved social 
entrepreneurs through our partnership 
with Hatch Enterprise for a third year, also 
supporting 72 founders through 93 volunteer 
hours of employee mentoring. 
• Our Circlers contributed 171 “Impact 
Days”, 1364 hours, volunteering with 
environmental and people charities 
including NishkamSWAT, Hatch Enterprise, 
and London Wildlife Trust.
Goals and roadmap for 2025
• Continue to identify internal and external 
opportunities to further embed our 
ambition of delivering positive social and 
sustainability outcomes for our customers. 
• In line with our core mission, build on 
our strong partnerships with Hatch, 
Thrive and others to support the wider 
SME ecosystem.
Climate and 
environment
Our ambition and 
commitment
To support initiatives 
that help drive progress 
towards net zero, and 
contribute meaningfully 
to climate, nature and 
biodiversity outcomes 
for healthier communities. 
Achievements in 2024
• We achieved a 35% reduction in GHG 
emissions (excluding 3.15 financed 
emissions) due to the sale of our US 
business, head office consolidation, and 
a real-world reduction in business travel.
• We brought forward our interim net zero 
target for emissions within our control 
(scopes 1, 2 and 3 business travel) from 
2030 to 2025, but retiring our previous net 
zero stretch target for supplier, employee 
commuting and waste emissions due to 
a need for further work to understand the 
drivers and scope for influence.
• We developed our approach to Beyond 
Value Chain Mitigation (“BVCM”), retiring the 
previous terminology on carbon neutrality, 
while retaining our commitment to climate 
and nature contributions in line with the 
Science Based Targets initiative (“SBTi”) 
BVCM principles. 
• Our partnership with Earthwatch Europe’s 
Tiny Forest initiative was featured in the 
UN Global Compact UK’s “Nature-based 
Solutions for Business” webinar series. 
Goals and roadmap for 2025
• Progress our restated interim net zero 
targets towards our 2050 net zero 
ambition, including our accelerated interim 
(2025) partial net zero target.
• Continue investing in UK-focused BVCM 
activities, including verified and robust 
carbon credit projects, to contribute 
societal nature and climate benefits.
Governance and 
risk management
Our ambition and 
commitment
To meet shareholder 
and investor expectations, 
and be viewed positively 
in the market.
Achievements in 2024
• We published our Human Rights Statement 
as planned.
• We developed our Climate Risk 
Management Framework (“CRMF”), and 
our disclosures are now aligned to the 
TCFD recommendations, considering 
proportionality and materiality and subject 
to continued evolution in certain areas. 
• We continued our engagement on 
sustainability issues related to SME lending 
with industry working groups under UK 
Finance and the Partnership for Carbon 
Accounting Financials (“PCAF”).
• We continued to uphold the highest 
standards of corporate governance and 
risk management more broadly, which are 
covered in the sections starting on pages 
51 and 70.
Goals and roadmap for 2025
• Prepare for UK introduction of ISSB/IFRS 
S1 and S2, and changes to the 2024 UK 
Corporate Governance Code.
• Understand how our current efforts align 
to transition planning guidance and identify 
priorities for further development.
STRATEGIC REPORT
CORPORATE GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
Funding Circle Holdings plc | Annual Report and Accounts 2024
25

Environment, social and governance (“ESG”) continued
Social impact
In line with our mission to back SMEs with business finance, 
we also aim to deliver and support initiatives that bring real 
benefits to small businesses and local communities.
Our customers and SMEs 
We value the contribution of SMEs to the economy, 
through the jobs they create and the potential multiplying 
effect they can have on wider society. Our lending 
helps businesses invest and scale up, but also sustains 
employment and stability locally. We recognise the 
importance of financial inclusion – our borrowers sit at the 
heart of diverse communities, and the business finance 
we provide supports SMEs in every corner of the UK.
Our primary impact as a business is the multi-faceted 
positive impact of our lending on society. Given the 
materiality of this impact versus our other social and 
environmental impacts, we work with Oxford Economics 
each year to carry out an economic impact analysis 
focused on our efforts and the outcomes they drive. In 
2024, Funding Circle’s Term Loans and FlexiPay lending 
supported 87,500 jobs, £7.2 billion in GDP, and helped 
businesses in every one of the 650 parliamentary 
constituencies. Please see page 14 for more detail. 
In 2024 we continued our partnership with Thrive 
Mental Wellbeing (“Thrive”). Thrive’s NHS-trusted app 
provides help anytime, anywhere. In our 2023 Resilience 
in SMEs report, 88% of respondents told us employee 
wellbeing and mental health was an area they wanted 
to focus on, with 79% reporting they would greatly value 
external support in this area. We are also giving access to 
Thrive’s unlimited in-app therapy to our most vulnerable 
customers, providing them with an alternative to NHS 
pathways which often have longer waiting times. 
Other societal contributions and commitments 
Funding Circle is a participant of the United Nations 
Global Compact and the UN Global Compact Network 
UK, and adheres to their principles-based approach 
to responsible business on human rights, labour, 
environment, and anti-corruption. We publish our 
Communication on Progress annually.
Please also see our Non-Financial and 
Sustainability Information Statement on page 39
We are a signatory to the HM Treasury Women in Finance 
Charter and the Investing in Women Code. 
We renewed our collaboration with Hatch Enterprise for 
a third year, contributing to its mission to build a fairer, 
more equitable and more diverse business landscape. 
In the 12 months to September 2024, our employees 
contributed 93 hours of volunteer mentoring, supporting 
72 founders. Through its programmes, Hatch supports 
underrepresented entrepreneurs from across the UK to 
launch and grow successful businesses that also have a 
positive impact on their communities. Its work is targeted 
at those typically underrepresented in entrepreneurship, 
including women and other marginalised genders, people 
from ethnic minority backgrounds, people with disabilities 
and neurodivergent people. 
Alongside our social impact, we want to contribute 
meaningfully to the environment, and our approach focuses 
on BVCM activities that help move towards societal net 
zero, by delivering positive climate and nature outcomes 
with co-benefits for communities. More detail on this is 
set out on page 31. 
Circlers participated in an annual Tower Climb charity 
event in March 2024 and fundraised over £3,000 for 
Great Ormond Street Hospital Children’s Charity.
STRATEGIC REPORT
CORPORATE GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
Funding Circle Holdings plc | Annual Report and Accounts 2024
26

Mathew Keech
Company name: HEJ Coffee
Borrower type: Term Loan
HEJ Coffee is an artisan neighbourhood coffee 
shop that roast their beans in house at their 
London roastery, allowing customers to enjoy 
their coffee whilst watching roasters create 
exceptional batches of coffee. They play an 
active part in their neighbourhood, celebrating 
individual identities and championing local 
charities and organisations – from including 
customer photos on their wall of fame, to 
sponsoring local schools and an LGBTQIA+ 
homeless shelter, and even building a 
grassroots football club, HEJ FC. 
In addition to being an important part of the 
community, Mathew and his team are making 
sustainability a key mission for HEJ Coffee. 
Leading in their industry, they are in the 
process of becoming B Corp certified. They 
have already invested in a 100% electric fleet, 
and are changing how they package and sell their 
coffee, to continue reducing carbon emissions 
and materials.
Since 2019, they have delivered significant 
environmental savings:
• More than 231,000 coffee bags and 38,000 
cardboard boxes were redirected from landfill.
• Over 88 tonnes of carbon emissions were 
averted by using electric vans or bikes 
for deliveries.
• They donated £23k towards planting over 2,300 
trees in urban areas.
HEJ Coffee came to Funding Circle in 2019, after 
their bank could not see their vision or support 
them in delivering their plans efficiently. Funding 
Circle fuelled the company with funding quickly, 
allowing Mathew to secure the equipment and 
begin the process of building the state of the art 
all-electric roastery.
“
We needed a partner that 
had faith in our ideas and 
could see our vision with the 
capacity to help us make 
it happen; with Funding 
Circle we got exactly that, 
a quick decision and a 
straightforward process, 
allowing us to get on with 
our business plans.”
STRATEGIC REPORT
CORPORATE GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
Funding Circle Holdings plc | Annual Report and Accounts 2024
27

Environment, social and governance (“ESG”) continued
Climate and 
environment
At Funding Circle, we are committed to fostering a 
resilient and sustainable business model that contributes 
to the broader global effort of mitigating climate change 
and protecting the environment. Our approach to 
environmental responsibility is being proportionately 
embedded in our operational strategies, recognising 
the growing importance of climate-related risks and 
opportunities for the wider UK economy, but limited 
idiosyncratic risks to Funding Circle’s business model. 
This section incorporates disclosures consistent with 
the Task Force on Climate-related Financial Disclosures 
(“TCFD”) recommendations, in compliance with the 
Financial Conduct Authority’s (“FCA”) UK Listing 
Rules1. Our disclosures are now aligned to the TCFD 
recommendations, considering proportionality and 
materiality and recognising that certain areas will 
continue to be deepened and enhanced over many years. 
This section includes greenhouse gas (“GHG”) emissions 
reporting per Companies Act 2006 regulations. 
1. Strategy
Climate-related risks and opportunities
Funding Circle is an SME finance platform, providing 
the technology, data and products to provide fast, fair 
and hassle-free finance to SMEs and diversified lending 
opportunities for institutional investors. Of the £2.8 billion 
balances under management on our platform as of 
31 December 2024, 98% are funded by third party 
institutional investors and 2% by Funding Circle equity. 
We have, however, chosen to incorporate all balances 
under management, as well as defaulted loans, in our 
assessment of climate-related risks to provide maximum 
transparency to our stakeholders. 
Following the sale of our US business on 1 July 2024, 
Funding Circle operates only in the UK. We define short, 
medium, and long-term horizons as one year or less, 
one to five years, and more than five years, respectively. 
These time periods are consistent with those used in 
our Enterprise Risk Management Framework (“ERMF”) 
and strategic planning, although we recognise that some 
climate-related risks and opportunities will take decades to 
materialise. The weighted average life of a Funding Circle 
Term Loan under management Note 2 is between 24 and 36 
months (i.e. within the current medium-term horizon).
Funding Circle’s business model means we have low 
exposure to physical risks from climate change: a minor 
operational physical presence, unsecured loan products 
which do not rely on the borrower’s physical assets as 
security3, maximum loan terms of six years, and a broad 
geographical distribution of lending to SMEs across the 
UK, as shown in Table 1. This means we are at low risk 
of operational disruption, have no risk of damage or 
devaluation of assets relied on for loan collateral, and are 
similarly diversified to the broader UK economy with an 
aim to maintain this diversification.
Funding Circle’s exposure to transition risks is also 
structurally low due to its business model: lending is well 
diversified across sectors in line with the broader UK 
economy as shown in Table 2, around a third of lending 
is to a broad spectrum of “carbon-related” sectors4, and 
we support a diversified pool of institutional investors. 
Furthermore, as our lending is unsecured3, we are not 
exposed to the risk of transition-related devaluation of 
physical assets used as loan security. 
We recognise that physical and transition risks will have 
wide-reaching and long-term impacts on all parts of 
the UK economy. Although our exposure to these risks 
through our lending is deemed low due to the absence 
of physical collateral, we acknowledge that potential 
disruptions to business continuity may make it difficult for 
some impacted SMEs to maintain regular, uninterrupted 
loan repayments. We therefore continue to invest in our 
forbearance processes and capabilities so that we can 
swiftly deploy the right support in the case of a climate-
related event whilst continuing to provide better access 
to finance to SMEs in all UK sectors and geographies. 
We continue to assess potential transition-related or 
sustainable finance product opportunities following 
an internal commercial review in 2023. However, we 
have seen no change to the review’s findings of muted 
customer demand and significant gaps in loan pricing 
and institutional investor return expectations. 
Beyond our on-balance-sheet lending, which comprises 
96% of our greenhouse gas emissions, Funding Circle’s 
largest source of emissions is from our supply chain, 
as shown in Figures 1 and 2. These principally relate to 
digital activities (including software, advertising and 
cloud computing) and to purchased services.
Our assessment to determine the materiality of current 
and potential future impacts of climate-related risks and 
opportunities on Funding Circle’s financial performance 
looked across our operations and value chain and 
involved measuring emissions, including financed 
emissions, a mixture of qualitative and quantitative 
analysis, risk analysis in line with our ERMF, and 
feedback from stakeholders and subject matter experts. 
Due to the nature of our business model, climate-related 
risks will only really manifest for us if they affect SME or 
investor appetite, performance or liquidity (rather than 
risks to any specific physical assets). Currently, we do 
not consider there to be any financially material climate-
related risks or opportunities, nor do we foresee any of 
significance materialising over the medium term. There 
was no impact on our financial position, performance or 
cash flows from climate-related risks and opportunities 
in the reporting period. Our analysis is summarised 
in Table 3.
STRATEGIC REPORT
CORPORATE GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
Funding Circle Holdings plc | Annual Report and Accounts 2024
28

Table 1: Geographical lending distribution 
UK Region 
All balances 
under 
management 
Balances on 
balance sheet 
South East
24%
25% 
London
15%
15% 
Midlands
15%
14% 
North West
12%
12% 
North East
10%
10% 
South West
10%
10% 
Scotland
5%
5% 
East Anglia
4%
4% 
Wales
3%
3% 
Northern Ireland
2%
2% 
Table 2: Sectoral lending distribution 
Sector (based on SIC classification) 
All balances 
under 
management 
Balances on 
balance sheet 
Wholesale & retail
17.9%
20.4% 
Other business activities
18.8%
18.2% 
Health & other service 
activities
12.7%
11.9% 
Other manufacturing
5.5%
6.4% 
IT & telecommunication
5.1%
5.4% 
Hotels & restaurants
4.1%
3.6% 
Finance
1.7%
1.6% 
Construction & real estate 
20.0%
18.6% 
Automotive
4.6%
4.7% 
Transport, storage & 
communication
3.9%
3.7% 
Manufacture of metal products
2.1%
1.9% 
Manufacture of paper 
products, publishing & printing
1.4%
1.3% 
Manufacture of food products 
& beverages
1.2%
1.2% 
Agriculture
0.8%
0.8% 
Electricity, gas & water supply
0.1%
0.2% 
Mining & quarrying
0.1%
0.1% 
Total “carbon related” Note 4 
34.2%
32.5% 
Note: In Tables 1 and 2, and Figure 1, we include defaulted loans for the 
estimation of financed emissions and the climate-related risk analysis, whereas 
defaulted loans are excluded when reporting balances under management 
elsewhere in this Annual Report. 
Fig.1: Total GHG emissions 2024 (location based) 
by Scope 1*, 2 and 3 (categories 1-15) 
Scope 2 – location based 
0.02% 
Scope 3 – categories 1–14 
3.49% 
Scope 3 – category 15 (financed emissions 
– balances on balance sheet)  
96.49% 
Fig.2: Total GHG emissions 2024 (location based) 
by Scope 1*, 2 and Scope 3 (excl. category 15) 
Scope 2 
2. Purchased electricity (location based) 
0.7% 
Scope 3 
3.1 Purchased goods and services 
79.4% 
3.2 Capital goods 
10.7% 
3.3 Fuel and energy activity 
0.2% 
3.5 Waste generated in operations 
0.4% 
3.6 Business travel 
3.9% 
3.7 Employee commuting 
3.2% 
3.8 Upstream leased assets 
1.5% 
Note * 
In 2024 we reclassified Scope 1 (gas heating of UK office) to 
Scope 3 category 8, as explained on page 34. 
1. The Company has also considered the 2021 TCFD Annex and the Supplemental Guidance for the Financial Sector. 
2. Term Loans make up 96% of balances under management, with the remaining balances being up to 12 months and corresponding to shorter-term open ended 
products (Cashback credit card and FlexiPay drawn lines of credit). 
3. The majority of Funding Circle’s loans under management are unsecured, with <5% subject to a debenture (floating charge). Funding Circle also provides SMEs 
with access to a range of asset, vehicle and equipment finance solutions through its Marketplace. These products are arranged directly between the SME and 
the third party provider and Funding Circle has no role in the delivery or management of the resulting loan. 
4. Carbon-related sectors as defined in “Implementing the Recommendations of the Task Force on Climate-related Financial Disclosures” (TCFD, 2021) and 
highlighted in Table 2.
STRATEGIC REPORT
CORPORATE GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
Funding Circle Holdings plc | Annual Report and Accounts 2024
29

Environment, social and governance (“ESG”) continued
Climate and environment continued 
1. Strategy continued 
Climate-related risks and opportunities continued 
Table 3: Summary of climate-related risks and opportunities 
Category
Driver
Potential business impact 
Horizon 
(short, 
medium, 
long)
Potential financial impact Note * 
Transition risk 
Market: changes to SME 
and/or investor demand 
and preferences 
Policy and legal: more 
demanding climate 
policy including 
carbon taxes 
Technology: need for 
SMEs and suppliers to 
transition to greener 
technologies 
Reputation: climate-
related compliance 
or delivery failures 
negatively impact public/ 
stakeholder perception 
Strategic: increased SME or investor 
demand for green finance products could 
reduce demand for existing Funding 
Circle products and/or require investment 
in data and product innovation 
Funding: reduced investor risk appetite 
for SME lending or for certain sectors, 
or reduction in available investor capital 
(e.g. as a result of climate policy) may 
constrain platform liquidity 
Credit: financial pressure on SME 
borrowers in higher carbon industries may 
impact their ability to repay 
Operational: compliance with more 
onerous climate data, reporting or 
other climate regulation or taxes could 
increase costs for Funding Circle, SME 
borrowers and investors; transition 
investment by suppliers may increase 
procurement costs 
M, L 
M, L 
M, L 
M, L 
Reduced revenue: 
• from lower demand for existing 
products and services; 
• from deteriorating borrower credit 
quality in higher carbon sectors; or 
• from write-offs, impairments and early 
retirement of existing assets 
Increased costs: 
• from compliance costs or carbon taxes; 
• from investment in data and product 
innovation; or 
• from suppliers passing on transition-
related costs 
Reduced access to capital and liquidity: 
• from changes to investor risk appetite 
or liquidity 
Likely to be below the threshold for 
financial materiality in the medium term 
Physical risk
Acute: e.g. increase in 
extreme climate-related 
weather events 
Chronic: e.g. alterations 
in weather patterns, 
rising sea levels 
Credit: temporary interruptions to SME 
borrowers’ operations affecting their 
ability to repay 
Reputation: insufficient forbearance tools 
and processes exacerbate SME stress 
and contribute to SME business closure 
Funding: reduced investor appetite or 
liquidity due to impacts of weather events 
on borrower or investor operations 
Credit: permanent changes to SME 
borrowers’ operations or supply chains 
resulting in structurally higher costs and 
affecting their ability to repay 
Funding: long-term changes in investor 
risk appetite or reduced liquidity due to 
chronic impacts on investors’ operations 
S, M, L 
L 
Reduced revenue: 
• from deteriorating borrower credit 
quality; 
• from customer boycotting; 
• from lower demand for products 
or services; or 
• from write-offs and early retirement 
of existing assets 
Increased costs: 
• from fines or litigation 
Likely to be below the threshold for 
financial materiality in the medium term 
Opportunities 
Market: changes to SME 
and/or investor demand 
and preferences 
Technology: innovation 
in circularity, energy 
efficiency and 
renewables 
Increased SME demand for 
transition-related finance 
Increased investor demand for 
transition-related or sustainable lending 
Platform and marketing enhancements 
to increase efficiency, reduce waste and 
utilise 100% renewable electricity 
S, M 
M, L 
Increased revenue: 
• from access to new and emerging 
markets; or 
• from new products and services 
relating to climate transition, resilience 
or adaptation 
Increased access to capital and liquidity 
(for the same reasons) 
Decreased costs: 
• from reduced reliance on volatile power 
sources; 
• from increased energy efficiency; or 
• from less physical (e.g. paper) resource 
use and waste 
Likely to be below the threshold for 
financial materiality in the medium term 
Note * 
For further detail on how we determine and define materiality for our climate-related risks and opportunities, please see page 28 and “Risk management” on 
pages 33 to 34.
STRATEGIC REPORT
CORPORATE GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
Funding Circle Holdings plc | Annual Report and Accounts 2024
30

Strategy, net zero and transition planning 
The identification and analysis of potential climate-
related risks and opportunities have not driven any 
changes to Funding Circle’s strategy, business model 
or credit decisioning to date. Our strategy supports an 
agile, low risk approach to the climate transition through 
the continued evolution of a diversified loan portfolio, a 
diversified investor base, and the ability to respond to 
changing market demands for new products. 
However, as a finance platform whose activities mirror 
the wider UK “real economy”, we are mindful of the 
broader economic impacts expected from the climate 
transition and physical risks. We expect that the longer-
term impact from climate change on Funding Circle, its 
customers and its investors will reflect overall changes 
to UK GDP. While we will continue to engage with 
relevant information and stakeholders to understand 
these impacts, we remain committed to lending to SMEs 
across a diverse geographic and sectoral distribution 
and do not plan to impose risk appetite changes that 
will alter our portfolio away from one that reflects the 
broader, diversified UK economy. In response to growing 
physical risks from climate change which may create 
business continuity challenges for some SME customers, 
we continue to invest in developing our forbearance 
measures to better support customers experiencing 
temporary repayment difficulties. 
We are beginning to see early signs of institutional 
investor interest in our climate policies and financed 
emissions data. We expect this to increase over 
time, driven by changing reporting and regulatory 
requirements, and will respond as needed, leveraging our 
platform technology and expanding data lake. However, 
the lack of emissions reporting requirements for SMEs or 
straightforward, standardised and affordable tools and 
methodologies for them to use is currently an obstacle to 
collecting primary data. 
We participate in industry-led working groups, actively 
engaging on sustainability issues and a just transition 
for SMEs – specifically, the UK Finance Industry Working 
Group on ESG implications for SMEs, and the PCAF (UK 
chapter) working group on Business Loans and Unlisted 
Equity, which aims to explore the challenges in calculating 
SME emissions and support the ongoing development of 
the PCAF Standard. 
More broadly, recognising the need for all businesses 
to proactively support the transition to a low carbon 
economy, we have an ambition to reach net zero by 
2050 across all emission scopes. In line with the latest 
climate science, we will endeavour to achieve this 
through absolute emissions reduction and offsetting the 
remaining hard-to-abate emissions by purchasing high 
quality carbon credits. 
In 2024, we updated our interim climate target, reflecting 
a deepening of our transition planning efforts. Previously, 
we had in place a stretch target to reach net zero by 2030 
for our operational emissions (Scope 1, 2 and 3 excluding 
financed emissions). We have evolved this to an interim 
target to achieve net zero for Scope 1, 2 and 3 business 
travel in 2025 (“interim (2025) partial net zero target”), 
which we are currently on track to meet without any 
material costs. We have significant constraints around 
data accuracy and level of influence for the remaining 
Scope 3 categories and as such have decided to retire 
the previous 2030 stretch target for these. We intend to 
focus efforts in 2025 on improving data accuracy and 
assessing potential levers, influence and dependencies, 
with a view to setting new interim targets as appropriate. 
This approach also allows us to take account of the SBTi’s 
revised Corporate Net Zero Standard which is under 
development at the time of publication. 
Meanwhile, we continue to develop our BVCM approach, 
aiming to contribute to the wider societal transition to 
net zero. 
In 2024, we expanded our environmental contributions 
towards nature-based and biodiversity projects in the 
UK. Through our partnership with Earthwatch Europe, 
we supported the planting of five new Tiny Forest sites 
across the UK as part of the Local Authority Treescapes 
Fund. With its programme of planting small forests in 
ecologically deprived areas nationwide, Tiny Forest 
reconnects people with nature, enhances wellbeing, 
helps mitigate the impacts of climate change and 
provides nature-rich habitat to support urban wildlife. 
The partnership was featured in the UN Global Compact 
Network UK’s webinar series on “Nature-based Solutions 
for Business”. We also partnered with GreenTheUK, 
the Blue Marine Foundation and Plantlife, to support 
initiatives helping native oyster restoration in the Solent 
and the Sussex Kelp Recovery Project, as well as 
protecting temperate rainforests in Devon and Cornwall. 
We continue to review the evolving technology and 
regulatory landscape for carbon credits and intend to 
undertake further scoping and due diligence to select 
appropriate carbon credits to offset the small tail of 
hard‑to‑abate emissions for our interim (2025) partial net 
zero target. 
Resilience of our strategy 
In 2023/24, Funding Circle engaged external experts to 
support the qualitative analysis of its lending in relation to 
physical and transition risks. This was based on loan-level 
data covering financed emissions (calculated in line with 
the PCAF methodology), geography, sector and principal 
outstanding as at 31 December 2023, and refreshed for 
31 December 2024. We assessed total balances under 
management, including defaulted loans, and balances 
held on Funding Circle’s balance sheet, with both 
exhibiting similar profiles. 
Each sector was assigned an overall transition risk 
vulnerability rating based on several risk factors: 
regulation, raw material cost, technology, market demand 
fluctuations, and reputational risk. Physical risks were 
assessed through sectoral and geographical lenses. 
Inputs were sourced from external research, literature 
and tools including the FCA’s Climate Financial Risk 
Forum (“CFRF”) climate scenario analysis narrative tool 
and the World Bank Group’s carbon pricing dashboard. 
STRATEGIC REPORT
CORPORATE GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
Funding Circle Holdings plc | Annual Report and Accounts 2024
31

Environment, social and governance (“ESG”) continued
Climate and environment continued 
1. Strategy continued 
Resilience of our strategy continued 
Our analysis showed a small proportion of balances, both on balance sheet and under management, that are to sectors 
with higher exposure or vulnerability to climate-related risks, as shown in Table 4. 
Table 4: Sectors with higher exposure or vulnerability to climate-related risks 
Sectors assessed as having high vulnerability to climate risks 
% balances on 
balance sheet 
% balances 
under management 
Transition risks: 
Transport, storage and communication
3.7%
3.9% 
Electricity, gas and water supply (“Electricity and Utilities”)
0.2%
0.1% 
Total
3.9%
4.0% 
Physical risks: 
Agriculture
0.8%
0.8% 
Total
0.8%
0.8% 
We used the Network for Greening the Financial System (“NGFS”) scenarios to assess Funding Circle’s climate 
resilience. This was done at a relatively high level, commensurate with the materiality of our climate-related risks and 
opportunities. Three diverse scenarios were considered, including one aligned to the latest international agreement on 
climate change (Net Zero 2050). The results of our scenario analysis, conducted in 2024, are summarised in the table 
below and show strong resilience as at the reporting date, with existing plans to develop our climate-related data, 
insight and reporting capabilities sufficient under all scenarios. 
As Funding Circle’s balances under management mirror the sectoral diversity of the broader UK economy, our exposure 
to any economic shocks or persistent declines would likely be in line with UK GDP. All scenarios are expected to have a 
negative impact on GDP by 2050 versus a baseline of no physical or transition risk. 
Table 5: Summary of climate scenario analysis 
Potential impacts 
Characteristics 
NGFS – Orderly Transition 
(Net Zero 2050)
NGFS – Disorderly (Delayed Transition) 
NGFS – Hot House  
World (NDCs) 
2050 GDP vs. baseline of negative 3% 
no physical/transition risk
negative 4.6% to negative 4.7% 
negative 5.7% to negative 6% 
Transition 
Policy reaction
Immediate, smooth
No additional actions until 2030
No additional pledges vs. today 
Technology change
Fast
Slow then fast
Slow 
Electrification, 
decarbonisation and 
energy efficiency 
Rapid and steady
Slow then fast
Slow 
Overall transition risk 
Medium
High
Low 
Physical 
Temperature rise
1.4C
1.6C
2.6C 
Physical risks
Low
Medium
High 
Impacts and considerations 
Funding Circle time 
horizons affected 
ST, MT, LT
LT
LT 
Potential impact on 
climate-related risks 
and opportunities 
(see Table 3) 
Heightened transition risks, 
particularly for “carbon-related” 
sectors, may put strain on SME 
profitability and require market-wide 
investment in climate compliance. 
Muted transition risks initially then 
significantly heightened after 2030, 
with a shock to revenues and costs likely 
felt across most sectors, with “carbon-
related” ones particularly exposed. 
Limited transition risks with even 
“carbon-related” sectors having a long 
time to adapt. Physical risks will increase 
significantly over the longer term with 
far-reaching economic consequences. 
Strategic 
considerations 
Continued investment in forbearance 
tools and processes will support 
SMEs experiencing short-term 
repayment challenges. 
Continued planned enhancement 
of Funding Circle’s climate reporting 
capabilities will support compliance 
with future regulation. 
Continued investment in forbearance 
tools will better support businesses 
suffering short-term stress in relation 
to transition-related economic shocks. 
Continued investment in forbearance 
processes and tools will better 
support businesses suffering business 
continuity impacts from physical 
climate events.
STRATEGIC REPORT
CORPORATE GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
Funding Circle Holdings plc | Annual Report and Accounts 2024
32

This qualitative approach is proportionate to the 
materiality of Funding Circle’s climate-related risks and 
opportunities. We will continue to refresh and enhance 
this analysis but do not currently have plans to invest 
in further quantitative analysis as we do not foresee it 
providing actionable outputs for the time being. 
2. Governance 
Board oversight 
The Board of Directors at Funding Circle holds ultimate 
responsibility for climate-related risks and opportunities. 
Matthew King, Non-Executive Director, continued as 
Board-level sponsor for climate in 2024, providing 
support and challenge to management, drawing on his 
significant financial services risk management experience 
as well as knowledge of climate change from his Non-
Executive Director role in a resource-intensive industry. 
Geeta Gopalan also has climate-related financial services 
risk management skills, and Helen Beck has undertaken 
training on transition planning. 
The Board reviews climate-related issues as part of 
its overall risk management and strategic planning 
processes. This includes reviewing analysis on physical 
and transition risk heatmaps and climate scenarios which 
demonstrate that climate-related risks and opportunities 
are not likely to be material in the medium term. The 
Board has taken this into account in its oversight of the 
Group’s strategy, with no trade-offs being required at 
this point. In addition, it delegates certain matters to 
two Committees, which are included in their Committee 
Terms of Reference: 
• the ESG Committee (“ESGC”), chaired by Andrew 
Learoyd and responsible for oversight of the Group’s 
ESG strategy including climate-related opportunities 
(see ESG Committee Report on page 88); and 
• the Audit and Risk Committee (“ARC”), chaired by Geeta 
Gopalan and responsible for oversight of climate-
related (and broader ESG) risk management. Climate‑
related risks are assessed in line with the ERMF and 
reviewed and approved by the ARC annually. 
 
The Board considers its skills and competencies in 
relation to climate-related risks and opportunities 
annually. Following Matthew King’s retirement from the 
Board, it will continue to consider ways of maintaining 
Board-level expertise on climate and other ESG topics, 
with this being a skill taken into consideration in the Non-
Executive Director appointment process. The skills of 
Geeta Gopalan and Helen Beck referred to above provide 
a strong competency framework, particularly given 
climate-related risks and opportunities are not likely to be 
material for Funding Circle over the medium term. Further 
external training has been provided in the past and will 
continue to be delivered as required as we deepen our 
climate scenario analysis and develop transition plans. 
Management’s role 
Executive responsibility for climate-related risks and 
opportunities is held by the CEO, who delegates climate risk 
management to the CRO. Management responsibility for 
execution and delivery of the Group’s climate (and broader 
ESG) strategy sits with the Chief Legal Officer and Company 
Secretary. Oversight is provided by the Management Risk 
Committee (“MRC”) which reports into the Board-level 
Committees described above. 
We have introduced controls and procedures 
proportionate to the level of materiality of climate-related 
risks and opportunities. As such, the principal procedure 
is to identify and assess climate-related risks in line with 
the ERMF which is reviewed by the MRC and approved 
by the ARC annually. In addition, in 2024 Funding Circle 
established the CRMF, which set safeguard thresholds 
for climate risk appetite and was approved by the 
ARC. The combination of the ERMF and CRMF ensures 
climate-related risks are integrated into our broader risk 
management processes and executives are updated 
regularly. 
3. Risk management 
Identification and assessment of climate-related risks 
Funding Circle evaluates the impact of climate-related 
risks on its own operations and its balances under 
management, across physical and transition risk drivers. 
As well as monitoring external developments to assess 
any increases to risk drivers, in 2023/24 we undertook 
a loan portfolio risk heatmap exercise. This assessed 
the level of exposure to physical and transition risks for 
all balances under management and underpinned our 
initial scenario analysis described above. The heatmap 
and scenario analysis results informed this year’s annual 
ERMF Risks and Control Self-Assessment. 
The materiality of potential climate-related impacts is 
assessed using a risk classification matrix which rates 
the inherent likelihood of the risk occurring and the 
impact on the business in financial and non-financial 
terms. In assigning ratings, we consider both qualitative 
factors (such as effect on customers, media coverage 
and business continuity) and quantitative financial 
thresholds ranging from “critical” (financial impact of £5 
million or more in a 12-month period) to “minor” (financial 
impact of £250k or less in a 12-month period) over a 
medium-term horizon. 
As with 2023, policy and legal transition risks were 
the main driver of climate-related risks to Funding Circle, 
with continued developments in reporting obligations 
likely to impact Funding Circle, its SME customers and 
institutional investors.
STRATEGIC REPORT
CORPORATE GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
Funding Circle Holdings plc | Annual Report and Accounts 2024
33

Environment, social and governance (“ESG”) continued
Climate and environment continued 
3. Risk management continued 
Identification and assessment of climate-related risks 
continued 
Our 2024 risk assessment identified climate as a level 1 
ESG risk, within the strategic risk category. The risk was 
defined as: “This risk covers (1) Transition Risks and (2) 
Physical Risks. Climate risk is a cross-cutting risk type 
that may manifest through some of our other established 
principal categories (regulatory, credit, operational, 
technology and funding).” The inherent likelihood was 
assessed as “Possible” (meaning a potential occurrence 
once every one to two years) and the inherent impact 
was deemed to be “Minor” based on an assessment of 
qualitative and quantitative factors as described above. 
The resulting inherent risk rating was “Low”. Consistent 
with 2023, the likelihood and impact of this risk on other 
principal categories over the ERMF time horizon was 
assessed as de minimis. 
Management and integration of climate-related risks 
Funding Circle’s risk appetite statement in relation to strategic 
risks including climate risk is that it “will make efficient use 
of its available resources to build a sustainable, diversified 
and profitable business that can successfully adapt to 
environment changes”. In line with the assessed “Low” impact 
materiality, we continue to take a proportionate approach to 
building our climate risk management capabilities. 
The main controls in place to manage climate-related 
risks include internal legal and regulatory review; 
management and risk oversight and controls; third party 
review; internal audit review; and internal policies and 
practices. The financed emissions data and physical 
and transition heatmaps developed in 2024 provide 
appropriate foundations to proportionately manage and 
embed climate risk in the medium term. 
The residual risk rating for climate risk in 2024, 
considering the effectiveness of controls in place, 
was “Low” and unchanged from last year. Through its 
integration into the ERMF, climate-related risk is subject 
to the same evaluation, response and monitoring process 
and governance as all other key risks. 
4. Metrics and targets 
GHG emissions metrics 
Methodology 
This section includes our mandatory reporting of GHG 
emissions in line with The Companies Act 2006 (Strategic 
Report and Directors’ Report) Regulations 2013, and the 
Streamlined Energy and Carbon Reporting (“SECR”) under 
The Companies (Directors’ Report) and Limited Liability 
Partnerships (Energy and Carbon Report) Regulations 
2018. Our GHG emissions reporting period is 1 January 
to 31 December and is aligned with our financial 
reporting year. 
We measure a full inventory of material Scope 1, 2 and 3 
emissions in accordance with the GHG Protocol Corporate 
Standard, using an operational control approach to define 
our organisational boundary. Activity data was used where 
available (Scopes 2, 3.5, 3.8, and 3.1 Cloud emissions), or 
estimated on a spend basis. Emissions were calculated by 
applying recognised and up-to-date emission factors from 
reference databases (mainly Exiobase 3.8.2, IEA 2023, UK 
GHG Conversion Factor 2024, and Base Empreinte Ademe 
23.4) selected based on geographical relevance and 
data quality. 
We carry out annual independent third party verification of 
our GHG emissions in accordance with ISO 14064-1, which 
was completed for FY 2023 at a limited level of assurance 
at a materiality of 5%, and covering all activities under our 
operational control, and all relevant emission categories, 
indicating any exclusions. Verification for FY 2024 is 
due in 2025. 
Beyond reporting requirements, we measure and report 
all material GHG categories as a way of monitoring the 
transition risks outlined in Table 3, with higher emissions 
being indicative of elevated transition risk. 
Comparative periods 
Funding Circle completed the sale of its US business on 
1 July 2024. In line with the GHG Protocol for treatment 
of structural business changes, emissions from our US 
business have been removed, where possible, from our 
core 2024 reported figures and comparative periods. 
Work undertaken in 2024 in relation to Funding Circle’s 
transition plan highlighted an inaccurate classification of 
the London office heating emissions. Funding Circle has 
no control over the hours of operation or the equipment 
used for heating this building, which is leased by 
Funding Circle and shared with other tenants. It was 
therefore deemed more accurate to reclassify these 
emissions from Scope 1 to Scope 3 category 8 for this 
reporting year and all comparative periods. 
Financed emissions methodology 
Scope 3 category 15 emissions (financed emissions) were 
calculated in accordance with the Partnership for Carbon 
Accounting Financials (“PCAF”) Global GHG Accounting 
and Reporting Standard (the “PCAF Standard”) 
methodology for business loans. As we have no primary 
emissions data for our SME customers, we have applied 
PCAF’s “economic activity-based emissions” method, 
which provides sector-based factors for the volume 
of emissions per £ revenue (based on Exiobase v3.9, 
base year 2019). We then attribute a proportion of an 
SME’s emissions based on the ratio between the amount 
outstanding originated through the Funding Circle 
platform and the total debt and equity of the SME. 
As Funding Circle holds only a small proportion of credit 
extended on its own balance sheet (c.6% of balances 
under management when including defaulted loans), the 
majority of attributed emissions form part of the carbon 
footprint of the institutional investors who fund the 
lending originated through the platform. For transparency, 
we report on both Funding Circle’s financed emissions 
(relating to the small number of on-balance-sheet loans) 
and the overall emissions attributed to the total balances 
under management.
STRATEGIC REPORT
CORPORATE GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
Funding Circle Holdings plc | Annual Report and Accounts 2024
34

This calculation includes several assumptions which can 
materially affect the final calculated emissions. This means 
we can provide no assurance as to the accuracy of the 
final calculated emissions. Our exposure-weighted data 
quality score, based on the PCAF Standard, was 4.01 
where 1 is the highest data quality and 5 is the lowest. 
This is in line with the previous year’s score, however, an 
updated PCAF methodology was used for the emissions 
factors meaning results are not comparable with 2023. 
As recommended by PCAF we used regional (sector 
average) emission factors, instead of country-level ones 
for 2023, with the former being generally higher. Had we 
taken the same approach as reported for 2023, financed 
emissions would have been 22% lower (2,190,709 tCO subscript 2 e ) 
for all balances under management, and 21% lower 
(156,693 tCO subscript 2 e ) for balances on balance sheet. 
We have not recalculated our 2023 financed emissions 
using the updated methodology as we anticipate further 
fluctuations until data quality and methodologies improve 
and stabilise. Such significant, methodology-related 
fluctuations make the development of actions or targets 
for financed emissions impractical at present. And while 
we have identified potential ways to improve the data 
quality score over time, a key limitation is our ability to 
source primary emissions data for SMEs, the majority 
of which do not measure or disclose this information 
at present. 
Actions taken to reduce emissions 
Total emissions, excluding 3.15 financed emissions, were 
reduced by 35% in 2024 (both market and location based) 
in part due to the sale of our US business in mid-2024. If 
we exclude US-related emissions, where possible, from 
2023, the 2024 reduction was 32%; however, we were 
unable to disaggregate the US in some categories of 
emissions (3.1 and 3.6) and will more fully understand the 
impact in 2025 when we report our first full year of UK-
only emissions. Our FTE intensity ratio (Scopes 1, 2 and 3 
excluding 3.15) was reduced by 11% (27% when excluding 
US-related emissions where possible). 
One of the key impacts of the sale is a real-world 
reduction in business travel emissions (down 62%), 
removing the need for flights between the UK and 
US from the second half of 2024, with full annualised 
benefits expected in 2025. Our travel policy restricts 
flights to essential cases, supported by flexible working 
policies, ensuring all feasible steps have now been taken 
to limit travel emissions. 
We also consolidated our London head office from 
two floors to one and completed a re-fit in the process 
which included an LED lighting upgrade. These actions 
reduced electricity use and, therefore, Scope 2 UK 
emissions (down 31% in 2024 vs. 2023). Following the 
sale of our US business and the corrected classification 
of our London head office heating emissions, our Scope 
1 and 2 emissions have now been reduced to zero on a 
market basis. Emissions from gas heating of this office 
are now reflected in Scope 3 category 8 due to our lack 
of operational control. Future reductions depend on 
whether and when UK policy abolishes gas boilers in 
commercial properties. 
We do not fully understand the drivers of the increase in 
our Scope 3 waste emissions in 2024, which are estimated 
pro rata from building-level data. There was a change in 
waste management provider and we saw higher building 
occupancy in 2024; however, we need to interrogate the 
changes further. The recycling rate was 75% and we are 
planning further employee and building management 
engagement in 2025. 
Key remaining Scope 3 categories – purchased goods and 
services, employee commuting (including homeworking), 
upstream leased assets and financed emissions – pose 
challenges due to limited influence and reliance on 
secondary data. Employee commuting emissions reduced 
by 36% in the year (even after adjusting for the sale of 
the US business); however, we need to better understand 
the reasons for this. Purchased goods and services 
emissions saw a 38% decrease year-on-year; however, 
we were unable to disaggregate country-level data and 
so are unsure how much of the decrease is driven by the 
divestment of our US business. Capital goods emissions 
were an exceptional item included this year due to our 
office re-fit. 
Excluding divested loans relating to the US business, 
Scope 3.15 financed emissions increased by 24% for 
balances under management, or 50% for balances on 
balance sheet. This reflects the move to an updated 
PCAF methodology described in the previous section. 
Underlying balances excluding the US business were 
broadly flat, and the type of lending and customer base 
remained consistent with prior years. 
We switched carbon accounting solutions during 2024, 
and although we do not believe this has any major 
impact on measured emission results, it may account 
for minor fluctuations relative to 2023. In 2025, we will 
focus on improving data accuracy and identifying which 
decarbonisation opportunities we might influence to 
inform our evolving transition plan, including modelling 
potential reduction levers, and investigating top supplier-
level emissions data. However, we expect there to 
be a material dependency on government policy and 
societal behaviours.
STRATEGIC REPORT
CORPORATE GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
Funding Circle Holdings plc | Annual Report and Accounts 2024
35

Environment, social and governance (“ESG”) continued
Climate and environment continued 
4. Metrics and targets continued 
Funding Circle Holdings plc global GHG emissions 
Global GHG emissions data for period 
1 January to 31 December 
2024 Note 1  
tCO subscript 2 e 
2023 
(comparative) Note 2 
tCO subscript 2 e 
2023 
tCO subscript 2 e 
2022 
tCO subscript 2 e 
2021 
tCO subscript 2 e 
Scope 1 Note 3 
—
—
108
77
129 
Scope 2 Note 4 
– location based 
51
75
265
313
340 
– market based 
—
—
190
239
411 
Total gross emissions (Scope 1 and 2) 
– location based 
51
75
373
390
469 
– market based 
—
—
298
316
540 
Scope 3 – category 1 purchased goods and services 
5,718 
9,217
9,217
n/a
n/a 
Scope 3 – category 2 capital goods Note 5 
766 
—
—
—
— 
Scope 3 – category 3 fuel and energy activity 
15 
54
103
n/a
n/a 
Scope 3 – category 5 waste generated in operations
29 
10
15
6
3 
Scope 3 – category 6 business travel 
279 
740
740
563
113 
Scope 3 – category 7 employee commuting
230 
358
568
n/a
n/a 
Scope 3 – category 8 upstream leased assets Note 3 
110 
108
8
n/a
n/a 
Total Scope 3 supply chain gross emissions
7,147
10,487
10,651
569
116 
Total gross emissions (Scope 1, 2 
and 3 excl. 3.15) Note 6 
– location based 
7,198 
10,562
11,024
959
585 
– market based 
7,147
10,487
10,949 Note 6 
885
656 
Scope 3 – category 15 investments: financed emissions – 
balances under management Note 7 
2,798,767 
2,250,205 2,886,452
n/a
n/a 
Scope 3 – category 15 investments: financed emissions – 
balances on balance sheet 
197,783 
132,105
220,357
n/a
n/a 
– 3.15 – balances on balance sheet: Scope 1 and 2 (tCO subscript 2 e )
54,419 
n/a
71,143
n/a
n/a 
– 3.15 – balances on balance sheet: Scope 3 (tCO subscript 2 e )
143,364 
n/a
149,214
n/a
n/a 
Total gross emissions (Scope 1, 2 
and 3 incl. 3.15) 
– location based 
204,981
142,667
231,381
n/a
n/a 
– market based 
204,930 
142,592
231,306
n/a
n/a 
Full-time employee (“FTE”) (average over the applicable 
reporting period) Note 8 
788
845
1,074
1,035
929 
Total income (£m) Note 8 
161.7
129.7
162.2
151.0
206.9 
Intensity ratio (Scope 1 and 2): tCO subscript 2 e/FTE – location based 
0.06
0.09
0.35
0.38
0.5 
– market based
—
—
0.28
0.31
0.58 
Intensity ratio (Scope 1 and 2): tCO subscript 2 e/£m 
– location based 
0.32
0.57
2.30
2.58
2.27 
– market based 
—
—
1.84
2.09
2.61 
Intensity ratio (Scope 1, 2 and 3 excl. 3.15): 
tCO subscript 2 e/FTE 
– location based 
9.13 
12.50
10.26
0.93
0.63 
– market based 
9.07
12.41
10.19
0.86
0.71 
Intensity ratio (Scope 1, 2 and 3 excl. 3.15): 
tCO subscript 2 e/£m 
– location based 
44.51
81.43
67.97
6.35
2.83 
– market based
44.20
80.86
67.50
5.86
3.17 
1. All figures presented for 2024 have not yet been subject to external assurance or verification. 2024 data reflects emissions from ongoing operations following 
the sale of our US operations in July 2024 (except for 3.1 and 3.6 where it was not possible to disaggregate the data, and which include US data up to July).  
2.  We provide here 2023 emissions excluding US emissions to enable better comparison with 2024 (except for 3.1 and 3.6 where it has not been practicable to fully  
disaggregate US and UK data).  
3.  Scope 1 emissions from gas heating of the UK leased office are now reflected in Scope 3 category 8 due to our lack of operational control. 
4.  Scope 2 includes purchased electricity (and steam for US offices where applicable); as per the GHG Protocol Corporate Standard, we also apply the market 
based method for Scope 2 RECs. 
5.  Category 3.2 capital goods emissions were an exceptional item included this year due to our office re-fit. 
6.  In our Annual Report 2023, Categories 3.3, 3.7 and 3.8 were reported as market-based; as per the GHG Protocol we now report all Scope 3 as location-based. 
7.  For Category 3.15 investments, for transparency we report on financed emissions for Funding Circle’s on-balance-sheet balances, as well as for total balances 
under management, and we include defaulted loans. In addition, we follow PCAF’s guidance to report Scope 1 and 2 financed emissions separately from Scope 
3 (to ensure transparency while acknowledging potential double counting issues). The move to an updated PCAF methodology means the results are not 
comparable for 2024 and 2023. 
8. FTE and total income for 2024 are reported for continuing operations only.
STRATEGIC REPORT
CORPORATE GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
Funding Circle Holdings plc | Annual Report and Accounts 2024
36

Regional breakdown of energy consumption data for period 1 January to 31 December 
(Kilowatt‑hour equivalent – kWhe)
Scope 1
Scope 2 
2024
2023
2022
2021
2024
2023
2022
2021 
Region 1 
UK
—2 
593,164 
457,208 
554,366
262,420 
359,778 
402,758 
359,638 
US
—
—
—
79,469
n/a 
385,700 
545,219 
643,284 
Total
—
593,164 
457,208 
633,835
262,420
745,478 
947,977 1,002,922 
Note 1. In prior years we disclosed emissions from our legacy European operations in Germany and the Netherlands, no longer relevant for FY 2024 onwards. 
2.  Scope 1 emissions from gas heating of the UK leased office are now reflected in Scope 3 category 8 due to our lack of operational control, however for 
transparency we can report that natural consumption for heating our UK office was estimated at 618,122 kWh for 2024. 
Climate-related risk metrics 
With support from third party experts in 2024, Funding Circle established portfolio-level physical and transition 
risk metrics as summarised in the tables below. We monitor these metrics at a portfolio level annually to inform our 
assessment of physical and transition risks outlined in “Climate-related risks and opportunities” on pages 28 to 30. 
Table 6.1: Sectoral transition risk level 
As at 31 December 2024
Low
Medium
High 
Proportion of balances under management
65.4%
29.2%
5.4% 
Proportion of balances on balance sheet
65.2%
28.9%
5.9% 
note: This analysis for 2024 was based on a previous sectoral definition (SIC codes were adopted during 2024 for the purpose of climate risk analysis) meaning the 
figures do not reconcile exactly to the sectoral splits provided in Tables 2 and 4. 
Table 6.2: Physical risk exposure by hazard (proportion of balances under management) 
As at 31 December 2024
Heat waves 
Low 
temperatures 
and snow 
Fluvial 
flooding 
Surface 
water 
flooding 
Coastal 
flooding Note * 
Drought 
Storm 
events
Wildfire 
Very low
65.5%
54.2%
—
—
—
88.7%
—
— 
Low
34.5%
28.6%
18.1%
86.2%
5.2%
11.3%
—
— 
Medium
—
16.3%
61.6%
13.6%
9.9%
0.0%
99.1%
66.1% 
High
—
0.9%
20.0%
0.2%
69.9%
0.0%
0.9%
33.4% 
Very high
—
—
0.3%
—
0.5%
—
—
0.5% 
* Coastal flooding is not applicable for the Midlands. 
Funding Circle established the CRMF in 2024 which underpins its ongoing processes to identify and assess climate-
related risks based on the metrics above. The framework sets safeguard levels to maintain geographical and sectoral 
distribution of the lending portfolio broadly in line with the UK economy. It also sets risk appetite thresholds for physical 
and transition risks based on the proportion of balances outstanding with high exposure to physical risks or to carbon 
intensive sectors Note 5 . 
Currently, “Low temperatures and snow” is the only “high exposure” physical risk subject to CRMF threshold targets 
described in the following section; however, we continue to monitor the UK National Risk Register for any changes. 
Carbon intensive sectors are a sub‑group (Agriculture, Electricity & Utilities, and Mining & Quarrying) of the sectors 
exposed to High transition risk and total 1% of loans outstanding as shown in Table 2. 
5.  For this purpose, Funding Circle defines high exposure to physical risks as a likelihood of ≥5% and an impact of “significant ” or worse based on the UK National 
Risk Register, and it defines carbon intensive sectors as Agriculture, Electricity & Utilities, and Mining and Quarrying.
STRATEGIC REPORT
CORPORATE GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
Funding Circle Holdings plc | Annual Report and Accounts 2024
37

Environment, social and governance (“ESG”) continued
Climate and environment continued 
4. Metrics and targets continued 
Targets 
In 2024, Funding Circle updated its ESG framework to reflect a more granular assessment of the real-world actions 
required to achieve net zero. The framework now sets out the following short, medium and long-term targets related to 
managing climate-related risks and opportunities: 
Table 7: Summary of targets 
Target
Scopes
Target date
FY24 update Status
Change from prior targets/commitments 
Net zero 
All
2050 Note 1 
↓ 11% vs. 
20232 
Too 
early to tell 
No change 
Interim (2025) partial net 
zero (market based) 
1, 2 and 3 
business travel 
2025
↓ 
62% vs. 2023 
On track
Accelerated from prior stretch target to 
reach net zero by 2030 
Enhance data accuracy and 
consider real-world actions – 
including modelling potential 
reduction levers, and 
investigating top supplier-
level emissions data 
3 – all categories 
excluding 
business travel 
2025
—
On track
Supplier, waste and employee commuting 
emissions were previously included in our 
2030 net zero stretch target which has been 
retired recognising the need for outputs 
relating to this new qualitative target before 
further quantitative targets are considered 
Maintain proportion of 
balances outstanding 
subject to high exposure to 
physical risks within agreed 
CRMF thresholds Note 3 
n/a
Annual
<1%
Within 
internal 
thresholds 
New target (internal) 
Maintain proportion of 
balances outstanding 
to carbon intensive 
sectors within agreed 
CRMF thresholds4 
3 – financed 
emissions 
Annual
1%
Within 
internal 
thresholds 
New target (internal) 
2030 net zero 
stretch target for our 
operational emissions 
Scope 1, 2, 3 waste, 
business travel, 
supplier, employee 
commuting 
2030 (2021 
baseline for Scope 
1,2 and 3 waste and 
business travel) 
Retired
Retired
Target data for Scope 1, 2 and business 
travel accelerated to 2025 but target 
removed (pending further analysis) for 
remaining scopes.
Note 1. Funding Circle’s target is to reach net zero in line with the UK government ’s target. This is currently 2050. 
2.  For total emissions including 3.15 financed emissions without adjusting for the sale of our US business. Excluding 3.15 (which increased due to a methodology 
change in 2024) the reduction was 35%. 
3.  Physical risks rated in the National Risk Register with a likelihood ≥5% and impact of significant or higher which is currently “Low temperature and Snow” per 
breakdown in Table 6.2. 
4. Defined as a subset of “carbon-related” sectors: Agriculture, Electricity and Utilities, and Mining and Quarrying, per breakdown in Table 2. 
Our new interim (2025) partial net zero target (market based) reflects our ambition to accelerate progress on 
decarbonisation that’s within our control. This target does not contain the typical requirements for “science-alignment” 
(a 90%+ reduction from a historic baseline) as our 2021 baseline was during the Covid‑19 pandemic and reflects 
significantly muted travel activity. However, we have achieved strong reductions in 2024 (negative 62% vs. 2023) and believe 
that by the end of 2025 we will have taken all possible reasonable actions within our control to reduce absolute Scope 
1, 2 and 3 business travel emissions, leaving only a small tail of hard-to-abate emissions beyond 2025, to be offset in 
line with net zero principles. This is being done through: purchasing renewable electricity for our offices, reducing air 
travel to absolute de minimis levels, and minimising business travel wherever practical. 
We recognise that our most significant categories of emissions, being financed emissions and those relating to 
purchased goods and services, are not currently subject to quantitative targets. As discussed in earlier sections, and 
committed in our near-term qualitative target, we are focused on improving data quality and granularity to provide a 
more accurate view of these emissions and will use this to help us understand what real-world actions are within our 
control or influence before considering targets. We also plan to review the SBTi’s updated Corporate Net Zero and 
Financial Institutions Net Zero Standards, which are expected in 2025, before committing to any further targets. 
Carbon credits 
For reporting periods 2020 to 2022, Funding Circle purchased and retired high quality carbon credits equivalent to the 
annual emissions from our Scope 1, 2 and 3 waste and business travel6. In 2023 and 2024, we retired this approach 
to BVCM in favour of expanding our investment in environmental projects (see page 31). From next year, we anticipate 
offsetting our small remaining tail of hard-to-abate Scope 1, 2 and 3 business travel emissions with carbon credits 
to achieve our interim (2025) partial net zero (market based) target. We intend to undertake further due diligence on 
potential sources of carbon credits and refer to the SBTi’s updated Corporate Net-Zero Standard in 2025 to inform our 
approach to offsetting and broader BVCM activities. 
6. In previous reporting periods we referred to this as achieving carbon neutrality – terminology which we retired when SBTi guidance became available on BVCM.
STRATEGIC REPORT
CORPORATE GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
Funding Circle Holdings plc | Annual Report and Accounts 2024
38

Non-financial and sustainability information statement
This section is produced in order to comply with the reporting requirements in sections 414CA and 414CB of the 
Companies Act 2006 as amended by The Companies (Strategic Report) (Climate‑related Financial Disclosure) 
Regulations 2022, which places requirements on us to incorporate climate disclosures in our Annual Report. We have 
provided the location of relevant disclosures by cross‑reference. Specifically, requirements A-H of section 414CB are 
covered on pages 28 to 38. 
Reporting 
requirement
Policies and standards 
Information necessary to understand 
our business and its impacts
Page reference 
Environmental 
matters 
Funding Circle ESG Framework* ESG 
Risk management 
Principal risks and uncertainties 
Board decision making and section 
172(1) duties 
Report of the ESG Committee 
24 to 38 
51 to 54 
55 to 62 
72 to 73 
88 to 89 
Our employees
Funding Circle Code 
of Conduct* 
People at Funding Circle* 
Whistleblowing Policy* 
DEI Statement 
Communication Handbook 
Our people 
ESG 
Risk management 
Principal risks and uncertainties 
Corporate governance report 
Report of the Audit and Risk Committee 
Report of the ESG Committee 
20 to 23 
24 to 38 
51 to 54 
55 to 62 
70 to 77 
82 to 87 
88 to 89 
Social matters
Funding Circle ESG Framework* 
Customer Complaints* 
ESG 
Social impact 
Engaging our stakeholders 
Our customers 
Risk management 
Report of the Directors 
24 to 38 
26 to 27 
40 to 43 
14 to 15 
51 to 54 
112 to 114 
Human rights
Human Rights Statement* 
External Assurance 
Supplier Standard* 
Supplier Code of Conduct* 
Modern Slavery Statement* 
ESG 
Corporate governance report 
Report of the ESG Committee 
Risk management 
Principal risks and uncertainties 
24 to 38 
70 to 77 
88 to 89 
51 to 54 
55 to 62 
Anti-corruption and 
anti-bribery matters 
Anti-Corruption and 
Bribery Policy* 
Risk management 
Principal risks and uncertainties 
51 to 54 
55 to 62 
Principal risks and 
risk management 
Enterprise Risk Management 
Framework Policy 
Risk management 
Principal risks and uncertainties 
Viability statement 
Report of the Audit and Risk Committee 
51 to 54 
55 to 62 
63 to 64 
82 to 87 
Description of business model 
Our business model 
Our strategy 
8 to 9 
10 to 11 
Non-financial KPIs
Our business model 
Engaging our stakeholders 
8 to 9 
40 to 43 
Relevant policies 
can be found on 
the Company’s 
Sustainability 
webpage
STRATEGIC REPORT
CORPORATE GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
Funding Circle Holdings plc | Annual Report and Accounts 2024
39
*

Engaging our stakeholders
We actively engage with 
all our stakeholders
Our shared mission with borrowers, institutional investors, shareholders and our people is to ensure that a vital, 
historically underserved part of our economy can access the funding it needs to win. We are committed to building 
open and constructive relationships with all our stakeholders. 
In 2024, we engaged with our stakeholders in a variety of ways to ensure they continued to feel connected and 
supported at all times.
 Borrowers
An expanded product set is enabling us to engage with 
and serve more SMEs than ever before, whatever their 
business needs. 
How we engage 
• Real-time monitoring of customer insight from every 
stage of the customer journey, human responses to all 
Google and Trustpilot reviews, and dedicated customer 
support via social media. 
• Regular surveys, focus groups, in-depth interviews 
and in-person borrower visits across the UK by the 
leadership and the broader team to shape our product 
and user experience. 
• Supporting borrowers by continuously updating our 
Purple Pages directory, to encourage employees to 
purchase products and services from small businesses. 
• Sourcing borrower products such as chocolates, tea 
and cakes as prizes and gifts for employees. 
• Twice yearly brand monitoring to an SME panel to measure 
sentiment, satisfaction and comparison against competitors. 
• Regular email updates and communications, including 
on the launch of our new products, changes to 
government guaranteed schemes and continued 
service improvements and resources for borrowers. 
Outcomes of engagement 
• We achieved a Group NPS of 79 (2023: 75). 
• Our Trustpilot score remains at an “Excellent” 4.6 rating. 
• We launched the Cashback credit card to help 
customers earn from their business spending, 
and added features to FlexiPay as a direct result 
of customer feedback, including more flexible 
payment terms, and credit transfers direct to their 
bank accounts.
STRATEGIC REPORT
CORPORATE GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
Funding Circle Holdings plc | Annual Report and Accounts 2024
40

 Circlers
Our people are what make Funding Circle special. We are 
committed to creating an environment where Circlers 
thrive and share our mission, values and ambition. 
How we engage 
• Regular All Hands meetings and our biannual 
Company‑ wide events, including the Full Circle and the 
newly launched CircleIN. These provide an opportunity 
to reinforce Funding Circle’s values and culture by 
bringing everyone physically together as “one team”.
• Meetings between Helen Beck, our Workforce 
Engagement Non-Executive Director, and employee 
groups, with subsequent feedback loops to the Board.
• Six Circler‑led groups (Women @ FC, Let’s Talk 
About Heritage, Circle of Pride, FC Impact, Parents 
@ FC and Neurodiversity @ FC) that empower our 
people to deliver initiatives important to them and our 
DEI agenda.
• Regular employee engagement surveys, with results 
shared with the Board, along with reports and updates 
on diversity and inclusion initiatives. 
Outcomes of engagement 
• Continued to embed our value, “Obsess over the 
customer” by giving Circlers the opportunity 
to visit Funding Circle borrowers to learn about 
their businesses.
• Delivered an allyship training programme, to further 
strengthen our education on diversity, equity and inclusion.
• Supported Circler resource groups in delivering over 50 
initiatives and events.
• 2024 engagement results achieved an overall score 
of 64.3% with 61% recommending Funding Circle as a 
place to work. 
Section 172(1) statement 
The Directors recognise that they have a duty to 
promote the success of the Company in accordance 
with section 172(1) of the Companies Act 2006. Further 
details on how the Board operates and the way in 
which it reaches decisions, including the matters 
discussed and debated during the year, are set out 
in the Governance section on pages 66 to 115. Some 
examples of how the Directors have had regard 
to the factors set out in section 172(1) (a) (f) when 
discharging their duties are on pages 72 and 73. 
STRATEGIC REPORT
CORPORATE GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
Funding Circle Holdings plc | Annual Report and Accounts 2024
41

Engaging our stakeholders continued
 Institutional investors
Providing stable and attractive returns to a 
diverse range of institutional investors is a central 
part of our strategy. 
How we engage 
• We actively engage with all types of institutional 
investors – for example asset managers, banks, 
insurance companies and pension funds – to share 
details of our products and services. This includes 
a presence at key global conferences, investor 
roadshows and bespoke meetings.
• We provide information and support to existing 
institutional investors in a range of accessible 
formats, including monthly and daily reporting 
on their investments. 
Outcomes of engagement 
• We onboarded new, and re-signed a number of 
existing, institutional investors, further diversifying our 
funding investor base across our product suite/product 
family offering.
• Continued institutional investor demand to fund loans 
– with an active forward pipeline.
 Shareholders
We maintain transparent and open engagement with 
our shareholders. This enables the Board to clearly 
communicate its strategy, provide updates on our 
performance and receive regular feedback. 
How we engage 
• Regular shareholder communications such as full and 
half-year results, and ad hoc regulatory news service 
announcements.
• In early 2024 and 2025, we actively consulted with 
top shareholders to get feedback on our proposed 
Remuneration Policies prior to them being circulated 
for approval at our 2024 and 2025 Annual General 
Meetings (“AGMs”).
• Held analyst and investor meetings and presentations/ 
roadshows, as well as ad hoc meetings and events 
with shareholders and prospective shareholders.
• The 2024 AGM was once again open to shareholders, 
offering an in-person opportunity for shareholders to 
interact with the Board.
• The Chair, Chief Executive Officer and Chief Financial 
Officer regularly communicate with shareholders and 
analysts as required and provide regular reports to the 
Board on shareholder interactions. 
Outcomes of engagement
• Took into account views of major shareholders through 
the year when shaping Company strategy and other 
key developments, including our new Remuneration 
Policies in 2024 and 2025, as well as announcing two 
share buybacks and a capital reduction.
STRATEGIC REPORT
CORPORATE GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
Funding Circle Holdings plc | Annual Report and Accounts 2024
42

 Communities
The SMEs we serve are at the centre of our 
communities. We are passionate advocates of 
community engagement and charitable causes that 
deliver social impact. 
How we engage 
• Continuous evolution and implementation of our ESG 
strategy, including our priorities for engagement with 
our various stakeholders.
• Regular touch points with institutional investors, 
including discussions regarding their ESG investment 
criteria as they apply to fund Funding Circle’s business 
finance products.
• Sustained approach to corporate partnerships to 
drive social and sustainability outcomes for SMEs and 
communities, including through employee engagement.
• Employee-led volunteering and charity initiatives led by 
Circler group FC Impact. 
Outcomes of engagement 
• Progressed our ESG strategy, which sets out a formal 
framework for operating as a responsible business and 
is overseen by our ESG Committee.
• Extended our partnership with Thrive Mental Wellbeing, 
an app trusted by the NHS, to help all UK small 
business leaders and employees get more support 
with their mental health.
• Continued to support charities delivering social and 
environmental value, such as Earthwatch’s citizen 
science campaigns, and Hatch Enterprise, which 
empowers underrepresented entrepreneurs to launch 
and grow their businesses, along with Funding Circle 
volunteers providing mentoring.
• Raised £12,828 for UK charities during 2024 and 
Circlers contributed 171 volunteering “Impact Days” 
in support of a range of good causes, including our 
charity of the year, Refuge.
 Government and regulators
Our goal is for Funding Circle to always be known as 
a trusted and reputable company, and to work with 
regulators and industry to ensure best practice. 
How we engage 
• Engagement with local, national and supra-national 
government agencies, including regulators, legislators, 
policymakers and industry groups. These interactions 
provide insight and leadership on policy and rule 
making related to issues affecting SME borrowers, 
institutional investors or lending in the fintech industry.
• Contribution to the discourse and debate on industry 
issues, including submitting position papers and 
participating in expert hearings, consultations, forums 
and other policy engagement initiatives.
• The Board ensures it uses the results of the above 
engagement, as well as key legal and regulatory 
changes affecting the business, to inform its strategy 
and decision making. 
Outcomes of engagement 
• Continued to work with the British Business Bank 
(“BBB”) as we started participating in the GGS, the 
successor to the UK government’s Recovery Loan 
Scheme; engaged with industry groups on issues 
such as levelling the playing field for fintech lenders 
and reviving the UK small and mid-cap market; and 
responded to the Treasury Committee’s enquiry into the 
accessibility of finance and lending to SMEs, including 
giving oral evidence.
STRATEGIC REPORT
CORPORATE GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
Funding Circle Holdings plc | Annual Report and Accounts 2024
43

Financial review
Strong performance 
and delivery against 
strategic objectives
Tony Nicol 
Chief Financial Officer 
 “We were pleased with the 
strong operational and 
strategic performance in 
2024. We saw significant 
growth in both of 
our businesses and 
improved profitability 
compared to 2023.” 
STRATEGIC REPORT
CORPORATE GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
Overview of the year ended 31 December 2024 
We were pleased with the strong operational and 
strategic performance in 2024. We saw significant 
growth in both of our businesses and improved Group 
profitability compared to 2023. The Group comprises 
two continuing Business Units which are at different 
stages of maturity: Term Loans (a longer-term financial 
product offering) and FlexiPay (a shorter-term working 
capital product). 
In H2 2024 we launched a Cashback credit card 
product. Given its recent launch, its contribution is 
relatively minimal. We have therefore included its results, 
transactions and balances in the FlexiPay segment. 
The US business was sold on 1 July 2024 and is therefore 
treated as discontinued in the year. 
Originations and 
transactions 
Balances under 
management 
FY 2024 
£m 
FY 2023 
£m 
31 
December 
2024 
£m 
31 
December 
2023 
£m 
Continuing 
operations 
UK Term Loans
1,407
1,060
2,714
2,853 
Other
—
—
n/a
11 
FlexiPay
492
234
119
58 
Total
1,899
1,294
2,833
2,922 
Term Loans 
Term Loans originations increased by 33% to £1,407 million 
(2023: £1,060 million). Growth was driven by increased 
applications, product innovation and enhancements. We 
participated in the third iteration of the Recovery Loan 
Scheme (“RLS”) (H2 2023 to H1 2024) and the longer‑term 
government guarantee programme, the Growth Guarantee 
Scheme (“GGS”) (from H2 2024). These schemes have 
enabled us to provide finance to SMEs in parts of the 
market we would not have reached otherwise. 
Funding Circle Holdings plc | Annual Report and Accounts 2024
44

Segmental highlights
31 December 2024 Note 1 
31 December 20231 
Continuing operations
Continuing operations 
United Kingdom
United Kingdom
Other
Total 
Term 
Loans 
£m 
FlexiPay 
£m 
Total 
£m 
Term 
Loans 
£m 
FlexiPay 
£m 
Term 
Loans 
£m 
Total 
£m 
Transaction fees
84.7
0.6
85.3
65.2 
0.1 
— 
65.3 
Servicing fees
37.5
—
37.5
38.8 
— 
0.2 
39.0 
Interest income
8.3
22.6
30.9
7.5 
7.8 
0.1 
15.4 
Other fees
5.1
0.1
5.2
6.3 
— 
0.1 
6.4 
Operating income
135.6
23.3
158.9
117.8 
7.9 
0.4 
126.1 
Net investment income
2.8
—
2.8
3.6 
— 
— 
3.6 
Total income
138.4
23.3
161.7
121.4 
7.9 
0.4 
129.7 
Fair value gains
4.2
—
4.2
3.1 
— 
— 
3.1 
Cost of funds
—
(5.8)
(5.8)
— 
(2.7)
— 
(2.7) 
Net income (“revenue”)
142.6
17.5
160.1
124.5 
5.2 
0.4 
130.1 
Adjusted EBITDA
37.0
(12.5)
24.5
21.3 
(14.4)
(0.2)
6.7 
Discount unwind on lease liabilities
(0.6)
—
(0.6)
(0.2)
— 
— 
(0.2) 
Depreciation, amortisation, impairment and modification 
gains/(losses)
(11.4)
(1.8) 
(13.2)
(11.3)
(1.3)
— 
(12.6) 
Share-based payments and social security costs
(6.5)
(1.3)
(7.8)
(3.3)
(0.5)
— 
(3.8) 
Exceptional items
(2.3)
(0.3)
(2.6)
— 
— 
— 
— 
Foreign exchange gains
0.5
—
0.5
— 
— 
— 
— 
Profit/(loss) before tax
16.7
(15.9)
0.8
6.5 
(16.2)
(0.2)
(9.9) 
1.  In the year to 31 December 2024, “Other” Term Loans are presented within the UK business segment on the basis that the legacy European operations included 
within Other are immaterial. The comparative period has not been re-presented. The segmental results of the US business are not presented above.
Term loan originations were funded in a platform model 
through forward flow agreements with institutional 
investors. As the loans are owned by these institutional 
investors, the Loans under Management (“LuM”) do not 
form part of Funding Circle’s balance sheet. 
We have also continued to grow originations through our 
Marketplace network of third party finance providers, 
where we refer SMEs if we are unable to lend to them 
directly, earning a commission. This allows us to support 
an even greater number of SMEs access to a wide range 
of financing options. 
Despite strong originations in the year, LuM decreased 
in 2024 as the amortisation of the legacy Covid-19 
government-guaranteed loans outpaced growth in new 
lending. As at 31 December 2024, the legacy Covid-19 
loans represented £743 million (31 December 2023: 
£1,457 million), c.27% of total LuM. We expect Term Loan 
LuM to grow in 2025. 
As at 31 December 2024, we have c.£2.1 billion of forward 
funding in place for future originations. 
FlexiPay and Cashback credit card 
Our line of credit product, FlexiPay, has demonstrated 
significant growth to date and we continue to invest in it. 
We successfully launched our Cashback credit card in H2 
2024 with a good uptake from our customers. 
Transactions more than doubled since FY 2023, reaching 
£492 million (2023: £234 million), demonstrating 
strong customer engagement. Drawn lines of credit 
(“balances”) grew to £119 million at 31 December 2024 
(2023: £58 million), in line with transaction growth. 
FlexiPay and the Cashback credit card are funded by 
Funding Circle capital and a senior debt facility. The lines 
of credit are part of Funding Circle’s balance sheet. 
Finance review 
Overview 
Revenue from continuing operations was £160.1 million 
(2023: £130.1 million), a 23% increase. Revenue consists 
of total income, fair value movements on SME loans held 
for sale and investments in trusts. It is net of cost of funds 
on the senior debt facility for FlexiPay. 
The Group made a profit before tax (before exceptional 
items) from continuing operations of £3.4 million (2023: 
loss of £9.9 million). The exceptional items of £2.6 million 
related to restructuring undertaken in the UK, mainly 
comprising redundancy costs. After exceptional items, 
the profit before tax from continuing operations was 
£0.8 million (2023: loss of £9.9 million).
STRATEGIC REPORT
CORPORATE GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
Funding Circle Holdings plc | Annual Report and Accounts 2024
45

Financial review continued
Term Loans business 
The Term Loans business delivered revenue of 
£142.6 million growing 15% on FY 2023. This growth 
came principally from the growth in originations and the 
corresponding transaction fees. Servicing fees reduced 
in the year, reflecting the reduction in LuM. 
The start of 2024 saw heightened demand from borrowers 
which normalised in the second quarter. We did experience 
more subdued demand over the summer months when 
businesses were awaiting the new government’s October 
Budget, and we then saw demand pick up in the final quarter. 
Term Loans generated AEBITDA of £37.0 million in 2024 
compared to £21.3 million in the prior year, with AEBITDA 
margin improvement. This demonstrated the strong 
operational leverage we are achieving from the more 
mature business, where costs above AEBITDA increased 
by 2.3%, following cost actions while revenue grew by 15%. 
Profit before tax and exceptional items was £19.0 million, 
up from £6.5 million in FY 2023, primarily due to the 
growth in AEBITDA. After exceptional items, profit before 
tax was £16.7 million, compared with £6.5 million in 2023. 
FlexiPay and Cashback credit card 
Revenue for FlexiPay was £17.5 million in 2024, increasing 
from £5.2 million in 2023 as a result of a rise in the 
number of transactions and fee growth. 
When the product was initially launched customers were 
able to draw and repay within a 3-month period. In H1 
2024 we expanded repayment options to include 1, 3, 6, 9 
and 12 months, with fees varying depending on payback 
period. As a result, the average fee for each drawdown 
grew to 5.8% (2023: 4.6%), reflecting a longer average 
repayment period of 4 months. 
A Cashback credit card was launched in H2 2024. When 
customers transact using cards, we earn an interchange 
fee of 1.75% alongside interest on any revolving balances. 
The revenues earned from the Cashback credit card in 
2024 were relatively minimal. 
FlexiPay is funded through Funding Circle invested capital 
and a senior debt facility with Citibank (it was solely funded 
by Funding Circle until June 2023). The interest payable on 
this facility is shown in “cost of funds” and is based on SONIA 
plus a margin. This facility is for £150 million with the ability to 
upsize further and is due for renewal in August 2025. 
The AEBITDA result was negative £12.5 million (2023: 
negative £14.4 million), with continued investment to 
support product momentum. The principal costs incurred 
include staff-related expenses, marketing costs and 
expected credit losses which are required to be recognised 
upfront for both drawn and undrawn lines of credit. 
As the business continues to grow, we anticipate ongoing 
investment with a resultant increase in the cost base, 
principally marketing and expected credit losses. Once 
onboarded, we earn repeat revenues as the customer 
uses the product. 
US Term Loans business 
As was previously announced, the Group signed an 
agreement in June 2024 to sell the US business to iBusiness 
Funding, LLC. The sale was completed on 1 July 2024, 
at which point the US business was deconsolidated. The 
operations of the US business are presented in a single line 
as discontinued operations within the financial statements. 
The Group recognised a gain on sale of £9.8 million 
(excluding foreign exchange reserve recycling through 
the profit and loss). Further details can be found in the 
financial statements in note 3.
How we make money from different products 
Revenue stream
Term Loans
FlexiPay 
Cashback 
credit card
2024 Typical yield %
2024 Driver 
Fees 
Transaction fees 
c.6%
Originations 
Servicing fees1 
c.1.5%
LuM 
Drawdown fees 
c.5.8%
Transactions 
Interchange fees 
1.75%
Transactions 
Other 
Bank interest 
Variable
Cash balances 
and base rates 
Investment income 
Variable
Invested capital 
Note 1. 	 Servicing fees include other fees.
STRATEGIC REPORT
CORPORATE GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
Funding Circle Holdings plc | Annual Report and Accounts 2024
46

Profit and loss 
Before 
exceptional 
items 
£m 
Exceptional 
items 
£m 
31 December 
2024 
Total 
£m 
31 December 
2023 
(re‑presented) 1 
£m 
Transaction fees
85.3
—
85.3
65.3 
Servicing fees
37.5
—
37.5
39.0 
Interest income
30.9
—
30.9
15.4 
Other fees
5.2
—
5.2
6.4 
Operating income
158.9
—
158.9
126.1 
Net investment income
2.8
—
2.8
3.6 
Total income
161.7
—
161.7
129.7 
Fair value gains
4.2
—
4.2
3.1 
Cost of funds
(5.8)
—
(5.8)
(2.7) 
Net income (“revenue”)
160.1
—
160.1
130.1 
People costs
(68.1)
(2.3)
(70.4)
(65.5) 
Marketing costs
(45.6)
—
(45.6)
(37.1) 
Depreciation, amortisation and impairment
(13.2)
(0.3)
(13.5)
(12.6) 
Expected credit loss charge
(8.6)
—
(8.6)
(4.5) 
Other costs
(21.2)
—
(21.2)
(20.3) 
Operating expenses
(156.7)
(2.6)
(159.3)
(140.0) 
Profit/(loss) before tax from continuing operations
3.4
(2.6)
0.8
(9.9) 
1.  The comparative consolidated statement of comprehensive income has been re-presented to reflect the results of the US business as a discontinued operation. 
Operating income includes transaction fees, servicing 
fees, interest income from loans held at amortised 
cost, interest on cash balances and other fees and 
was £158.9 million (2023: £126.1 million). 
• Transaction fees, representing fees earned 
on originations, increased to £85.3 million 
(2023: £65.3 million), driven by growth in originations as 
the business continued to expand its Term Loan offering 
to more segments of the market, and attract more 
applications from SMEs. Average transaction fee yields 
decreased in the Term Loans business to 6.0% (2023: 
6.2%) due to the mix in government‑guaranteed/non‑
government lending. 
 
• Servicing fees, representing income for servicing LuM, 
were £37.5 million (2023: £39.0 million). The fees move 
in line with the quantum of LuM, which decreased in the 
Term Loans business as growth in LuM from new lending 
was offset by continued repayment on the legacy Covid-19 
scheme loans outpacing the impact of new originations. 
• Servicing fees are not charged on FlexiPay lines of 
credit. Servicing yields remain similar to 2023 levels. 
• Interest income represents: i) The fees earned on 
FlexiPay lines of credit and interest earned on cash 
and cash equivalents. FlexiPay interest income is a fee 
charged on transactions and spread over a number 
of months, in line with borrower repayments. It has 
increased to £21.3 million (2023: £7.6 million), driven by 
transaction levels and the average fees on transactions 
which were 5.8% in the year (2023: 4.6%).
ii) Interest earned on cash and cash equivalents 
increased to £9.2 million (2023: £7.4 million) in line 
with higher average base rates. This interest applies 
to the Group’s unrestricted cash as well as restricted 
cash drawn from the Citi facility in anticipation of 
future drawdowns. 
• Other fees arose principally from collection fees we 
recovered on defaulted loans. 
Net investment income represents the investment 
income, less investment expense, on loans held on 
balance sheet at fair value. It declined to £2.8 million 
(2023: £3.6 million), driven by the continued amortisation 
of the remaining loans on balance sheet. 
Net income (“revenue”), defined as total income after 
fair value adjustments and cost of funds, was £160.1 
million (2023: £130.1 million). The fair value gain in the 
year of £4.2 million (2023: £3.1 million) related primarily 
to certain investment in trusts and co-investments, which 
were sold earlier than originally anticipated thereby 
accelerating the receipt of future cash flows, which were 
valued at a discount. As the on-balance sheet loans 
continue to amortise, we would expect fair value gains/ 
losses to decline in future. 
STRATEGIC REPORT
CORPORATE GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
Funding Circle Holdings plc | Annual Report and Accounts 2024
47

Financial review continued
Operating expenses: At an overall level, operating 
expenses increased compared with 2023. However, costs 
remain actively and tightly managed with a 12% increase 
in expenses before exceptional items compared to a 23% 
growth in revenue. 
The primary drivers of cost growth were the variable 
expenses associated with marketing and expected credit 
losses. Marketing costs increased by 23% to £45.6 million 
and expected credit losses increased to £8.6 million from 
£4.5 million, primarily due to growth in FlexiPay balances. 
For the remaining costs, share based payments grew by 
£4.0 million, driven by the growth in share price which 
impacts employers’ national insurance costs. Excluding 
this, the costs remained flat year on year with salary 
expenses decreasing following the restructuring. 
Exceptional items – restructuring: As part of its ongoing 
commitment to profitability, the Group launched a cost 
efficiency programme during the year. These actions are 
on track to deliver an annualised run rate cash saving of 
~£15 million in 2025 and an actual reduction in the overall 
number of roles by c.120. This resulted in redundancy 
costs of £2.3 million and impairment of capitalised 
development spend intangible assets of £0.3 million 
which were treated as exceptional items. 
People costs (including contractors) represent the 
Group’s largest ongoing operating cost and include 
salary-related costs plus share-based payments. 
Salary-related costs reduced by 2% in the year with 
the savings achieved from the restructuring more than 
offsetting inflation, new hires and the absorption of 
global costs previously allocated to the US business. 
The average salary per head increased by 5%. 
The share-based payment charge for the year, included 
in people costs, was £7.8 million (2023: £3.8 million), 
largely driven by a higher share price which increases 
the national insurance costs associated with the awards. 
Following the UK Government’s Budget in October 2024, 
we expect that the Group’s employer’s national insurance 
will increase by c.£2 million. 
Continuing operations 
31 December 
2024 
£m 
31 December 
2023 
£m 
Change 
% 
Salary costs
69.3
70.9
(2) 
Less capitalised development spend (“CDS”)
(9.0)
(9.2)
(2) 
Salary costs net of CDS
60.3
61.7
(2) 
Share-based payments
7.8
3.8
105 
Total people costs
68.1
65.5
4 
Average headcount (incl. contractors)
788
845
(7) 
Year-end headcount (incl. contractors)
726
857
(15) 
Marketing costs comprise performance marketing (direct 
mail and online), brand spend and commission payments 
made to brokers. Marketing costs increased in the year to 
£45.6 million (2023: £37.1 million). 
Depreciation, amortisation and impairment costs 
of £13.5 million (2023: £12.6 million) largely represent 
the amortisation of the cost of the Group’s capitalised 
technology development and the depreciation of right-
of-use assets related to the Group’s office lease. Included 
within this charge is £0.3 million exceptional impairment 
of intangible assets related to projects used for activities 
deprioritised as a result of our go forward focus. 
Expected credit losses principally relate to the IFRS 
9 charge for FlexiPay where we account for actual and 
future expected credit losses from SMEs defaulting on 
their lines of credit. We would expect this charge to 
increase as FlexiPay and Cashback credit card grow. 
Other operating costs, which consist of loan processing 
costs, data and technology, professional fees and staff 
and office-related costs, have grown as the Group 
continued to invest in growth in the FlexiPay business. 
The increase is driven by inflation, higher volumes and 
loan processing costs.
STRATEGIC REPORT
CORPORATE GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
Funding Circle Holdings plc | Annual Report and Accounts 2024
48

Balance sheet and investments 
The Group’s net equity was £217 million at 31 December 2024 (31 December 2023: £247 million). This reduction reflects the 
share buyback by the Group. 
The majority of the Group’s balance sheet is represented by cash and invested capital as shown below. The invested capital 
is in certain SME loans, either directly or historically through investment vehicles, and in the FlexiPay lines of credit. 
Operating business
Investment business 
Term Loans 
business 
£m 
FlexiPay 
£m 
Legacy 
securitisation, 
warehouse 
and other 
loans at 
fair value 
£m 
CBILS/ 
RLS/GGS/ 
commercial 
co-investments 
£m 
Private 
funds 
£m 
31 December 
2024 
Total 
£m 
31 December 
2023 
Total 
£m 
SME loans and lines 
of credit
2.1
97.1
1.2
17.8
0.6
118.8
102.0 
Cash and cash 
equivalents 
Unrestricted
150.2
0.3
—
—
—
150.5
169.6 
Restricted
—
32.1
—
5.0
—
37.1
51.8 
Other assets
—
6.3
—
—
—
6.3
2.7 
Borrowings
—
(101.9)
—
—
—
(101.9)
(56.9) 
Cash and net 
investments
152.3
33.9
1.2
22.8
0.6
210.8
269.2 
Other assets
45.3
—
—
—
—
45.3
47.1 
Other liabilities
(34.6)
—
—
(5.0)
—
(39.6)
(69.5) 
Equity
163.0
33.9
1.2
17.8
0.6
216.5
246.8 
The table below provides a summation of Funding Circle’s net invested capital in products and vehicles: 
Investment in product/vehicles 
31 December 
2024 
£m 
31 December 
2023 
£m 
1. Legacy securitisation, warehouse and other loans at fair value
1
19 
2. CBILS/RLS/GGS/commercial co-investments Note 1 
18
25 
3. Private funds
1
2 
Net invested
20
46 
FlexiPay Note 1 
34
18 
Total net invested capital
54
64 
Note 1. 	 These vehicles are bankruptcy remote, see note 29 of the financial statements for details. 
Legacy loans at fair value – this relates to the legacy loans previously held in SPVs and warehouses and reduced 
through the sale of the US business and ongoing amortisation.
CBILS/RLS/GGS/commercial co-investments – as part of our participation in the CBILS, RLS and GGS UK 
government-guaranteed loan schemes, we were required to co-invest c.1% alongside institutional investors. 
Private funds – there are a small amount of other loans, comprising seed investments in private funds held 
as associates. 
STRATEGIC REPORT
CORPORATE GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
Funding Circle Holdings plc | Annual Report and Accounts 2024
49

Cash flow 
At 31 December 2024, the Group’s cash position was 
£187.6 million (31 December 2023: £221.4 million). Of this 
balance £150.5 million (31 December 2023: £169.6 million) 
is unrestricted in its use with £37.1 million (£51.8 million) 
being restricted. 
Restricted cash relates to cash held in the funding vehicle 
of FlexiPay together with amounts owed to the British 
Business Bank (“BBB”) for guarantee fees collected 
from institutional investors under the participation of the 
CBILS, RLS and GGS schemes. Total cash movements 
have principally been driven by: 
i) trading performance; 
ii)  timing of working capital movements associated with 
UK government loan guarantee payments received 
from investors still to be paid to the BBB; 
iii)  monetisation of on-balance sheet SME loans as they 
have continued to pay down; 
iv)  ongoing investment in FlexiPay lines of credit with 
external bank debt; and 
v)  purchase of shares as part of the share 
buyback programme. 
Free cash flow, excluding the one-off guarantee fee 
payment, has significantly improved year on year, and 
is nearing positive, driven by the disposal of the loss-
making US business and the move to profitability of the 
continuing UK Group. 
Free cash flow, which is an alternative performance 
measure, represents the net cash flows from operating 
activities less the cost of purchasing intangible assets, 
property, plant and equipment and lease payments. It 
excludes the investment vehicle financing and funding 
cash flows together with FlexiPay lines of credit and 
Cashback credit card. The Directors view this as a key 
liquidity measure and it is the net amount of cash used or 
generated to operate and develop the Group’s platform 
each year. 
The table below shows how the Group’s cash has been utilised: 
2024 
£m 
2023 
£m 
Adjusted EBITDA from continuing operations
24.5
6.7 
Adjusted EBITDA from discontinued operations
(8.7)
(10.6) 
Adjusted EBITDA
15.8
(3.9) 
Fair value adjustments
(6.4)
(8.7) 
Purchase of tangible and intangible assets
(11.9)
(12.2) 
Payment of lease liabilities
(3.2)
(6.0) 
Working capital/other
4.5
2.9 
Free cash flow (excl. restricted cash movement due to guarantee fee payment)
(1.2)
(27.9) 
Cash movement due to guarantee fee payment
(26.1)
23.0 
Free cash flow
(27.3)
(4.9) 
Net distributions from associates
0.9
1.2 
Net movement in trusts and co-investments
10.5
4.8 
Net movement in lines of credit (net of borrowings)
(7.5)
15.8 
Net movement in SME loans at amortised cost (net of borrowings)
2.2
(3.3) 
Net movement in loans at fair value through profit and loss (net of bonds)
13.5
32.7 
Share buyback/purchase of own shares
(33.7)
(1.8) 
Net proceeds from sale of US business
7.5
— 
Effect of foreign exchange
0.1
(0.8) 
Movement in the year
(33.8)
43.7 
Cash and cash equivalents at the beginning of the year
221.4
177.7 
Cash and cash equivalents at the end of the year
187.6
221.4 
Share buybacks 
During the year, the Group announced two share buybacks totalling up to £50 million. As at 31 December 2024, 
33.5 million shares have been purchased for £33.7 million. The shares have been cancelled, reducing share 
capital by c.9%.
Financial review continued
STRATEGIC REPORT
CORPORATE GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
Funding Circle Holdings plc | Annual Report and Accounts 2024
50

Risk management
Delivering superior 
risk-adjusted returns
Belkacem Krimi 
Chief Risk Officer 
“
As we enter 2025, we are 
optimistic about our future. 
With the increasing reliance 
of UK SMEs on non-bank 
fintech lenders, we are well-
positioned to capitalise on 
this trend.”
2024: A year of economic uncertainty and continued 
SME resilience 
2024 ended with greater uncertainty over the UK 
economy than when it began and growth expectations 
are now within the boundaries of a wider confidence 
interval. Early hopes of easing inflation were tempered 
by the new government’s October budget in the UK and 
the US election, both of which sowed uncertainty and 
dampened consumer and business confidence. While 
acute inflationary pressures have largely subsided, 
central banks remain cautious due to persistent risks 
impacting the labour market, including potential trade 
barriers and demographic challenges. The rapid 
advancement of AI further complicates the economic 
outlook, presenting both opportunities and challenges. 
Despite these late-year headwinds, we successfully 
navigated the higher-rate environment. Our credit 
portfolios have performed well, demonstrating 
the resilience of UK SMEs and the strength of our 
underwriting. As we enter 2025, the full implementation 
of Labour’s economic policies and the trajectory of US 
trade policy will be pivotal in shaping the UK economic 
landscape and influencing SME investment and financing 
decisions. We remain vigilant, closely monitoring these 
developments and positioning our products to capitalise 
on emerging opportunities. 
As always, we commend the adaptability of UK SMEs 
and remain optimistic about their long-term prospects. 
While short-term challenges persist, our focus on 
superior service, product innovation and leveraging AI 
will enable us to navigate these uncertain times and 
emerge stronger. 
A simpler Funding Circle helping more UK SMEs 
2024 was a year of significant transformation for Funding 
Circle. By streamlining our operations and focusing on 
the UK market, we emerged as a more agile and resilient 
organisation. Our strategic pivot was well-received by 
stakeholders, and we consistently executed on our plans.
STRATEGIC REPORT
CORPORATE GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
Funding Circle Holdings plc | Annual Report and Accounts 2024
51

Risk management continued
A simpler Funding Circle helping more UK SMEs 
continued 
Our credit portfolios demonstrated resilience in the face 
of a deteriorating market, showcasing the strength of 
our underwriting and risk management practices. This 
resilience, coupled with our commitment to innovation, 
has enabled us to expand our product offerings to 
cater to more SME needs, allowing them to borrow, 
pay later, and spend with Funding Circle. By providing 
broader access to finance for SMEs, we empower more 
businesses with more financing solutions and we enable 
economic growth. 
We continue to strengthen our risk management 
framework and continuously improve our underwriting 
models with advanced data and risk analytics, using 
the latest trends in decision science. To ensure the 
security and integrity of our platform, we invest in risk 
management, cybersecurity and fraud prevention. 
These measures safeguard our customers and protect 
their financial interests, reinforcing our position as a 
trusted partner in the financial services industry. Our 
commitment to ESG is unwavering, as we integrate ESG 
factors into our risk management framework to build a 
sustainable and responsible business. 
Finally, I am very proud of our internal culture of risk 
awareness. Circlers are empowered to identify and manage 
risks, fostering a culture of risk awareness and accountability. 
Looking Ahead 
As we enter 2025, we are optimistic about our future. 
With the increasing reliance of UK SMEs on non-bank 
fintech lenders, we are well-positioned to capitalise on 
this trend. Our goal is to accelerate our growth, double 
down on our strengths and empower even more SMEs to 
achieve their full potential. 
While we anticipate ongoing market volatility, Funding 
Circle is well-prepared to navigate these challenges. 
Our strong financial position, operational efficiency and 
experienced team provide us with a competitive edge. We 
are confident in our ability to deliver sustainable growth 
and create value for all stakeholders. 
Risk culture 
At Funding Circle, we recognise that fostering an open 
and robust risk culture is integral to promoting ethical 
behaviour and professional conduct. As part of our 
ongoing commitment to upholding the Company’s values, 
we actively promote this risk culture, encouraging Circlers 
to consistently ‘Do the Right Thing’ in their interactions 
with customers, colleagues, the environment, the 
community and other stakeholders. 
Board role 
The Board is responsible for setting the strategy, 
corporate objectives, and risk appetite. It has delegated 
responsibility for reviewing the effectiveness of the 
Group’s risk management framework to the ARC. On 
the advice of the ARC, the Board approves the level of 
risk acceptable under each principal risk category while 
providing oversight to ensure an adequate framework for 
reporting and managing those risks. 
Chief Risk Officer (‘‘CRO’’) and the Risk function 
Our CRO leads the Risk function, which is independent 
of the business and has a direct reporting line to the 
Board. He is responsible for developing, maintaining 
and implementing the Enterprise Risk Management 
Framework (ERMF). He is also responsible for providing 
assurance to the Board that the principal risks are 
appropriately managed and that Funding Circle operates 
within risk appetite. 
Risk management policies 
We have established and implemented comprehensive 
risk management policies that outline mandatory 
requirements for mitigating the principal risks faced by 
the organisation. These policies include clearly defined 
risk limits and monitoring mechanisms to ensure ongoing 
adherence. Our Risk and Compliance teams conduct 
regular reviews of these policies and controls to assess 
compliance and make adjustments as necessary to 
address evolving business conditions. 
Risk appetite 
Our risk appetite is defined as the level of risk that we, 
as a company, are prepared to accept whilst pursuing 
our core business strategy, recognising a range of 
possible outcomes as business plans are implemented. 
Having set the risk appetite, the Board regularly reviews 
the Company’s risk profile against it. The risk appetite 
framework serves as a guideline for shaping business 
strategies and determining the necessary level of control. 
Furthermore, it establishes a foundation for ongoing 
dialogue between management and the Board regarding 
Funding Circle’s current and evolving risk profile, enabling 
strategic and financial decisions to be made with greater 
insight and confidence. 
Risk governance 
Funding Circle has a robust risk governance framework, 
as outlined in the ERMF. The Board is ultimately 
responsible for defining and approving the ERMF, with 
delegations of authority granted to the Group Board, the 
UK Board and relevant Principal Risk Committees. 
Throughout 2024, we effectively managed our principal 
risks through a Three Lines of Defence model, operating 
in conjunction with our well-defined risk governance 
structure. The ARC is supported by the Management 
Risk Committee (MRC), comprised of members of the 
Executive Committee. 
Effective January 2025, we implemented a new risk 
governance structure to enhance efficiency and focus on 
core risk management activities. This revised structure 
emphasises key areas such as Board risk appetite, 
committee scorecards, and updates on material risk 
incidents while minimising the administrative complexities 
of the previous model. 
Under this revised structure, our business will continue 
to operate within the Three Lines of Defence model. 
Executive management will retain full ownership and 
responsibility for risk management, underscoring our 
commitment to proactive and disciplined risk oversight.
STRATEGIC REPORT
CORPORATE GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
Funding Circle Holdings plc | Annual Report and Accounts 2024
52

Risk governance structure 
Board Governance Committees 
Funding Circle Holdings plc Board 
Funding Circle Holdings plc 
Audit and Risk Committee 
Funding Circle Holdings plc 
Market Disclosure Committee 
Executive Governance Committee 
Management Risk Committee 
Management & Implementation Committees 
Technology Risk Committee
Term Loans Risk Committee
FlexiPay Risk Committee 
Management Risk Committee (MRC) 
The MRC provides an oversight in assessing all principal 
and other emerging risks. It supports & challenges 
risk mitigation and acceptance. It reviews risk reports, 
monitors strategic risks, and ensures risk integration 
in planning and budgeting. It also approves relevant 
policies, drives ESG risk strategies, and monitors audit 
and compliance findings for effective remediation. 
Technology Risk Committee (TRC) 
The focus of the TRC is to ensure effective governance 
and controls are in place for the ongoing management 
of risks that could impact the performance, stability, 
information security and resilience of the technology 
infrastructure and operations that support our key 
business and compliance processes. 
Term Loans Risk Committee (TLRC) 
The TLRC facilitates and monitors the implementation 
of effective risk management practices by the business 
insofar as they relate to regulatory, reputational and 
conduct risk, operational risk and credit risk for Term 
Loan products, Marketplace and retail investor products. 
FlexiPay Risk Committee (FRC) 
The FRC facilitates and monitors the implementation 
of effective risk management practices by the business 
insofar as they relate to regulatory, reputational & conduct 
risk, operational risk and credit risk for FlexiPay and 
Cashback credit card products.
STRATEGIC REPORT
CORPORATE GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
Funding Circle Holdings plc | Annual Report and Accounts 2024
53

Risk assessment 
framework
A standard risk assessment framework is used to evaluate risks 
at both the Business Unit and Group levels, enabling consistent  
measurement. Risk assessments are carried out by those 
individuals, teams and departments that are best placed to 
identify and assess potential risks. They are supported in this 
process by our Risk and Compliance teams. 
We typically follow the evaluate/respond/ 
monitor methodology: 
Enterprise risk 
management 
1 
2 
3
1. Evaluate 
• Identify key risks 
• Set risk appetite 
• Assess adequacy of existing controls 
• Estimate residual risk 
2. Respond 
• Design control improvement plans 
• Prioritise remediation work and assign 
responsibilities 
3. Monitor 
• Track business performance vs. risk appetite 
• Report, analyse and escalate risk incidents 
• Identify new or emerging risks 
• Track delivery of agreed control improvements
Evaluate 
As part of its responsibilities under the ERMF the 
Board has formally recognised a series of risks that are 
continuously present at Funding Circle and can materially 
affect the achievement of Funding Circle’s objectives. 
These risks have been organised under a consistent 
and simple taxonomy with a hierarchy of risk categories, 
which facilitates risk management and oversight. The 
management of these risks is assigned to designated 
business owners who regularly formally assess the level 
of these risks, the adequacy of controls and the need for 
further mitigations. 
Respond 
The appropriate risk response ensures that risks are 
within appetite. At Funding Circle we have four types of 
possible risk responses: 
• accept the risk; 
• take mitigation actions (such as additional risk controls) 
to reduce the risk; 
• stop the existing activity/do not start the proposed 
activity to remove the risk; or 
• continue the activity and transfer the risk to another party 
(e.g. insurance). 
Monitor 
Monitoring and reporting on Funding Circle’s risk 
exposures are undertaken through risk governance 
structures. The ARC receives a consolidated risk report 
no less than three times a year detailing the risks 
facing the Group and mitigation plans, as well as the 
risk outlook. The ARC is also provided with metrics and 
regular reports about the activities of the Audit, Risk and 
Compliance functions. 
Risk assurance 
Assurance on the management of risk is provided by 
the Three Lines of Defence model including the Internal 
Audit function. We also execute external annual controls 
assurance reports (e.g. ISAE 3402) certified by auditors. 
Risk management continued 
STRATEGIC REPORT
CORPORATE GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
Funding Circle Holdings plc | Annual Report and Accounts 2024
54

Principal risks and uncertainties
The Board confirms that throughout 2024 a robust assessment of 
the principal & emerging risks facing Funding Circle was completed. 
A comprehensive list of Group-wide risks and emerging risks was reviewed and monitored throughout the 
year. The most significant risks and uncertainties faced by Funding Circle are listed in the table below, 
categorised by principal risk: 
Risk trend key 
Increasing
Stable
Decreasing 
Strategic risk 
Strategic risk is defined as the failure to build a sustainable, diversified and profitable business that can 
successfully adapt to environmental changes due to the inefficient use of Funding Circle’s available resources. 
Risk appetite 
Funding Circle will make efficient use of its available resources to build a sustainable, diversified and profitable business. 
Key risks
Management of risk
Change in risk in the year 
Strategic risk 
Risk arising from 
the failure to build a 
sustainable, diversified 
and profitable 
business that can 
successfully adapt to 
environmental changes. 
The ExCo manages the strategic planning 
process based on risk appetite, financial 
considerations, strategic themes, market 
trends and economic assumptions. 
We manage strategic risk by: 
• performing a thorough, in-depth business 
strategy review at least once a year; 
• reviewing financials, strategic plans which 
include new products and initiatives, and key 
performance indicators; 
• reviewing the strategic risk implications of 
new products, business expansion, and other 
Company initiatives and projects; and 
• ensuring that the Board has oversight of 
strategic risk and approves strategic business 
plans at least annually. 
Market expectations are that interest 
rates have now peaked which should 
ease credit conditions. However, the 
impact of the broader macroeconomic 
climate on SMEs remains uncertain. 
This leads to uncertainties around 
borrower and investor demand which 
may impact our strategic objectives. 
Funding Circle has also continued to 
grow new products such as FlexiPay 
for which performance and demand 
may be uncertain until they reach 
sufficient scale. 
We closely monitor these trends and 
we continuously adjust our product 
offerings to fit market conditions and 
meet evolving customer demand.
STRATEGIC REPORT
CORPORATE GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
Funding Circle Holdings plc | Annual Report and Accounts 2024
55

Principal risks and uncertainties continued 
Key risks
Management of risk
Change in risk in the year 
Economic environment 
Risk arising from 
macroeconomic or 
political factors that 
may impact funding, 
credit performance, and 
overall financial stability. 
It encompasses broader 
considerations, including 
demand fluctuations, 
funding availability, and 
cost management. 
This risk reflects the 
potential failure to 
establish a sustainable, 
diversified, and profitable 
business model capable 
of adapting to evolving 
economic and regulatory 
environments. 
We continually monitor the health of our loan 
portfolios and perform stress test simulations 
to help ensure that loan returns remain resilient 
in the context of risk volatility. Key mitigating 
actions include (but are not limited to): 
• annual stress testing of all loan portfolios; 
• resilient credit strategy and continuous 
tuning of risk and pricing parameters to 
correct for possible deviations in returns; 
• monthly monitoring of internal and external 
signals as part of the TLRC & FRC; and 
• a robust in-house Collections and Recoveries 
(C&R) function, designed with built‑in 
scalability to adapt to evolving demands. 
Our capabilities are enhanced by automated 
strategies and self-service solutions, 
ensuring efficiency and responsiveness. 
Additionally, we maintain a strategic 
partnership with a specialist Debt Collection 
Agency (DCA), which can be leveraged in the 
event of a significant economic disruption, 
such as the Covid-19 pandemic. 
Interest rates have begun to reduce 
and the majority of macroeconomic 
indicators are better than at the end of 
2023. Nonetheless, the macroeconomic 
environment remains uncertain and 
insolvencies are at an elevated level 
to historical norms. 
Environmental, social and governance risk 
Environment, social and/ 
or governance events 
or circumstances could 
cause an actual or 
potential material negative 
impact on Funding Circle’s 
financial performance or 
reputation. 
• Our ESG framework outlines our approach 
to ESG and is approved by the Board. 
• The Board retains ultimate responsibility 
for providing the strategic focus, support 
and oversight for the implementation of 
the Group’s ESG strategy, including for 
climate-related risks and opportunities. 
The Board delegates certain matters related 
to climate-related risks and opportunities 
to two Committees: 
• the ESG Committee is responsible 
for oversight of the Group’s overall 
ESG strategy, including climate-
related opportunities and voluntary 
commitments; and 
• the ARC is responsible for oversight of 
risk management related to ESG risks, 
including climate-related risks. 
We continue to integrate climate-related 
risks into our ERMF and mature our 
ESG framework. 
We continue to assess our climate-
related risks and opportunities and 
further embed them into day-to-day 
practices and first-line teams. 
For further information, please see 
ESG section.
Strategic risk continued 
Risk appetite continued
STRATEGIC REPORT
CORPORATE GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
Funding Circle Holdings plc | Annual Report and Accounts 2024
56

Funding and balance sheet risk 
Funding and balance sheet risks are the risks associated with the funding of our product set of Term Loans and 
lines of credit and any exposure that our balance sheet has to this funding through normal and stress scenarios. 
Risk appetite 
Funding Circle will make efficient use of its balance sheet and optimise and diversify funding and liquidity sources to 
enable a balanced funding strategy whilst limiting downside risk. 
Key risks
Management of risk
Change in risk in the year 
Funding risk 
Funding risk is the 
risk that demand from 
borrowers for credit 
cannot be met by the 
providers of that funding 
(institutional investors in 
the case of Term Loans 
and Funding Circle and 
CitiBank in the case of 
lines of credit). This risk 
varies with the economic 
attractiveness of Funding 
Circle products as an 
investment, the level of 
diversification of funding 
sources and the level of 
resilience of these funding 
sources and their returns 
through economic cycles. 
Funding Circle’s business model is to be a lending 
platform that efficiently matches the supply of 
capital to the demand of SME borrowers. 
We carefully manage this matching by: 
• building long-term relationships with 
investors and developing a forward-looking 
pipeline of new investors; 
• actively managing concentration risk and 
diversifying sources of funding; 
• managing Funding Circle’s lending activities 
whether through direct lending capacity, 
securitisation capacity or investment fund 
lending vehicles; 
• monitoring a broad range of management 
information and key performance indicators at 
the BSMC, TLRC, FRC and Board levels; and 
• leveraging an experienced capital markets 
team for sales and transaction structuring. 
Despite 2024 providing a number 
of macroeconomic challenges, we 
experienced demand from institutional 
investors to fund new loans. This 
demonstrated the trust our funding 
partners place in our risk management 
and operational processes, as well 
as their previous experience of 
stable, robust and positive returns on 
their investments. We also revised 
our lending rates to match market 
movements and maintain loan returns. 
We have onboarded new investors, 
continuing the trend from the previous 
years and renewed existing investors 
cementing strong institutional 
relationships providing a good basis 
for our future funding needs. 
Balance sheet risk 
Balance sheet risk is the 
risk that, where Funding 
Circle has put its balance 
sheet to use in funding 
either Term Loans or lines 
of credit, investment 
positions reduce in value 
or cannot be exited at 
an economically viable 
price; the risk that Funding 
Circle liabilities cannot be 
met when they fall due 
or can only be met at an 
uneconomic price. This 
risk is also associated with 
interest rate fluctuations, 
particularly in the context 
of levered investments. 
Balance sheet risk applies 
to all products offered, 
the potential challenges 
faced in managing 
investment positions and 
meeting obligations under 
favourable conditions. 
We carefully manage this risk by: 
• setting clear guardrails for Funding Circle 
balance sheet exposures and following 
a set of agreed investment principles to 
guide capital allocation; 
• maintaining a prudent level of liquidity to 
cover unexpected outflows to ensure that 
we are able to meet financial commitments 
for an extended period, including under 
stress scenarios; 
• regularly monitoring investment performance 
and assessing headroom against the trigger 
hurdles agreed with senior lenders; 
• considering a broad range of management 
information and key performance indicators 
at the senior management level; and 
• leveraging a dedicated and experienced 
Balance Sheet Management team. 
Our overall approach to having a 
robust balance sheet and prudent 
management of liquidity remains 
unchanged. 
Legacy SME loans on our balance sheet 
continue to perform strongly as they 
amortise down. 
FlexiPay remains funded from our own 
cash, leveraged with senior financing 
from CitiBank. During the year we added 
a Cashback credit card product to the 
FlexiPay suite, which is also funded 
through the same levered vehicle. The 
credit performance of these products is 
in line with our expectations. We have 
sufficient disposable cash to cover our 
liquidity needs and any credit downside 
risk, including when tested against 
stressed liquidity scenarios, and to fund 
our medium-term plan going forwards.
STRATEGIC REPORT
CORPORATE GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
Funding Circle Holdings plc | Annual Report and Accounts 2024
57

Principal risks and uncertainties continued
Credit risk 
Credit risk is the risk of financial loss to an investor including Funding Circle itself when lending from its balance 
sheet should any borrower fail to fulfil their contractual repayment obligations. Credit risk management is the 
sum of activities necessary to deliver a risk profile at portfolio level in line with Funding Circle management’s 
expectations, in terms of net credit loss rate, risk-adjusted rate of return and its volatility through economic cycles. 
Risk appetite 
Whether or not Funding Circle owns any credit risk, credit risk of loans will be managed with the utmost care and 
attention to deliver credit performance and returns in line with expectations. 
Key risks
Management of risk
Change in risk in the year 
Credit risk 
Borrower acquisition 
Credit performance and 
returns of new loans can 
deviate from expectations 
due to several factors: 
changes in credit 
quality of incoming 
applications, calibration 
of risk models or strategy 
parameters, and control 
gaps in processing loan 
applications. 
Portfolio risk 
management 
Credit performance 
and returns of existing 
portfolio can deviate 
from expectations 
due to several factors: 
deterioration of credit 
environment, increased 
competition driving 
higher prepayment rates, 
effectiveness of portfolio 
monitoring, collections 
and recoveries. 
Funding Circle’s aim is for well-balanced loan 
portfolios that generate positive returns for 
investors through the economic cycle. 
We are actively managing credit risk by: 
• formulating credit risk policies (covering 
credit assessment and risk grading, portfolio 
monitoring and reporting, collections and 
recoveries) and ensuring adherence to 
these policies; 
• recruiting, training and managing expert 
risk professionals with the adequate skills, 
objectives and capacity; 
• establishing the formal mandates and 
authorisation structure for setting risk 
parameters and approving loans; 
• performing independent quality control of 
credit decisions; 
• limiting concentration risk to counterparties 
and industries; 
• actively monitoring the performance of the 
loan portfolios and the market trends that 
could affect performance; 
• implementing adequate procedures and 
controls for model risk (including the 
independent validation and monitoring of 
credit scoring models); 
• performing annual stress tests with regards to 
government programmes, tightly controlling 
adherence to eligibility criteria; 
• having adequately staffed and well trained 
C&R department; 
• ensuring forbearance tools and policies 
are fully integrated in customer life 
cycle management; 
• constantly monitoring our portfolio 
for credit insights that feed into the 
underwriting policies/models and 
decisioning infrastructure; 
• regular pricing reviews to ensure adequate 
risk-adjusted returns for our investors in a 
more volatile interest rate environment; and 
• active management of credit limits 
and unused credit limits in the case of 
open-ended products. 
Whilst our portfolios are showing 
resilience and generally performing 
well, we do take into account the 
economic environment as a potentially 
significant challenge to our borrowers 
and are adopting a prudent approach 
to credit risk management. We are 
continuously monitoring our portfolios 
of existing lending and use the most 
recent data to adjust our risk appetite 
and underwriting policies. 
Funding Circle is entering 2025 in 
a strong position from a credit risk 
standpoint, capitalising on our data 
and experience since our inception.
STRATEGIC REPORT
CORPORATE GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
Funding Circle Holdings plc | Annual Report and Accounts 2024
58

STRATEGIC REPORT
CORPORATE GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
Funding Circle Holdings plc | Annual Report and Accounts 2024
59
Regulatory, reputation and conduct risk
Regulatory, reputation and conduct risk is defined as the risk of engaging in activities that detract from Funding 
Circle’s goal of being a trusted and reputable company with products, services and processes designed for 
customer success and delivered in a way that will not cause customer detriment or regulatory censure.
Risk appetite
Funding Circle will not engage in activities that detract from its goal of being a trusted and reputable financial services 
company with products, services and processes designed for customer success and delivered in a way that will not 
cause customer detriment or regulatory censure.
Key risks
Management of risk
Change in risk in the year
Regulatory risk
The risk that Funding 
Circle’s ability to 
effectively manage its 
regulatory relationships 
is compromised or 
diminished, that the 
Group’s governance and 
controls framework is 
not satisfactory given 
business growth, or 
that there is business 
interruption by reason 
of non-compliance 
with regulation or the 
introduction of business-
impacting regulation.
• We maintain vigilance around policy shifts, 
and proactively engage with industry bodies 
and policy-makers, highlighting our platforms’ 
features, benefits, and impact;
• We continue to implement and maintain 
business practices and controls focused 
on regulatory risk. These include controls 
designed to comply with the Senior 
Managers and Certification Regime and the 
Consumer Duty;
•
 We continue to focus on governance and 
controls and train all employees in such 
matters relevant to their role;
• For ESG-related risks, including DEI, social 
impact and climate change, we continue to 
work with service providers to assist with the 
integration of TCFD recommendations and 
our net zero ambitions; and
• GenAI and emerging technologies feature 
in Funding Circle’s data strategy as an 
opportunity to enhance productivity, 
innovation, and customer experience. 
We recognise that the adoption of these 
technologies creates potential risks to ethical 
business practices and compliance with 
certain legal and regulatory regimes. In 2024, 
we established a GenAI steering committee 
with representation from Funding Circle’s 
Executive team focusing on oversight of the 
successful adoption of GenAI in a responsible 
way. Based on our current scale and use, 
we consider this an emerging rather than 
primary risk.
The Retail Investor product’s 
trajectory remains downward from 
a risk perspective, impacted by 
balance reduction efforts. Low 
residual performing balances are 
anticipated to fully amortise by July 
2025. The Consumer Duty came into 
force for closed products on 31 July 
2024, and we have reviewed against 
expectations and taken the appropriate 
actions to deliver good outcomes for 
retail customers. 
The use of personal guarantees in 
commercial lending was a focus of 
industry groups, as well as the regulator. 
The FCA undertook an exercise to 
identify potential harm where the 
lending falls within the regulatory 
perimeter, and we are encouraged to 
see that the regulator did not identify 
instances of poor practice. While our 
lending activity is either unregulated 
or exempt from regulation, we believe 
it is important that lenders take notice 
of the possibility of harm. To that end, 
we became a supporter of the UK 
Finance commercial finance industry 
commitments to personal guarantees. 
In October 2024, we saw the decision 
by the Court of Appeal in a landmark 
case on lender liability where 
commission is paid to a broker in motor 
finance arrangements. The potential 
impact of the decision is widespread 
and, while the case was focused on 
consumer lending in the motor finance 
industry, has created uncertainty across 
the commercial lending industries. 
We are closely monitoring the 
developments and the outcome of the 
appeal to the Supreme Court. 
Increased regulation looms for ESG 
risks, including mandatory disclosures 
and labelling. We continue to proactively 
monitor this area, and comply with all 
current obligations.

Principal risks and uncertainties continued
Regulatory, reputation and conduct risk continued
Risk appetite continued
Key risks
Management of risk
Change in risk in the year
STRATEGIC REPORT
CORPORATE GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
Funding Circle Holdings plc | Annual Report and Accounts 2024
60
Reputation risk
Operational or 
performance failures 
could lead to negative 
publicity that could 
adversely affect our 
brand, business, results, 
operations, financial 
condition or prospects.
We continue to implement and maintain 
business practices and controls focused 
on reputation management, including: 
• ensuring risk and compliance considerations 
for new or iterated products and initiatives;
• engaging fully with regulators when required, 
and external advisers in relation to any new 
or iterated products and initiatives that might 
impact customer outcomes;
• undertaking specific projects to address 
identified risk topics and issues, including 
retrospective reviews, internal audit reviews 
and monitoring and testing programmes; and
• updating and refining our approach to issue 
and risk identification and management.
Continued investment in FlexiPay and in 
newer products, including the Cashback 
credit card, presents potential risks 
as a higher number of customer 
touchpoints leads to more potential 
for customer dissatisfaction. These 
factors are closely monitored to ensure 
smooth operations and optimal product 
performance.
Operational risk
Operational risk is the risk of loss resulting from inadequate or failed internal processes, people and systems 
or from external events.
Risk appetite
Funding Circle will operate well managed processes with reliable performance and effective controls preventing 
significant and non-anticipated operational risk losses.
Key risks
Management of risk
Change in risk in the year
Client money risk
Failure of Funding Circle 
to adequately protect and 
segregate client money 
may lead to financial loss, 
reputational damage and 
regulatory censure.
Funding Circle holds funds for retail and 
institutional investors in segregated client 
money bank accounts in line with the Financial 
Conduct Authority’s client money (‘‘CASS’’) 
regulations. We continue to manage the 
risk through: 
• daily payments and reconciliation controls; 
• a monthly CASS governance sub-committee 
focused on providing oversight and challenge 
regarding the effectiveness of client money 
controls, making decisions in relation to 
client money and reviewing management 
information and regulatory returns, as well as 
reviewing risks and mitigating controls when 
introducing new product cash flows into the 
client money framework;
• oversight from the Funding Circle 
Limited Board;
• annual external CASS audit providing 
assurance on the Firm’s compliance with 
the FCA’s “CASS” rules; and
• With the runoff of retail investor funds, the 
risk profile has reduced, becoming primarily 
B2B rather than consumer-focused.
In 2024, we have maintained a robust 
control environment in relation 
to payment creation, payment 
authorisation, and monthly reporting 
and have increased efficiency and 
accuracy across the reconciliation 
review process through adoption of a 
specialised third-party client money 
reconciliation tool. 
Controls implemented in the 2023 
for the late payment money flow are 
embedded in the control environment, 
and we continue to comply with the 
regulatory requirements in relation to 
holding and treatment of client money 
and perform internal and external client 
money reconciliations daily. 
Proactive contact continued to be 
made with our retail investors to 
create awareness of funds available to 
withdraw in their legacy portfolios, and 
we saw the balance held continue to 
reduce throughout 2024.

Key risks
Management of risk
Change in risk in the year
STRATEGIC REPORT
CORPORATE GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
Funding Circle Holdings plc | Annual Report and Accounts 2024
61
Financial crime
Risk of regulatory 
breach, financial loss 
or reputational damage 
arising from a failure to 
adequately manage or 
prevent money laundering, 
terrorist financing, bribery 
and corruption, or to 
comply with sanctions 
regulations.
• We comply with the laws and regulations 
designed to counter money laundering, 
terrorist financing, corruption and bribery is 
fundamental to Funding Circle’s operations;
• The Board has adopted policies to 
address financial crimes that have been 
implemented through formal standards and 
procedures; and
• We have a dedicated Financial Crime 
Operations team within the first line of 
defence that is advised, challenged and 
monitored by the second-line Financial 
Crime Compliance team.
The growth of the FlexiPay product 
has added complexity and risks related 
to money laundering and fraud as 
the product scales. We continue to 
undertake rigorous fraud, anti-money 
laundering and Know Your Customer 
checks as part of our processes; 
however, further improvement and 
iteration will be required as the 
product matures.
Process risk
Failure to originate and 
service loans in line 
with Funding Circle 
internal policies, investor 
guidelines and third party 
loan guarantees (e.g. BBB) 
may result in Funding 
Circle repurchasing loans 
from investors. 
The risk of operational 
incident could impact 
the ability to originate 
new loans or the 
ability to service loans 
through collections from 
borrowers and return of 
money to investors.
We actively manage process risk by: 
• continuing to automate key controls;
• performing robust first-line quality assurance 
and secondary checks on manual processes;
• monitoring and testing of key controls;
• reviewing key risk indicators as part of the 
Business Unit Operational Risk Committee;
• reporting, reviewing and resolving 
operational errors;
• performing independent quality control 
checks and ensuring highlighted issues 
are resolved;
• implementing adequate policies and 
procedures;
• providing training and education on risk 
culture and risk management; and
• performing supplier due diligence and 
undertaking ongoing performance 
monitoring of key suppliers.
Building upon the effectiveness of 
our established first-line of defence 
controls, we sustained a stable process 
risk profile over the past year. 
In addition, we carry out independent 
quality checks to ensure that all loans 
originated are compliant with loan 
eligibility requirements. 
In October 2024 an application for 
summary judgement, which related to 
two loans originated on the Funding Circle 
platform and now held by a third party 
debt buyer, was dismissed. The questions 
relate solely to who has the right to bring 
legal proceedings. We have taken legal 
advice and are confident that the claimant, 
being the third party debt buyer, will be 
successful at trial. 
The growth of Funding Circle’s 
FlexiPay product may lead to increased 
operational and third-party risks due to 
its reliance for processing transactions. 
To ensure the effectiveness of our internal 
controls, we perform both internal and 
external assurance activities. Our external 
assurance process which included an ISAE 
3402 Control Report yielded satisfactory 
results. In FY 2024, an internal Risk & 
Control Self-Assessment was conducted. 
The overall risk profile remained within 
appetite. A few areas have been identified 
for further control enhancement, we are 
actively working to address these areas 
and ensure continued alignment with our 
risk appetite. 

Principal risks and uncertainties continued
STRATEGIC REPORT
CORPORATE GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
Funding Circle Holdings plc | Annual Report and Accounts 2024
62
Technology risk
Technology Risk refers to the potential negative consequences that can arise from the use or implementation 
of technology, including hardware, software, and data management systems. Technology risks can arise from 
a variety of sources, including hardware failures, software bugs, cyber attacks, data breaches, and user errors. 
In response to evolving threats and the rise of GenAI, Technology risk has been designated a “Principal Risk”, 
ensuring stringent oversight and proactive mitigation. We have made significant strides in enhancing our security 
and data maturity posture. We are committed to continuous improvement and will continue to mature our security 
and data practices.
Risk appetite
Funding Circle will manage its technology, data, and security risks with effective controls, preventing significant and 
non-anticipated loss of confidentiality, integrity and availability of systems and data.
Key risks
Management of risk
Change in risk in the year
Technology risk
Failure of the technology 
platform could have a 
material adverse impact 
on Funding Circle’s 
business, results of 
operations, financial 
condition or prospects.
• Technology remains central to Funding 
Circle’s operations. Recognising the rise of 
GenAI and the evolving nature of threats, the 
Risk Committee upgraded technology risk 
to a standalone principal risk. This change 
enhances oversight of technology and data 
risks now and into the future; and 
• We continue to make significant investments 
in our technology platform to ensure 
it is resilient and scalable to support 
business growth.
We have improved our technology 
automation, alerting and incident 
response capability to maintain a stable 
platform to enable business growth, 
scalable products and services. 
Technology risk and technical resilience 
continue to improve with more 
robust testing capabilities in place to 
support changes before production 
implementation. Nevertheless, we 
remain committed to explore additional 
opportunities to further strengthen 
our approach.
Information security
Failure to protect the 
confidential information 
of Funding Circle’s 
borrowers, investors 
and IT systems may 
lead to financial loss, 
reputational damage and 
regulatory censure.
• Information security is a priority for Funding 
Circle as a technology-driven company;
• As such we maintain in-depth defence with 
a multi-layered control infrastructure; and
• Information security is appropriately 
managed, based on materiality, and is 
escalated to the TRC.
In 2024, we continued to see 
improvements in our information 
security infrastructure with a strong 
focus by the Board.  
We have increased our overall security 
maturity and continue to adapt our 
information security controls as the 
threat landscape continues to evolve.
Data risk
Failure in our ability 
to acquire, use, secure 
and transform our data 
assets could result in 
adverse material impacts 
across Funding Circle.
• Our data risk management framework is 
aligned to the Group’s ERMF; and
• Data risks are appropriately managed, 
based on materiality, and are escalated 
to the TRC. 
We continue to mature and embed 
our data governance framework and 
organisational structure to manage 
data risk including the implementation 
of new tools to maintain the standards 
of documentation, clarity and integrity 
of our data. 
Protecting our customer and employee 
data, in particular personally identifiable 
information, is a high priority, and we 
take appropriate measures to prevent 
losses or breaches.

STRATEGIC REPORT
CORPORATE GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
Funding Circle Holdings plc | Annual Report and Accounts 2024
63
Viability statement
In accordance with the UK Corporate Governance Code 
(the “Code”), the Directors have assessed the future prospects 
and viability of the Group for a period significantly longer 
than 12 months from the approval of the financial statements.
Assessment of prospects
The Directors have determined that a three-year period 
to 31 December 2027 constitutes an appropriate period 
over which to perform the assessment as:
• it is within the time period which the Group’s medium-
term planning process covers (up to five years);
• it represents a period over which there is a reasonable 
degree of confidence in the reliability and accuracy of 
forecasts; and
• periods beyond this point in a high-growth business 
like Funding Circle are significantly harder to 
predict accurately.
The Group’s overall strategy and business model, as 
set out on pages 10 to 11, and 8 to 9, are fundamental in 
driving the growth of the business and therefore its future 
prospects. The key factors that are likely to affect the 
future prospects of the Group, aside from macroeconomic 
factors, include the ability to:
• develop and introduce new credit products;
• grow awareness of the Funding Circle brand in order to 
attract more businesses to our platforms;
• retain, diversify and increase funding from a variety of 
investors in order to meet future borrower demand; and 
• continue to invest in data analytics and technology 
leading to innovation, expanded datasets, enhanced 
credit models, better customer experience and a 
greater conversion rate of applicants.
Funding Circle’s future prospects are assessed through 
the Group’s strategic planning process. The strategic 
planning process involves a detailed review of the 
medium-term plan by the CEO and CFO. This is done 
in conjunction with the Executive Committee (“ExCo”), 
consisting of functional leaders, together with a review 
and discussion by the Board.
The strategic plan starts with the Group’s 2025 annual 
budget which is subject to re-forecasting periodically 
through the year. The budget is extended into the second 
and third year of the plan using the Group’s various 
drivers and expected growth rates experienced across 
the Group. 
Progress against the financial budget and forecasts is 
then reviewed each month by the ExCo and reported to, 
and challenged by, the Board.
Key assumptions
The key assumptions underpinning the strategic plan 
(before severe but plausible scenarios) include:
• there is sufficient investor funding in place to support 
projected growth in originations;
• levels of marketing spend, the number of applications, 
conversion rates, average loan sizes and mix of product 
channels which drive originations and loans under 
management (“LuM”);
• levels of repayments, prepayments, defaults and 
recoveries which drive movements in LuM;
• expected yields on loans originated and service fee 
charges which drive fee income;
• interest income receipts and interest expenses 
related to our investment vehicles which drive net 
investment income;
• costs across Business Units with specific focus on 
fixed costs and those that fluctuate with income such 
as marketing costs;
• headcount consideration across functions and 
departments given it is the Group’s largest cost;
• an assumption of continued investment in the Group’s 
IT infrastructure and its product set but with the 
expectation of no fundamental breakdown in the IT 
infrastructure or major data loss; 
• review in the context of indicative market share;
• there is no improvement of deterioration to the 
current macro environment conditions over the 
medium term; and
• we have not assumed further government stimulus 
packages over the medium term.

Viability statement continued
STRATEGIC REPORT
CORPORATE GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
Funding Circle Holdings plc | Annual Report and Accounts 2024
64
Assessment of viability
The output of the medium-term plan reflects the Directors’ 
best assessment of the future prospects of the Group over 
the next three years. 
As part of this assessment, the Directors have considered 
and carried out a robust assessment of the principal risks 
as set out on pages 55 to 62. They have also considered 
the potential impact of the risks on the viability of the 
Group with specific focus on shorter-term liquidity 
needs and its availability, including liquidity currently tied 
up in investment products. The Group currently holds 
£151 million of unrestricted cash together with £54 million 
equity invested in loans.
The financial plan was subject to scenario analysis to 
assess those risks and quantify the financial impact 
on the Group. The Group also operates liquidity and 
capital guardrails that it monitors which are of particular 
importance in the shorter term.
The scenario that represented the most severe but 
plausible scenario was modelled as described below. This 
sensitivity took into account the likely mitigating actions 
to the operations. The scenario is hypothetical and 
severe but designed to stress the business model and the 
viability of the Group.
Severe but plausible scenario
Under a severe downturn it is expected that:
• there would be a short-term period in year one where
there would be significantly reduced transaction fees
earned, driven by increased inflation and interest rates,
alongside a large operational risk event impacting
the Group;
• following a further severe global downturn there would
be a significant increase in the number of borrowers
defaulting impacting LuM and our invested capital
cash flows;
• the returns for investors would be negatively affected
by the widening of discount rates and deterioration of
loan performance resulting in a withdrawal of funding;
• this in turn would reduce the level of originations unless
higher incentives were offered to investors to continue
funding; and
• over the medium term originations are subdued
with LuM and servicing fees consequently
negatively affected.
A further subset of risks, including the reduction in 
trust from both borrowers and investors, has also been 
considered within this scenario. We considered whether 
environmental stress would materially impact the Group 
but consider the existing stresses above would be more 
material to the near to medium term.
The mitigating actions that would be taken by 
management include a reduction in the overall marketing 
and salary spend through hiring freezes, a tightening 
of the credit models to improve the levels of return for 
investors and increased costs of borrowing for SMEs. Our 
medium-term plan assumes we continue to be the sole 
equity funder of FlexiPay. 
In a stressed scenario, a further management action 
is that we would curtail the growth of FlexiPay and 
this would reduce the level of investment required by 
Funding Circle.
Links to principal risks and uncertainties 
• Strategic risk
• Credit risk
• Liquidity risk
Going concern 
In addition to the broad viability of the Group, the 
Directors have assessed the Group’s going concern 
presumption over the 15-month period to 30 June 2026.
The shorter-term projections within the Group’s strategic 
plan are also used to assess the Group’s ability to operate 
as a going concern. As at 31 December 2024, the Group 
had net assets of £217 million, together with unrestricted 
cash of £151 million and £54 million of invested capital, 
some of which could be monetised if liquidity needs 
arise. At all times during the assessment, and after stress 
scenarios are modelled, the Group retains sufficient 
financial resources. 
The stress testing confirmed that the Group’s forecast 
net cash position remained positive and that none of the 
scenarios would threaten the going concern presumption 
over the assessment period or the Group’s regulatory 
capital requirements. 
In all cases including the severe but plausible scenario 
above, with appropriate management actions, the 
scenarios were controllable to mitigate the impact on 
the Group’s liquidity for the broader assessment of the 
Group’s going concern.
The Group has limited regulatory capital requirements to 
maintain sufficient unrestricted cash. At all times through 
the forecast period, and after stress scenarios, the Group 
remains within the required levels.
Based on this assessment, the Directors have a 
reasonable expectation that the Group will be able 
to continue in operation and meet its liabilities and 
obligations as they fall due over the period to 30 June 
2026 as well as for at least the next 12-month period from 
the date of this Annual Report. See also page 128 of the 
financial statements related to going concern.

 
 
 
 
 
 
STRATEGIC REPORT
CORPORATE GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
Funding Circle Holdings plc | Annual Report and Accounts 2024
65
Corporate 
governance
66 Chair’s introduction 
67 Governance at a glance
68 Board of Directors
70 Corporate governance report
78 Report of the Nomination Committee
82 Report of the Audit and Risk Committee
88 Report of the ESG Committee
90 Directors’ remuneration report
101 Annual report on remuneration
112 Report of the Directors
115 Statement of Directors’ responsibilities in 
respect of the financial statements

Funding Circle Holdings plc | Annual Report and Accounts 2024
66
STRATEGIC REPORT
CORPORATE GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
Chair’s introduction
Andrew Learoyd 
Chair
“
As a Board, we are committed to 
maintaining a strong and resilient 
corporate governance foundation 
that ensures Funding Circle is a 
successful, sustainable business 
that benefits all our stakeholders 
over the long term.”
I am delighted to introduce Funding Circle’s Corporate 
Governance Report for the financial year ended 31 December 
2024, which will be my final report before handing over the 
Chair role to Ken Stannard at the end of the 2025 AGM.
As a Board, we are committed to maintaining a strong and 
resilient corporate governance foundation that ensures 
Funding Circle is a successful, sustainable business 
that benefits all our stakeholders over the long term.
Board activities
2024 was a pivotal year of change for the Group. Key 
areas of the Board’s focus included Board and senior 
management succession planning, another Remuneration 
Policy review, Group strategy, Committee governance 
enhancements, and simplification of the Funding Circle 
business structure (as discussed further in the Chief 
Executive Officer’s Statement on pages 5 to 7). We 
cover these updates within the respective delegated 
Committees’ reports later in this report.
Board succession
As noted further in the Nomination Committee Report, 
the Board’s composition was reviewed this year, taking 
into account a range of issues including its size, the 
tenure of the Directors, its diversity, its independence and 
the range of skills and experience required to support the 
Company in this next stage of its strategic development. 
This is still a work in progress and the Board will continue 
to work on increasing its independence to comply with 
provision 11 of the UK Corporate Governance Code.
Governance
Confirmation of how we have complied with the 2018 
Code for the year under review is set out on page 75. 
From FY 2025, the updated 2024 Code will apply to the 
Company (excluding provision 29 which will apply from 
FY 2026), and work is underway to ensure that we are 
prepared for these changes.
I hope you find the Corporate Governance Report 
informative. The Board will be available at the Annual 
General Meeting to respond to any questions you may have.
Andrew Learoyd
Chair 
6 March 2025
Code principles
Please see below for details regarding the 
application of the principles of the Code.
Board leadership and company purpose (A-E)
Risk management – pages 51 to 62
Our people and engagement – pages 20 to 23, page 70 
Engaging our stakeholders – pages 40 to 43, page 70
Division of responsibilities (F-I)
Corporate governance report – pages 70 to 77 
Composition, succession and evaluations (J-L)
Report of the Nomination Committee – pages 78 to 81
Directors’ biographies – pages 68 to 69 
Board effectiveness review – page 76 
Audit, risk and internal control (M-O)
Corporate governance report – pages 70 to 77
Report of the Audit and Risk Committee – pages 82 to 87
Risk management – pages 51 to 62
Viability Statement – pages 63 to 64 
Remuneration (P-R)
Directors’ Remunerations Report – pages 90 to 100 

 
 
Male
Female
 
White
Asian/Asian British
Executive Director 
Independent Non-Executive Director 
Non-Independent Non-Executive Director
0–3 years 
3–6 years
6+ years
12.5%
50.0%
37.5%
37.5%
2
62.5%
2
3
87.5%
12.5%
STRATEGIC REPORT
CORPORATE GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
Funding Circle Holdings plc | Annual Report and Accounts 2024
67
Governance at a glance
Board gender balance 
(as at 31 December 2024)
Board ethnicity 
(as at 31 December 2024)
Board independence 
(excluding Chair, as at 31 December 2024)
Board tenure 
(as at 31 December 2024)
Rolling three-year female 
representation on the Board
2022
30.0% 
2023
30.0% 
2024
37.5% 
Board skills 
(as at 1 January 2025)
Marketing/brand
ESG
Current executive leadership
Remuneration/human resources
Lending/credit
Corporate finance/equity capital management
Risk management
Financial services
Technology/innovation
Governance
Board changes 
during 2024 and 
looking into 2025
Eric Daniels retired from 
the Board on 15 May 2024 
at the AGM
Samir Desai CBE resigned from 
the Board on 25 October 2024
Oliver White resigned as CFO 
on 31 December 2024
Matthew King resigned 
from the Board on 
31 December 2024 
Ken Stannard appointed 
as Non-Executive Director 
and Chair Designate on 
1 January 2025 
Tony Nicol appointed as CFO 
on 1 January 2025
Andrew Learoyd to step down 
as Chair at May 2025 AGM
Ken Stannard to be appointed 
Chair post-May 2025 AGM 

AR   
R   
 
N   
 
E   
 
D   
 
  
 
Funding Circle Holdings plc | Annual Report and Accounts 2024
68
STRATEGIC REPORT
CORPORATE GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
Board of Directors
Leading our business 
from the front
1 
2 
3 
Incoming 
FY25
4 
5 
6 
7 
8
Incoming 
FY25
9 
Board Committees
Audit and Risk Committee
Remuneration  
Committee
Nomination Committee
ESG Committee
Market Disclosure 
Committee
Committee Chair
Changes to the Board between 
31 December 2024 and the date 
of this Annual Report
Oliver White and Matthew King resigned from the 
Board on 31 December 2024 so we have not 
included their biographies in this report.
Tony Nicol was appointed as CFO and Ken Stannard 
was appointed as Non-Executive Director and Chair 
Designate, both with effect from 1 January 2025.

N  R  E  D
D
D
AR  N  D
E
R  N  AR E  
N  R  
D
Funding Circle Holdings plc | Annual Report and Accounts 2024
69
STRATEGIC REPORT
CORPORATE GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
1  Andrew Learoyd 
Chair of the Board
Term of office: Appointed to the Board as 
a Non-Executive Director in February 2010 
and became Chair of the Board in May 2016.
Independent: On appointment.
Skills and experience: Andrew spent 
23 years working in investment banking as 
a research analyst, in corporate finance, in 
equity capital markets and finally as Chief 
Operating Officer of the Equities Division 
in Europe of Goldman Sachs. He retired 
as a Managing Director of Goldman Sachs 
in 2006. Andrew has been involved as an 
angel investor, Non-Executive Director and 
consultant to several start-up businesses. 
Andrew was previously a Non-Executive 
Director of Threshold Sports Limited until 
the end of 2023.
External appointments: Andrew is also a 
Director of WLG Learning Ltd which provides 
educational services for children with 
special learning disabilities.
2  Lisa Jacobs 
Chief Executive Officer
Term of office: Lisa was appointed to 
the Board as Chief Executive Officer on 
1 January 2022.
Independent: No.
Skills and experience: Lisa joined Funding 
Circle in 2012 and was previously UK 
Managing Director and Chief Strategy 
Officer. Prior to Funding Circle, Lisa 
worked as a Management Consultant, both 
independently and for the Boston Consulting 
Group, where she had a financial services 
focus. She has had roles in NGOs in Tanzania 
and India.
External appointments: None.
3  Tony Nicol 
Chief Financial Officer 
Term of office: Tony was appointed to 
the Board as Chief Financial Officer on 
1 January 2025.
Independent: No.
Skills and experience: Tony joined Funding 
Circle in 2018 as Director of Finance and 
was part of the team leading the IPO. Prior 
to Funding Circle, he was Group Financial 
Controller at IG Group Holdings plc, where 
he was responsible for all financial reporting 
including budgeting and forecasting. Before 
then, Tony worked at PwC as an Assurance 
Director auditing and advising listed and 
private businesses in a number of sectors. 
Tony is an FCA of the ICAEW and holds a 
BSc in Mathematics from the University 
of Bristol.
External appointments: None.
4  Geeta Gopalan 
Senior Independent Director
Term of office: Geeta was appointed to 
the Board as a Non-Executive Director 
in November 2018. She became Chair of 
the Audit and Risk Committee (previously 
the Audit Committee) in November 2018. 
Geeta was appointed as Senior Independent 
Director in May 2021.
Independent: Yes.
Skills and experience: Geeta has over 
25 years of experience of financial services 
and retail banking, particularly payments 
and digital innovation. Geeta was formerly 
Executive Chair of Monitise Europe. Among 
the many roles in her career, Geeta was 
Director of Payment Services with HBOS 
plc and previously Managing Director, UK 
Retail Bank and Business Development Head 
EME at Citigroup. Geeta was previously 
a Non-Executive Director at Dechra 
Pharmaceuticals until January 2024. Geeta 
is also a chartered accountant. 
External appointments: Geeta serves as a 
Non-Executive Director of NatWest Group plc, 
Auto Trader Group plc and Intrum AB (where 
she is Chair of the Risk Committee). Geeta is 
also a Trustee for the Old Vic Theatre.
5  Hendrik Nelis
Non-Executive Director
Term of office: Hendrik was appointed to 
the Board as a Non-Executive Director in 
September 2013.
Independent: No.
Skills and experience: Hendrik joined 
Accel in 2004 and focuses on software, 
fintech and consumer internet companies. 
He led Accel’s investments in KAYAK 
(NASDAQ: KYAK, acquired by Priceline), 
Showroomprive (EPA: SRP), Funding Circle 
(LON: FCH), Celonis, CHECK24, Instana, 
Miro and Zepz.
Hendrik started his career in Silicon Valley 
as an engineer at Hewlett-Packard before 
founding a venture-backed software 
company. He is from the Netherlands and 
graduated from Harvard Business School 
and Delft University of Technology.
External appointments: Hendrik serves as 
Manager, Partner Director and/or Member 
at a number of Accel entities, as well as a 
Director or supervisory board member of 
several other companies.
6  Neil Rimer 
Non-Executive Director
Term of office: Neil was appointed to 
the Board as a Non-Executive Director in 
March 2011.
Independent: No.
Skills and experience: Neil is a Co-Founder 
and Partner of Index Ventures. Before 
starting Index Ventures, he spent four 
years with Montgomery Securities in San 
Francisco. Neil was previously a Director of 
Photobox Holdco Limited, Supercell Oy and 
The Climate Corporation.
External appointments: Neil is currently 
a Director on various boards of companies 
based in the UK, Europe, the Cayman Islands 
and the US including Raisin GmbH, Nexthink 
SA, , Sofia Holdings Limited, Taxfix GmbH 
and Typeform S.L. He is also the Co-Chair of 
Human Rights Watch.
7  Helen Beck 
Non-Executive Director
Term of office: Helen was appointed to 
the Board as a Non-Executive Director in 
June 2021.
Independent: Yes.
Skills and experience: Helen has over 
25 years of experience in financial services, 
particularly in remuneration design, 
regulation and human resources. Helen was 
formerly a Partner at Deloitte and, among 
her previous roles in her career, Helen was 
Global Head of Reward at Standard Bank 
and Head of McLagan Europe (part of Aon) 
and held roles in human resources at Fidelity 
International. Helen was also previously a 
Non-Executive Director of Irwin Mitchell.
External appointments: Helen serves as 
Non-Executive Director of Picton Property 
Income Limited (where she is Chair of 
the Remuneration Committee) and as an 
independent adviser of Charles II Realisation 
LLP. Helen is an independent adviser for the 
Wellcome Foundation’s Remuneration Sub-
Committee, is a Governor of the University 
of Bedfordshire and independent member of 
the Remuneration Committee for The British 
Olympic Association.
8  Ken Stannard 
Non-Executive Director and Chair 
Designate
Term of office: Ken was appointed to the 
Board as a Non-Executive Director and Chair 
Designate in January 2025. 
Independent: Yes.
Skills and experience: Ken brings 30 years’ 
experience in credit, lending and payments, 
having held senior executive roles at Lloyds 
Banking Group, Capital One and American 
Express, and most recently as CEO of Cabot 
Credit Management. Prior to his executive 
roles, he was a partner at Oliver Wyman LLC. 
Ken has an MBA from INSEAD and an MA 
in Engineering Science from the University 
of Oxford.
External appointments: Ken is currently 
Chair of Castle Trust Capital Plc, Castle Trust 
Holdings Limited and Viewture Limited. He 
is currently also a Non-Executive Director of 
Verastar Ltd. and Chair of its Remuneration 
Committee and Lead Director of Cepal 
Hellas Financial Services S.A.
9  Lucy Vernall 
Company Secretary, 
Chief Legal Officer 
Term of office: Lucy was appointed 
Company Secretary in July 2014.
Independent: Not applicable.
Skills and experience: Lucy is responsible 
for the Legal, Compliance, ESG and Comms 
functions of the business, in addition to 
being Company Secretary. Prior to joining 
Funding Circle in 2014, Lucy was one of 
the founder members of Kemp Little LLP, a 
technology focused City law firm. She was 
Managing Partner of the firm from 2009 
until 2011, when she became Wonga’s first 
General Counsel.
External appointments: Lucy serves on the 
board of the charities Bardhan Research 
and Education Trust of Rotherham and The 
Emerson Trust.

 
Funding Circle Holdings plc | Annual Report and Accounts 2024
70
STRATEGIC REPORT
CORPORATE GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
Corporate governance report
Board leadership 
and Company purpose
Funding Circle’s purpose is to help small businesses get 
the funding they need to win. When small businesses 
succeed, they create jobs, support local communities 
and drive the economy forward. 
Funding Circle backs small businesses with the finance 
they need to win and this purpose is underpinned by 
several values including “Make it Happen” and “Live the 
Adventure” which ask Circlers to embrace the founding 
entrepreneurial spirit with which Funding Circle was 
established. The Board embraces the Company values 
as part of its decision-making process which is always 
in the long-term sustainable interests of the Company 
to generate value for shareholders and the wider 
society. More information on the Company’s mission, 
values and strategy is set out in the Strategic Report on 
pages 1 to 64.
Measuring performance against strategic objectives
A review of performance against the Company’s 
strategy, objectives, business plans and budget is 
considered at Board meetings. Maintaining oversight 
of the Company’s operations, ensuring competent and 
prudent management, sound planning, an adequate 
system of control, and adequate accounting in addition to 
reviewing any significant risks faced by the Company and 
establishing and maintaining risk management systems in 
co-ordination with the Audit and Risk Committee, ensures 
the Company fulfils its business objectives.
The Board is comfortable that sufficient resources are 
in place for the Company to meet its objectives and 
measure performance against them. As the Company 
grows and seeks to achieve its medium-term plan, 
the Board continues to support the ExCo with the 
implementation of objectives and key results across 
the whole business.
Our culture and employee engagement
We consider our employees and culture fundamental 
to the success of our business. The Board monitors 
the Group’s culture to ensure it is aligned with the 
Company’s purpose, values and strategy. Helen Beck is 
our dedicated Non-Executive Director for the workforce 
providing a vital connection between the Board and 
our Circlers. In 2024, Helen held an employee focus 
group with various Circlers to gain diverse views across 
various departments and she fed these views back to 
the Board for discussion. In addition, the Board receives 
regular updates from the Chief People Officer on Circler 
initiatives and culture updates, including results from 
employee surveys. Further information on how we engage 
with our employees can be found on pages 20 to 23 
and page 41. 
As part of the Board’s responsibility to monitor and 
oversee the Company’s culture, the Board discussed 
and agreed that Helen Beck and the Chief People 
Officer would set out a proposed schedule of further 
opportunities for direct engagement between the Board 
and employees during 2025.
Our workforce policies and practices are regularly 
reviewed by the Board and Committees and the Board 
is satisfied that they are consistent with the Company’s 
values and support its long-term sustainable success.
In addition, as part of our “Be Open” value, we want 
to ensure we foster an environment where Circlers 
are encouraged and feel safe to freely raise issues 
of concern. We have a dedicated whistleblowing 
process which provides various channels for Circlers 
to communicate and report issues of concern, including 
anonymously. Our Audit and Risk Committee receives 
regular whistleblowing updates. Further information can 
be found in the Report of the Audit and Risk Committee 
on pages 82 to 87.
Shareholder engagement
The Board is responsible for ensuring effective 
engagement with, and encouraging participation from, 
various stakeholders, including shareholders. Information 
on how the Company has engaged with shareholders and 
other stakeholders can be found in the “Engaging our 
Stakeholders” section on pages 40 to 43.
Our Investor Relations team supports the Board with 
continuous engagement with shareholders. In addition, 
the Board receives copies of analysts’ and brokers’ 
reports on the Company along with a monthly Investor 
Analytics Report which details key shareholders, 
shareholder history, top buyers and sellers, market 
analysis and share price performance to aid familiarity 
with details of shareholdings.
The Company Secretarial function engages with 
shareholders, providing support and information on 
governance matters as required, whilst the Company’s 
registrar also provides a range of shareholder services.
The Board has considered the feedback received from 
the shareholder consultation held in early 2025 in relation 
to the Company’s new Remuneration Policy and has taken 
it into consideration when drafting the disclosures in this 
Report. Details on our engagement with shareholders 
who had significantly voted against certain resolutions in 
the 2024 AGM can be found on page 114.

 
 
 
 
 
Funding Circle Holdings plc | Annual Report and Accounts 2024
71
STRATEGIC REPORT
CORPORATE GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
Board activities
The Board meets formally at least six times during the 
year, with meetings planned around key events in the 
corporate calendar, including the half-year and full-year 
results and the AGM and an annual dedicated Strategy 
Day. The Board also receives monthly management 
financial reports and CEO updates in between meetings. 
The Chair and Non-Executive Directors have regular 
discussions without Executive Directors present. Ad hoc 
meetings may be called as and when appropriate, as was 
the case in 2024.
Standing items provide an anchor to the strategy and 
provide the Board with a consistent view of progress 
during the year, whilst sessions on priority topics 
allow for deeper insight. A summary of the Board’s key 
activities during 2024 is set out below. In addition, some 
examples of key decisions taken by the Board in 2024, 
in the context of its section 172 (1) duties, are set out 
on pages 72 to 73. Agendas and accompanying papers 
are distributed to the Board and Committee members 
well in advance of each Board or Committee meeting. 
These include reports from Executive Directors, other 
members of senior management and external advisers, 
as appropriate. All Directors have direct access to senior 
management should they require additional information 
on any of the items to be discussed. 
The table below sets out attendance at the eight Board 
meetings held in 2024. The attendance for the Committee 
meetings is detailed in each of the Committee reports.
Director
No. of meetings
Attendance
Andrew Learoyd
8/8
100%
Lisa Jacobs
8/8
100%
Oliver White (resigned on 
31 December 2024)
8/8
100%
Geeta Gopalan
8/8
100%
Hendrik Nelis
8/8
100%
Neil Rimer
8/8
100%
Helen Beck 
8/8
100%
Matthew King (resigned on 
31 December 2024)
8/8
100%
Samir Desai CBE (resigned on 
25 October 2024)
7/7
100%
Eric Daniels (resigned on 
15 May 2024)
3/3
100%
Key topics discussed by the Board 
Financial 
performance 
• Group’s financial results throughout the year 
(incl. half-year reforecast)
• KPIs and milestones review
• Annual budget approval and quarterly forecasts review
• Capital allocation deep dive and approval of share buybacks 
and capital reduction
Strategy
• Approval of sale of US business
• Approval of cost efficiency actions and focus on go forward 
profitability of UK business
• Customers and market deep dive
• Approval of strategy for FY 2025 and medium-term plan
• Technology and FlexiPay deep dives
• Review and approval of product propositions for Term 
Loans, FlexiPay and Cashback credit card
Governance, risk 
and compliance
• Risk and macro deep dive and approval of ERMF
• Committee updates
• Appointment of new Chair and CFO
• Internal evaluations of the Board and Committees
• Approval of Whistleblowing Policy
• Approval of risk management framework for 
climate- related risks
Culture and 
engagement
• Employee engagement and culture updates 
• Diversity and inclusion update
• Shareholder engagement updates
• Approval of Board Diversity Policy
• Review Workforce Engagement Non-Executive Director’s 
report on employee focus group feedback
Key
Circlers
Borrowers
Institutional 
Investors
Shareholders
Government 
and regulators
Communities

Board activities continued
Corporate governance report continued
Funding Circle Holdings plc | Annual Report and Accounts 2024
72
STRATEGIC REPORT
CORPORATE GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
Board decision making and section 172(1) duties 
Funding Circle has a wide and varied group of internal and external stakeholders which the Board keeps in mind 
during all discussions. In addition, our Investor Relations team supports the Board with continuous engagement with 
shareholders. Further information on how we have engaged with all our stakeholders can be found on page 40 to 43.
The Directors have full regard to their duties set out under section 172 of the Companies Act 2006 when making 
decisions. Our section 172 Statement can be found in the Strategic Report on page 41. The following table summarises 
how the Board and the wider Group have had regard to the duties under section 172(1) when considering specific 
matters during the year.
Principal decision 
Stakeholders 
considered
Board’s decision-making process
Approval of sale 
of US business 
and focus on 
go forward 
profitability of UK 
business
Borrowers 
Institutional 
Investors 
Shareholders 
Circlers 
Government 
and regulators 
Communities 
The Board carefully considered the strategic direction of the Group following 
the challenging macro economic environment in 2023. At the end of 2023, 
Funding Circle’s US business was awarded an SBA issuer license (subject 
to final SBA approval). While this reflected the progress made in the US and 
offered attractive long-term growth, the Board recognised that it would require 
a significant amount of cash and a different approach in terms of capital and 
other resource requirements to grow the SBA proposition. The Board therefore 
took the decision to simplify the business and focus on go forward profitability 
of the UK business, believing that this would deliver greater shareholder value 
with improved profitability and cash generation. 
After due consideration and discussions over a number of months, in March 
2024, the Board announced its intention to sell the US business and that it was 
in early-stage discussions with interested parties. In addition to accelerating 
profitability, this would also enable management to focus on the UK business 
and delivering new products and an excellent customer experience to its 
growing UK customer base. The Board appointed a Board Sub-Committee to 
oversee the transaction and, following a thorough process involving several 
interested parties, the Board agreed to sell the US business to iBusiness 
Funding, LLC, a leading provider of lending solutions for banks and lenders 
of all sizes with a specialisation in SBA lending. The transaction completed 
on 1 July 2024. US impacted employees were carefully considered during the 
sale process and Funding Circle worked with iBusiness Funding to ensure 
that there were roles for as many individuals as possible post-acquisition 
(including certain UK-based employees who transferred under the Transfer 
of Undertakings (Protection of Employment) Regulations 2006). 
Streamlining of 
UK business and 
cost efficiency 
actions 
Shareholders 
Circlers 
In May 2024, as part of the Group’s long-term strategic plan to promote 
sustainable growth and to ensure a simpler, leaner and better positioned 
UK-focused operation, the Board reviewed and approved management’s 
recommendation of certain cost efficiency actions. This included a reduction 
in employee headcount by c.120 and other changes to strengthen cost 
management and efficiency across the business. 
Funding Circle prides itself on its strong culture so this was a difficult decision, 
but a necessary one to create a leaner, profitable business and reduce 
leadership and management layers following the change to a UK-only business. 
The wellbeing of Funding Circle’s employees has always been a material 
consideration for the Board and the approach to the reduction of roles was 
discussed at length, with a focus on a sympathetic and compliant process 
and support for those impacted. This included offering enhanced redundancy 
payments, payments in lieu of working notice periods where possible and 
extended private health cover. 

Principal decision 
Stakeholders 
considered
Board’s decision-making process
Funding Circle Holdings plc | Annual Report and Accounts 2024
73
STRATEGIC REPORT
CORPORATE GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
Initiation of two 
share buyback 
programmes 
and a capital 
reduction process
Shareholders 
Circlers 
Government 
and regulators 
As part of the Group’s overall objective to provide sustainable long-term 
stakeholder value, the Board regularly considers its capital allocation strategy 
along with its budget and financial planning strategy. At the time of the full-year 
results in March 2024, the Company had significant cash available in excess of 
c.£200 million and available distributable reserves in excess of £30 million. The 
Board also considered the share price to materially undervalue Funding Circle’s 
business. After careful consideration, and having taken advice as to the options 
available for a capital redistribution, in March 2024, the Board approved a share 
buyback and cancellation programme of up to £25 million which was further 
extended by up to a further £25 million in September 2024. 
In addition, in October 2024, the Board approved the initiation of a capital 
reduction process which completed in December 2024. The Board considered 
this to be in the best interests of the Company and its shareholders (including 
Circlers who are also shareholders through employee share schemes) as this 
would increase distributable reserves by £294 million. 
Appointment of 
Chief Financial 
Officer and new 
Non-Executive 
Chair 
Borrowers 
Institutional 
Investors 
Shareholders 
Circlers 
Government 
and regulators 
The Company disclosed in its 2023 Annual Report that it was commencing a 
search for a new Non-Executive Chair and that there would be other changes 
to the Non-Executive Board composition as some Directors were coming to the 
end of their tenures. It also announced in May that Oliver White had informed 
the Board of his intention to stand down from his role. As part of the Board’s 
decision-making process in relation to succession planning for the CFO and 
Chair roles, the Board considered all stakeholders that would be impacted by 
the outcomes of these appointments. For example, in addition to the underlying 
skills, experience and capability required in the role, it was important that these 
leadership appointments would add and reinforce the strong culture embedded 
within Funding Circle. This was one of the considerations in appointing Tony 
Nicol into the role – having been with Funding Circle for six years. 
Additionally, finding a new Chair with a complementary skill set to the existing 
Board, including card and credit experience, was important to the Board to 
help drive its strategic decision making and enhance our borrowers’ end-to-
end experience. This was one of the reasons Ken Stannard was chosen by the 
Board as the successor to Andrew Learoyd.
Approval of 
launch of 
Cashback credit 
card
Borrowers 
Institutional 
Investors 
Circlers 
Shareholders 
The Board approved the launch of FlexiPay in H2 2021 to further enable the 
Group’s vision of supporting small businesses as they borrow, pay later and 
spend to grow and manage their businesses. By the beginning of H2 2024, 
FlexiPay had grown significantly. In response to customer feedback that they 
wanted a business credit card providing benefits and rewards for everyday 
business spending, in July 2024, the Board approved management’s proposal 
to launch the Cashback credit card product. Having carefully considered the 
evolution of the FlexiPay product, the Board considering that the proposed 
product would complement FlexiPay in helping to solve customers’ cash flow 
requirements and attract SMEs not currently looking to immediately borrow, 
thereby enabling Funding Circle to properly start serving the spend use case. 
The Board approved the proposal to enter the market with a leading cashback 
proposition.
Adoption of risk 
management 
framework for 
climate-related 
risks
Government 
and regulators 
Communities 
In 2024, the Board adopted a new climate risk management framework which 
set safeguard thresholds for climate risk appetite and for physical and transition 
risks. The framework was debated at the ARC and approved in November 
2024, thereby integrating climate-related risks into the Group’s broader risk 
management processes and underpinning its ongoing processes to identify 
and assess climate-related risks.

Corporate governance report continued
 
Funding Circle Holdings plc | Annual Report and Accounts 2024
74
STRATEGIC REPORT
CORPORATE GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
Division of 
responsibilities
The Board has adopted a formal schedule of matters reserved for its approval and delegated other specific 
responsibilities to the following five Board Committees: Audit and Risk, Remuneration, Nomination, ESG and Market 
Disclosure. Each Board Committee has written Terms of Reference which define the role and responsibilities of the 
respective Committee and these are reviewed annually, along with the schedule of matters reserved for the Board. 
Further details can be found here: corporate.fundingcircle.com/who-we-are/corporate-governance/board-committees. 
More information about the role and activities of each of the Board Committees, with the exception of the Market 
Disclosure Committee, can also be found in the Committee reports.
Corporate governance framework
Board
Audit 
and Risk 
Committee
Market 
Disclosure 
Committee
Remuneration 
Committee
ESG 
Committee
Nomination 
Committee
Chief Executive Officer
Executive Committee (“ExCo”)
Executive Governance Committee and Management Implementation Committees 
(see risk governance structure on page 53)
The responsibilities for the Market Disclosure Committee, 
which is chaired by the Company Secretary and 
comprises the Chair of the Board, the Chair of the Audit 
and Risk Committee, the CEO, the CFO and the CRO, 
include overseeing the disclosure of information by the 
Company to meet its obligations under the Market Abuse 
Regulation, the FCA’s UK Listing Rules (“UKLR”) and the 
Disclosure and Transparency Rules (“DTR”). 
The ExCo provides leadership in the day-to-day 
management of the business and implements the 
strategy approved by the Board. The ExCo is supported 
by a number of management committees which provide 
consistent reporting on key areas of the business. 
There is a flow of information both ways between the 
management committees and the ExCo and the Board 
of Directors and its Committees. Further details on the 
management risk committees are available in the Risk 
management section on page 53. 
Board roles and responsibilities
There is a clear division of responsibilities between 
the leadership of the Board and that of the Executive 
Directors and the responsibilities of the Chair, CEO, 
and Senior Independent Director are set out in writing, 
reviewed and approved by the Board annually. 
The responsibilities 
of these roles can be 
found on our website

Funding Circle Holdings plc | Annual Report and Accounts 2024
75
STRATEGIC REPORT
CORPORATE GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
Composition, 
succession and 
evaluations 
Board succession
As noted under Governance at a Glance on page 67, 
there have been a number of changes to the Board during 
2024 and up to the date of this report. One of the Board’s 
2024 priorities was to refresh its composition to ensure 
it had the appropriate skills, experience and knowledge 
to support the Company’s execution of its more 
simplified business strategy. The Board has established 
a Nomination Committee to which it has delegated 
responsibility for reviewing the leadership needs of the 
business, including Board composition, considering 
succession plans for both the Board and ExCo, selecting 
and appointing new Directors, having oversight of Board 
induction processes and considering the results of the 
Board effectiveness reviews. 
At the 2024 AGM, Eric Daniels retired from the Board after 
an almost eight-year term. Samir Desai CBE also retired 
from the Board in October 2024 after 14 years, firstly 
as an Executive Director and subsequently as a Non-
Executive Director during his term. In December 2024, 
Oliver White resigned as CFO and Executive Director after 
a four-year term. Matthew King resigned from the Board 
of both Funding Circle Holdings plc and Funding Circle 
Ltd on 31 December 2024. 
More information on the work of the Nomination 
Committee can be found on pages 78 to 81. 
Appointments
There were no new Director appointments during 
2024. Two new appointments were announced with 
effect from 1 January 2025: Tony Nicol, CFO, and Ken 
Stannard, independent Non-Executive Director and 
Chair Designate. More details on how the Nomination 
Committee led these appointment processes are noted 
in its Committee Report on pages 78 to 81.
Board composition
The Nomination Committee reviews the structure, size 
and composition of the Board to maintain and develop the 
robust succession plan for the Board and ExCo. For more 
details on the Board’s composition, see Governance at a 
glance on page 67. 
Board skills
The Nomination Committee uses a skills and experience 
matrix to regularly review the expertise of the Board 
and its Committees, taking into account the skills and 
experience, length of service and time commitment. 
The Board’s skills matrix can be found on page 67.
UK Corporate Governance Code (the “Code”) 
compliance 
As a listed company, the Company applies the 
principles and provisions of the Code which can 
be found, in full, at www.frc.org.uk. This is the last 
year we are reporting against the 2018 Code and 
next year, we will report against the 2024 Code.
As part of this Corporate Governance Report, 
we have laid out how the Board applies each of 
the principles of the Code at Funding Circle. The 
Board takes seriously the need for high standards 
of governance and aims to implement a robust 
corporate governance framework that works for 
the Company, enabling it to achieve long-term 
sustainable success and its wider objectives. With 
this in mind, the Company was compliant with all 
the provisions of the Code, except for provisions 
11 and 19.
Provision 11 requires that at least half the 
Board, excluding the Chair, should be Non-
Executive Directors whom the Board considers 
to be independent. During 2024, the Board 
was not compliant with this provision as there 
were three Non-Independent Directors on the 
Board, two of which were large shareholder 
representative Directors in addition to the CEO 
and CFO also being on the Board. With Eric 
Daniels and Samir Desai CBE having resigned 
from the Board during 2024, only three of the 
eight Board members (excluding the Chair) were 
considered to be independent by the end of the 
year. One of the Board’s priorities in 2025 will 
be to continue to refresh its composition and 
increase independence. Please see the Report of 
the Nomination Committee on pages 78 to 81 for 
additional details.
Provision 19 provides that the Chair should not 
remain in post beyond nine years from the date 
of their first appointment to the Board. Andrew 
Learoyd has served on the Board for more than 
nine years. However, as previously announced, 
a succession plan has been put in place with Ken 
Stannard’s recent appointment on 1 January 2025 
as Non-Executive Director and Chair Designate, 
with a view to Ken being appointed as Board Chair 
upon his election at the 2025 AGM. Further detail 
on the Chair’s succession planning process can be 
found in the Report of the Nomination Committee 
on page 80. 

Corporate governance report continued
Funding Circle Holdings plc | Annual Report and Accounts 2024
76
STRATEGIC REPORT
CORPORATE GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
Board effectiveness review
The Board takes its continuous improvement and development very seriously and, at the end of 2024, conducted a 
detailed internal effectiveness review of the performance of the Board, Chair and individual Directors. Topics included 
leadership and purpose, composition and division of responsibility, independence, Board meeting progress, Board 
development and support, risks and controls oversight, and culture and stakeholder engagement oversight. The 
evaluation process is outlined below:
Scope and planning
The Chair and Company 
Secretary met to determine the 
proposed scope and approach 
of the questionnaire to be 
circulated for completion.
Obtaining feedback
Tailored questionnaire was 
agreed and circulated by online 
software to all Directors and 
the Company Secretary to 
gain feedback on the Board’s 
effectiveness.
Analysing and reporting
The results of the questionnaire 
were analysed with key themes 
summarised in a final report 
presented to the Board for 
discussion. Actions were 
agreed to take forward.
Outcomes 
The evaluation concluded that the Board, Chair and Directors continue to be effective. Some areas noted for 
improvement, which the Board is committed to addressing in 2025, included:
• continuing to review Board succession plans and performance; and
• reviewing and enhancing processes for Board oversight of people and culture, including mechanisms for 
employee engagement.
Progress against actions identified in 2023 effectiveness review
Set out below is the progress during 2024 against actions identified through the 2023 Board effectiveness review:
Action for 2024
Progress
Reviewing the Board agenda programme to ensure the 
appropriate deep dive topics are scheduled with the 
right frequency.
The Chair circulated the 2024 Board annual planner to 
all Directors for feedback on additional deep dive topics. 
The Company Secretary then incorporated these topics 
into the Board’s annual planner and meeting agendas.
Ensuring all Board members have access to all Board 
Committee meetings and materials even if they are not 
members of those Committees.
All Non-Executive Directors are now invited to all 
Committee meetings and have access to all Committee 
materials regardless of whether they are a member of 
that Committee.
Encouraging further active shareholder engagement by 
management and the Chair.
Management actively engages and offers direct meetings 
with shareholders and prospective shareholders at 
all half-year and full-year results periods and to gain 
feedback on relevant matters. In addition, the Board Chair 
and Remuneration Committee Chair, via the Company 
Secretary, regularly offers to meet with shareholders to 
discuss governance matters such as the Remuneration 
Policy review and AGM voting results.
Improving the tracking and reporting on a range of 
agreed KPIs and milestones by better building this into 
management’s quarterly reporting to the Board.
Quarterly milestone trackers were added to management’s 
reporting to the Board and discussed at each meeting. 
External evaluation
The Board discussed the value of an externally facilitated evaluation at length including the recommendation in provision 
21 of the 2018 Code and the value of an external evaluation from the perspective of stakeholders. The Board decided that 
it was not appropriate at this time due to the significant change to the Board’s composition during the year and as the 
internal evaluation was rigorous with full engagement and candid responses from Board members. Areas of improvement 
were identified which the Board was fully committed to working on in 2025. 

 
Funding Circle Holdings plc | Annual Report and Accounts 2024
77
STRATEGIC REPORT
CORPORATE GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
Audit, risk and 
internal control
The Board has delegated to the ARC responsibility 
for overseeing the financial and corporate reporting 
and internal financial controls of the Company and 
its subsidiaries. This includes reviewing the content 
of the Annual Report and Accounts and advising the 
Board on whether, taken as a whole, it is fair, balanced 
and understandable. Details of this process and the 
focus of the review and of the ARC’s role, activities 
and relationship with the external auditors are on 
pages 82 to 87 of the Report of the ARC.
Audit
The Board has formal and transparent procedures in 
place to ensure the independence and effectiveness 
of the internal and external audit functions, as required 
by the Code. An effectiveness review of both the internal 
and external audit functions was completed during 
the year which included an evaluation of professional 
integrity and independence. Further details of the 
evaluations can be found in the Report of the ARC on 
pages 86 to 87.
The Board delegates responsibility for ensuring the 
integrity of the financial and narrative statements to the 
ARC. Further detail can be found on pages 82 to 87.
Responsibility for preparing the Annual Report and 
Accounts
The Board is responsible for maintaining adequate 
accounting records and seeks to ensure compliance 
with statutory and regulatory obligations. An explanation 
from the Directors about their responsibility for preparing 
the financial statements is on page 115 in the Statement 
of Directors’ Responsibilities. The Company’s external 
auditors explain their responsibilities on pages 121 to 122.
Streamlining governance
With effect from 1 January 2024, the Board approved, 
with the recommendation of the Nomination Committee, 
the creation of a combined ARC, replacing the old Audit 
and Risk & Compliance Committees, exhibiting how 
the Board continuously considers the efficacy of its 
Committees and its overall governance framework.
Risk management and internal control systems
In accordance with the Code, the Board is required to 
monitor the Group’s risk management and internal control 
systems on an ongoing basis and carry out a review of 
their effectiveness. To discharge this responsibility, the 
Board has established frameworks for risk management 
and internal control using a “Three Lines of Defence” 
model as outlined in the Group’s ERMF and reserves for 
itself the setting of the Group’s risk appetite. 
Whilst the Board retains ultimate responsibility for the 
Group’s systems of internal control and risk management, 
it has delegated in-depth monitoring of the establishment 
and operation of prudent and effective controls in order 
to assess and manage risks associated with the Group’s 
operations to the ARC. The ARC also monitors compliance 
with the ERMF. Members of the ExCo are responsible 
for the application of the ERMF, for implementing and 
monitoring the operation of the systems of internal 
control and for providing assurances on this to the Board 
and its relevant Committees. For further details on the 
ERMF and our approach to risk management, please 
see page 54.
The Internal Audit function provides an independent and 
objective assessment to the ARC on the robustness of 
the ERMF and the appropriateness and effectiveness of 
internal controls. The ARC provides regular updates to 
the Board on the Committee’s review of the Group’s risk 
management and internal control systems as discussed 
in its Committee meetings, further details of which are 
outlined in the Report of the ARC on page 87.
During the year, the Board, supported by the ARC, carried 
out a robust assessment of the emerging and principal 
risks and uncertainties facing the Group, including 
any that would threaten our business model, future 
performance, solvency or liquidity. There is an ongoing 
process for identifying, evaluating and managing the 
principal risks faced by the Company as described in 
more detail in the Risk section. The systems have been 
in place for the year under review and up to the date of 
approval of this Report and they are regularly reviewed 
by the ARC. 

Funding Circle Holdings plc | Annual Report and Accounts 2024
78
STRATEGIC REPORT
CORPORATE GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
Report of the Nomination Committee
Andrew Learoyd 
Chair
“
2024 was a significant 
year of change to the 
Board’s composition.”
Members and attendance
Member
Meetings
Attendance
Andrew Learoyd (Chair)
7/7
100%
Geeta Gopalan
7/7
100%
Helen Beck 
7/7
100%
The Committee’s role and key 
responsibilities are defined in its 
Terms of Reference which can 
be found on our website
2024 Committee activity
• An overwhelming majority of the Committee’s 
work during the year related to the extensive 
search and recruitment processes for Chair 
and NED succession planning (which included 
significant additional ad hoc meetings), as well 
as leading a rigorous recruitment process for a 
CFO replacement.
• Reviewed Committee and Board performance 
results and approval of new Board 
Diversity Policy.
• Reviewed Director conflicts and NED time 
commitment annual review and recommended 
Directors to stand for re-election at the AGM.
The Committee’s focus for 2025
• Drive forward the process of continued 
succession planning for the Board.
On behalf of the Board, I am pleased to present the 
Committee’s Report for the year ended 31 December 2024. 
With three Non-Executive Directors (including our Founder, 
Samir Desai CBE) and our CFO retiring and new CFO and 
Chair recruitment processes being undertaken this year, the 
Committee has been very busy with refreshing the Board. 
More detail on these changes is provided within this Report.
The Committee met seven times in 2024 which enabled 
us to cover all our duties and responsibilities. In this report, 
we have provided information on the activities of the 
Committee in 2024 as well as the Committee’s work on 
Board composition, succession planning, diversity and 
Committee effectiveness. Where we have diverted from the 
UK Corporate Governance Code 2018, we have provided 
a clear explanation as to why this is the best approach for 
Funding Circle at this time.
Skills and experience 
The Committee maintains a skills and experience matrix 
which helps us review the current skills and experience 
of the Board and identify any gaps that may need filling. 
The skills and experience of the Directors on the Board 
were evaluated as part of the annual effectiveness review 
and our succession plan for the Board will take into 
account the appropriate skills and expertise to match the 
Company’s new strategic direction. Details of the Board’s 
skills are outlined on page 67.
Board diversity
The Committee is mindful of the importance of ensuring 
the Board’s and Committees’ diversity in the broadest 
sense. With this in mind, the Board considers the 
guidance published by the Parker Review on ethnic 
diversity in the boardroom, the FTSE Women Leaders 
Review (formerly the Hampton-Alexander Review) on 
gender diversity in the boardroom and the requirements 
of the Code in relation to composition and succession of 
the Board. In February 2024, the Board adopted a Board 
Diversity Policy, which outlines our approach to diversity 
and inclusion with respect to the Board, the Board’s 
Committees, the ExCo and their direct reports, a copy 
of which can be found on our website. 

 
Funding Circle Holdings plc | Annual Report and Accounts 2024
79
STRATEGIC REPORT
CORPORATE GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
Leadership diversity 
DEI is a priority at Funding Circle, which extends across 
the Company at all levels. DEI is a key component of our 
ESG framework, overseen by our ESG Committee which 
works closely with the Committee to support and oversee 
the implementation of diversity goals across the Group 
including at Board level. 
Group diversity statistics can be found in the Strategic 
Report on page 20. We are pleased to say that 
representation of women in roles held at the ExCo level 
along with their direct reports is 43%. The Committee 
recognises that there is still work to be done to improve 
diversity within the Group and the ESG Committee has 
discussed the work being done to improve diversity 
across the Group. This extends to our approach and 
process to drive diverse recruitment, which includes 
diverse candidate and hiring panels, alongside 
ensuring DEI remains a core focus for our internal talent 
management strategies. Initiatives include a female 
empowerment programme, emerging and senior leader 
development programmes, and reverse mentoring. 
The Company also regularly reviews and is proud to offer 
a range of family friendly and flexible working policies 
and practices (such as adoption leave, care leave, and 
support for parents returning to work).
Board appointments 
We announced the appointment of Tony Nicol as successor 
to Oliver White, Executive Director and CFO, and the 
appointment of Ken Stannard, as Independent Non-
Executive Director and Chair Designate, both effective 
from 1 January 2025. The process for the CFO appointment 
was led by the Committee. As the Board Chair leads the 
Committee, the process for his successor was led by a 
Sub-Committee chaired by Geeta Gopalan, our Senior 
Independent Director, comprising of Helen Beck, another 
Committee member, and the CEO, with additional support 
provided by the Chief People Officer and the Company 
Secretary. The rest of the Board, including the Board Chair, 
provided feedback throughout the process when requested 
by the Sub-Committee. Further details on the process for 
the appointments are outlined on page 80. 
The following comprises our reporting against the FCA’s UK Listing Rules targets and requirements on diversity 
and inclusion on company Boards and Executive management. Whilst the Board recognises it does not currently meet 
the minimum 40% female representation on the Board, it does highlight that this is offset by two female directors in 
senior positions, being CEO and SID roles, which is above the FCA’s requirement. The Board will continue to take into 
consideration all diversity requirements in its board succession planning.
Gender representation in the Board and senior management – 31 December 2024
Number of 
Board members
Percentage 
of the Board
Progress 
from 
2023
Number of senior
 positions on the
 Board (CEO,
 CFO, SID and
 Chair)
Progress 
from 
2023
Number 
in ExCo
Percentage 
of ExCo
Progress 
from 
2023
Men
5
62.5%
2
6
75%
Women
3
37.5%
2
2
25%
Ethnicity representation in the Board and senior management – 31 December 2024
Number of 
Board members
Percentage 
of the Board
Progress 
from 
2023  Note 1 
Number of senior
 positions on the
 Board (CEO,
 CFO, SID and
 Chair)
Progress 
from 
2023
Number 
in ExCo
Percentage 
of ExCo
Progress 
from 
2023
White British 
or other White 
(including minority-
White groups)
7
87.5%
3
6
75%
Asian/Asian British
1
12.5%
1
—
—
Other ethnic group
—
—
—
2
25%
1. The reduction in ethnic representation on the Board is due to Samir Desai CBE resigning as Non-Executive Director in October 2024.
Key
Improving
No change
Deteriorating

Report of the Nomination Committee continued
 
Board appointments continued
Funding Circle Holdings plc | Annual Report and Accounts 2024
80
STRATEGIC REPORT
CORPORATE GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
Chair Designate appointment process 
Stage 1
The Committee reviewed at length the Board’s composition, skills, experience and diversity and agreed on what would be required 
by a new Chair to complement both the existing and near-term Board composition. A Sub-Committee was appointed.
Stage 2 
The Sub-Committee reviewed and approved an outline brief and role specification and appointed Heidrick & Struggles to identify 
suitable candidates from a diverse pool of individuals in line with the Board Diversity Policy. The Sub-Committee, taking input from 
the wider Committee and other key stakeholders (including the CEO), determined a short list of candidates for outreach. 
Stage 3
The short-listed candidates met with the respective Sub-Committee, with the preferred candidates going on to meet the remaining 
members of the Board.
Stage 4
The Sub-Committee agreed the preferred candidate based on the range of skills, experience and knowledge that complemented 
those of the existing Board members and recommended the same to the Board.
Stage 5
The Board considered the candidates on their merits and approved the appointment of Ken Stannard as a Non-Executive Director and Chair 
Designate with effect from 1 January 2025.
1. Heidrick & Struggles is an independent executive search and global leadership advisory business with no other connection to the Company or any individual 
Director. Heidrick & Struggles is accredited by the Enhanced Voluntary Code of Conduct for Executive Firms for its support to FTSE 350 Boards in increasing 
gender diversity. It is also a partner with organisations like the Paradigm for Parity® coalition and the 30% Club’s Future Female Directors programme to help 
close the corporate leadership gender gap and promote gender parity across all levels of organisations. Specific guidance was given to Heidrick & Struggles to 
ensure diversity within the candidate long and short lists whilst identifying candidates who had the relevant skills and experience required on the Board.
 
CFO appointment process 
Stage 1
The Committee reviewed and approved an outline brief and role specification for the CFO role. The Committee also reviewed the 
existing ExCo succession plan reviewed by the Board which identified Tony Nicol as a potential successor to Oliver White as CFO.
Stage 2 
The Committee appointed Heidrick & Struggles to carry out an external benchmarking exercise and identified external candidates 
from a diverse pool of individuals in order to compare against internal candidate options. 
Stage 3
The internal candidate went through a thorough interview process with the members of the Committee and the CEO.
Stage 4 
The Committee agreed that the internal candidate was the preferred candidate for the position, based on his range of skills, 
experience, knowledge and strong culture fit for the Executive role, already being a long-standing senior leader in the organisation 
who had built strong stakeholder relationships within the Company and the Board, and recommended his appointment to the Board. 
Stage 5
The Board considered the candidate on his merits and approved the appointment of Tony Nicol as a Executive Director and CFO with 
effect from 1 January 2025.

Funding Circle Holdings plc | Annual Report and Accounts 2024
81
STRATEGIC REPORT
CORPORATE GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
Board induction process
Director induction programmes to the Board are 
facilitated by the Company Secretarial team and overseen 
by the Committee. All new Directors are provided with full 
access to our secure resource centre within our secure 
Board software, which provides induction materials such 
as Group policies, structure charts, Terms of Reference, 
strategy material, investor relations coverage, and past 
Board and Committee meeting papers and minutes.
For Ken Stannard’s induction, in addition to the above, 
Ken had meetings with members of the ExCo, key 
external corporate advisers, heads of key Group 
functions, and the external auditors. Ken also attended an 
introductory breakfast meeting with the Group’s Senior 
Leadership team. Ken also met with some shareholders 
upon request prior to the 2025 AGM. 
As Tony Nicol was already on the Senior Leadership team 
prior to being appointed as CFO, he had already built 
strong relationships with the ExCo, Senior Leadership 
team, external advisers and the external auditors. Due 
to Tony’s existing investor relations remit, he was also 
familiar with major shareholders. As this was Tony’s first 
Board-level Executive role with a listed Company, he was 
provided with tailored training in relation to Directors’ 
duties (e.g. s.172) and the Code. Tony has also previously 
completed Deloitte’s CFO programme.
Board and Committee effectiveness
The Committee reviewed the 2024 Board effectiveness 
review results and discussed feedback that related 
to the Committee’s remit. More detail on the Board’s 
effectiveness review is on page 76.
Progress on actions from 2023 Committee 
effectiveness review 
Feedback from the 2023 effectiveness review noted 
that the Committee needed to focus more on Board 
succession planning and in particular the Chair 
succession planning and this was actioned in the year 
with seven meetings taking place during 2024. 
2024 Committee effectiveness review
The Company Secretarial team facilitated an 
effectiveness review of the Committee at the end of 
2024. A comprehensive questionnaire was distributed 
to all the Committee members. All members of the 
Committee, the Chief People Officer and the Company 
Secretary responded to the questionnaire and engaged 
with the evaluation process.
Overall, scores were good across all elements of the 
questionnaire of the Committee’s effectiveness. There 
was consistent commentary amongst all members noting 
that Board and ExCo succession planning should remain 
a key priority for 2025.
Re-election
I will not be standing for re-election at the 2025 AGM as I 
am resigning as Board Chair at the AGM. The Committee 
has recommended to the Board that the other remaining 
Directors stand for election or re-election at the 
forthcoming AGM. 
Senior management succession
The Committee’s responsibilities include making 
recommendations to the Board for orderly succession 
for appointments to senior management and keeping 
the Executive leadership needs of the Company and 
its Group under review, with a view to ensuring they 
continue to compete effectively in the market. 
Board succession, composition and the year ahead
There have been several changes to our Board since 
the Annual General Meeting in 2024 which are noted in 
more detail within the Corporate Governance Report. 
Whilst the Board is not currently majority independent, 
the Committee has discussed in depth the composition 
of the Board in respect of independence and tenure and 
in respect of aligning the Board’s composition with the 
Company’s needs which will remain a key focus for the 
Committee during 2025.
Andrew Learoyd
Chair of the Nomination Committee 
6 March 2025

 
 
Funding Circle Holdings plc | Annual Report and Accounts 2024
82
STRATEGIC REPORT
CORPORATE GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
Report of the Audit and Risk Committee
Geeta Gopalan 
Chair of the Audit and 
Risk Committee 
“
In 2024, we streamlined the Board’s 
audit and risk oversight to support a 
more holistic view of the effectiveness 
of the Group’s risk and internal 
controls environment.” 
Members and attendance
Member
Meetings
Attendance
Geeta Gopalan (Chair)
5/5
100%
Matthew King
5/5
100%
Helen Beck
5/5
100%
Eric Daniels Note 1 
(resigned on 15 May 2024)
1/2
50%
1. Eric Daniels only attended one meeting during the year as he resigned 
at the AGM in May 2024 and he missed one other Committee meeting 
due to a meeting schedule conflict that was unavoidable. 
The Committee’s role and key 
responsibilities are defined in its 
Terms of Reference which can be 
found on our website
On behalf of the Board, I am pleased to present the 
inaugural Report of the newly combined Audit and Risk 
Committee for the year ended 31 December 2024. In 
2024, we streamlined the Board’s audit and risk oversight 
to support a more holistic view of the effectiveness of the 
Group’s risk and internal controls environment.
2024 key activities 
Risk
• Overseeing our approach to loan originations and 
agreeing to changes in credit strategy to enable 
fast and effective change in an increasingly volatile 
environment. Portfolios have been generally resilient 
and within target despite the challenging environment.
• Receiving regular updates and closely monitoring the 
external environment to look ahead at indicators of 
major change and assessing risk in relation to inflation 
and rising interest rates, and their impacts on SME 
credit standing. 
• Receiving updates on emerging risks and principal 
risks including strategic, funding and balance sheet, 
credit, operational, regulatory and reputational, and 
technology risks (including GenAI).
• Receiving updates and reviewing and approving the 
climate risk management framework.
• Applying scrutiny to information security and technology 
risk and receiving updates on their mitigation plans. 
• Reviewing risk assessments associated with new 
products in FlexiPay and Term Loans, including the 
launch of the Cashback credit card.
• Approving amendments to the Group risk appetite 
and Enterprise Risk Management Framework which 
included the elevation of technology risk as a principal 
risk (moving it from a level 1 risk under operational risk). 
2024 key activities 
Audit
• Reviewing the integrity of the half-year and full-year 
financial statements, ensuring they were fair, balanced 
and understandable, considering significant accounting 
judgements, estimates and disclosures, especially 
in relation to the sale of the US business, the impact 
of the macro economic environment and the Group’s 
ability to continue as a going concern, together with its 
viability disclosures. 
• Challenging, monitoring and evaluating the 
effectiveness of both financial and non-financial 
controls in the Group.
• Completing in-depth evaluations on the effectiveness 
of the Internal Audit team, external auditors and the 
Committee itself. 
• Reviewing and enhancing the Group’s whistleblowing 
processes to include a third party anonymous 
reporting line. 
• Appointing the new Director of Internal Audit.

Funding Circle Holdings plc | Annual Report and Accounts 2024
83
STRATEGIC REPORT
CORPORATE GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
2025 key priorities 
Risk
• Continue to review the Group’s key and emerging risks, 
especially technology and cyber risks, paying close 
attention to the macro environment and fraud risk.
• Greater focus on people and culture risk. 
• As the Group continues to embrace new products and 
increased automation, the Committee will monitor the 
associated risks, both prior to and post-implementation, 
as they scale as well as the execution risk as the 
business moves from a focus on one product to a 
number of different products.
• Continue to review the management of balance sheet 
exposures and the credit risk position in relation to our 
financial objectives under different outlook scenarios.
• Continue to review progress on the climate risk 
management framework. 
• Oversee GenAI initiatives from an internal controls and 
risk perspective. 
2025 key priorities 
Audit
• Continue to assess accounting judgements and estimates, 
particularly in relation to a provision for expected credit 
losses on FlexiPay lines of credit, the evolution and 
improvement of the Group’s credit provision models, 
and new product launches as they mature and grow 
in volume.
• Continue to review the Group’s internal financial 
controls and internal control systems to ensure they 
continue to develop in line with the Group’s business 
with a particular focus on the end-to-end processes 
and the ongoing development of the controls of new 
products and new features.
• Oversight of the implementation of the updated 2024 
Code for audit and risk requirements.
Committee composition, skills and experience
The membership of the Committee complies with 
provision 24 of the Code, requiring a minimum 
membership of two Independent Non-Executive 
Directors not including the Chair of the Board. 
All members of the Committee have relevant financial 
experience across banking and financial services, 
demonstrating competency relevant to the sector 
in which Funding Circle operates, including the 
Committee Chair who is a chartered accountant.
The Committee meets privately to discuss matters with 
the external and internal auditors, who regularly attend 
all meetings, without management present. 
Significant matters considered in relation to the financial statements
The Committee assessed the quality and appropriateness of, and adherence to, the Group’s accounting policies and 
principles. It reviewed whether the accounting estimates and judgements made by management were appropriate. 
The significant matters and accounting judgements considered by the Committee during the year are set out below.
Reporting issue
Committee action
Going concern and viability 
The period over which the Directors have 
determined the viability assessment is three years. 
Going concern is assessed annually based 
on detailed cash flow forecasts for the next 
15 months including a severe but plausible 
downside scenario. 
Inflationary pressures have eased but remained 
prominent during the year, with the impact of 
the UK government budget and increased global 
instability also weighing on SMEs. These factors 
have been considered in the above assessments. 
The Committee reviewed reports from management that set out 
its view on both the shorter-term going concern and longer-term 
viability of the Group. These included: 
• reviewing the Group’s principal risks as set out on pages 55 to 62;
• assessing and reviewing the adherence to the risk appetite 
set by the Committee to track the Group’s capital, liquidity and 
exposures of its funding products; 
• reviewing the Group’s short- and medium-term plan, cash, 
capital and liquidity; 
• reviewing the outcomes of stress testing after applying a severe 
but plausible scenario aligned to the principal risks; and
• reviewing the risk, going concern and viability disclosures for 
clarity on scenarios, uncertainties, sensitivities and management 
actions considering macro economic risks in particular. 
Having challenged and considered the outcomes of management’s 
assessment, the Committee recommended the Viability Statement 
to the Board for approval, concluded the Group remains a going 
concern and considered that related disclosures were sufficiently 
clear and transparent.

Reporting issue
Committee action
Report of the Audit and Risk Committee continued
Significant matters considered in relation to the financial statements continued
Funding Circle Holdings plc | Annual Report and Accounts 2024
84
STRATEGIC REPORT
CORPORATE GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
Sale of US business and disclosure as a 
discontinued operation 
The Group sold its US business on 1 July 2024 to 
iBusiness Funding, LLC for consideration of £32.6 
million. A gain on sale at the Group level of £9.8 
million along with £8.7 million reclassification 
of foreign currency translation reserve. At the 
Parent Company level a gain of £25.9 million, 
was recognised when the US business was 
deconsolidated.
The Committee received and reviewed reports and draft 
disclosures from management related to: 
• the proposed disclosure of the US business as a discontinued 
operation and re-presentation of the comparative statement 
of comprehensive income and related notes on this basis;
• the treatment of the US business as a disposal group at the 
half-year reporting at 30 June 2024, and presentation of the 
balance sheet and related notes on this basis; and
• the calculation and treatment of the gain on disposal inclusive 
of recycling of the foreign currency translation reserve. 
Having reviewed the disclosures and treatment the Committee 
concluded that the application was correct and the disclosure 
was clear and transparent in both the Group and standalone 
entity accounts.
Expected credit loss impairment of FlexiPay 
The Group holds FlexiPay lines of credit on its 
balance sheet. These lines of credit are held at 
amortised cost net of IFRS 9 expected credit 
loss impairment allowance. As the business has 
grown and the product features have developed, 
there is more historic data available and more 
complexity for use in estimating the allowance. 
The allowance is sensitive to assumptions related 
to the probability of default derived from macro 
economic assumptions.
The Committee received and reviewed the assumptions and 
methodologies used to determine the expected credit loss 
together with the level of sensitivity to those assumptions and 
considered whether these appropriately reflected risks in the 
portfolio and development of the product in the year. 
The Committee also considered the views of the external auditors 
on the methodology and the assumptions, including comparing 
the results to the external auditors’ independent estimation of 
the allowance. The Committee considered the disclosures within 
the Annual Report and after due challenge concluded that the 
valuations were reasonable and the disclosures were appropriate. 
Deferred tax recognition 
The UK business is forecast to be in a taxable 
profit position for the year ended 31 December 
2025, and consideration was given as to whether 
a deferred tax asset should be recognised as at 31 
December 2024. 
It was concluded that a deferred tax asset should 
not be recognised as there was not sufficient 
certainty regarding the probability of sustained 
future taxable profits and disclosure was made 
within the critical accounting judgements note. 
The Committee reviewed a paper from management which set 
out both positive and negative evidence related to the decision 
to recognise a deferred tax asset or not. The Committee: 
• considered the Group’s position in the context of ESMA 
guidance on whether there is sufficient compelling evidence 
to consider whether it is probable there will be future taxable 
profits; and 
• considered if not recognising a deferred tax asset now, what 
evidence would be considered compelling in future that might 
result in the recognition of a deferred tax asset at a later date. 
It was determined that the decision to not recognise a deferred tax 
asset at 31 December 2024 was sound, and that indicators that 
may lead to a different outcome in future may include the delivery 
of sustained taxable profit over a period of time and ongoing 
market expectation of taxable profits. 
The disclosure within the critical accounting judgements note 
was reviewed and considered to be clear and transparent. 
Exceptional items 
The Group has a defined accounting policy for the 
treatment and presentation of non-recurring and 
material items as exceptional. These exceptional 
items are also presented in a columnar fashion 
on the consolidated statement of comprehensive 
income in order to increase transparency and 
understanding for readers. 
The cost efficiency programme undertaken by 
the UK totalling £2.6 million, related impairment of 
intangible assets of £0.3 million and the gain on 
sale of the US business of £9.8 million have been 
disclosed as exceptional items.
The Committee received papers from management setting 
out the analysis of the exceptional items and the rationale for 
their inclusion. 
The Committee received the views of the external auditors on 
the items that management had included within these costs. 
It noted that the disclosure as exceptional was consistent with 
the Group’s accounting policy and with prior year presentations, 
and concluded that the amounts and this presentation were 
appropriate.

Reporting issue
Committee action
Funding Circle Holdings plc | Annual Report and Accounts 2024
85
STRATEGIC REPORT
CORPORATE GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
Fair, balanced and understandable reporting and 
alternative performance measures (“APMs”) 
The Board is required to report as to whether the 
contents of the 2024 Annual Report and Accounts, 
when taken as a whole, are fair, balanced and 
understandable. The Group uses APMs in its 
reporting of adjusted EBITDA for the Group. These 
measures are used to provide insight into the 
underlying performance of the business. They also 
provide a close approximation to cash generation 
which is key to the business. These measures are 
defined within the segmental information note on 
pages 144 and 193.
At the request of the Board, the Committee has assessed the 
information contained within the Annual Report. This assessment 
included discussions with management on the underlying 
financial processes, and confirmation from the management 
team of its review of the Annual Report being fair, balanced and 
understandable. The Committee also discussed the contents of 
the Annual Report with the external auditors. 
In addition, the Committee also considered the use of various 
APMs and other measures used by the Group and agreed that 
these supported the understanding of the financial performance of 
the Group and facilitated a better understanding of the business. 
The Committee was satisfied that there were sufficient disclosures 
of the same with the appropriate balance and reconciliation 
between these and statutory measures in the accounts. 
Having considered all of the available information including 
previously published information about the business and press 
releases through the year the Committee has concluded that, in its 
judgement, the 2024 Annual Report and Accounts, when taken as 
a whole, is fair, balanced and understandable.
Risk management and internal controls 
With effect from 1 January 2024, we combined the Audit 
Committee and the Risk & Compliance Committee into 
one Committee and reviewed the annual cycle of work 
to allow the Committee to carry out its role of monitoring 
and reviewing risk for the Group, including the nature 
and extent of principal and emerging risks against an 
uncertain macro environment. The Committee is also 
responsible for monitoring the Group’s compliance with 
the ERMF, which is detailed further on page 54 of the 
Strategic Report. 
In addition to formal meetings, the Committee also 
received regular reports and updates on overall credit 
performance. 
The Committee is responsible for supporting the 
Board in its robust assessment of the principal and 
emerging risks of the Group. The CRO reports at each 
risk meeting on the top of mind principal and emerging 
risks. In addition, ExCo members liaise swiftly with 
the ARC when identifying an emerging risk requiring 
immediate attention. The Committee considers these 
and other risks that may impact the Group’s strategy and 
operations and assesses its aggregated risk profile. For 
in-depth information on the Group’s approach to risk and 
identification of principal and emerging risks for 2024, 
please refer to the Strategic Report on pages 55 to 62. 
Review of effectiveness of internal controls and risk 
management systems 
During the year, to bring greater transparency to 
the assurance the Committee receives and to gain 
greater comfort over the Group’s management of risks, 
monitoring of internal controls and the accuracy of 
reporting, the Committee reviewed: 
• the Risk Taxonomy and the cartography of risk owners;
• an annual risk and controls assessment prepared by the 
enterprise risk management team;
• business line risk assessments directly from the MDs and 
the CTO to foster a strong culture of risk management and 
clear tone from the top across the first line;
• the assessment of the internal controls system, and 
monitoring of management actions arising from the 
assessment, and focus on residual risks requiring 
further mitigation;
• the audit plan and actions taken following audit 
recommendations;
• annually, the financial crime risk assessments, including 
fraud risk and AML/CTF risk;
• whistleblowing reports and confirmation of testing;
• specific risk mitigation actions in relation to information 
security risk and data risk;
• UK credit environment and adequacy of our approach 
to credit assessment in all its dimensions (credit 
validation, pricing, ongoing loan management); and
• the performance of all our credit portfolios including 
analysis of historical trends and forecast of expected 
future performance.
During the year, there was also an ad hoc deep dive 
on credit risk held between the Committee Chair and 
the business CRO and monthly communications were 
distributed by the CRO to the Committee about the most 
recent credit performance. 
Additionally, throughout the year, the Committee has 
monitored and reviewed the adequacy and effectiveness 
of the Group’s internal controls, by receiving, discussing, 
and challenging regular reports from management, 
internal audit and external audit on matters in relation to 
control effectiveness, monitoring and testing. 
Based on its activities, the Committee confirmed to the 
Board its assessment that the Group’s internal controls 
and risk management systems were sufficiently robust 
and operating effectively.

Report of the Audit and Risk Committee continued
Funding Circle Holdings plc | Annual Report and Accounts 2024
86
STRATEGIC REPORT
CORPORATE GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
External audit
Auditor independence
External auditors:
PwC
Length of tenure:
10 years (appointed in 2015)
Lead audit partner:
Heather Varley 
Lead audit partner tenure:
1 year
Total audit fees payable to 
auditors in the year:
 £925,615 
The Committee monitors the objectivity, independence 
and effectiveness of the external auditors. The Company 
is mindful of the provisions of the Code, best practice, 
the Competition and Market Authority Audit Order 2014 
and audit legislation in particular with regard to audit firm 
rotation and the provision of non-audit services.
The Committee operates a policy for the tender of 
external audit services. This policy provides that, in 
accordance with applicable law and regulation, the 
Company will re-tender the external audit at least every 
ten years since IPO and will change the external auditors 
at least every 20 years. PwC was first appointed in 2015 
so, in 2023, the Committee conducted a competitive 
tender of external audit services for FY 2024 and, 
following a rigorous process, PwC was successful.
The auditors’ partner was rotated during 2024 from 
Nick Morrison to Heather Varley. The Committee met 
with PwC during the year to assess the potential new 
audit engagement partner and the Committee endorsed 
Heather Varley as being a suitable replacement for Nick 
Morrison as new audit partner.
The Committee regularly reviews the objectivity and 
independence of the external auditors and has concluded 
this is safeguarded by: 
• obtaining assurances from the external auditors that 
adequate policies and procedures exist within their firm 
to ensure that the firm and employees are independent 
of the Group by reason of family, finance, employment, 
investment and business relationship (other than in the 
normal course of business); 
• enforcing a policy of reviewing all cases where it is 
proposed that a former employee of the external 
auditors be employed by the Group in a senior 
management position or at Board level;
• monitoring the external auditors’ compliance with 
applicable UK ethical guidance on the rotation of audit 
partners; and 
• approving non-audit services prior to being undertaken 
by the external auditors.
The engagement of the external audit firm to provide 
non-audit services to the Group can impact on the 
independence assessment and the Company has, 
therefore, adopted a policy which requires Committee 
approval for non-audit services. This policy is in line with 
the FRC’s Revised Ethical Standard 2019 and gives the 
Chair of the Committee delegated authority from the 
Committee to approve individual non-audit services items 
of up to £50,000 per service. 
All fees paid to PwC for non-audit services have been 
approved (in accordance with the non-audit services 
policy), with a summary of all non-audit services being 
provided at each Committee meeting.
External audit fees: Non-audit and audit-related 
services
Description
2024 
£000
2023 
£000
Interim review of half-year 
results announcement
141.7
137.7
CASS reporting
143.2
140.4
ISAE 3402 controls assurance
127.5
134.4
Other
1.4
1.4
Total
413.8
413.9
The Committee concluded that it was in the best interests 
of the Group to purchase these services from PwC on 
the basis that it was independent and was considered 
to be the right provider for the services required (or, in 
some cases, they were required to be performed by the 
external auditors). 
PwC are prohibited from providing certain non-
audit services to safeguard auditor objectivity and 
independence, including, but not limited to, internal audit 
work, valuations work and tax-related work. 
PwC has confirmed to the Committee that it remained 
independent during the year. 
Audit performance and effectiveness
The quality, performance and effectiveness of the 
external auditors is reviewed annually by the Committee 
through an effectiveness questionnaire distributed to 
management and Committee members for completion. 
This covers: the quality of robust challenge provided by 
the audit team; an evaluation of the knowledge and skills 
of the external audit team; the accessibility of the lead 
audit partner; independence and objectivity; openness, 
integrity and professionalism; the quality of reporting; 
the audit plan; communication between external auditors 
and the Committee; and the audit team’s robustness 
and constructive challenge during its engagement with 
management. In FY 2024, PwC continued to receive 
positive feedback.
The external auditors challenged management over the 
various scenarios that they had modelled, the level of 
stress testing in the models and the impact that this 
would have on the ability of the Group to continue as a 
going concern. There was also robust challenge around 
the methodology and assumptions utilised in the FlexiPay 
lines of credit expected credit loss impairment allowance, 
the fair value of loans on balance sheet and the 
assessment of indicators of impairment and consideration 
of impairment risk related to the Parent Company 
investment in subsidiaries.

Funding Circle Holdings plc | Annual Report and Accounts 2024
87
STRATEGIC REPORT
CORPORATE GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
Internal Audit
The Committee receives updates on the work of the 
Internal Audit team at each meeting, including a periodic 
assessment of the Group’s risk and control framework. 
The Committee considered, challenged, approved, 
and monitored the Internal Audit plan. Throughout 
the year, the plan was regularly assessed to ensure 
it remained focused on the Group’s key risks and 
priorities. All proposed audit plan adjustments were 
considered, challenged, and approved by the Committee. 
Areas assessed by the Internal Audit team during 
2024 included:
• technology strategy setup and outcomes;
• recoveries distribution in multiple defaulted loans;
• GGS readiness assessment;
• client money payment platform, operations 
and controls;
• FlexiPay billing and card transactions (report 
finalised in 2025);
• Marketplace conduct and lending partnerships (report 
finalised in 2025);
• enterprise data governance; and
• cyber security strategy and risk management approach.
Following business restructuring and internal promotion, 
Protim Banerjee was appointed as the new Director 
of Internal Audit with effect from 1 July 2024. This 
appointment was announced following a rigorous 
recruitment process with candidates which included 
several interviews with the Committee Chair and other 
members of the Committee and ExCo. 
The Internal Audit plan for 2025 was approved by the 
Committee in November 2024 and aligns to areas of 
highest inherent risk and strategic, operational and 
regulatory priority, including:
• FlexiPay – third party management and reliance on 
specific suppliers; 
• financial crime and underwriting approach across 
multiple products;
• FlexiPay – credit exposure monitoring and 
management;
• technology performance;
• FY 2025 new Term Loans products;
• marketing effectiveness (carry over from the FY 2024 
IA plan); and
• enterprise-wide product development methodology 
(carry over from the FY 2024 IA plan).
The team also continued to validate ongoing open 
issues e.g. business resilience, end user computing and 
collection, recoveries and litigation processes.
Internal Audit effectiveness review
An effectiveness review was conducted by the 
Committee to evaluate the performance of the Internal 
Audit team. The outcomes of the evaluation overall 
were good with high scores demonstrating that the 
Internal Audit team remained independent, objective 
and effective, with sufficient resources available to 
provide the necessary assurance across the Group. 
There were a small number of areas suggested for further 
enhancement that will be appropriately progressed 
during 2025.
Whistleblowing
The Company takes whistleblowing very seriously and 
wants all employees to feel able to raise concerns when 
they arise. This is emphasised in the Code of Conduct for 
all employees which is reviewed annually. The Committee 
reviewed the adequacy and security of the Group’s 
whistleblowing arrangements, which included regular 
whistleblowing updates, and it also provided reports to 
the Board where appropriate.
As part of the Committee’s commitment to ensuring 
the whistleblowing process and handling of potential 
incidents are of the highest standards, the Committee 
reviewed a recommendation by management to introduce 
a third party anonymous reporting option for employees 
under the Group’s Whistleblowing Policy. This additional 
line of reporting, together with the rest of the Group’s 
whistleblowing processes, was communicated to 
employees in both the Company’s news bulletin and at 
a bi-weekly All Hands meeting. There were no incidents 
reported in 2024.
Committee effectiveness
During the year, a review was undertaken of the 
effectiveness of the Audit and Risk Committee. Overall, 
the results of the evaluation were positive. Feedback 
on the first annual meeting cycle of the new combined 
Committee was positive and members generally felt that 
the oversight of the effectiveness of the Group’s risk and 
internal controls was more aligned and that a framework 
of prudent and effective controls was in place which 
enabled risk to be assessed and managed appropriately. 
The Committee agreed that its composition should be 
reviewed in 2025 considering the recent Board changes 
and that the agenda would have more focus on emerging 
and strategic risks.
Subsidiary audit and risk governance
The Group’s main operating subsidiary, Funding Circle 
Ltd (“FCL”), maintained its own Audit and Risk Committee 
during 2024, which was chaired by the Chair of the 
FCL Board, Matthew King, until his departure from the 
Board on 31 December 2024. With the changes in the 
business in 2024 and reflecting on the fact that the 
main regulated activity by FCL is now a closed product, 
the decision has been taken that FCL would no longer 
have a separate Audit and Risk Committee and that 
FCL matters relating to audit and risk would instead be 
covered by this Committee. The regulated FCL Board will 
continue to meet as a separate Board, with the Chair of the 
Funding Circle Holdings Board as a member, and with a 
newly agreed schedule of matters reserved for decisions 
including approval of the CASS audit and the FCL Annual 
Report and Accounts. 
Geeta Gopalan
Chair of the Audit and Risk Committee 
6 March 2025

Funding Circle Holdings plc | Annual Report and Accounts 2024
88
STRATEGIC REPORT
CORPORATE GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
Report of the ESG Committee
Andrew Learoyd
Chair of the ESG Committee
“
In 2024, the Company made 
good progress in delivering 
against its ESG objectives.”
Members and attendance
Member
Meetings
Attendance
Andrew Learoyd (Chair)
2/2
100%
Matthew King
2/2
100%
Neil Rimer
1/2
50%
Helen Beck
2/2
100%
The Committee’s role 
and key responsibilities 
are defined in its Terms 
of Reference which can 
be found on our website
On behalf of the Board, I am pleased to present 
the ESG Committee’s report for the year ended 
31 December 2024.
The Committee met twice this year, in accordance with 
its updated Terms of Reference. In addition to formal 
meetings, the Committee also received quarterly reports 
on progress of ESG activities. The Committee was 
pleased that the majority of the 2024 ESG framework 
goals were completed to its satisfaction, and is 
comfortable with the level of ambition set for 2025.
In 2024, the Company made good progress in delivering 
against its ESG objectives, taking into consideration 
changes in the business, including the sale of the US 
operations. We carried out benchmarking of our activities 
and reviewed our ambition statements for each of our key 
pillars – environmental, social impact, DEI and governance 
– to ensure they remain in line with our vision and broader 
sustainability developments. 
For more detailed information on the Group’s ESG 
activities and goals, and TCFD and Climate disclosures, 
please see the Environment, Social and Governance 
section of our Strategic Report from page 24 and the 
Climate and Environment section from page 28.

Diversity, equity and inclusion 
On DEI and social impact, the Committee continued to 
be impressed with the sustained level of engagement of 
the various employee “Circler groups”. This was brought 
to life in particular at the CircleIN event in October of 
last year, spotlighting the vibrant culture and values at 
Funding Circle. 
In 2024, we were pleased to see relatively stable 
engagement and continued strong inclusion and 
belonging results across our key DEI metrics. While we 
were disappointed to see a drop in our “recommend” 
score, we recognise it has been a significant year of 
organisational change for Circlers, who throughout have 
demonstrated their continued resilience and commitment 
to our business. In particular, we were delighted and 
proud to see Circlers recognised externally for their 
contributions to the DEI agenda. 
In 2025, we will report a higher gender pay gap ratio 
compared to our lowest ever reported in 2024. The 
Committee continues to focus on diversity at senior 
levels of the Company and continues to challenge senior 
management to identify where improvements can be 
made to demonstrate progress at these levels.
Social impact
The Company is a participant of the United Nations 
Global Compact, and in 2024 we published our Human 
Rights Statement as planned.
We were pleased to renew our partnerships with Hatch 
to support underserved social entrepreneurs, and with 
Thrive Mental Wellbeing to support the mental health 
of SME owners and their employees in the UK. It was 
encouraging to see sustained Circler volunteering, with 
171 impact days used in 2024 across a number of great 
social and environmental causes.
Climate and the environment
The Company successfully completed independent 
third party verification (ISO 14064-1) of its 2023 GHG 
emissions data for all activities under its operational 
control for the first time. During the year we evolved 
our interim net zero targets, reflecting a deepening of 
our transition planning efforts, as well as the sale of our 
US business.
We were pleased to renew our support for Earthwatch’s 
Tiny Forest UK-wide initiative, contributing to the 
wellbeing of ecologically deprived areas. 
We appreciate the potential challenges and opportunities 
that a transition to a lower-carbon future brings for the 
Company, its customers and other stakeholders. We 
continued to engage on these topics through industry 
forums and we look forward to continued progress, and 
understanding of our financed emissions data. 
Governance and risk management
The Committee is pleased with the progress made 
against our roadmap this year. We developed and 
approved our Climate Risk Management Framework, 
and our disclosures are consistent with the TCFD 
recommendations.
Matthew King continued his role as sponsor for climate-
related activities in 2024. Following his resignation 
from the Board, we will continue to consider ways of 
maintaining Board-level expertise on ESG topics. Helen 
Beck continued with her role as Workforce Engagement 
Non-Executive Director and engaged with Circlers across 
the Group during the year through an employee focus 
group. This provided an open forum to gain Circler insight 
on the Group’s culture, recent changes to the Group’s 
strategic direction and other issues of importance to 
Circlers, which Helen then fed back to the Board.
2024 Committee effectiveness review 
The Committee completed an internal effectiveness 
review for 2024. Overall, the results of the evaluation 
were positive. The questionnaire addressed the 
composition and set-up of the Committee, the frequency 
of meetings, the timeliness and quality of the papers, the 
work of the Committee and whether it receives enough 
information to feel confident about its oversight role.
Key activities in 2025
In 2025 we will continue to make progress against 
our DEI goals to support a diverse and inclusive 
organisational culture. We will focus on progressing our 
net zero targets, while investing in BVCM activities that 
contribute to environmental and societal benefits. As 
sustainability regulation evolves, we will work towards 
preparing for IFRS S1 and S2, and understanding how our 
efforts align to transition planning guidance. Our detailed 
goals and roadmap for 2025 are outlined in the ESG 
section on page 25. 
Andrew Learoyd
Chair of the ESG Committee 
6 March 2025
Funding Circle Holdings plc | Annual Report and Accounts 2024
89
STRATEGIC REPORT
CORPORATE GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

Directors’ remuneration report
Helen Beck
Chair of the 
Remuneration Committee
Members and attendance
Member
Meetings Attendance
Helen Beck (Chair)
6/6
100%
Andrew Learoyd
6/6
100%
Matthew King
6/6
100%
The Committee’s role and key 
responsibilities are defined in its 
Terms of Reference which can be 
found on our website
On behalf of the Board, I am pleased to present the 
Directors’ Remuneration Report for the year ended 
31 December 2024. 
2024 was a significant year for Funding Circle. Good 
progress was made against each of our strategic pillars 
as the business successfully exceeded our financial 
and strategic goals, with profit ahead of expectations 
for the year (see pages 44 to 50 for more information 
on business performance). The team demonstrated 
resilience and focus, executing on multiple strategic 
goals effectively, creating a simple UK-focused business 
to serve our customers. This was achieved during a 
year where Funding Circle completed the sale of the 
US business, recognising a £10 million gain on the sale.
Executive Director Remuneration for 2024
For the 2024 annual bonus, the weighting on financial 
targets was 70% (split equally between Group Revenue 
and Group PBT) and the remaining 30% was on strategic/
non-financial metrics. As described in more detail on 
pages 103 to 104, the outcome for Group Revenue was 
above target and for Group PBT (before exceptionals) 
was near the maximum. The Committee assessed the 
strategic/non-financial goals to have been exceeded. 
The overall outcome of the bonus assessment against 
the agreed targets was therefore 85.4% of maximum. 
The Committee considers this an appropriate reflection 
of the overall performance delivered for stakeholders, 
and no discretion was applied. 
The 2022 restricted share awards granted to Lisa Jacobs 
and Oliver White were a fixed number of shares (determined 
at the beginning of the Policy period, in 2021) and represented 
78% and 58% of salary respectively, a reduction of 
approximately 42% on the typical Policy levels (being 
133% of salary for the CEO and 100% of salary for the 
CFO). The Committee assessed performance over the 
vesting period and determined that the awards will vest 
in full on 24 March 2025. Further information is set out 
on page 105. 
During the year, the CEO and CFO were granted restricted 
share awards at the level of 115% and 85% of salary, 
respectively. As indicated in last year’s report, the Committee 
granted these awards below the respective Policy maxima 
(133% and 100% of salary) in consideration of business 
performance and share price at the time of award.
CFO transition
As announced in May 2024, Oliver White stood down 
from his role as CFO at the end of the year, following a 
successful transition period. The Committee determined 
that Oliver would be treated as a good leaver, and as 
such his unvested Restricted Share awards will be 
time-prorated and vest on their original vesting dates, 
subject to the relevant underpins. Oliver remained 
eligible for a 2024 bonus having been in office for the 
full financial year. The bonus outcome is as described 
above and will be paid fully in cash in line with our policy. 
He will not receive any other payments linked to his exit. 
Further information is set out on page 108. 
Tony Nicol, previously our Director of Finance and 
Investor Relations, succeeded Oliver White as Chief 
Financial Officer on 1 January 2025.
Remuneration Policy review
Following strategic decisions made in 2024 to focus 
on a simple, leaner, and profitable UK business the 
Committee determined it was appropriate to propose a 
new Remuneration Policy for approval at the 2025 AGM. 
The new Policy is designed to support our evolving 
business strategy and new medium-term plan, will place 
a strong emphasis on performance-related awards, and 
will be focused on delivering against our financial goals 
as a sustainable, profitable, growth business. To achieve 
this, a performance share plan (the “FC PSP”) will replace 
restricted shares, the current long-term incentive. Under 
the proposed Policy, around 70% of the CEO’s total 
remuneration will be performance-based (compared to 
around 20% under the current policy). We believe this 
creates greater alignment between Executive Directors 
and shareholders, and incentivises the ongoing creation 
of long-term value, building on progress made in 2024. 
We conducted a detailed consultation with our largest 
shareholders, covering over 80% of our issued share 
capital, and we were grateful for all of the feedback 
received which helped shape the final Policy design, 
including the approach to salary increases, selection 
of appropriate performance measures and overall 
Funding Circle Holdings plc | Annual Report and Accounts 2024
90
STRATEGIC REPORT
CORPORATE GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

remuneration structure. Under the new Policy, Executive 
Directors will remain eligible for an annual bonus, with 
maximum opportunities of 150% of salary for the CEO and 
100% of salary for the CFO. For the FC PSP, the maximum 
award size under the Policy will be 350% of salary, with 
typical awards being 350% and 250% of salary for the 
CEO and CFO respectively. The Committee considered 
the overall quantum for Executive Directors holistically, 
taking into consideration the stretching nature of our 
ambitious strategy, the need to retain and incentivise 
high calibre individuals, alongside relevant market data 
for companies of a similar size (those at the top of the 
FTSE SmallCap – see page 93 for more details). Executive 
Directors will only receive the maximum vesting outcomes 
under the FC PSP for achieving exceptional performance. 
The proposed Remuneration Policy is designed to provide 
Executive Directors with a total remuneration package 
which is market competitive but more heavily weighted 
towards being long-term, share-based and subject to 
stretching performance targets, which we believe reflects 
our culture and philosophy, and our desire to incentivise 
long-term sustainable growth. 
To ensure further alignment with shareholders the CEO 
shareholding guidelines will be increased to 250% of 
salary, for both in-post and post-exit purposes. For the 
annual bonus up to 40% of any bonus earned will be 
deferred into shares for three years. However, in line 
with developing market practice, this may be decreased 
by the Committee if the Executive Directors have met 
their shareholding requirement at the time of the bonus 
payment, subject to Committee retaining the capacity 
to exercise malus and clawback provisions. A level of 
deferral will always apply to Executive Director annual 
bonus outcomes (e.g. 20%).
No other changes to the Policy are proposed, which 
remains well aligned to key principles of best practice. 
The full Remuneration Policy, which is set out on pages 
94 to 100 of this report, will be submitted for shareholder 
approval at the 2025 AGM. 
Executive Director remuneration arrangements for 2025 
The Committee believes the CEO salary should be 
increased to £475k, to appropriately reflect the CEO’s 
skills, experience and value brought to the business, and 
the importance of ensuring a competitive salary. Such 
a salary level would remain low against companies of 
a similar size. However, as outlined above, through the 
incentive opportunities available under the new Policy, 
target total remuneration would be market competitive, 
but weighted towards the achievement of the stretching 
performance-based elements of the package. 
Following shareholder consultation, considerations on 
the wider Circler salary increase and our culture, as 
well as input from the CEO herself, this increase will be 
phased over two years. With effect from 1 March 2025, 
Lisa Jacobs will receive a salary increase to £450k, with 
a further increase to £475k from 1 March 2026. The CFO 
was appointed on 1 January 2025 on a salary of £350k, 
and will not receive a further increase this year.
The 2025 annual bonus will be based 70% on financial 
measures, which will continue to reflect revenue and 
profit goals, and 30% on key strategic/non-financial 
objectives. Bonus opportunities will be in line with the 
new Remuneration Policy as described above. In respect 
of the 2025 FC PCP, we intend to grant the CEO 350% of 
salary and the CFO 250% of salary, in line with the normal 
awards in the new Policy. Vesting of the award will be 
subject to an assessment of performance conditions, 
based 60% on relative Total Shareholder Returns (rTSR) 
against the FTSE 250 excluding Investment Trusts, 
and 40% on stretching Profit Before Tax (PBT) targets. 
The targets are disclosed on page 95. In line with good 
practice, and as requested by shareholders, for awards 
in future years, we will keep the measures under review, 
including reviewing whether other measures (e.g. return 
on tangible equity, RoTE), would be appropriate to 
include. As always, the Committee will consider overall 
performance in determining any vesting of awards 
(including share price appreciation).
Remuneration arrangements for Circlers
In a significant year for the business, I wish to thank all 
our Circlers for their dedication and commitment over 
the course of 2024. The Group annual bonus for 2024 
is being awarded at c.118% of target in aggregate, with 
payment being based on similar financial measures as the 
Executive Directors. 
In 2024, we continued our Share Incentive Plan, where 
for Circlers buying “Partnership” shares in Funding 
Circle they would receive two “Matching” shares for 
every “Partnership” share purchased. We also paid a 
bonus of up to £1,000 for junior Circlers in December 
and continued to keep pace with the “Real Living Wage” 
increasing the salary of any Circlers whose salary was 
below the threshold in 2024.
For 2025, the Executive Committee members will be 
included in the FC PSP and will be subject to the same 
performance measures, targets, and vesting periods as 
the Executive Directors. This ensures that the most senior 
Circlers are aligned on driving the performance of the 
business over the long term.
Conclusion
On behalf of the Remuneration Committee, I would like 
to thank the other Committee members and the Circlers 
who have supported the Committee this year. I would also 
like to thank our shareholders for their continued support, 
including those who engaged in our Remuneration Policy 
reviews during 2024 and 2025. We were delighted with 
the support received from shareholders at the 2024 
AGM and we hope to continue to receive your support 
at our 2025 AGM, where I will be available to respond to 
any questions on this report or in relation to any of the 
Committee’s activities.
Helen Beck 
Chair of the Remuneration Committee 
6 March 2025
Funding Circle Holdings plc | Annual Report and Accounts 2024
91
STRATEGIC REPORT
CORPORATE GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

Directors’ remuneration report continued
At a glance: Remuneration outcome for 2024
The charts below show the potential 2024 remuneration opportunity and actual achievement.
Lisa Jacobs, CEO
Oliver White, CFO
Minimum
On-target
Maximum
2024 actual
2023 actual
445
1,204
1,485
1,407
701
£0k
£250k
£500k
£750k
£1,000k £1,500k
Minimum
On-target
Maximum
2024 actual
2023 actual
443
1,011
1,221
1,164
844
£0k
£250k
£500k
£750k
£1,000k £1,500k
 Salary 
 Benefits 
 Pension 
 Bonus 
 Restricted shares
2024 annual bonus outturn
The chart below shows the outcome of the 2024 annual bonus. A summary of overall business performance is on 
pages 44 to 50. 
Performance measure
Weighting
Threshold 
0% payout
Target 
50% payout
Maximum 
100% payout
Outcome 
(% of maximum)
Group Revenue
35%
 
Actual £160.1m
67.4%
£131m
£152.6m
£174.1m
Group Profit 
Before Tax
35%
 
Actual £3.4m
91.0%
negative £9.7m 
negative £2.5m 
£4.7m
Strategic/non-financial 
(including FlexiPay)
30%
Performance of strategic/non-financial objectives exceeded 
expectations, and with significant strategic value delivered in 
2024. See pages 103 to 104 for further details.
100%
Outcome 
(% of salary)
Total (CEO)
85.4%
113.6%
Total (CFO)
85.4%
85.4%
Payments for 2024 cover a time period of 5 years
Element
Maximum opportunity 
for 2024
Awarded 
for 2024
2024
2025
2026
2027
2028
Salary
n/a
CEO: £424k Note 1 
CFO: £420k
Salary, 
benefits and 
pension paid 
in cash or 
contributions
Pension
5% of salary
5% of salary
Benefits
In line with 
other Circlers
In line with 
other Circlers
Annual bonus
CEO: 133% of salary 
CFO: 100% of salary
113.6% of salary
85.4% of salary
60% 
paid in cash
100% 
paid in cash
40% deferred into shares for 3 years
Restricted 
shares 
(granted 
16 May 2024)
CEO: 133% of salary 
CFO: 100% of salary
115% of salary 
85% of salary Note 2 
3-year vesting period (underpins tested 
following completion of vesting period)
Post-vesting holding period 
of 2 years
1. The CEO waived a proposed increase to £434k in 2024.
2. Oliver White’s 2024 restricted share award will be prorated for time in role.
Shareholding guidelines for Executive Directors as at 31 December 2024
700%
600%
500%
400%
300%
200%
100%
0%
Total
CEO (Lisa Jacobs)
CFO (Oliver White)
331.7%
198.8%
Guideline
Shareholding 
(% of salary)
 Unvested awards 
 Unvested awards (not subject to performance) 
 Vested but unexercised 
 Beneficially owned shares
Shareholding as a % of salary is based on the three-month average 
share price to 31 December 2024 of 133.3p. Unvested awards 
subject to performance conditions are not taken into account in 
the assessment of the shareholding until such time as they vest.
Funding Circle Holdings plc | Annual Report and Accounts 2024
92
STRATEGIC REPORT
CORPORATE GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

At a glance: Revised policy overview and implementation for 2025
Element of 
Remuneration Policy
Current Policy
Proposed changes in Policy and rationale
Implementation in 2025
Salary
• Reviewed annually in March.
• Salaries take account of the 
external market and the overall 
employee context.
• No prescribed maximum salary level 
or salary increases. 
Proposed changes: 
• No changes.
As of 1 March 2025, Executive 
Director salaries are as follows: 
• £450,000 for the CEO.
• £350,000 for the CFO on 
appointment on 1 January 2025.
Benefits & 
pension 
• Executive Directors receive the 
same benefits as other UK Circlers 
which currently include, but are not 
limited to, life assurance and private 
medical insurance.
• Maximum contribution is in line 
with contribution to other Circlers 
in the Group, which is currently 5% 
of salary. Individuals are entitled 
to receive some or all of their 
pension allowance as cash in lieu 
of pension contribution.
Benefits offered to Executive 
Directors will be in line with those 
available to other employees in 
the Group. 
Executive Directors will receive 
5% of salary in a combination of 
contributions into their pension and 
cash in lieu of pension contributions.
Annual bonus
• A maximum opportunity in respect 
of any financial year of: 
• CEO: 133% of salary.
• Other Executive Directors: 
100% of salary.
• 40% of any bonus earned will be 
deferred into Funding Circle shares 
and will cliff vest after 3 years.
Proposed changes: 
• Increased opportunity for the CEO to 
further increase performance-based 
variable pay.
• Up to 40% of any bonus earned 
will be deferred into Funding Circle 
shares which will cliff vest after 3 
years. The level is dependent on the 
shareholding of individual Executive 
Directors. A level of deferral will 
always apply (e.g. 20%).
Maximum opportunities of: 
• 150% of salary for the CEO.
• 100% of salary for the CFO.
70% of bonus based on financial 
measures, 30% strategic/
non-financial.
FC PSP 
(replacing the 
Restricted 
Shares awards)
n/a
Proposed changes: 
• Introduction of the FC PSP. Grants 
of up to 350% of salary, with typical 
award sizes of 350% of salary for the 
CEO and 250% for the CFO.
• Awards will vest after 3-years subject 
to the achievement of performance 
metrics. A post-vesting holding period 
of 2 years will apply.
Maximum opportunities of: 
• 350% of salary for the CEO.
• 250% of salary for the CFO.
Will vest 60% on Relative TSR and 
40% on PBT.
Market positioning: Executive Director Remuneration
The Committee reviewed the proposed total remuneration for the Executive Directors against other listed companies 
of a similar size. At the end of 2024, Funding Circle’s market capitalisation was positioned near the top of the FTSE 
SmallCap. The total remuneration package, which is less fixed, and more long-term, performance-linked, than companies 
of a similar size, is below the upper quartile of the top half of the FTSE SmallCap, however due to the higher leverage 
will provide above upper quartile pay for achieving exceptional performance (data was also referenced against the 
bottom of the FTSE 250 to ensure consistency). This weighting towards performance and the long-term aligns with 
the Company’s remuneration philosophy as well as our strategic direction.
 
CEO
CFO
Salary
Target total 
remuneration
Salary
Target total 
remuneration
FTSE 
SmallCap 
Top Half
Upper 
quartile
£583k
£1,711k
£402k
£1,054k
Median
£518k
£1,386k
£350k
£888k
Lower 
quartile
£484k
£1,193k
£320k
£778k
Funding 
Circle
Current 
(2024 
Policy)
£424k
£1,292k
£350k
£893k
Proposed
£450k
£1,599k
£984k
Alignment 
with Circlers
Fixed pay
Variable pay
Salary
Benefits
Pension
Annual 
bonus
Restricted 
shares
FC PSP
Executive 
Directors
Executive 
Committee
Senior 
management
Mid-level 
Circlers
Junior 
Circlers
Funding Circle Holdings plc | Annual Report and Accounts 2024
93
STRATEGIC REPORT
CORPORATE GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

Directors’ remuneration report continued
Remuneration Policy
The Remuneration Policy, as set out in this section, applies to the roles 
of Chair, Executive Director and Non-Executive Director. If approved by 
shareholders in a binding vote at the 2025 AGM, the Remuneration Policy 
will apply for a maximum of three years from the AGM.
The key changes to the Policy are the implementation of performance share plan and removal of restricted shares, 
alongside increased variable short and long term opportunities, to drive performance based outcomes for Executive 
Director reward. The other changes to the Policy include deferrals for short-term opportunities will now be subject 
to Committee assessment of current Executive Director shareholdings, and the CEO shareholding requirement is 
increased to 250% in-post and post-exit.
As part of the policy review, shareholders representing over 80% of issued share capital were consulted and helped 
shape final Policy design.
Executive Directors’ remuneration
Element of 
remuneration
Key features
Purpose and link to 
strategy
Maximum opportunity
Performance measures
Salary
Normally reviewed 
annually in March. 
Salaries take account of 
the external market and the 
overall employee context.
Supports the 
attraction and 
retention of the 
best talent.
No prescribed maximum salary 
level or salary increases. 
Account will be taken of increases 
applied to employees as a 
whole when determining salary 
increases. 
Committee retains the discretion 
to award higher increases where it 
considers it appropriate, such as, 
but not limited to: 
• where an Executive Director 
has had a change in scope or 
responsibility;
• an Executive Director’s 
development or performance 
in role (e.g. to align a newly 
appointed Executive Director’s 
salary with the market over 
time);
• where there is a significant 
change in the size and/or 
complexity of the Company; and
• where salary is considered to fall 
behind the market competitive 
range for similar roles.
n/a
Benefits
Executive Directors’ benefits 
currently include, but are not 
limited to, life assurance and 
private medical insurance. 
The Committee may 
determine that Executive 
Directors should receive 
additional benefits if 
appropriate, taking into 
account typical market 
practice and practice 
throughout the Group.
Market competitive 
(and cost effective) 
benefits provide 
reassurance and 
risk mitigation and 
support retention 
of talent.
The value of benefits is not capped 
as it is determined by the cost to 
the Company, which may vary. 
Benefits offered to Executive 
Directors are broadly in line with 
those available to other employees 
in the Group.
n/a
Pension
Executive Directors are 
entitled to receive employer 
contributions to the 
Funding Circle Ltd defined 
contribution pension plan. 
Individuals are entitled to 
receive some or all of their 
pension allowance as cash in 
lieu of pension contribution.
To provide 
retirement benefits 
for Executive 
Directors.
Maximum contribution in line with 
contribution to other employees in 
the Group, which is currently 5% 
of salary.
n/a
Funding Circle Holdings plc | Annual Report and Accounts 2024
94
STRATEGIC REPORT
CORPORATE GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

Element of 
remuneration
Key features
Purpose and link to 
strategy
Maximum opportunity
Performance measures
 
All-employee 
plans
Executive Directors are 
eligible to participate in 
HMRC tax-efficient plans that 
are available to all employees. 
Funding Circle currently 
operates a Share 
Incentive Plan.
To encourage 
share ownership 
and alignment with 
shareholders.
Participation levels are in line with 
HMRC limits. 
n/a
Annual bonus
Awards are based on 
performance (typically 
measured over a financial 
year) against key 
performance measures. 
Up to 40% of any bonus 
earned will normally be 
deferred into shares for three 
years. The level is dependent 
on the shareholding 
of individual Executive 
Directors. A level of deferral 
will always apply (e.g. 20%).  
The Executive Directors 
may, at the discretion of 
the Committee, receive 
dividend equivalents on the 
deferred shares. 
Malus and clawback 
provisions apply (see below).
To motivate 
and reward the 
achievement of 
the Group’s annual 
financial and 
strategic targets.
A maximum opportunity in respect 
of any financial year of:   
• CEO: 150% of salary.
• Other Executive Directors: 100% 
of salary.
Measures and targets will 
normally be set annually by the 
Committee and will be in line 
with Funding Circle’s strategy. 
A mix of both financial and non-
financial measures will typically 
be used, with at least 60% of 
the annual bonus normally 
based on financial measures. 
The target annual bonus is 
normally 50% of maximum 
opportunity. Typically, 0% 
will be payable for threshold 
performance. 
The Committee has discretion 
to amend the payout should 
any formulaic outcome not 
reflect the Committee’s 
assessment of overall business 
performance, the performance 
of the individual, or the 
experience of shareholders or 
other stakeholders over the 
performance period.
FC 
Performance 
Share Plan 
(PSP)
Executive Directors are 
granted FC PSP awards with 
a three-year performance 
and vesting period. 
Following the end of the 
vesting period, any vested 
awards will be subject to a 
two-year holding period. 
Awards may be granted in 
the form of conditional share 
awards or nil-cost options. 
The Executive Directors 
may, at the discretion of the 
Committee, receive dividend 
equivalents on vested shares. 
The awards are subject 
to malus and clawback 
provisions (see below).
Align Executive 
Directors with 
shareholders’ 
interests, and 
incentivises 
execution of Funding 
Circle’s long-
term strategy.
The maximum award level granted 
in respect of a financial year is 
350% of salary. 
Awards will typically be 350% 
of salary for the CEO and 250% 
of salary for other Executive 
Directors. 
Prior to each grant, the Committee 
will consider the size of grant to 
be awarded taking into account 
the share price at the time of grant 
as well as other factors such as 
appropriate market data.
The vesting of the FC PSP 
awards will be subject to 
performance conditions. 
Performance is measured over 
three years against measures 
set by the Committee for 
each award. 
The PSP is based on 
quantitative measures, with 
the majority normally based on 
financial measures, aligned to 
strategy and shareholder value. 
The performance measures for 
awards to be granted in 2025 
are as follows: 
• Relative total shareholder 
return (TSR) – 60% 
• Adjusted Profit Before Tax 
(PBT) – 40%
Different performance 
measures and/or weightings 
may be used for awards in 
future years. 
The level of vesting for 
threshold performance 
will be no higher than 25% 
of maximum. 
At the end of the three-year 
vesting period, the Committee, 
in its absolute discretion, will 
determine the overall vesting 
level of the award to ensure 
that outcomes accurately 
reflect the Committee’s 
assessment of overall business 
performance, the performance 
of the individual, performance 
against key strategic, 
governance or ESG metrics, or 
the experience of shareholders 
(e.g. share price appreciation) 
or other stakeholders over the 
vesting period.
Funding Circle Holdings plc | Annual Report and Accounts 2024
95
STRATEGIC REPORT
CORPORATE GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

Directors’ remuneration report continued
Element of 
remuneration
Key features
Purpose and link to 
strategy
Maximum opportunity
Performance measures
In-post 
shareholding 
requirement
Executive Directors are 
expected to build and 
maintain a holding of shares 
in the Company.
Supports our 
ownership mentality 
focus, promotes 
stewardship 
and helps align 
management with 
shareholders
Minimum shareholding 
requirement, to be satisfied 
within five years of appointment 
of no less than 250% of salary 
for the CEO and 200% of salary 
for other Executive Directors. If 
any Executive Director does not 
meet the requirement, subject to 
consideration by the Committee of 
the factors at the time, they will be 
expected to retain all of the net of 
tax number of shares vesting under 
any of the Company’s discretionary 
share incentive arrangements until 
the requirement is met.
n/a
Post-exit 
shareholding 
requirement
Executive Directors 
are expected to retain 
a proportion of their 
shareholding for a two year 
period after they have left 
Funding Circle.
To reinforce long-
term alignment of 
Executive Directors’ 
interests with those 
of shareholders 
post cessation of 
employment.
Minimum post-exit shareholding 
requirement of “guideline shares” 
equal to 250% of salary for the 
CEO and 200% of salary for other 
Executive Directors or the actual 
shareholding on departure, if 
lower. “Guideline shares” do not 
include shares which the Executive 
Director held at IPO, purchased 
in the market directly or acquired 
pursuant to the exercise of 
pre-IPO awards
n/a
Performance measures and targets selection
Performance measures
The measures used in the annual bonus plan will be selected annually to reflect the Group’s key financial and strategic 
objectives for the year. The FC PSP will be subject to performance measures that will be measured over three years. 
These measures will be selected annually to reflect the Group’s key long-term strategy and overall goals, and alignment 
with value creation for shareholders. Measures are kept under review and are subject to change in line with business 
strategy. 
Performance targets
In setting performance targets, the Committee considers a range of factors including internal and external forecasts, 
prior year performance, degree of stretch against the performance targets in the business plan, and market conditions. 
Targets are set to be stretching, yet achievable to ensure Executive Directors are motivated, with maximum targets set 
at a level reflecting exceptional performance.
Malus and clawback policy
Malus and clawback provisions apply to annual bonus awards, deferred bonus awards and FC PSP Share awards over 
the following time periods:
Malus
Clawback
Annual bonus
To such time as payment is made.
Up to two years following payment.
Deferred bonus awards
To such time as the award vests.
No clawback provisions apply (as malus provisions 
apply for three years from the grant date).
FC PSP
To such time as the award vests.
Up to two years following vesting.
Malus and clawback may apply in the following circumstances: 
• a material misstatement of the audited accounts of a member of the Group; 
• an error in assessing a performance measure or underpin, or an error in the information or assumptions on which 
awards were granted, vest or released; 
• a material failure of risk management in any member of the Group or a relevant Business Unit; 
• serious reputational damage to any member of the Group or a relevant Business Unit; or
• serious misconduct or material error on the part of the participant.
Remuneration Policy continued
Executive Directors’ remuneration continued
Funding Circle Holdings plc | Annual Report and Accounts 2024
96
STRATEGIC REPORT
CORPORATE GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

 
Discretions reserved in administering incentive awards
The Committee will administer the annual bonus, deferred bonus awards, FC PSP awards and Share Incentive Plan 
awards in accordance with the relevant plan rules and the above Remuneration Policy table. The Committee retains 
certain discretions, consistent with market practice, in relation to the administration of the awards including:
• the determination of performance measures, underpins and targets and resultant vesting and pay-out levels;
• the ability to amend or substitute a performance measure or target if one or more events occur which cause the 
Committee to reasonably consider that an amended or substituted performance measure or target would be more 
appropriate and would not be materially less difficult to satisfy than originally intended;
• the determination of the treatment of individuals who leave employment, based on the relevant plan rules, and the 
treatment of the awards on exceptional events, such as a change of control of the Company; and
• the ability to make adjustments to deferred bonus awards, Restricted Share awards, Share Incentive Plan awards and 
FC PSP awards in certain circumstances (e.g. rights issues or corporate restructurings).
Illustrations of the application of the Remuneration Policy in 2025
CEO (Lisa Jacobs)
Minimum
474
1,599
2,724
3,511
£4,000k
£3,500k
£3,000k
£2,500k
£2,000k
£1,500k
£1,000k
£500
0
Target
Maximum
Maximum + 
50% share 
price increase
100%
30%
21%
49%
17%
25%
58%
14%
19%
67%
 Fixed 
 Annual Bonus 
 FC PSP Total
CFO (Tony Nicol)
Minimum
371
984
1,596
2,034
£4,000k
£3,500k
£3,000k
£2,500k
£2,000k
£1,500k
£1,000k
£500
0
Target
Maximum
Maximum + 
50% share 
price increase
100%
38%
18%
44%
23%
22%
55%
18%
17%
65%
Illustration assumptions
Element of pay
Minimum
Target
Maximum
Maximum + 50% share 
price appreciation
Fixed remuneration: 
• Base salary – effective as at 1 March 2025 
• Benefits – in line with the value of 2024 benefits disclosed in the single figure table (which includes the previous 
CFO’s value for the new CFO)
• Pension – 5% of salary
Annual bonus
No payout
50% of maximum 
(target payout)
Maximum payout
FC PSP
No vesting
Assumes threshold 
performance with 25% 
of the award vesting. 
Assumes 100% of 
award vests.
Maximum value vesting 
multiplied by 1.5 times.
Legacy arrangements
The Committee reserves the right to make any remuneration payments and payments for loss of office (including exercising 
any discretions available to it in connection with such payments) notwithstanding that they are not in line with the Policy set out 
above where the terms of the payment were agreed (i) before the 2025 Policy came into effect provided that the terms of the 
payment were consistent with any shareholder-approved Directors’ Remuneration Policy in force at the time they were agreed 
or (ii) at a time when the relevant individual was not a Director of the Company or other person to whom this policy applies and, 
in the opinion of the Committee, the payment was not in consideration for the individual becoming a Director of the Company 
or other such person. For these purposes “payments” includes the Committee satisfying awards of variable remuneration and, 
in relation to an award over shares, the terms of the payment are “agreed” at the time the award is granted. 
The Committee reserves the right to make minor amendments to the Policy, for regulatory, exchange control, tax or 
administrative purposes or to take account of a change in legislation, without seeking shareholder approval.
Funding Circle Holdings plc | Annual Report and Accounts 2024
97
STRATEGIC REPORT
CORPORATE GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

Directors’ remuneration report continued
Remuneration Policy continued
Executive Directors’ service contracts
The Executive Directors’ service contracts are on a rolling basis and are terminable by either the Company or the 
individual on 12 months’ notice for the CEO and six months’ notice for the CFO. Notice periods for Executive Directors 
will not exceed 12 months from either party.
Date of service agreement
Lisa Jacobs, CEO
1 January 2022
Tony Nicol, CFO
1 January 2025
Payments for loss of office
The principles on which the determination of payments for loss of office will be approached are set out below.
Policy
Payment in 
lieu of notice
The Committee has discretion to make a payment in lieu of notice based on salary for the unexpired period of notice. The 
Company may make such payment in monthly instalments, and it may be subject to mitigation. 
Annual bonus
This will be at the discretion of the Committee on an individual basis and the decision as to whether or not to pay a 
bonus in full or in part will be dependent on a number of factors, including the circumstances of the Executive Director’s 
departure and their contribution to the business during the performance period in question. 
Any bonus earned will normally be pro-rated for time in service during the performance period and will, subject to 
performance, be paid at the usual time (although the Committee retains discretion to pay the bonus earlier in appropriate 
circumstances) and in the normal manner. Any bonus earned for the year of departure and, if relevant, for the prior year 
may be paid wholly in cash at the discretion of the Committee.
Deferred 
bonus award
The extent to which any unvested awards will vest will be determined in accordance with the Deferred Bonus Plan rules. 
If an Executive Director leaves for any reason (other than being dismissed for cause) during the deferral period 
then unvested awards will continue and vest at the normal vesting date. In exceptional circumstances (including if a 
participant dies), the Committee may decide that the Executive Director’s unvested award will vest and be released early 
at the date of cessation of employment, in which case the Committee has discretion to apply time pro rating in limited 
circumstances.
FC PSP
The extent to which any unvested awards will vest will be determined in accordance with the share plan rules. 
Unvested awards will normally lapse on cessation of employment. However, unless a participant is dismissed for cause, 
the Committee has discretion to determine that the unvested awards will continue and remain capable of vesting at the 
normal vesting date, subject to the performance measures being met. To the extent that the awards vest, a two-year 
holding period would then normally apply. In exceptional circumstances (including if a participant dies), the Committee 
may decide that the Executive Director’s awards will vest and be released early at the date of cessation of employment or 
at some other time (e.g. at the vesting date). 
In either case, vesting will depend on the extent to which the performance conditions have been satisfied and will be 
subject to a pro rata reduction for time served during the vesting period (although the Committee has discretion to 
disapply time pro rating if the circumstances warrant it). 
Change 
of control
Deferred bonus awards and FC PSP will vest early in the event of a takeover, merger or other relevant corporate event. 
Deferred bonus awards will typically vest in full. 
As regards FC PSP awards, vesting will depend on the extent to which the performance conditions have been satisfied, 
with the Committee taking into account relevant factors at the time, and will be subject to a pro rata reduction for time 
served during the vesting period (although the Committee has discretion to disapply time pro rating if the circumstances 
warrant it).
Alternatively, the Committee may permit deferred bonus awards and FC PSP awards to be exchanged for equivalent 
awards of shares in a different company (including the acquiring company).
Other 
payments
Executive Directors will be entitled to payment for accrued holiday. 
Awards under the Share Incentive Plan may be released in the event of cessation of employment or change of control in 
accordance with the plan rules. 
The Committee reserves the right to make any other payments in connection with a Directors’ cessation of office or 
employment where such payments are made in good faith in discharge of an existing legal obligation (or by way of 
damages for breach of such an obligation) or by way of settlement or compromise of any claim arising in connection 
with the termination of a Director’s office or employment. Any such payments may include but are not limited to paying 
any fees for outplacement assistance and for the Directors’ legal and/or professional advice fees in connection with his 
cessation of office or employment. Incidental expenses may also be payable where appropriate.
Recruitment policy
The Company’s recruitment remuneration policy aims to give the Committee sufficient flexibility to secure the 
appointment of high calibre executives to strengthen the management team and secure the skill sets necessary 
to deliver the Group’s strategic aims. 
When hiring a new Executive Director, the Committee will typically align the remuneration package with the Remuneration 
Policy as set out above. The Committee may include other elements of pay which it considers appropriate, however, this 
discretion is capped and is subject to the principles and the limits referred to below. The key terms and rationale for any 
such element would be disclosed in the Directors’ Remuneration Report for the relevant year.
Funding Circle Holdings plc | Annual Report and Accounts 2024
98
STRATEGIC REPORT
CORPORATE GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

Policy
Salary
Salary will be set at a level appropriate to the role and the experience of the Executive Director being appointed. 
This may include a provision for future increases up to a market rate, in line with increased experience and 
responsibilities, subject to good performance, where it is considered appropriate.
Buy-out awards
It may be necessary to make additional awards in connection with the recruitment to buy-out remuneration terms 
forfeited by the individual on leaving a previous employer if it considers the cost can be justified and it is in the 
best interests of the Company. Buy-out awards are not subject to a formal cap. The Committee will seek to make 
buy-outs subject to what are, in its opinion, comparable requirements in terms of service and performance. 
Where considered appropriate, buy-out awards will be liable to forfeiture or recovery provisions on early departure.
Maximum level 
of variable 
remuneration
The maximum level of variable remuneration which may be granted (excluding buy-out awards) will be 150% of 
salary for the annual bonus and 350% of salary for FC PSP awards, in line with the limits in the Policy Table above. 
Other elements of 
remuneration
Other elements may be included in the following circumstances: 
• An interim appointment being made to fill an Executive Director role on a short-term basis.
• If exceptional circumstances require that the Chair or a Non-Executive Director takes on an executive function on 
a short-term basis.
• If an Executive Director is recruited at a time in the year when it would be inappropriate to provide an annual 
bonus or Restricted Share award for that year, subject to the limit on variable remuneration set out above, the 
quantum in respect of the period employed during the year may be transferred to the subsequent year.
• If the Executive Director is required to relocate, reasonable relocation, travel and subsistence payments may be 
provided (either via one-off or ongoing payments or benefits).
For an internal appointment, any legacy arrangements will either continue on their original terms or be adjusted to 
reflect the new appointment, as appropriate.
Any share awards referred to in this section will be granted as far as possible under the Company’s existing share 
plans. If necessary, and subject to the variable remuneration limits referred to above, awards may be granted outside 
of these plans as permitted under the Listing Rules which allow for the grant of awards to facilitate, in unusual 
circumstances, the recruitment of an Executive Director.
Fees payable to a newly appointed Chair or Non-Executive Director will be in line with the fee policy in place at the time 
of appointment.
Policy on external appointments
Executive Directors may hold external directorships and retain any fees for such directorships if the Board determines 
that such appointments do not cause any conflict of interest. 
Non-Executive Directors’ remuneration
Key features
Purpose and link to strategy
The fees paid to the Chair are determined by the Remuneration Committee. The 
fees for the Non-Executive Directors are determined by the Board as a whole. 
The Chair and the Non-Executive Directors are paid annual fees and do not 
participate in any of the Company’s incentive arrangements or receive any 
pension provision or other benefits. 
Additional fees are payable for additional Board duties, including acting as Senior 
Independent Director and for chairing Committees. Additional fees may be paid 
in the exceptional event that Non-Executive Directors are required to commit 
substantial additional time above that normally expected for the role. 
The Chair and/or Non-Executive Directors may receive part of their fee(s) in 
company shares. 
The Non-Executive Directors are not entitled to any compensation on termination 
of their appointment. 
The Non-Executive Directors are entitled to reimbursement of reasonable 
expenses (including any associated tax liabilities). 
Overall fees paid to the Chair and Non-Executive Directors will remain within the 
limits set by the Company’s Articles of Association.
Fees are set at a level to reflect 
the amount of time and level of 
involvement required in order to 
carry out their duties as members 
of the Board and its Committees 
and to attract and retain Non-
Executive Directors of the highest 
calibre with relevant commercial 
and other experience.
Funding Circle Holdings plc | Annual Report and Accounts 2024
99
STRATEGIC REPORT
CORPORATE GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

Directors’ remuneration report continued
Remuneration Policy continued
Non-Executive Directors’ remuneration continued
As an early-stage private company, which did not pay Directors’ fees, the Company historically granted options to 
certain Non-Executive Directors under the Company’s pre-IPO share option plan. Although the options granted will 
continue to be held by those Non-Executive Directors going forward, no further options have or will be granted to 
Non-Executive Directors post-IPO under any of the Company’s share option plans. The options held by the relevant 
Non-Executive Directors are all vested.
Remuneration Policy for Circlers
The Committee receives regular updates on overall pay and conditions in the Group, and pay and employment 
conditions generally in the Group are taken into account when setting Executive Directors’ remuneration.
The approach to annual salary reviews is consistent across the Group, with consideration given to the level of 
experience, responsibility, individual performance and salary levels in comparable companies.
All Circlers are eligible for either the Group annual bonus plan or another bonus arrangement. Opportunities vary by 
organisational level and function. From inception, a key element of the remuneration philosophy has been to support 
share ownership across the business. This has historically been achieved through making equity incentives available 
to Circlers to encourage them to behave as owners – taking decisions that balance long-term value creation with 
achieving shorter-term strategic priorities. The remuneration policy for Circlers is reviewed annually to ensure it’s 
aligned with our strategy, valued by Circlers, and provides value for money.
The key elements to the incentive arrangements are:  
• The Executive Committee members currently participate in a restricted share plan which is similar in nature to 
the plan that the Executive Directors are currently eligible for. If the proposed Remuneration Policy is approved at 
the 2025 AGM, the Executive Committee members will participate in the FC PSP, to ensure an increased focus on 
performance and alignment with Executive Directors. The same performance conditions will apply to the Executive 
Committee as the Executive Directors and will be measured over three years and vest after three years.
• Other senior management and senior specialist roles participate in a restricted share plan with grant size increasing 
with seniority. Equity awarded to these Circlers is subject to continued employment for the two years following the 
grant date but is not otherwise normally subject to performance conditions.
• The leadership team, managers and specialists participate in a Group annual bonus plan which has similar financial 
measures as the Executive Directors’ annual bonus.
• All Circlers, including Executive Directors, are eligible to participate in our Share Incentive Plan where, for every 
“Partnership share” that is purchased, two “Matching shares” are awarded.
• Junior Circlers are eligible to receive a cash bonus each year, the size of which depends on their length of service 
and affordability.
Our workforce engagement Director, Helen Beck, frequently holds workforce engagement sessions with Circlers. While 
Circlers were not directly consulted in the development of the Directors’ Remuneration Policy, a range of topics are 
discussed in workforce engagement sessions including those of remuneration, reward and recognition.
Alignment between Executive and Circlers’ remuneration
The Executive Directors’ Policy was designed to align Circler and Executive pay. The main differences between how 
Executive Directors and Circlers are remunerated are the participation in the FC PSP, longer time periods (vesting, 
holding and deferral) and tougher performance criteria. The annual performance measures that apply to senior 
management and specialist roles are the same as those used by Executive Directors.
Funding Circle Holdings plc | Annual Report and Accounts 2024
100
STRATEGIC REPORT
CORPORATE GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

Annual report on remuneration
This part of the report sets out how the current Remuneration Policy 
has been applied in 2024 and how the Committee intends to apply the 
proposed Remuneration Policy in 2025. This part of the report will be 
subject to an advisory shareholder vote at the 2025 AGM. 
Role of the Committee
The Committee’s primary role is to determine the remuneration of the Directors and Executive Committee, and the 
Remuneration Policy for the Executive Directors, as well as monitoring and reviewing its ongoing appropriateness 
and relevance. In doing so, the Committee ensures that the Remuneration Policy is aligned with the Company’s key 
remuneration principles as well as taking into account external guidance, such as the UK Corporate Governance Code. 
For information regarding the Committee’s role and key responsibilities, please see the Terms of Reference on our 
website at corporate.fundingcircle.com/who-we-are/corporate-governance/board-committees.
Committee composition
None of the members who have served on the Committee during the year had any personal interest in the matters 
decided by the Committee and they are all considered to be independent by the Company. The Company Secretary 
acted as Secretary to the Committee.
Committee members
Number of meetings attended
Helen Beck, Chair
6/6
Andrew Learoyd
6/6
Matthew King
6/6
The Executive Directors, Chief People Officer, other members of the senior management team and our external 
remuneration consultants, Alvarez & Marsal, were invited to Committee meetings where it was deemed appropriate. 
No individuals were involved in decisions relating to their own remuneration. 
2024 Committee workstreams
• determined the payout of the Executive Directors’ 2023 annual bonus;
• approved the payout of the 2023 annual bonus for Circlers;
• approved the design of the 2024 annual bonus for Circlers and the equity plans;
• set the 2024 annual bonus targets for Executive Directors;
• set the 2024 Restricted Share Plan underpins and approved the grants for Executive Directors; 
• reviewed other variable pay plans in the Group;
• approved reward decisions relating to members of the Executive Committee and reviewed Circler compensation; and
• conducted a comprehensive review of the Remuneration Policy, which included consultation with our shareholders, 
in preparation for its renewal at the 2025 AGM.
2025 Committee priorities
• approve the remuneration arrangements for the Executive Committee, including their equity grants and 2024 
bonus outcomes;
• approve the design of the 2025 annual bonus for Circlers and the equity plans, and review other non-Group incentives;
• set the 2025 annual bonus targets, ensuring they align with Funding Circle’s strategy as well as its ESG priorities;
• set the 2025 FC PSP performance conditions and approve the grants for Executive Directors; and
• continue to monitor remuneration practices across the Company as a whole, keeping abreast of current and evolving 
market practice.
Funding Circle Holdings plc | Annual Report and Accounts 2024
101
STRATEGIC REPORT
CORPORATE GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

Committee effectiveness
The Committee undertook an effectiveness review at the end of 2024, whereby each Committee member and, by 
invitation, the Chief People Officer, Company Secretary, and the Head of Reward completed a tailored questionnaire. 
The questionnaire covered topics such as the quality of the remuneration support provided to the Committee and the 
appropriateness of the remuneration policies and practices implemented in 2024. The positive scores and comments 
demonstrated that the Committee is working well.
External advisers
The Committee is satisfied that the advice it has received from its appointed adviser Alvarez & Marsal as remuneration 
consultants is independent, and that the engagement partner and team that have provided remuneration advice do 
not have connections with the Company that might impair their independence. Alvarez & Marsal was appointed by 
the Committee in 2023 following a competitive tender process. Alvarez & Marsal is a member of the Remuneration 
Consultants Group and, as such, voluntarily operates under its Code of Conduct in relation to executive remuneration 
matters in the UK.
The fee paid to Alvarez & Marsal in 2024 in relation to advice provided to the Committee was £51,900 (excluding VAT), 
which was based on time spent. Alvarez & Marsal provide no other services to the Group. 
Letters of appointment and service contracts
Director
Commencement date 
of current term
Expiry of 
current term
Notice period
From Company
From Director
Executive Directors
Lisa Jacobs
1 January 2022
n/a
Twelve months
Twelve months
Tony Nicol
1 January 2025
n/a
Six months
Six months
Non-Executive Directors
Andrew Learoyd
10 September 2024
30 June 2025
One month
One month
Ken Stannard
1 January 2025
1 January 2028
One month
One month
Geeta Gopalan
18 September 2024
18 September 2027
One month
One month
Hendrik Nelis
5 September 2024
5 September 2027
One month
One month
Neil Rimer
5 September 2024
5 September 2027
One month
One month
Helen Beck
3 July 2024
3 July 2027
One month
One month
The Executive Directors’ service contracts are on a rolling basis. All Non-Executive Directors have letters of 
appointment with the Company. The appointments of each of the Non-Executive Directors are for an initial term 
of three years, and have been extended for those Non-Executive Directors whose original term has since expired. 
The appointment of each Non-Executive Director is subject to annual re-election at the AGM.
Shareholder voting
The Committee’s resolutions in respect of the Remuneration Policy and Annual Report on Remuneration at the 2024 
AGM received the following votes from shareholders:
Number of votes
Remuneration Policy 
(2024 AGM)
Annual Report on Remuneration 
(2024 AGM)
Votes cast in favour
262,845,251
98.7%
265,526,769
99.7%
Votes cast against
3,377,814
1.3%
696,296
0.3%
Votes withheld
42,130
0.0%
42,130
0.0%
Total votes cast (including withheld)
266,265,195
100.0%
266,265,195
100.0%
Annual report on remuneration continued
Funding Circle Holdings plc | Annual Report and Accounts 2024
102
STRATEGIC REPORT
CORPORATE GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

Single total figure of remuneration (audited)
The following tables set out the aggregate emoluments earned by the Directors in the year ended 31 December 2024 
and 2023 respectively.
 
Salary 
and fees 
£000
Taxable 
benefits Note 1 
£000
Pensions  Note 2 
£000
Bonus 
£000
Long-term 
incentives 
£000
Total 
£000
Total 
fixed 
£000
Total 
variable 
£000
2024
Executive Directors
Lisa Jacobs
423
5
21
480
478 Note 3
1,407
449
958
Oliver White
419
7
21
358
359 Note 3
1,164
447
717
Non-Executive Directors
Andrew Learoyd
207
—
—
—
—
207
207
—
Eric Daniels4
21
—
—
—
—
21
21
—
Geeta Gopalan
80
—
—
—
—
80
80
—
Helen Beck
70
—
—
—
—
70
70
—
Matthew King
70
—
—
—
—
70
70
—
Samir Desai CBE5
45
—
—
—
—
45
45
—
Hendrik Nelis6
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
Neil Rimer6
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
2023
Executive Directors
Lisa Jacobs
412
1
20
268
—
701
433
268
Oliver White
408
4
20
200
212 Note 7
844
432
412
Non-Executive Directors
Andrew Learoyd
207
—
—
—
—
207
207
—
Eric Daniels
70
—
—
—
—
70
70
—
Geeta Gopalan
80
—
—
—
—
80
80
—
Helen Beck
70
—
—
—
—
70
70
—
Matthew King
70
—
—
—
—
70
70
—
Samir Desai CBE
55
—
—
—
—
55
55
—
Hendrik Nelis6
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
Neil Rimer6
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
Note 1.  Taxable benefits for Executive Directors principally include private medical cover and life assurance cover and awards made under the Share Incentive Plans 
(including matching shares). Taxable benefits for Non-Executive Directors relate to reimbursement of travel to the workplace. The Company ensures that the 
Non-Executive Directors are kept whole by settling the expense and any related tax. The figures shown include the cost of the taxable benefit plus the related 
tax charge.
2. Executive Directors were eligible for a 5% of base salary pension contribution, £10,000 was paid into each of Lisa Jacobs and Oliver White’s company pension 
with the remainder paid as cash in lieu.
Note 3.  Shows the value of the vesting of the 2022 Restricted Share award based on a 3-month average share price to 31 December 2024 of 133.3p. This award was 
granted on 24 March 2022 was based on a fixed number of shares and was worth 78% of salary for the CEO and 58% of salary for the CFO using a 3-month 
average share price of 86.6p at date of grant. The fixed number of shares meant that the value of the award was far less than the initial policy maximums of 133% 
of salary for the CEO and 100% of salary for the CFO. The proportion of the vested value which is attributable to share price growth is therefore 35.1% of the 
value, or £167k for the CEO and £126k for the CFO. The Remuneration Committee did not exercise discretion in respect of this share price appreciation.
4. Eric Daniels stepped down from the FCH Board on 15 May 2024.
5. Samir Desai CBE stepped down from the FCH Board on 25 October 2024.
6. Hendrik Nelis and Neil Rimer, who are non-independent Non-Executive Directors, have waived their entitlement to a fee.
Note 7.  Shows the value of the 2021 Restricted Share award that vested on 19 May 2024 at a share price of 78.8p. This award was granted on 19 May 2021 based on 
a share price of 148.5p. The proportion of the vested value which is attributable to share price growth is therefore zero. The Remuneration Committee did 
not exercise discretion in respect of this share price depreciation. The 2021 Restricted Share award value disclosed in the 2023 Remuneration Report was an 
estimate based on an average three-month share price to 31 December 2023 of 37.5p.
2024 annual bonus (audited)
The maximum opportunities for 2024 were 133% of salary for the CEO and 100% of salary for the CFO. As announced 
in last year’s Directors’ Remuneration Report, the weighting of the financial measures would be at least 60% of 
the annual bonus measures and the strategic/non-financial measures at most 40%. The Remuneration Committee 
determined that the weighting on financial measures would be 70%, split equally between Group Revenue and Group 
Profit Before Tax (pre-exceptionals). The remaining 30% on strategic/non-financial was based on delivering key 2024 
strategic, stewardship, and sustainability objectives. The measures were set by the Committee and were in line with 
Funding Circle’s strategy. Stretching financial targets were set by the Committee at the start of the year, taking into 
consideration a number of factors including our 2024 guidance. For the financial measures, an on-target bonus could 
be earned for achieving 2024 guidance performance. 
Funding Circle Holdings plc | Annual Report and Accounts 2024
103
STRATEGIC REPORT
CORPORATE GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

Annual report on remuneration continued
2024 annual bonus (audited) continued
Structure of the 2024 bonus
Element (weighting %)
Threshold 
(0% payout)
Target 
(50% payout)
Maximum 
(100% payout)
Outcome
Implied payout 
of element
CEO
CFO
Financial 
measures (70%)
Group revenue (35%)
£131m
£152.6m
£174.1m
£160.1m
67.4%
Group profit before tax (35%) 
(pre-exceptionals)
negative £9.7m 
negative £2.5m 
£4.7m
£3.4m
91.0%
Strategic/non-financial (30%)
See below
100%
Total (% of maximum)
85.4%
Total (% of salary)
113.6%
85.4%
Final outcome (£k)
480
358
In this overall performance context, the outcome of the bonus assessment against the agreed targets was 85.4% 
of maximum. The Committee considers this an appropriate reflection of the overall performance delivered for 
stakeholders, and therefore no discretion was applied. In line with our Remuneration Policy, 40% of Lisa Jacobs’ bonus 
payout will be deferred into shares for three years (subject to continued employment) and Oliver White’s bonus will be 
paid in cash. 
Strategic/non-financial measures
In 2024 we removed personal performance from the Executive Directors’ strategic/non-financial measures as the 
Committee believes that their personal performance is reflected in the overall Company performance.
Category
Details on objectives and performance
Strategy 
Delivery of key 
2024 strategic 
objectives 
#1 in new products: FlexiPay: 
• More than  3 times growth in FlexiPay line of credit compared to 2023.
• Built the infrastructure and capability for a credit card product, launching a Cashback credit card in the 
second half of the year.
• Over 18k FlexiPay cards issued, and c.12k active accounts. 
US disposal:  
• Successful divestment of US business at a gain of £10 million and transfer of all US Circlers to the 
acquiring party.
Journey to ongoing Group profitability: increased efficiency, cost management, and productivity 
improvements: 
• Successful streamlining of the business to deliver £15 million annualised savings into 2025, including a 
reduction in headcount (approximately 120).
• > 3 times share price and >£400 million market cap.
Stewardship & 
Sustainability 
Delivering 
business goals in 
the right way
Risk & Controls appetite maintained within agreed thresholds: 
• Our credit portfolios demonstrated resilience in the face of a deteriorating market, showcasing the 
strength of our underwriting and risk management practices.
• Continued to strengthen risk management framework and improve our credit models.
Building culture and increasing engagement: 
• Engagement maintained, scoring 64% (v.66% in 2023). This is considered a positive outcome in light of 
significant business change in 2024. This included a reduction in the number of UK Circlers through a 
redundancy programme, and change to the hybrid working policy (increasing office attendance to at 
least 3 days per week). 
• Voluntary attrition levels remained low throughout the year at around 18%.
Committed and sustained focus on our ESG agenda and goals: 
• In 2024, the Company made good progress in delivering against its ESG objectives, taking into 
consideration changes in the business, including the sale of the US operations. 
• Carried out benchmarking of our activities and reviewed our ambition statements for each of our key 
pillars – Environmental, Social Impact, DEI and Governance – to ensure they remain in line with our 
vision and broader sustainability developments.
The Remuneration Committee determined that as performance against strategic/non-financial objectives exceeded 
expectations, and with significant strategic value delivered in 2024, that 100% of the strategic/non-financial element 
should pay out. This has been a year of considerable progress for Funding Circle.
Funding Circle Holdings plc | Annual Report and Accounts 2024
104
STRATEGIC REPORT
CORPORATE GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

 
Restricted shares awarded in 2022 vesting in respect of 2024 (audited)
The 2022 restricted share awards granted to Lisa Jacobs and Oliver White were based on a number of shares which 
was fixed at the beginning of the 2021 Remuneration Policy. Awards of 358,177 and 269,306 shares were made to the 
CEO and CFO on 24 March 2022. This represented 78% and 58% of salary respectively, a reduction of approximately 
42% on the Policy levels at that time (being 133% of salary for the CEO and 100% of salary for the CFO). 
The restricted share awards were subject to a number of underpins (as opposed to performance conditions). The 
financial underpin was based on achieving average Total Income for the Group of £181.3 million over the three-year 
period to 31 December 2024. Following the sale of the US business, it was no longer feasible to assess performance 
against this underpin in a way which was fair and consistent with the basis of the original calibration. Further, as the 
US business was highly capital intensive and required significant capital allocation from the wider Group to achieve 
its goals, the Committee determined that a restatement of the underpin was not appropriate nor feasible given the 
different investment assumptions that would need to be applied for the wider Group. In this context, the Committee has 
considered the underpin based on a broader assessment of overall performance during the period. In this assessment, 
the Committee considered a number of key aspects of financial and strategic performance, including: 
• profitability being achieved ahead of expectations in 2024 and over the three-year period; 
• the successful sale and transition of the US business to the acquiring party; 
• successful launch of a new UK-focused multi-product strategy, including a short-term credit SME proposition in 
FlexiPay; and 
• market acknowledgement and significant change to share price and market capitalisation, having approximately 
doubled over the period. 
In addition to the financial underpin there were also qualitative underpins to ensure that Executive Directors are not 
rewarded where the Committee considers there to have been a failure in performance, including serious breach 
of regulation, material reputational damage and gross misconduct. The Committee determined that the qualitative 
underpins were achieved.
In determining the final vesting, the Committee also took into consideration the size of the awards, which were reduced 
significantly from the Policy level at the time of grant due to the fixed number of shares approach, as described above. 
In this context, the Committee determined that awards will vest in full on 24 March 2025. There is a further 2-year post-
vesting holding period that will apply until 24 March 2027.
Restricted Share awards granted during 2024 (audited) 
Restricted Share awards were granted to the Executive Directors on 30 March 2024 under our Policy. Details of the 
awards are set out below:
Face value at grant  Note 1 
Type of award
Number of shares
£
% of salary
Grant date
Vesting date
Holding period
Lisa Jacobs
Nil-cost option
1,006,191
488,003
115%
16 May 2024
16 May 2027
16 May 2027 
to 16 May 2029
Oliver White
Nil-cost option
736,521
357,213
85%
16 May 2024
16 May 2027
16 May 2027 
to 16 May 2029
Note 1.  In line with Funding Circle’s established approach, based on a three-month average share price to the grant date of 48.5p and salaries of £424,350 for Lisa 
Jacobs and £420,250 for Oliver White.
We disclosed in the 2023 Directors’ Report on Remuneration that the Committee intended to grant awards at a level 
below the Policy maximum of 133% and 100% of salary, for the CEO and CFO respectively in 2024. This was to reflect 
investor expectations around safeguarding against the potential for “windfall gains” in scenarios where long-term share 
awards are granted following a period of share price decline. In May 2024 we granted awards at the level of 115% and 
85% of salary for the CEO and CFO respectively. These awards are subject to an assessment of financial and non-
financial underpins.
Funding Circle Holdings plc | Annual Report and Accounts 2024
105
STRATEGIC REPORT
CORPORATE GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

Annual report on remuneration continued
Restricted Share awards granted during 2024 (audited) continued
Restricted share awards are subject to discretionary underpins that guide the Remuneration Committee when 
determining whether any discretion needs to be applied to reduce, including to nil, the final vesting of the restricted 
shares. The underpins are both financial as well as non-financial, and are as follows:
• For the financial underpins the Remuneration Committee will assess whether there is a material weakness in 
the underlying financial health or sustainability of the business. Factors such as, but not limited to, share price, 
Originations, Net Income, profitability, and cash generation would be considered, in the context of the Board’s 
expectations and the market environment.
• For the non-financial underpins the Remuneration Committee will assess ESG performance, delivery against strategic 
objectives, and personal performance over the vesting period.
• To ensure that Executive Directors are not rewarded where the Committee considers there to have been a failure in 
performance, including serious breaches of regulation, material reputational damage or gross misconduct further 
reductions will be made. 
• Prior to vesting, the Committee retains the flexibility to assess any element of performance it deems appropriate in 
order to determine whether a discretionary adjustment is requirement.
Any vested awards will remain subject to a two-year post-vesting holding period.
Directors’ shareholding and share interests (audited)
Table of Directors’ share interests as at 31 December 2024 Note 1 
Beneficially 
owned shares  Note 2 
Vested but 
unexercised 
awards
Unvested 
awards 
(not subject to 
performance 
conditions)
Unvested 
awards 
(subject to 
performance 
conditions)
Total
Total that count 
towards 
shareholding 
guidelines 
(including 
unexercised 
awards 
net of tax)
Executive Directors
Lisa Jacobs
414,658
736,142
473,496
1,722,545
3,346,841
1,055,766
Oliver White
179,441
340,543
502,787
1,275,133
2,297,904
626,406
Non-Executive Directors
Andrew Learoyd
1,789,991
—
—
—
1,789,991
n/a
Samir Desai CBE
8,388,206
2,150,000
192,570
—
10,730,776
n/a
Eric Daniels
—
—
—
—
—
n/a
Geeta Gopalan
33,216
—
—
—
33,216
n/a
Helen Beck
9,235
—
—
—
9,235
n/a
Matthew King
15,400
—
—
—
15,400
n/a
Hendrik Nelis
—
—
—
—
—
n/a
Neil Rimer
—
—
—
—
—
n/a
1. Samir Desai CBE stepped down from the Board on 25 October 2024. Share interests are listed as of this date. 
2. Includes shares owned by connected persons.
Note: Between the year end and the date of this Annual Report and Accounts, there has been no movement in current Directors’ Shareholdings from that 
shown above.
The Company’s share ownership requirements are that Executive Directors shall (subject to personal circumstances) 
build and maintain a shareholding equivalent to at least 200% of salary over five years from their appointment 
(increasing to 250% of salary for the CEO in 2025). At the end of the 2024 financial year, the CEO (who was appointed 
to the Board on 1 January 2022), held 1,055,766 shares, equal to 332% of salary (which includes unexercised awards on 
a net of tax basis) based on the three-month average share price to 31 December 2024 of 133.3p. The CFO (who was 
appointed to the Board on 15 June 2020), held 626,406 shares, equal to 199% of salary (which includes unexercised 
awards on a net of tax basis) based on the three month average share price to 31 December 2024 of 133.3p. Unvested 
awards subject to performance conditions are not taken into account in the assessment of the shareholding until such 
time as they vest.
Funding Circle Holdings plc | Annual Report and Accounts 2024
106
STRATEGIC REPORT
CORPORATE GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

Table of Directors’ vested and unvested share awards (audited) 
Award type Note 1 
Date of grant
No. of 
awards at 
1 January 
2024
Awards 
granted 
in the year 
Awards 
lapsed 
in the year
Awards 
vested 
in the year
Awards 
exercised 
in the year
No. of 
awards at 
31 December 
2024
Date of 
vesting/end of 
performance 
period
Exercise 
price 
Market 
price 
on 
exercise
Executive Directors
Lisa Jacobs
2018 LTIP
29/11/2019
250,000
—
—
—
—
250,000
11/03/2020
£0.00
n/a
18/03/2020
162,500
—
—
—
—
162,500
12/03/2022
£0.00
n/a
26/03/2021
173,642
—
—
—
—
173,642 26/03/2023
£0.00
n/a
Restricted 
Shares
24/03/2022
358,177
—
—
—
—
358,177 24/03/2025
£0.00
n/a
30/03/2023
358,177
—
—
—
—
358,177 30/03/2026
£0.00
n/a
16/5/2024
— 1,006,191
—
—
—
1,006,191
16/5/2027
£0.00
n/a
2021 Deferred 
bonus plan2
30/3/2023
166,110
—
—
—
—
166,110
30/3/2026
£0.00
n/a
26/3/2024
—
303,106
—
—
—
303,106
26/3/2027
£0.00
n/a
Share 
Incentive Plan
03/11/2020
4,646
—
—
—
—
4,646
15/04/2022
£0.00
n/a
05/05/2021
2,341
—
—
—
—
2,341 05/05/2023
£0.00
n/a
20/04/2022
4,814
—
—
4,814
—
4,814 20/04/2024
£0.00
n/a
16/06/2022
3,005
—
—
3,005
—
3,005
16/06/2024
£0.00
n/a
17/6/2024
—
4,370
—
—
—
4,370
17/6/2026
£0.00
n/a
Unapproved
09/05/2018
150,000
—
—
—
—
150,000
01/03/2022
£0.44
n/a
Oliver White
Share 
Incentive Plan
03/11/2020
4,991
—
—
—
—
4,991
15/04/2022
£0.00
n/a
18/01/2021
3,967
—
—
—
—
3,967
18/01/2023
£0.00
n/a
20/04/2022
4,814
—
—
4,814
—
4,814 20/04/2024
£0.00
n/a
16/06/2022
3,005
—
—
3,005
—
3,005
16/06/2024
£0.00
n/a
17/6/2024
—
4,372
—
—
—
4,372
17/6/2026
£0.00
n/a
2020 bonus 
buyout
26/03/2021
71,237
—
—
—
—
71,237 26/03/2022
£0.00
n/a
Restricted 
Shares
19/05/2021
269,306
—
— 269,306
—
269,306
19/05/2024
£0.00
n/a
24/03/2022
269,306
—
—
—
—
269,306 24/03/2025
£0.00
n/a
30/03/2023
269,306
—
—
—
—
269,306
30/3/2026
£0.00
n/a
16/5/2024
—
736,521
736,521
16/5/2027
£0.00
n/a
2021 Deferred 
bonus plan Note 2 
21/04/2022
147,533
—
—
—
—
147,533
21/04/2025
£0.00
n/a
30/03/2023
124,895
—
—
—
—
124,895 30/03/2026
£0.00
n/a
26/3/2024
—
225,987
—
—
—
225,987
26/03/2027
£0.00
n/a
Non-Executive Directors
Andrew Learoyd
Unapproved
18/6/2015
100,000
—
—
—
100,000
—
18/06/2015
£0.31
£0.41
Samir Desai CBE
Unapproved
13/06/2018 2,150,000
—
—
—
— 2,150,000
01/06/2020
£0.00
n/a
2021 Deferred 
bonus plan
21/04/2022
192,570
—
—
—
—
192,570
21/04/2025
£0.00
n/a
Eric Daniels
Unapproved 
09/09/2016
187,500
—
—
—
187,500
—
01/03/2016
£0.39
£1.25
Note 1.  Other than in certain circumstances as set out in the Remuneration Policy on page 98 (e.g. on termination of employment or change of control), vested 
unapproved options can be exercised during a period of ten years from the date of grant.
2.  2023 bonus deferrals: 40% of Lisa Jacobs’ bonus (£107.2k) was deferred into nil cost options for three years on 26 March 2024, using a 3-month average share  
price of 35.36p. 40% of Oliver White’s bonus (£79.9k) was deferred into nil cost options for three years on 26 March 2024, using a 3-month average share price 
of 35.36p.
Funding Circle Holdings plc | Annual Report and Accounts 2024
107
STRATEGIC REPORT
CORPORATE GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

Annual report on remuneration continued
Payments for loss of office (audited)
After nearly 5 years, Oliver White stood down from his role as CFO on 31 Dec 2024, following a successful transition 
period. The Committee took into account Oliver’s commitment and significant contribution to the business over the 
course of 2024, including the successful sale of the US business, and a reorganisation of the UK business, alongside 
the delivery of the key strategic objectives of the business. Oliver will be treated as a good leaver and his unvested 
Restricted Share awards will be time-prorated and vest on their original vesting dates, subject to the relevant 
underpins. Any unvested deferred bonus share awards will vest in full on their original vesting date. Any unvested 
matching shares granted under our all-employee Share Incentive Plan lapsed in full, in line with the plan rules. Oliver 
remained eligible for a 2024 bonus having been in office for the full financial year. The bonus outcome is as described 
above and it will be paid fully in cash in line with our policy. He will not receive any other payments linked to his exit.
Payments to former Directors (audited)
There were no payments made to former Directors during the year.
Performance graph
The chart below illustrates the Company’s TSR performance compared with that of the FTSE AllShare Index. This index 
has been chosen as the Company is a constituent and it is considered the most appropriate benchmark against which 
to assess the relative performance of the Company. The chart shows the value of £100 invested in Funding Circle at 
the IPO offer price of £4.40 per share on 28 September 2018 compared with the value of £100 invested in the FTSE 
AllShare Index on that date to the end of each subsequent financial year. 
0
20
40
60
80
100
120
31 Dec 2018
31 Dec 2019
31 Dec 2020
Funding Circle plc
FTSE AllShare Index
31 Dec 2021
31 Dec 2022
31 Dec 2023
 
CEO remuneration table
The table below sets out the CEO’s single figure of total remuneration.
£000
2017
2018
2019
2020
2021
2022
2023
2024
CEO
Samir 
Desai CBE
Samir 
Desai CBE 
Samir 
Desai CBE
Samir 
Desai CBE
Samir 
Desai CBE
Lisa 
Jacobs
Lisa 
Jacobs
Lisa 
Jacobs
CEO total remuneration1
204
4,081
211
201
629
661
701
1,407
Annual bonus payout (% maximum)2
n/a
n/a
n/a
n/a
78.4%
45.0%
48.9%
85.4%
Long-term incentives (% maximum)3
n/a
n/a
n/a
n/a
n/a
n/a
n/a
100%
Note 1.  The 2018 figure includes share options that were granted prior to IPO which were subject to continued employment only. In 2021 Samir Desai waived his salary 
increase from £210,000 to £400,000.
2. Samir Desai CBE did not participate in any bonus from 2016 to 2020.
Note 3.  Samir Desai CBE did not participate in any long-term incentive. Lisa Jacobs’ first long-term incentive opportunity as CEO was the Restricted Share award made 
in March 2022 with the first vesting in March 2025.
Relative importance of spend on pay
The table below sets out our relative importance of spend on pay. There have been no dividends paid to date.
Net Income and Profit Before Tax (PBT) have been presented as these are two key performance measures used by the 
Directors in assessing Funding Circle’s performance.
2024
2023
% Change
Net income
£160.1m
£130.1m
23.1%
Profit before tax
£3.4m
(£9.9m)
(134.3%)
People costs
£68.1m
£65.5m
4.0%
Average number of employees
721
756
(4.6%)
Funding Circle Holdings plc | Annual Report and Accounts 2024
108
STRATEGIC REPORT
CORPORATE GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

Percentage change in Directors’ remuneration compared with employees 
The table below sets out the annual percentage change in remuneration from 2019 to 2024 for each individual who was 
a Director during 2024, compared to that for an average employee. Data for former Directors during this timeframe can 
be found in the relevant Directors’ Remuneration Reports spanning their tenure.
Salary/fees1
Benefits
Annual bonus
2023 
to 
2024
2022 
to 
2023
2021 
to 
2022
2020 
to 
2021
2019 
to 
2020
2023 
to 
2024
2022 
to 
2023
2021 
to 
2022
2020 
to 
2021
2019 
to 
2020
2023 
to 
2024
2022 
to 
2023
2021 
to 
2022
2020 
to 
2021
2019 
to 2020
Executive Directors
Lisa Jacobs2
+2.7% +2.9%
n/a
n/a
n/a
+3.4%
+2.7%
n/a
n/a
n/a
+79.3% +12.0%
n/a
n/a
n/a
Samir Desai CBE 
(CEO)
n/a
n/a
n/a
+5%
minus 5% 
n/a
n/a
n/a 33.6% 3
0%
n/a
n/a
n/a
n/a
n/a
Oliver White4
+2.5%
+2.1%
—
—
n/a
+2.1%
+1.7%
minus 22% +8.4%
n/a
+79.0%
+11.1% minus 43.7%
n/a
n/a
Non-Executive Directors
Andrew Learoyd
+0% +0.6%
+2.9%
+5% -100%
minus 100% 
n/a
n/a
n/a
n/a
n/a
n/a
n/a
n/a
n/a
Samir Desai CBE 
(NED)
minus 17.7%
—
n/a
n/a
n/a
— 
—
n/a
n/a
n/a
n/a
n/a
n/a
n/a
n/a
Eric Daniels
70.5%
+1.2%
+6.4%
+5%
minus 5% 
minus 82.1% minus 91.9% 
+21%
n/a minus 100%
n/a
n/a
n/a
n/a
n/a
Geeta Gopalan
—
+1.1%
+11%
+15%
minus 5%
—
n/a
n/a
n/a
n/a
n/a
n/a
n/a
n/a
n/a
Helen Beck5
—
+1.2%
+6.4%
n/a
n/a
—
n/a
n/a
n/a
n/a
n/a
n/a
n/a
n/a
n/a
Matthew King6
— +3.7% +39.3%
n/a
n/a
—
n/a
n/a
n/a
n/a
n/a
n/a
n/a
n/a
n/a
Hendrik Nelis7
n/a
n/a
n/a
n/a
n/a
—
n/a
n/a
n/a
n/a
n/a
n/a
n/a
n/a
n/a
Neil Rimer7
n/a
n/a
n/a
n/a
n/a
—
n/a
n/a
n/a
n/a
n/a
n/a
n/a
n/a
n/a
Average employee8
+0.9% +3.4%
8.7% minus 13.3%
minus 1.7%
minus 17.3%
+7.3% minus 4.0% +8.7%
+1.8%
minus 9.1%
7.0%
+3.3% +17.1% +61.2%
Note 1.  The Board and the Executive Committee (then Global Leadership Team) voluntarily reduced their salaries and fees by 20% over the period March to May 2020 in 
response to the Covid-19 pandemic. This is the reason for the change in salaries and fees from 2019 to 2021 shown above. No Director received a salary or fee 
increase during 2020 or 2021. Samir Desai CBE, as CEO, waived his salary increase for 2021.
2. Lisa Jacobs was appointed to the Board on 1 January 2022.
3. Samir Desai’s CBE benefits did not include a pension contribution or cash in lieu which he waived his right to.
4. Oliver White was appointed to the Board on 15 June 2020.
Note 5.  Helen Beck was appointed to the Board on 1 June 2021. For the comparison of 2021 to 2022, Helen’s 2021 fee has been annualised to permit meaningful 
comparison. The increase reported in the table above reflects the increase in 2022 in the additional fee payable for chairing the Remuneration Committee.
Note 6.  Matthew King was appointed to the Board on 19 May 2021. For the comparison of 2021 to 2022, Matthew’s 2021 fee has been annualised to permit meaningful 
comparison. The increase reported in the table above reflects the introduction of an additional fee payable for chairing the Board of Funding Circle Ltd.
7. Hendrik Nelis and Neil Rimer, who are non-independent Non-Executive Directors, have waived their entitlement to a fee.
8. The annual percentage change of the average remuneration of the Company’s employees, calculated on a full-time equivalent basis.
CEO pay ratio
Funding Circle is committed to remunerating its employees fairly and competitively. We calculate our CEO pay ratio 
using the prescribed Methodology A, as shown in the table below. Methodology A was selected as this is considered 
the most accurate approach and is generally the preferred approach by shareholders and proxy agencies.
Year
Method
25th percentile pay ratio
Median pay ratio
75th percentile pay ratio
2024
Option A
34.9
21.9
13.6
2023
Option A
18.1
11.8
7.4
2022
Option A
17.6
11.3
7.0
2021
Option A
18.4
11.6
6.9
2020
Option A
5.8
3.8
2.3
2019
Option A
6.8
3.9
2.5
There has been an increase in the CEO pay ratio for 2024 due to Lisa’s bonus paying out higher in 2024 than in 2023 
as well as her first vesting of the 2022 Restricted Share award. The Board has confirmed that the median ratio is 
consistent with the Company’s wider policies on employee pay, reward and progression.
Funding Circle Holdings plc | Annual Report and Accounts 2024
109
STRATEGIC REPORT
CORPORATE GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

Annual report on remuneration continued
CEO pay ratio continued 
Total pay and benefits used to calculate the ratios
The table below sets out the UK employee percentile pay and benefits used to determine the above pay ratios and the 
salary component for each figure.
2024
25th percentile
Median
75th percentile
Salary component
£33,843
£50,159
£83,187
Total pay and benefits
£40,218
£64,183
£103,191
The CEO remuneration is the total single figure remuneration for the relevant years and 2023 and 2024 are disclosed 
on page 103. The employee total remuneration has been calculated based on the amount paid or receivable for the 
relevant years. The calculations for the UK employees were performed as at the final day of the relevant financial year.
Implementation of the Remuneration Policy for the year ended 31 December 2025
Salary
The Committee believes the CEO salary should be increased to £475k. Following shareholder consultations, 
considerations on the wider Circler salary increase and our culture, as well as input from the CEO herself, this increase 
will be phased over two years. In 2025 the Committee will increase Lisa Jacob’s salary to £450k, which represents 
an increase of 6.0% on her current salary, and 4.5% on the proposed 2024 base salary which she decided to waive. 
This new salary is still low relative to the market, however when combined with variable pay opportunities positions 
the total remuneration package at a competitive level, but more heavily weighted towards the performance-related 
elements. The Committee intends to increase her salary by a further 5.6% on 1 March 2026 to £475,000. Tony Nicol 
was appointed CFO on 1 January 2025 on a salary of £350,000. The salary budget for other Circlers in 2025 is 3.5%.
1 March 
2024
1 March 
2025
% change
Lisa Jacobs
£424,350
£450,000
6.0%
Tony Nicol
n/a
£350,000
n/a
Annual bonus
The maximum opportunity for the CEO is 150% of salary and for the CFO is 100% of salary. In line with 2024, we will 
base the annual bonus 70% on financial measures, which will continue to be 35% on revenue and 35% on profit, and 
30% on strategic/non-financial measures.
Up to 40% of any bonus earned will be deferred into shares for three years. The deferral applied by the Committee 
will reflect whether the Executive Directors have met their shareholding requirement at the time of the bonus payment, 
provided that the Committee still has sufficient ability to exercise malus and clawback provisions. A level of deferral 
will always apply (e.g. 20%). The Board considers the actual targets for 2025 to be commercially sensitive at this time, 
however, we will provide retrospective disclosure of these targets in next year’s report.
FC PSP
In line with the typical opportunities as set out in the proposed Policy, the CEO award will be 350% of salary and the 
CFO award will be 250% of salary. The 2024 awards will be granted following shareholder approval of the new Policy at 
the AGM in May. The Committee retains discretion to ensure the actual grant, which will be disclosed when awards are 
granted and in next year’s report, reflects the latest available information prior to grant. 
The vesting of the FC PSP awards will be subject to performance measures. These measures will be relative Total 
Shareholder Returns (rTSR) which will be weighted 60% and Adjusted Profit before Tax (PBT) which will be weighted 
40%. The Total Shareholder Returns will be measured against the FTSE 250 excluding Investment Trusts, which reflects 
our ambition to enter, and progress through, the FTSE 250. The Adjusted PBT targets for 2027 have been set to reflect 
the Board’s ambitions for growth as the business delivers on the strategy. The target range represents an appropriate 
level of stretch, with maximum vesting requiring significant outperformance. The threshold and maximum performance 
targets are summarised below:
Measure
Threshold (25% vesting)
Maximum (100% vesting)
rTSR vs. the FTSE 250 excluding Investment Trusts
Median TSR ranking
Upper quartile TSR ranking
Adjusted PBT in 2027
£20 million
£60 million
There will be straight-line vesting in between threshold and maximum performance. As always, the Committee will 
consider overall performance in determining any vesting of awards (including share price appreciation).
Any vested awards will remain subject to a two-year post-vesting holding period.
Funding Circle Holdings plc | Annual Report and Accounts 2024
110
STRATEGIC REPORT
CORPORATE GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

Benefits and pension contributions
In line with our Policy, the benefits offered to Executive Directors are in line with those available to other employees in 
the Group. The Executive Directors, and all UK Circlers, are eligible to receive a pension contribution and/or cash in lieu 
of 5% of salary. 
Non-Executive Director and Chair fees
Fee
2024
2025
Chair fee
£207,000
£220,000 Note 1
Non-Executive Director base fee2
£55,000
£60,000
Senior Independent Director fee
£10,000
£10,000
Remuneration Committee Chair fee
£15,000
£15,000
Combined Audit and Risk Committee Chair fee3
£15,000
£25,000
ESG Committee (or any similar committee appointed by the Board)
n/a
£5,000
Not e 1. Ken Stannard will receive a prorated fee of £220,000 following his appointment as Funding Circle Chair if approved at the 2025 AGM. Up until that date 
Ken Stannard will receive a prorated Non-Executive Director base fee. Andrew Learoyd continues to receive £207,000 until he steps down at the 2025 AGM.
Note 2.  The Non-Executive Director base fee will be increased to £60,000 in 2025. This is the first increase to base fees since IPO in 2018. Hendrik Nelis and Neil Rimer, 
who are non-independent Non-Executive Directors, have waived their entitlement to a fee.
Note 3.  The Audit and Risk Committees are currently combined, and the Chair will therefore receive a combined fee of £25,000. If the Audit and Risk Committees were 
standalone, the respective Committee Chairs would receive the standard fee of £15,000 each. 
How our remuneration is aligned with the principles of the code
Alignment to strategy and culture
• The design of remuneration at Funding Circle is aligned to our values, 
culture and strategy.
• The annual bonus is based on financial and strategic performance 
promoting collective accountability and helps to align the Executive 
Directors’ incentive structure with the wider Group.
• Performance share awards fully align with our remuneration philosophy of 
ensuring that senior management are significant share owners, promoting 
good stewardship and incentivising Executive Directors to create long term 
value as the business continues to mature. 
Clarity and simplicity
• Our Policy aligns the Executive Directors’ pay with pay for other Circlers.
• Our Policy is simple to understand for participants and shareholders and 
promotes long term stewardship.
Risk
• Our Policy appropriately balances fixed and variable pay as well as short- 
and long-term incentives.
• Opportunities are set at a level which rewards performance at the same 
time as not unduly encouraging excessive risk taking.
• The annual bonus and performance share awards are subject to malus 
and clawback provisions and the Committee has the discretion to adjust 
pay outcomes.
Proportionality
• A significant portion of the total remuneration opportunity for Executive 
Directors is variable pay. This variable pay is aligned to Company strategy 
through the choice of performance measures and the link to share price. 
• Our Policy is clear on the threshold, target and maximum levels of pay that 
Executives can earn. Notwithstanding that actual outcomes will vary based 
on the level of achievement and share price performance.
This report has been prepared in accordance with the Companies Act 2006, Schedule 8 of the Large and Medium-
sized Companies and Groups (Accounts and Reports) Regulations 2008 (as amended), the 2018 UK Corporate 
Governance Code and the UK Listing Authority’s Listing Rules.
Funding Circle Holdings plc | Annual Report and Accounts 2024
111
STRATEGIC REPORT
CORPORATE GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

Report of the Directors
for the year ended 31 December 2024
The Directors present their report (the “Directors’ Report”) and the Annual Report and Accounts for the year ended 
31 December 2024. 
Information required to be part of the Directors’ Report either by statute, by UK Listing Rule 6.6 or by the DTRs can 
be found either in this section or elsewhere in this document, as indicated in the table below. All information located 
elsewhere in this document is incorporated into this Directors’ Report by reference:
Section of Annual Report
Page reference
Information required by UKLR6.6/DTRs
Corporate Governance Statement
Corporate Governance Statement (page 75)
Going Concern and Viability Statement
Viability statement (pages 63 to 64)
Directors’ interests
Remuneration Report (page 106) and Directors’ Report (page 112)
Long-term incentive schemes
Remuneration Report (page 95)
Waiver of emoluments 
Remuneration Report (pages 90 to 111) 
Powers for the Company to buyback its shares
Directors’ Report (page 113)
Allotment of shares during the year
Note 17 to the consolidated financial statements (page 167)
Significant shareholders
Directors’ Report (page 114)
Related party agreements
Note 25 to the consolidated financial statements (page 175)
Diversity policy
Strategic Report (page 22)
Climate-related financial disclosures
Environment, social and governance (“ESG”) (pages 24 to 39)
Statutory information
Stakeholder engagement
Strategic Report – Engaging our stakeholders (pages 40 to 43). See also 
Board decision making and section 172 duties on pages 72 to 73 of the 
Corporate Governance Report.
Employee engagement
Strategic Report – Engaging our stakeholders (pages 40 to 43) and Our 
people (pages 20 to 23). See also Board decision making and section 
172 duties on pages 72 to 73 of the Corporate Governance Report.
Policy concerning the employment of disabled 
persons
Strategic Report – Our people (page 23) 
Financial instruments
Note 16 to the financial statements (pages 154 to 167) 
Future developments of the business
Strategic Report (pages 1 to 64)
Greenhouse gas emissions, energy consumption 
and energy efficiency action
Strategic Report – Environment, social and governance (pages 24 to 39)
Significant agreements
Directors’ Report (page 112)
Non-financial reporting
Strategic Report – see below
Management Report
This Directors’ Report, together with the Strategic Report 
on pages 1 to 64, forms the Management Report for the 
purposes of DTR 4.1.5R.
Strategic Report
Section 414A of the Companies Act 2006 (the “Act”) 
requires the Directors to present a Strategic Report in 
the Annual Report and Accounts. The information can be 
found on pages 1 to 64.
The Company has chosen, in accordance with section 
414C (11) of the Act and as noted in this Directors’ Report, 
to include certain matters in its Strategic Report that 
would otherwise be disclosed in this Directors’ Report.
Section 414C of the Act requires the Company to include 
within its Strategic Report a non-financial sustainability 
information statement setting out such information as is 
required by section 414CB of the Act. Such information 
is set out in the ESG section on pages 24 to 39, the Our 
business model section on pages 8 to 9, Our strategy 
section on pages 10 to 11, our KPIs on page 11 to 12, and 
the Risk management and Going concern and Viability 
Statement sections on pages 51 to 64.
Directors and their interests
Biographies of the Directors currently serving on the 
Board are set out on page 68 to 69. Our Articles of 
Association provide that all our Directors must stand 
for re-election by shareholders at each AGM.
Details of Directors’ service contracts are set out in 
the Directors’ Remuneration Report on page 102. The 
interests of the Directors in the shares of the Company 
are also shown on page 106 of that report. In the period 
between 1 January 2025 and the date of this report, there 
were no additional ordinary shares allotted to Lisa Jacobs 
or Tony Nicol under the Company’s Share Incentive Plan.
In line with the requirements of the Act, each Director has 
notified the Company of any situation in which they have, 
or could have, a direct or indirect interest that conflicts, or 
possibly may conflict, with the interests of the Company 
(a situational conflict). The Board has formal procedures 
to deal with Directors’ conflicts of interest.
Geeta Gopalan is a Director of Intrum AB, which provides 
servicing to Funding Circle’s European subsidiaries.
None of the Directors has a material interest in any significant 
contract with the Company or any member of its Group.
Funding Circle Holdings plc | Annual Report and Accounts 2024
112
STRATEGIC REPORT
CORPORATE GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

Insurance and indemnities
The Company maintains appropriate insurance to 
cover Directors’ and Officers’ liability for itself and its 
subsidiaries. In addition, the Company indemnifies 
each Director under a separate deed of indemnity. 
The Company also indemnifies each Director under its 
Articles of Association. Such indemnities are qualifying 
indemnities for the purposes of, and permitted under, 
section 234 of the Act.
Results and dividends
The Group’s and the Company’s audited financial 
statements for the year are set out on pages 124 to 192.
The Directors do not recommend payment of a final 
dividend for 2025 (2024: £nil).
Authority to allot or purchase the Company’s shares
The Articles permit the Directors to issue or approve the 
purchase by the Company of its own shares, subject to 
obtaining shareholders’ prior approval. The authority to 
issue or buy back shares will expire at the 2025 AGM, 
and it will be proposed at the meeting that the Directors 
be granted new authorities to issue and buy back 
shares. The Directors currently have authority to approve 
the Company’s purchase of up to 54,085,678 of the 
Company’s ordinary shares. The Company announced a 
share buyback programme on 7 March 2024 to buy up 
to £25 million worth of shares and a further programme 
for up to £25 million was announced on 16 October 2024. 
As at 31 December 2024, the Company made market 
purchases of 33,548,734 ordinary shares of nominal 
value of £0.001 in the Company, of which 181,370 were 
pending cancellation at 31 December 2024, representing 
9.29% of the issued share capital and all shares were 
cancelled. The total cost of the market purchases was 
£33.4 million (excluding stamp duty and broker fees) 
with the weighted average purchase price of each share 
being £1.16.
The trustee of the Company’s Employee Benefit Trust 
made no market purchases of ordinary shares. As at 
the date of this report, the trustee holds 2.10% of the 
Company’s issued share capital.
Share capital
The Company’s issued share capital comprises 
ordinary shares of £0.001, each of which is listed on 
the London Stock Exchange. The issued share capital 
of the Company as at 31 December 2024 comprises 
327,935,779 ordinary shares of £0.001 each. Further 
information regarding the Company’s issued share capital 
can be found on page 167 of the financial statements.
Rights attaching to shares
All shares have the same rights (including voting and 
dividend rights and rights on a return of capital) and 
restrictions as set out in the Articles, described below. 
Except in relation to dividends and rights on a liquidation 
of the Company, the shareholders have no rights to share 
in the profits of the Company. The Company’s shares 
are not redeemable. However, following any grant of 
authority from shareholders, the Company may purchase 
or contract to purchase any of the shares on or off 
market, subject to the Act and the requirements of the 
UK Listing Rules.
Voting rights
All members who hold ordinary shares are entitled to 
attend and vote at the AGM. On a show of hands at a 
general meeting, every member present in person shall 
have one vote and on a poll, every member present in 
person or by proxy shall have one vote for every share 
of which he or she is the holder. No shareholder holds 
ordinary shares carrying special rights relating to the 
control of the Company and the Directors are not aware 
of any agreements between holders of the Company’s 
shares that may result in restrictions on voting rights.
Shares held by the Company’s Employee Benefit Trust rank 
pari passu with the shares in issue and have no special 
rights. Voting rights and rights of acceptance of any offer 
relating to shares held in trust rest with the Trustees and 
are not exercisable by employees, although the Trustees 
will not automatically exercise such rights arising from 
allocated shares unless directed by the Company. 
Restrictions on transfer of securities
The Articles do not contain any restrictions on the 
transfer of ordinary shares in the Company other than the 
usual restrictions applicable where any amount is unpaid 
on a share. All issued share capital of the Company at 
the date of this report is fully paid. Certain restrictions 
are also imposed by laws and regulations (such as insider 
dealing and market requirements relating to closed 
periods) and requirements of the Disclosure Guidance 
and Transparency Rules, as well as the Company’s own 
dealing codes, whereby Directors, persons connected 
to the Directors and certain employees of the Company 
require approval to deal in the Company’s securities.
Change of control
Certain LTIP Awards held by members of the ExCo 
(excluding the Executive Directors) contain additional 
protections in the event of termination of employment due 
to a takeover bid where such termination is deemed to 
be connected with the change of control. Save in respect 
of these awards, there are no agreements between the 
Company and its Directors or employees providing for 
compensation for loss of office or employment (whether 
through resignation, purported redundancy or otherwise) 
because of a takeover bid.
The Group is party to a limited number of funding and 
servicing agreements that include change of control 
provisions which, in the event of a change of control 
undertaken not in compliance with the procedural 
requirements of the relevant arrangement, could result in 
the termination of further loan origination and termination 
of servicing by the Group under the affected arrangement. 
In addition, the Group participates in one or more lending 
schemes that benefit from a form of government-backed 
guarantee and it is expected that, in the event of a change 
of control of the Company, the consent of the relevant 
loan guarantor would be required to enable the Group’s 
continued participation in those schemes.
Funding Circle Holdings plc | Annual Report and Accounts 2024
113
STRATEGIC REPORT
CORPORATE GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

Significant shareholdings
As at 31 December 2024 and at the date of this report, the Company has been notified pursuant to DTR5.1, or 
is otherwise aware via our registrar, of the following significant interests in the issued ordinary share capital of 
the Company:
Name of shareholder
Number 
of ordinary 
shares as at 
31 December
2024
Percentage 
issued share 
capital as at 
31 December 
2024
Number 
of ordinary 
shares as at 
6 March 
2025
Percentage 
issued capital 
as at 
6 March 
2025
Index Ventures
58,618,351
17.88
58,618,351
18.07
Aktieselskabet af 2.7.2018
47,067,936
14.36
47,067,936
14.51
Accel London Management
26,906,743
8.21
26,906,743
8.29
Schroder Investment Management
24,963,260
7.60
26,448,592
8.15
DST Managers
16,505,378
5.04
16,505,378
5.09
Capital Group
14,713,073
4.49
14,713,073
4.53
BlackRock
13,995,821
4.27
12,647,423
3.90
Research and development
The Group invests in the research and development 
of technology and software products that enable the 
Group to achieve its key performance objective of 
growing lending to SMEs whilst delivering resilient returns 
to investors. 
Political donations
There were no political donations made during the year 
or the previous year.
External branches
The Company has subsidiaries in the United Kingdom, 
Germany, and the Netherlands and has one UK branch 
of the Dutch entity and four UK branches of the 
German entities.
External auditors
PwC have confirmed their willingness to continue as 
external auditors and a resolution to reappoint them 
as the Company’s external auditors, and to authorise 
the Directors to fix the auditors’ remuneration, will be 
proposed at the 2025 AGM.
Statement of disclosure of information to auditors
Each of the persons who is a Director at the date of 
approval of this report confirms that:
• so far as the Director is aware, there is no relevant audit
information of which the Company’s external auditors 
are unaware; and
• the Director has taken all the steps that they ought to
have taken as a Director in order to make themselves
aware of any relevant audit information and to
establish that the Company’s auditors are aware of
that information.
This confirmation is given and should be interpreted in 
accordance with the provisions of section 418 of the Act. 
Voting results final update – 2024 AGM
At the Company’s AGM, held on 15 May 2024, 20% 
or more votes were cast against Resolutions 17 
(general disapplication of pre-emption rights) and 18 
(disapplication of pre-emption rights in connection with 
an acquisition or specified capital investment). These 
were special resolutions requiring a 75% majority, which 
did receive sufficient support to be passed, receiving 
votes in favour of 78.52% respectively. However, a 
significant number of votes (21.48%) were against 
both resolutions.
As per provision 4 of the Code, on 14 November 2024, 
the Company provided an update on its engagement 
with shareholders to better understand the reasons 
why the above resolutions were voted against. The 
Company understands that these votes reflected, among 
other things, the voting policy of certain shareholders 
and the potential for dilution especially in the absence 
of a specific transaction for which the authority 
would be used.
2025 AGM
The Company’s AGM will take place at 12:00 pm on 
15 May 2025 at the Company’s offices at 71 Queen 
Victoria Street, London EC4V 4AY. 
A separate circular, comprising a letter from the Chair 
of the Board, Notice of Meeting and explanatory notes 
on the resolutions being proposed, has been circulated 
to shareholders and is available on our website, 
https://corporate.fundingcircle.com/investors/
shareholder-meetings. 
Report of the Directors continued
for the year ended 31 December 2024
Funding Circle Holdings plc | Annual Report and Accounts 2024
114
STRATEGIC REPORT
CORPORATE GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

Statement of Directors’ responsibilities in respect of the financial statements
The Directors are responsible for preparing the Annual 
Report and the financial statements in accordance with 
applicable law and regulation.
Company law requires the Directors to prepare financial 
statements for each financial year. Under that law 
the Directors have prepared the Group and Company 
financial statements in accordance with UK-adopted 
international Accounting Standards.
Under company law, Directors must not approve the 
financial statements unless they are satisfied that they 
give a true and fair view of the state of affairs of the 
Group and Company and of the profit or loss of the Group 
for that period. In preparing the financial statements, the 
Directors are required to:
• select suitable accounting policies and then apply
them consistently;
• state whether applicable UK-adopted International
Accounting Standards have been followed, subject to 
any material departures disclosed and explained in the 
financial statements;
• make judgements and accounting estimates that are
reasonable and prudent; and
• prepare the financial statements on the going concern
basis unless it is inappropriate to presume that the
Group and Company will continue in business.
The Directors are also responsible for safeguarding the 
assets of the Group and Company and hence for taking 
reasonable steps for the prevention and detection of 
fraud and other irregularities.
The Directors are also responsible for keeping adequate 
accounting records that are sufficient to show and 
explain the Group’s and Company’s transactions and 
disclose with reasonable accuracy at any time the 
financial position of the Group and Company and 
enable them to ensure that the financial statements and 
the Directors’ Remuneration Report comply with the 
Companies Act 2006.
The Directors are responsible for the maintenance 
and integrity of the Company’s website. Legislation 
in the United Kingdom governing the preparation and 
dissemination of financial statements may differ from 
legislation in other jurisdictions.
Directors’ confirmations
The Directors consider that the Annual Report and 
Accounts, taken as a whole, is fair, balanced and 
understandable and provides the information necessary 
for shareholders to assess the Group’s and Company’s 
position and performance, business model and strategy.
Each of the Directors, whose names and functions are 
listed in the Report of the Directors confirm that, to the 
best of their knowledge:
• the Group and Company financial statements, which
have been prepared in accordance with UK-adopted
International Accounting Standards, give a true and
fair view of the assets, liabilities and financial position
of the Group and Company, and of the profit of the
Group; and
• the Strategic Report includes a fair review of the
development and performance of the business and the
position of the Group and Company, together with a
description of the principal risks and uncertainties that
they face.
Approved by the Board and signed on its behalf.
Lisa Jacobs
Chief Executive Officer 
6 March 2025
Funding Circle Holdings plc | Annual Report and Accounts 2024
115
STRATEGIC REPORT
CORPORATE GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

Financial 
statements
117  Independent auditors’ report
124 Consolidated statement of comprehensive 
income
125 Consolidated balance sheet
126 Consolidated statement of changes in equity
127 Consolidated statement of cash flows
128 Notes forming part of the consolidated 
financial statements
180 Company balance sheet
181 Company statement of changes in equity
182 Company statement of cash flows
183 Notes forming part of the Company financial 
statements
193 Alternative performance measures
194 Glossary
197 Shareholder information
198 Company information
STRATEGIC REPORT
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
CORPORATE GOVERNANCE
Funding Circle Holdings plc | Annual Report and Accounts 2024
116

Funding Circle Holdings plc | Annual Report and Accounts 2024
117
Independent auditors’ report
to the members of Funding Circle Holdings plc
Report on the audit of the financial statements
Opinion
In our opinion, Funding Circle Holdings plc’s Group 
financial statements and Company financial statements 
(the “financial statements”):
• give a true and fair view of the state of the Group’s and 
of the Company’s affairs as at 31 December 2024 and 
of the Group’s profit and the Group’s and Company’s 
cash flows for the year then ended;
• have been properly prepared in accordance with UK-
adopted international accounting standards as applied 
in accordance with the provisions of the Companies 
Act 2006; and
• have been prepared in accordance with the 
requirements of the Companies Act 2006.
We have audited the financial statements, included within 
the Annual Report and Accounts (the “Annual Report”), 
which comprise: the Consolidated and Company balance 
sheet as at 31 December 2024; the Consolidated 
statement of comprehensive income, the Consolidated 
and Company statement of changes in equity and the 
Consolidated and Company statement of cash flows 
for the year then ended; and the notes to the financial 
statements, comprising material accounting policy 
information and other explanatory information.
Our opinion is consistent with our reporting to the Audit 
and Risk Committee.
Basis for opinion
We conducted our audit in accordance with International 
Standards on Auditing (UK) (“ISAs (UK)”) and applicable 
law. Our responsibilities under ISAs (UK) are further 
described in the Auditors’ responsibilities for the audit of 
the financial statements section of our report. We believe 
that the audit evidence we have obtained is sufficient 
and appropriate to provide a basis for our opinion.
Independence
We remained independent of the Group in accordance 
with the ethical requirements that are relevant to our 
audit of the financial statements in the UK, which 
includes the FRC’s Ethical Standard, as applicable to 
listed public interest entities, and we have fulfilled our 
other ethical responsibilities in accordance with these 
requirements.
To the best of our knowledge and belief, we declare 
that non-audit services prohibited by the FRC’s Ethical 
Standard were not provided.
Other than those disclosed in note 6, we have provided 
no non-audit services to the Company or its controlled 
undertakings in the period under audit.
Our audit approach
Overview
Audit scope
• The scope of our audit and the nature, timing and 
extent of audit procedures performed were determined 
by our risk assessment.
• We identified the Term Loans business as a significant 
component and as a result it was subject to a full scope 
audit. We identified three non-significant components 
(FlexiPay business, US business and Parent entity) and 
applied judgment in determining the extent of audit 
testing to be performed over each. Audit testing over 
specific balances has been completed for FlexiPay 
based on either size or risk profile and specified audit 
procedures were performed over the US business 
(up to the point of sale) to address identified risks 
of material misstatement. A full scope audit was 
performed over the parent entity given the Company 
accounts are included within the Annual Report.
Key audit matters
• The allowance for expected credit losses in relation 
to FlexiPay lines of credit (Group)
• Carrying value of the investment in FCL (parent)
Materiality
• Overall Group materiality: £1,617,500 (2023: 
£1,622,000) based on 1% of total income.
• Overall Company materiality: £3,560,000 (2023: 
£3,592,000) based on 1% of total assets.
• Performance materiality: £1,213,125 (2023: £1,216,500) 
(Group) and £2,670,000 (2023: £2,694,000) 
(Company).
The scope of our audit
As part of designing our audit, we determined materiality 
and assessed the risks of material misstatement in the 
financial statements.
Key audit matters
Key audit matters are those matters that, in the auditors’ 
professional judgement, were of most significance 
in the audit of the financial statements of the current 
period and include the most significant assessed risks 
of material misstatement (whether or not due to fraud) 
identified by the auditors, including those which had 
the greatest effect on: the overall audit strategy; the 
allocation of resources in the audit; and directing the 
efforts of the engagement team. These matters, and any 
comments we make on the results of our procedures 
thereon, were addressed in the context of our audit 
of the financial statements as a whole, and in forming 
our opinion thereon, and we do not provide a separate 
opinion on these matters.
This is not a complete list of all risks identified by 
our audit. 
Carrying value of the investment in FCL (parent) is a 
new key audit matter this year. Carrying value of the 
Company’s investment in the US subsidiary (parent) and 
Valuation of SME loans (securitised) and investments in 
RLS/CBILs trusts, which were key audit matters last year, 
are no longer included because of the sale of the US 
business and, in relation to the loans and investments, 
continued amortisation of the remaining portfolios 
through the year. Otherwise, the key audit matters below 
are consistent with last year.
CORPORATE GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
STRATEGIC REPORT

Funding Circle Holdings plc | Annual Report and Accounts 2024
118
Key audit matter
How our audit addressed the key audit matter
The allowance for expected credit losses in 
relation to FlexiPay lines of credit (Group)
Refer to Report of the Audit Committee – Key audit 
matters considered in relation to the financial 
statements; note 1 (material accounting policies); 
note 2 (critical accounting judgements and key 
sources of estimation uncertainty); and note 16 
(financial risk management) of the Group 
financial statements. 
At 31 December 2024 the gross carrying value of 
FlexiPay lines of credit was £110.0 million and the 
associated allowance for expected credit losses 
was £12.9 million on drawn lines of credit and 
£2.7 million on undrawn lines of credit. 
The determination of the allowance for expected 
credit losses is subjective and judgmental. A model 
is used to collectively determine the allowance for 
expected credit losses for both the drawn and 
undrawn lines of credit. The key assumptions and 
inputs into this model are the probability of default, 
loss given default and the use of multiple, 
probability weighted, macroeconomic scenarios. 
As a new product, FlexiPay continues to be a 
strategic priority for the business. Given this, along 
with continued evolution of the ECL model in the 
year, the corresponding provision for expected 
credit losses was a focus of our audit.
Together with our credit risk specialists, we performed the following 
substantive procedures over the allowance for expected credit losses 
on FlexiPay lines of credit: 
• we engaged our credit risk specialists to review the methodology 
and assumptions applied by management in calculating the 
allowance for expected credit losses; 
• we independently tested the derivation of key assumptions, 
and tested that the model methodology has been implemented 
as intended; 
• we performed sensitivity analysis to understand and evaluate 
the impact of conceptual limitations and key judgments used 
in management’s ECL calculation. This included building a 
challenger macro-economic default rate model to test the 
sensitivity of the ECL to macro scenarios;
• we assessed macro-economic forecasts and weightings used 
in the model by benchmarking to independent forecasts, 
and evaluating the reasonableness of judgements applied by 
management; and
• we tested the accuracy of the historical loan tape used as a key 
input into the credit loss model including customer utilisation 
and performance.
We also assessed the disclosures in note 2, regarding the critical 
accounting judgements and key sources of estimation uncertainty 
involved in determining the expected credit loss provision and found 
them to be appropriate. 
Based on the evidence obtained, we concluded that the methodologies, 
modelled assumptions and management judgements in determining the 
allowance for expected credit losses for FlexiPay lines of credit to be 
appropriate and compliant with the requirements of IFRS 9.
Carrying value of the investment in FCL (Parent)
Refer to Report of the Audit and Risk Committee 
– Key audit matters considered in relation to the 
financial statements; note 1 (Investment in 
subsidiaries); and note 5 (Investments in subsidiary 
undertakings) of the Company financial statements. 
The Company holds an investment in FCL with a 
carrying value of £258.2 million. IAS 36 ‘Impairment 
of Assets’ requires that investments should be 
assessed for any indicators of impairment at the 
end of each reporting period. Management 
performed an assessment for indicators of 
impairment and concluded that there were none 
in relation to the UK business. 
Given the carrying value of the investment is 
material and its significance to the Company 
balance sheet, the level of uncertainty associated 
with the future cash flows associated with the 
FlexiPay business and the extent of restructuring 
that has occurred in the year this has been an area 
of focus in our audit.  
Our audit procedures comprised the following:  
• We understood the methodology used by management to assess 
their investment in subsidiaries for impairment indicators. 
• We evaluated the indicators considered by management against 
IAS36 requirements and substantiated relevant information 
within the assessment of indicators.
• Given the significant change in the business in the year,  we 
performed sensitivity analysis over certain assumptions, in 
particular FlexiPay cash flows, using a discounted cash flow model 
to assess the impact on the recoverable value.
Based on the above procedures performed, and evidence 
obtained, we considered the Directors’ conclusion that there are no 
impairment indicators for the investment in FCL to be reasonable.
Independent auditors’ report continued
to the members of Funding Circle Holdings plc
Report on the audit of the financial statements continued
Our audit approach continued
Key audit matters continued 
STRATEGIC REPORT
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
CORPORATE GOVERNANCE

Funding Circle Holdings plc | Annual Report and Accounts 2024
119
Report on the audit of the financial statements 
continued
Our audit approach continued
How we tailored the audit scope 
We tailored the scope of our audit to ensure that we 
performed enough work to be able to give an opinion 
on the financial statements as a whole, taking into 
account the structure of the Group and the Company, 
the accounting processes and controls, and the industry 
in which they operate. 
1) Audit approach to Funding Circle’s operations: We 
performed a risk assessment, giving consideration to 
relevant external and internal factors, including economic 
risks, climate change, relevant accounting and regulatory 
developments, and Funding Circle’s strategy. We also 
considered our knowledge and experience obtained in 
prior year audits. We designed our audit approach for the 
products and services that substantially make up Funding 
Circle’s continuing business in the UK in Term Loans 
and FlexiPay such as platform lending, marketplace 
referrals and the origination of, and investment in, SME 
loan portfolios and lines of credit and the discontinued 
US business. 
2) Audit work for in scope components: The risks of 
material misstatement can be reduced to an acceptable 
level by testing components that are significant due to 
their size and those that drive significant risks identified 
as part of our risk assessment. We identified the Term 
Loans business as a full scope component due to being 
significant due to size. We considered FlexiPay as a non-
significant component and material balances have been 
included in our scope for the purpose of the Group audit. 
We considered the US business as a non-significant 
component and performed specified procedures over 
certain balances. Whilst the parent entity is considered 
non-significant for the consolidated audit, we have 
completed a full scope audit given the Company 
accounts are included within the Annual Report. We 
assigned materiality levels to components reflecting the 
size of their operations. One team performed all audit 
work on the components. Through the work performed 
we concluded that sufficient appropriate audit evidence 
had been obtained as a basis for our opinion on the 
Group financial statements as a whole. 
3) Audit procedures undertaken at a Group level and 
on the Company: In planning and executing our audit 
no other component teams were used. We ensured 
that appropriate work was undertaken for the Group 
and Company. 
The impact of climate risk on our audit 
As part of our audit we made enquiries of management to 
understand the extent of the potential impact of climate 
risk on the Group’s and Company’s financial statements, 
and we remained alert when performing our audit 
procedures for any indicators of the impact of climate 
risk. Our procedures did not identify any material impact 
as a result of climate risk on the Group’s and Company’s 
financial statements. 
Materiality 
The scope of our audit was influenced by our application 
of materiality. We set certain quantitative thresholds 
for materiality. These, together with qualitative 
considerations, helped us to determine the scope of 
our audit and the nature, timing and extent of our audit 
procedures on the individual financial statement line 
items and disclosures and in evaluating the effect of 
misstatements, both individually and in aggregate on the 
financial statements as a whole. 
Based on our professional judgement, we determined 
materiality for the financial statements as a whole 
as follows: 
 
Financial statements – Group
Financial statements – Company 
Overall materiality
£1,617,500 (2023: £1,622,000).
£3,560,000 (2023: £3,592,000). 
How we determined it
1% of total income
1% of total assets 
Rationale for benchmark applied
We consider this to be an appropriate 
benchmark as total income is a key 
performance indicator for Group 
performance and a metric used to guide 
analysts as well as a measure to 
determine executive compensation. 
We consider total assets to be an 
appropriate benchmark to apply on the basis 
that the Company is a non-trading 
investment Company that holds investment 
in the Group’s subsidiaries.
CORPORATE GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
STRATEGIC REPORT

Funding Circle Holdings plc | Annual Report and Accounts 2024
120
Independent auditors’ report continued
to the members of Funding Circle Holdings plc
Report on the audit of the financial statements 
continued
Our audit approach continued
Materiality continued
For each component in the scope of our Group audit, we 
allocated a materiality that is less than our overall Group 
materiality. The range of materiality allocated across 
components was between £1,536,000 and £1,374,000. 
Certain components were audited to a local statutory 
audit materiality that was also less than our overall 
Group materiality. 
We use performance materiality to reduce to an 
appropriately low level the probability that the aggregate of 
uncorrected and undetected misstatements exceeds overall 
materiality. Specifically, we use performance materiality in 
determining the scope of our audit and the nature and extent 
of our testing of account balances, classes of transactions 
and disclosures, for example in determining sample sizes. 
Our performance materiality was 75% (2023: 75%) of overall 
materiality, amounting to £1,213,125 (2023: £1,216,500) 
for the Group financial statements and £2,670,000 (2023: 
£2,694,000) for the Company financial statements. 
In determining the performance materiality, we considered 
a number of factors - the history of misstatements, risk 
assessment and aggregation risk and the effectiveness of 
controls - and concluded that an amount at the upper end 
of our normal range was appropriate. 
We agreed with the Audit and Risk Committee that we 
would report to them misstatements identified during 
our audit above £80,875 (Group audit) (2023: £81,100) 
and £178,000 (Company audit) (2023: £179,615) as well 
as misstatements below those amounts that, in our view, 
warranted reporting for qualitative reasons. 
Conclusions relating to going concern 
Our evaluation of the directors’ assessment of the 
Group’s and the Company’s ability to continue to adopt 
the going concern basis of accounting included: 
• obtaining and evaluating management’s going 
concern assessment; 
• performing a risk assessment to identify factors that 
could impact the going concern basis of accounting, 
including the impact of external risks such as an 
uncertain economic environment and climate change; 
• understanding and evaluating management’s financial 
forecasts and liquidity and regulatory capital over the 
going concern period and an evaluation of the stress 
testing performed by management; 
• substantiation of financial resources available to the 
Group and Company as at the balance sheet date 
including the unrestricted cash; and 
• reading and evaluating the adequacy of the disclosures 
made in the financial statements in relation to 
going concern. 
Based on the work we have performed, we have not 
identified any material uncertainties relating to events 
or conditions that, individually or collectively, may cast 
significant doubt on the Group’s and the Company’s 
ability to continue as a going concern for a period of at 
least twelve months from when the financial statements 
are authorised for issue. 
In auditing the financial statements, we have concluded 
that the directors’ use of the going concern basis of 
accounting in the preparation of the financial statements 
is appropriate. 
However, because not all future events or conditions can 
be predicted, this conclusion is not a guarantee as to 
the Group’s and the Company’s ability to continue as a 
going concern. 
In relation to the directors’ reporting on how they have 
applied the UK Corporate Governance Code, we have 
nothing material to add or draw attention to in relation to 
the directors’ statement in the financial statements about 
whether the directors considered it appropriate to adopt 
the going concern basis of accounting. 
Our responsibilities and the responsibilities of the 
directors with respect to going concern are described 
in the relevant sections of this report. 
Reporting on other information 
The other information comprises all of the information 
in the Annual Report other than the financial statements 
and our auditors’ report thereon. The directors are 
responsible for the other information. Our opinion on the 
financial statements does not cover the other information 
and, accordingly, we do not express an audit opinion or, 
except to the extent otherwise explicitly stated in this 
report, any form of assurance thereon. 
In connection with our audit of the financial statements, 
our responsibility is to read the other information and, 
in doing so, consider whether the other information is 
materially inconsistent with the financial statements 
or our knowledge obtained in the audit, or otherwise 
appears to be materially misstated. If we identify 
an apparent material inconsistency or material 
misstatement, we are required to perform procedures 
to conclude whether there is a material misstatement 
of the financial statements or a material misstatement 
of the other information. If, based on the work we 
have performed, we conclude that there is a material 
misstatement of this other information, we are required 
to report that fact. We have nothing to report based on 
these responsibilities. 
With respect to the Strategic report and Report of the 
Directors, we also considered whether the disclosures 
required by the UK Companies Act 2006 have 
been included. 
Based on our work undertaken in the course of the 
audit, the Companies Act 2006 requires us also to report 
certain opinions and matters as described below.
STRATEGIC REPORT
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
CORPORATE GOVERNANCE

Funding Circle Holdings plc | Annual Report and Accounts 2024
121
Report on the audit of the financial statements 
continued
Reporting on other information continued
Strategic report and Report of the Directors 
In our opinion, based on the work undertaken in the 
course of the audit, the information given in the Strategic 
report and Report of the Directors for the year ended 
31 December 2024 is consistent with the financial 
statements and has been prepared in accordance with 
applicable legal requirements. 
In light of the knowledge and understanding of the 
Group and Company and their environment obtained in 
the course of the audit, we did not identify any material 
misstatements in the Strategic report and Report of the 
Directors. 
Directors’ Remuneration 
In our opinion, the part of the Directors’ remuneration 
report to be audited has been properly prepared in 
accordance with the Companies Act 2006. 
Corporate governance statement 
The Listing Rules require us to review the directors’ 
statements in relation to going concern, longer-term 
viability and that part of the corporate governance 
statement relating to the Company’s compliance with 
the provisions of the UK Corporate Governance Code 
specified for our review. Our additional responsibilities 
with respect to the corporate governance statement as 
other information are described in the Reporting on other 
information section of this report. 
Based on the work undertaken as part of our audit, 
we have concluded that each of the following elements 
of the corporate governance statement is materially 
consistent with the financial statements and our 
knowledge obtained during the audit, and we have 
nothing material to add or draw attention to in relation to: 
• The directors’ confirmation that they have carried out a 
robust assessment of the emerging and principal risks; 
• The disclosures in the Annual Report that describe 
those principal risks, what procedures are in place 
to identify emerging risks and an explanation of how 
these are being managed or mitigated; 
• The directors’ statement in the financial statements 
about whether they considered it appropriate to 
adopt the going concern basis of accounting in 
preparing them, and their identification of any 
material uncertainties to the Group’s and Company’s 
ability to continue to do so over a period of at least 
twelve months from the date of approval of the 
financial statements; 
• The directors’ explanation as to their assessment of 
the Group’s and Company’s prospects, the period 
this assessment covers and why the period is 
appropriate; and 
• The directors’ statement as to whether they have a 
reasonable expectation that the Company will be able 
to continue in operation and meet its liabilities as they 
fall due over the period of its assessment, including any 
related disclosures drawing attention to any necessary 
qualifications or assumptions. 
Our review of the directors’ statement regarding the 
longer-term viability of the Group and Company was 
substantially less in scope than an audit and only 
consisted of making inquiries and considering the 
directors’ process supporting their statement; checking 
that the statement is in alignment with the relevant 
provisions of the UK Corporate Governance Code; 
and considering whether the statement is consistent 
with the financial statements and our knowledge and 
understanding of the Group and Company and their 
environment obtained in the course of the audit. 
In addition, based on the work undertaken as part of 
our audit, we have concluded that each of the following 
elements of the corporate governance statement is 
materially consistent with the financial statements and 
our knowledge obtained during the audit: 
• The directors’ statement that they consider the 
Annual Report, taken as a whole, is fair, balanced 
and understandable, and provides the information 
necessary for the members to assess the Group’s 
and Company’s position, performance, business 
model and strategy; 
• The section of the Annual Report that describes the 
review of effectiveness of risk management and 
internal control systems; and 
• The section of the Annual Report describing the work 
of the Audit and Risk Committee. 
to report when the directors’ statement relating to the 
We have nothing to report in respect of our responsibility 
Company’s compliance with the Code does not properly 
disclose a departure from a relevant provision of the 
Code specified under the Listing Rules for review by 
the auditors. 
Responsibilities for the financial statements and 
the audit 
Responsibilities of the directors for the financial 
statements 
As explained more fully in the Statement of Directors’ 
responsibilities in respect of the financial statements, 
the directors are responsible for the preparation of the 
financial statements in accordance with the applicable 
framework and for being satisfied that they give a true 
and fair view. The directors are also responsible for such 
internal control as they determine is necessary to enable 
the preparation of financial statements that are free from 
material misstatement, whether due to fraud or error.
CORPORATE GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
STRATEGIC REPORT

Funding Circle Holdings plc | Annual Report and Accounts 2024
122
Independent auditors’ report continued
to the members of Funding Circle Holdings plc
Report on the audit of the financial statements 
continued
Responsibilities for the financial statements and 
the audit continued
Responsibilities of the directors for the financial 
statements continued
In preparing the financial statements, the directors are 
responsible for assessing the Group’s and the Company’s 
ability to continue as a going concern, disclosing, as 
applicable, matters related to going concern and using 
the going concern basis of accounting unless the 
directors either intend to liquidate the Group or the 
Company or to cease operations, or have no realistic 
alternative but to do so. 
Auditors’ responsibilities for the audit of the 
financial statements 
Our objectives are to obtain reasonable assurance about 
whether the financial statements as a whole are free from 
material misstatement, whether due to fraud or error, 
and to issue an auditors’ report that includes our opinion. 
Reasonable assurance is a high level of assurance, but is 
not a guarantee that an audit conducted in accordance 
with ISAs (UK) will always detect a material misstatement 
when it exists. Misstatements can arise from fraud or 
error and are considered material if, individually or in 
the aggregate, they could reasonably be expected to 
influence the economic decisions of users taken on the 
basis of these financial statements. 
Irregularities, including fraud, are instances of 
non-compliance with laws and regulations. We design 
procedures in line with our responsibilities, outlined 
above, to detect material misstatements in respect 
of irregularities, including fraud. The extent to which 
our procedures are capable of detecting irregularities, 
including fraud, is detailed below. 
Based on our understanding of the Group and industry, 
we identified that the principal risks of non-compliance 
with laws and regulations related to the Financial 
Conduct Authority (“FCA”), and we considered the 
extent to which non-compliance might have a material 
effect on the financial statements. We also considered 
those laws and regulations that have a direct impact 
on the financial statements such as the Companies 
Act 2006. We evaluated management’s incentives and 
opportunities for fraudulent manipulation of the financial 
statements (including the risk of override of controls), 
and determined that the principal risks were related 
to bias in accounting estimates and posting of journal 
entries. Audit procedures performed by the engagement 
team included: 
• 	review of correspondence with, and reports 
to, the FCA; 
• review of a sample of customer complaints to 
identify any indicators of breaches in laws and 
regulations or fraud; 
• enquiries of the Directors, the Chair of the Audit 
and Risk Committee, the Head of Internal Audit and 
management, as well as the Group’s Chief Legal 
Officer and the Group’s Head of Compliance, including 
consideration of known or suspected instances of non-
compliance with laws and regulation and fraud; 
• review of board meeting minutes and internal audit 
reports issued in the period to identify any indicators 
of breaches in laws and regulations and fraud that 
could require further investigation; 
• identifying and testing journal entries, including those 
with unusual account combinations impacting total 
income; and 
• challenging significant assumptions and judgements 
made by management in its accounting estimates and 
assessing them for bias. 
There are inherent limitations in the audit procedures 
described above. We are less likely to become aware of 
instances of non-compliance with laws and regulations 
that are not closely related to events and transactions 
reflected in the financial statements. Also, the risk of 
not detecting a material misstatement due to fraud is 
higher than the risk of not detecting one resulting from 
error, as fraud may involve deliberate concealment by, 
for example, forgery or intentional misrepresentations, 
or through collusion. 
Our audit testing might include testing complete populations 
of certain transactions and balances, possibly using data 
auditing techniques. However, it typically involves selecting 
a limited number of items for testing, rather than testing 
complete populations. We will often seek to target particular 
items for testing based on their size or risk characteristics. In 
other cases, we will use audit sampling to enable us to draw 
a conclusion about the population from which the sample 
is selected. 
A further description of our responsibilities for the 
audit of the financial statements is located on the FRC’s 
website at: www.frc.org.uk/auditorsresponsibilities. 
This description forms part of our auditors’ report. 
Use of this report 
This report, including the opinions, has been prepared 
for and only for the Company’s members as a body in 
accordance with Chapter 3 of Part 16 of the Companies 
Act 2006 and for no other purpose. We do not, in giving 
these opinions, accept or assume responsibility for any 
other purpose or to any other person to whom this report 
is shown or into whose hands it may come save where 
expressly agreed by our prior consent in writing.
STRATEGIC REPORT
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
CORPORATE GOVERNANCE

Funding Circle Holdings plc | Annual Report and Accounts 2024
123
Other required reporting 
Companies Act 2006 exception reporting 
Under the Companies Act 2006 we are required to report 
to you if, in our opinion: 
• we have not obtained all the information and 
explanations we require for our audit; or 
• adequate accounting records have not been kept by 
the Company, or returns adequate for our audit have 
not been received from branches not visited by us; or 
• certain disclosures of directors’ remuneration specified 
by law are not made; or 
• the Company financial statements and the part of the 
Directors’ remuneration report to be audited are not in 
agreement with the accounting records and returns. 
We have no exceptions to report arising from 
this responsibility. 
Appointment 
Following the recommendation of the Audit and Risk 
Committee, we were appointed by the directors on 4 
August 2015 to audit the financial statements for the 
year ended 31 December 2015 and subsequent financial 
periods. The period of total uninterrupted engagement is 
ten years, covering the years ended 31 December 2015 to 
31 December 2024. 
Other matter 
The Company is required by the Financial Conduct 
Authority Disclosure Guidance and Transparency Rules to 
include these financial statements in an annual financial 
report prepared under the structured digital format 
required by DTR 4.1.15R - 4.1.18R and filed on the National 
Storage Mechanism of the Financial Conduct Authority. 
This auditors’ report provides no assurance over whether 
the structured digital format annual financial report has 
been prepared in accordance with those requirements. 
Heather Varley (Senior Statutory Auditor) 
for and on behalf of PricewaterhouseCoopers LLP 
Chartered Accountants and Statutory Auditors 
London 
6 March 2025
CORPORATE GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
STRATEGIC REPORT

Funding Circle Holdings plc | Annual Report and Accounts 2024
124
Consolidated statement of comprehensive income 
for the year ended 31 December 2024 
Note 
31 December 
2024 
Before 
exceptional 
items 
£m 
Exceptional 
items 1 
£m 
31 December 
2024
 £m 
31 December 
2023
 (re-presented) Note 2 
£m 
Transaction fees
85.3
—
85.3
65.3 
Servicing fees
37.5
—
37.5
39.0 
Interest income Note 3 
30.9
—
30.9
15.4 
Other fees
5.2
—
5.2
6.4 
Operating income
158.9
—
158.9
126.1 
Net investment income
2.8
—
2.8
3.6 
Total income
161.7
—
161.7
129.7 
Fair value gains
4.2
—
4.2
3.1 
Cost of funds
(5.8)
—
(5.8)
(2.7) 
Net income Note 4 
5
160.1
—
160.1
130.1 
People costs
4, 6, 7
(68.1)
(2.3)
(70.4)
(65.5) 
Marketing costs
6
(45.6)
—
(45.6)
(37.1) 
Depreciation, amortisation and impairment
4, 5, 6, 10, 11
(13.2)
(0.3)
(13.5)
(12.6) 
Expected credit loss charge
6, 16
(8.6)
—
(8.6)
(4.5) 
Other costs
6
(21.2)
—
(21.2)
(20.3) 
Operating expenses
6
(156.7)
(2.6)
(159.3)
(140.0) 
Profit/(loss) before taxation
5
3.4
(2.6)
0.8
(9.9) 
Income tax (charge)/credit
8
(0.5)
—
(0.5)
1.7 
Profit/(loss) for the year from continuing operations
2.9
(2.6)
0.3
(8.2) 
(Loss)/profit for the year from discontinued operations
3
(10.2)
18.5
8.3
(30.1) 
(Loss)/profit for the year
(7.3)
15.9
8.6
(38.3) 
Other comprehensive expense 
Items that may be reclassified subsequently to profit and loss: 
Exchange differences on translation of foreign operations 
– discontinued operations 
3, 19
(0.2)
(8.7)
(8.9)
(2.7) 
Total comprehensive (expense)/income for the year
(7.5)
7.2
(0.3)
(41.0) 
Total comprehensive income/(expense) attributable to: 
Owners of the Parent 
Income/(expense) from continuing operations
2.9
(2.6)
0.3
(8.2) 
(Expense)/income from discontinued operations
3
(10.4)
9.8
(0.6)
(32.8) 
Total comprehensive (expense)/income attributable to the 
owners of the Parent 
(7.5)
7.2
(0.3)
(41.0) 
Earnings per share 
Basic earnings/(loss) per share from continuing operations 
9
0.8p
0.1p
(2.4)p 
Diluted earnings/(loss) per share from continuing operations 
9
0.8p
0.1p
(2.4)p 
Basic (loss)/earnings per share from discontinued operations
3, 9
(3.0)p
2.4p
(8.7)p 
Diluted (loss)/earnings per share from discontinued operations
3, 9
(3.0)p
2.2p
(8.7)p 
1. Exceptional items are detailed in note 4. 
Note 2.  The comparative consolidated statement of comprehensive income has been re-presented to reflect the results of the US business as a discontinued operation. 
See note 3. 
3. Interest income recognised on assets held at amortised cost under the effective interest rate method and £7.7 million (2023: £5.3 million) on money market  
funds held at fair value through profit and loss. 
4. Net income is also referred to as “revenue”. 
The notes on pages 128 to 179 form part of these financial statements. 
STRATEGIC REPORT
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
CORPORATE GOVERNANCE

Funding Circle Holdings plc | Annual Report and Accounts 2024
125
Consolidated balance sheet 
as at 31 December 2024 
Note 
31 December 
2024 
£m 
31 December 
2023 
(re-presented )1 
£m 
Non-current assets 
Intangible assets
10
21.2
23.0 
Property, plant and equipment
11
9.6
5.0 
Investment in associates
29
0.6
1.5 
Investment in trusts and co-investments
12, 16
17.8
25.2 
SME loans held at amortised cost
12, 16
1.4
5.6 
Trade and other receivables
13
—
1.4 
50.6
61.7 
Current assets 
 
SME loans held at amortised cost
12, 16
0.7
1.1 
SME loans held at fair value through profit and loss
12, 16
1.2
18.6 
Lines of credit
12, 16
97.1
50.0 
Trade and other receivables 
13
20.8
20.4 
Cash and cash equivalents
22
187.6
221.4 
307.4
311.5 
Total assets
358.0
373.2 
Current liabilities 
 
Trade and other payables
14
27.8
54.3 
Bank borrowings
16, 22
101.9
54.7 
Short-term provisions and other liabilities
15
3.6
1.5 
Lease liabilities
11, 22
1.8
7.2 
135.1
117.7 
Non-current liabilities 
 
Long-term provisions and other liabilities
15
0.6
1.1 
Bank borrowings
16, 22
—
2.2 
Lease liabilities
11, 22
5.8
5.4 
Total liabilities
141.5
126.4 
Equity 
 
Share capital
17
0.3
0.4 
Share premium account
18
0.1
293.1 
Foreign exchange reserve
19
5.3
14.2 
Share options reserve
20.6
24.0 
Retained earnings/(accumulated losses)
20
190.2
(84.9) 
Total equity
216.5
246.8 
Total equity and liabilities
358.0
373.2 
1. SME loans have been presented under aggregated headings and the comparative year re-presented in order to simplify the presentation of these loans as the 
balances become less material. Additionally, the comparative SME loans held at amortised cost have been re-presented to more accurately reflect the current 
and non-current split of these loans. See note 1 for details. 
The financial statements on pages 124 to 179 were approved by the Board and authorised for issue on 6 March 2025. 
They were signed on behalf of the Board by: 
Tony Nicol 
Director 
Company registration number 07123934 
The notes on pages 128 to 179 form part of these financial statements.
CORPORATE GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
STRATEGIC REPORT

Funding Circle Holdings plc | Annual Report and Accounts 2024
126
Consolidated statement of changes in equity 
for the year ended 31 December 2024 
Note 
Share 
capital 
£m 
Share 
premium 
account 
£m 
Foreign 
exchange 
reserve 
£m 
Share 
options 
reserve 
£m 
 
(Accumulated 
losses)/
retained 
earnings 
£m 
 
Total 
equity 
£m 
Balance at 1 January 2023
0.4
293.1
16.9
22.2
(48.6)
284.0 
Loss for the year
20
—
—
—
—
(38.3)
(38.3) 
Other comprehensive expense 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Exchange differences on translation 
of foreign operations 
19
—
—
(2.7)
—
—
(2.7) 
Total comprehensive expense
—
—
(2.7)
—
(38.3)
(41.0) 
Transactions with owners 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Transfer of share option costs
20
—
—
—
(3.8)
3.8
— 
Purchase of own shares held in 
Employee Benefit Trust
17. 20
—
—
—
—
(1.8)
(1.8) 
Employee share schemes – 
value of employee services 
21
—
—
—
5.6
—
5.6 
Balance at 31 December 2023
0.4
293.1
14.2
24.0
(84.9)
246.8 
Profit for the year
20 
—
—
—
—
8.6
8.6 
Other comprehensive expense 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Exchange differences on translation 
of foreign operations 
19
—
—
(8.9)
—
—
(8.9) 
Total comprehensive (expense)/income
—
—
(8.9)
—
8.6
(0.3) 
Transactions with owners 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Transfer of share option costs
20
—
—
—
(6.6)
6.6
— 
Buyback and cancellation of own shares
17, 20
(0.1)
—
—
—
(33.6)
(33.7) 
Capital reduction
18, 20
—
(293.5)
—
—
293.5
— 
Issue of share capital/exercise 
of share options
18
—
0.5
—
—
—
0.5 
Employee share schemes – 
value of employee services 
21
—
—
—
3.2
—
3.2 
Balance at 31 December 2024
0.3
0.1
5.3
20.6
190.2
216.5 
The notes on pages 128 to 179 form part of these financial statements.
STRATEGIC REPORT
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
CORPORATE GOVERNANCE

Funding Circle Holdings plc | Annual Report and Accounts 2024
127
Consolidated statement of cash flows 
for the year ended 31 December 2024 
Note 
31 December 
2024 
£m 
31 December 
2023 
(re-presented) 1 
£m 
Net cash outflow from operating activities
22
(67.4)
(25.6) 
Investing activities 
 
 
 
Purchase of intangible assets
10
(9.0)
(11.5) 
Purchase of property, plant and equipment
11
(2.9)
(0.7) 
Originations of SME loans held at amortised cost
16
(0.2)
(4.7) 
Cash receipts from SME loans held at amortised cost 
16
3.0
21.2 
Originations from SME loans held at fair value through profit and loss
16
—
 (11.9) 
Cash receipts from SME loans held at fair value through profit and loss
16
13.5
37.6 
Proceeds from sale of SME loans held at fair value through profit and loss
16
—
30.4 
Investment in trusts and co-investments
16
(4.1)
(1.8) 
Cash receipts from investments in trusts and co-investments
16
14.6
6.6 
Redemption in associates
25, 29
0.9
1.1 
Dividends from associates
25, 29
—
0.1 
Proceeds from sale of subsidiary
3
32.6
— 
Direct costs of selling subsidiary
3
(2.0)
— 
Cash disposed of on sale of subsidiary
3
(23.1)
— 
Net cash inflow from investing activities
 
23.3
66.4 
Financing activities 
 
 
 
Proceeds from bank borrowings
22
52.6
55.8 
Repayment of bank borrowings
22
(6.0)
(20.9) 
Payment of bond liabilities
22
—
(23.4) 
Proceeds from the exercise of share options
18 
0.5
— 
Purchase of own shares
17, 20 
—
(1.8) 
Share buyback
17, 20
(33.7)
— 
Proceeds from subleases
0.4
1.2 
Payment of lease liabilities
22
(3.6)
(7.2) 
Net cash inflow from financing activities
 
10.2
3.7 
Net (decrease)/increase in cash and cash equivalents
 
(33.9)
44.5 
Cash and cash equivalents at the beginning of the year
 
221.4
177.7 
Effect of foreign exchange rate changes
 
0.1
(0.8) 
Cash and cash equivalents at the end of the year
22
187.6
221.4 
1. SME loan-related cash flows have been presented under aggregated headings and the comparative year re-presented. See note 1 for details. 
The notes on pages 128 to 179 form part of these financial statements. 
Cash flows from discontinued operations are shown in note 3.
CORPORATE GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
STRATEGIC REPORT

Funding Circle Holdings plc | Annual Report and Accounts 2024
128
Notes forming part of the consolidated financial statements 
for the year ended 31 December 2024 
1. Material accounting policies 
General information 
Funding Circle Holdings plc (the “Company”) is a public 
company limited by shares, which is listed on the London 
Stock Exchange and is domiciled and incorporated in 
the United Kingdom under the Companies Act 2006 
and registered in England and Wales. The address of its 
registered office is given on page 198. The consolidated 
financial statements of the Group for the year ended 
31 December 2024 comprise the Company and its 
subsidiaries (together referred to as the “Group” and 
individually as “Group entities”). 
The principal activities of the Group and the nature of the 
Group’s operations are as a facilitator of finance for SMEs. 
The principal accounting policies applied in the 
preparation of these financial statements are set out 
below. These policies have been consistently applied to 
all the years presented, unless otherwise stated. 
Going concern 
The Group’s business activities together with the factors 
likely to affect its future development and position are set 
out in the Strategic Report. 
The financial statements are prepared on a going concern 
basis as the Directors are satisfied that the Group has 
the resources to continue in business for the foreseeable 
future (which has been taken as at least 12 months from 
the date of approval of the financial statements). 
The Group made a total comprehensive expense of £0.3 
million during the year ended 31 December 2024 (2023: 
expense of £41.0 million). As at 31 December 2024, the 
Group had net assets of £216.5 million (2023: £246.8 
million). This includes £187.6 million of cash and cash 
equivalents (2023: £221.4 million) of which £37.1 million 
(2023: £51.8 million) is held for specific purposes and 
is restricted in use. Additionally, within the net assets, 
the Group holds £53.5 million (2023: £63.5 million) of 
invested capital, some of which is capable of being 
monetised if liquidity needs arise. 
The Group has prepared detailed cash flow forecasts for 
the next 15 months to 30 June 2026 and has updated 
the going concern assessment to factor in the potential 
ongoing impact of inflation and related economic stress. 
The base case scenario assumes: 
• the economic environment remains as is with 
no improvement or deterioration in the macro 
environment forecast; 
• launching and growing short-term lending and non-
limited company lending; 
• growth in Cashback credit card alongside FlexiPay lines 
of credit; 
• the Group continues to fund the lines of credit through 
its balance sheet along with the senior banking facility; 
• costs are controlled with any growth driven by 
marketing, expected credit losses (“ECL”) and cost 
of funds. Remaining costs grow but predominantly 
through inflation. Strict control of headcount, with 
limited increases; 
• the current share buyback programme concludes in 
early 2025 with no additional buyback or dividend 
assumed; and 
• corporation tax begins to be paid alongside utilising 
brought forward tax losses. 
Management prepared a severe but plausible downside 
scenario in which: 
• further macroeconomic volatility continues through 
the period with elevated inflation and interest rates 
reducing originations as borrower demand for loans 
at higher interest rates reduces and investor funding 
appetite reduces; 
• investment returns reduce owing to increased funding 
costs, widening discount rates and deterioration in 
loan performance; 
• an operational event occurs requiring a cash 
outlay in 2025; 
• a downside loss scenario is applied to Funding Circle’s 
on-balance sheet investment in SME loans resulting in 
higher initial fair value losses and lower cash flows to 
the investments it owns combined with the inability to 
monetise these; 
• a reduction in operating interest income from money 
market funds due to lower cash balances under 
stress; and 
• a combined credit and liquidity risk stress for FlexiPay. 
Management has reviewed its regulatory capital 
requirements. In the downside scenario, the risk of capital 
requirement breach is considered remote. The Group 
does not currently rely on committed or uncommitted 
borrowing facilities, with the exception of a facility for 
the purpose of originating FlexiPay lines of credit and 
does not have undrawn committed borrowing facilities 
available to the wider Group. 
The Directors have made enquiries of management and 
considered budgets and cash flow forecasts for the 
Group and have, at the time of approving these financial 
statements, a reasonable expectation that the Company 
and the Group have adequate resources to continue 
in operational existence for the foreseeable future, 
specifically assessed for the 15 months to 30 June 2026. 
Further detail is contained in the Strategic Report on 
pages 63 and 64.
STRATEGIC REPORT
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
CORPORATE GOVERNANCE

Funding Circle Holdings plc | Annual Report and Accounts 2024
129
1. Material accounting policies continued
Basis of preparation 
The financial statements have been prepared in 
accordance with UK-adopted International Accounting 
Standards in conformity with the requirements of the 
Companies Act 2006 and the disclosure guidance and 
transparency rules sourcebook of the United Kingdom’s 
Financial Conduct Authority. 
The financial statements have been prepared on 
the historical cost basis except for certain financial 
instruments that are carried at fair value through profit 
and loss (“FVTPL”). 
The preparation of financial statements requires the 
use of certain accounting estimates. It also requires 
management to exercise its judgement in the process 
of applying the Group’s accounting policies. Changes 
in assumptions may have a significant impact on the 
financial statements in the year the assumptions changed. 
Management believes that the underlying assumptions 
are appropriate. The areas involving a higher degree of 
judgement or complexity, or areas where assumptions 
and estimates are significant to the financial statements, 
are disclosed in note 2. 
Significant changes in the current reporting year 
The financial position and performance of the Group were 
affected by the following events and transactions during 
the year ended 31 December 2024: 
i) Sale of the US business 
As was previously announced in the 31 December 2023 
financial results, the Group sought to divest of the US 
business. A competitive bid process was undertaken with 
interested parties and a sale agreement was signed on 
24 June 2024 to sell the business to iBusiness Funding, 
LLC and completion occurred on 1 July 2024. As a result 
of the sale of the US Business Unit, the business and 
assets related to the US were considered to form a 
disposal Group under IFRS 5 Non-Current Assets Held 
For Sale and Discontinued Operations. The operations of 
the US business have been disclosed in the consolidated 
statement of comprehensive income separately as 
a discontinued operation, and the comparative year 
restated. Details related to the discontinued operations 
can be found in note 3. 
ii) Simplification and streamlining of UK business 
As part of its ongoing commitment to profitability, the 
Group launched a redundancy and cost efficiency 
programme during the year. Non-recurring costs 
to achieve these changes have been recorded as 
exceptional items. See note 4. 
iii) Launch of share buyback programme 
As was previously announced, the Group commenced 
a share buyback programme in March 2024 to buy and 
cancel up to £25 million of shares in order to return 
value to shareholders. The nominal cost of the shares 
cancelled reduces the Group’s share capital with an 
equal increase in the capital redemption reserve. The full 
cost of the buyback inclusive of stamp duty and broker 
fees is debited to retained earnings. This programme 
was completed on 15 October 2024 with the purchase 
of 27,308,339 ordinary shares, and the programme was 
extended to up to a further £25 million of shares. In the 
year to 31 December 2024, 33.5 million shares were 
purchased for consideration of £33.7 million inclusive of 
fees and expenses under the programme representing 
9.3% of the called up share capital. 0.2 million of the 
purchased shares were pending cancellation as at 31 
December 2024. See notes 17 and 20. 
iv) Capital reduction 
In November 2024, shareholders approved a capital 
reduction at a general meeting held by the Company, 
being the cancellation of the entire amount standing 
to credit the Company’s share premium account. The 
capital reduction process was completed in December 
2024 and resulted in the cancellation of the share 
premium and creation of accumulated profit within the 
statement of changes in equity by £293.5 million. This 
increased the distributable reserves of the Company to help 
facilitate ongoing capital actions and return of value to 
shareholders. See notes 18 and 20. 
v) Modification to UK office lease 
During February 2024, the Group signed an agreement 
to modify the terms of its lease on the two levels of the 
UK office previously expiring in March 2025, shortening 
one to expire in June 2024 and extending the other to 
March 2035 with termination options in March 2030. Both 
were accounted for as a lease modification. See note 11 
for details. 
vi) Investment in trust and co-investment transactions 
During the year, certain warehouses invested in trusts in 
which Funding Circle is a minority co-investor sold their 
loan assets to a third party and Funding Circle partially 
re-invested alongside the purchaser. As a result of the 
transaction, the net cash flows from the investment were 
realised and a net fair value gain of £2.2 million was 
recognised through fair value gains in the consolidated 
statement of comprehensive income. The cash flows related 
to the transaction are presented net within “Cash receipts 
from investment in trusts and co-investments” in the statement 
of cash flows, reflecting the net settlement of the realisation 
and re-investment. See note 16.
CORPORATE GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
STRATEGIC REPORT

Funding Circle Holdings plc | Annual Report and Accounts 2024
130
Notes forming part of the consolidated financial statements continued
for the year ended 31 December 2024
1. Material accounting policies continued
Significant changes in the current reporting year 
continued
vii) Launch of Cashback business credit card 
During the year the Cashback credit card product was 
launched offering borrowers the ability to spend against 
their credit limit and earn cashback on this spend with 
an introductory rate of 2% reducing to 1% after six 
months. The borrowers qualify for cashback if they 
either repay the card spend in full, or make a minimum 
repayment by their billing date. Borrowers who repay 
the balance in full do not incur interest charges, while 
any borrowers who do not pay the card spend balance 
in full will be charged interest on the drawn balance. 
The cashback is netted against the borrowers’ card 
spend balance due. The Group recognises interchange 
fee income on the card spend of c.1.75% recognised 
in transaction fee income. £0.3 million of interchange 
fee income (2023: £nil) was recognised during the year 
gross of cashback. The cashback paid to the borrower is 
recognised as a reduction in the transaction price under 
IFRS 15 as it is cash settled in nature and is presented 
netted against the interchange fee income, while interest 
earned on card balances which revolve is recognised 
within interest income in the consolidated statement of 
comprehensive income. 
Changes in accounting policy and disclosures 
The Group has adopted the following new and amended 
IFRSs and interpretations from 1 January 2024. 
Standard/interpretation
Content 
Applicable for 
financial years
 beginning 
on/after 
Amendments to IAS 1 – 
Classification of Liabilities 
as Current or Non-current 
Presentation of 
financial 
statements 
1 January 
2024 
Amendments to IAS 1 – 
Non-current Liabilities with 
Covenants 
 
Presentation of 
financial 
statements 
1 January 
2024 
Amendments to IAS 12 – 
International Tax Reform – 
Pillar Two Model Rules 
Tax
1 January 
2024 
IFRS 1 General 
Requirements for Disclosure 
of Sustainability-related 
Financial Information 
Sustainability 
disclosures 
1 January 
2024 
IFRS S2 Climate-related 
Disclosures 
Sustainability 
disclosures 
1 January 
2024 
Amendments to IAS 7 and 
IFRS 7 – Supplier Finance 
Arrangements 
Financial 
instruments 
1 January 
2024 
Amendments to IFRS 16 – 
Lease Liability in a Sale and 
Leaseback 
Leases
1 January 
2024 
The amendments and interpretations listed above did not 
materially affect the current year and are not expected to 
materially affect future years. 
Certain new accounting standards and interpretations 
have been published that are not mandatory for 31 
December 2024 reporting years and have not been early 
adopted by the Group as follows: 
Standard/interpretation
Content 
Applicable for 
financial years
 beginning 
on/after 
Amendments to IAS 21 – 
Lack of Exchangeability 
Foreign 
exchange rates 
1 January
 2025 
Amendment to IFRS 9 and 
IFRS 7 – Classification and 
Measurement of Financial 
Instruments 
Financial 
instruments 
1 January
 2026 
IFRS 18 Presentation and 
Disclosure in Financial 
Statements 
Financial 
statements 
disclosures 
1 January
 2027 
IFRS 19 Subsidiaries without 
Public Accountability: 
Disclosures 
Financial 
statements 
disclosures 
1 January
 2027 
With the exception of IFRS 18, these standards are not 
expected to have a material impact on the Group in 
the current or future reporting years or on foreseeable 
future transactions. 
IFRS 18 was issued in April 2024 and is effective for 
periods beginning on or after 1 January 2027. Early 
application is permitted and comparatives will require 
restatement. The standard will replace IAS 1 Presentation 
of Financial Statements. It will not change how items are 
recognised and measured but will focus on the income 
statement and reporting of financial performance, 
specifically, classifying income and expenses into three 
new defined categories – “operating”, “investing” and 
“financing”, and two new subtotals – “operating profit 
and loss” and “profit or loss before financing and income 
tax”, introducing disclosures of management defined 
performance measures (“MPMs”) and enhancing general 
requirements on aggregation and disaggregation. The 
impact of the standard is yet to be fully assessed by 
the Group. 
Summary of new and amended accounting policies 
Re-presentation of SME loans: 
On the balance sheet “SME loans (securitised)”, “SME 
loans (warehouse)” and “SME loans (other)” held at fair 
value through profit and loss have been presented under 
“SME loans held at fair value through profit and loss” and 
“SME loans (other)” held at amortised cost have been 
presented under “SME loans held at amortised cost” in 
order to simplify the presentation of these loans as the 
balances become less material with the comparative 
year re-presented on this basis. Additionally, the current 
and non-current split of SME loans held at amortised 
cost has been re-presented to more accurately reflect 
when the cash flows become due. This presentation and 
re-presentation has been applied to the applicable notes 
and cash flow statement throughout these accounts.
STRATEGIC REPORT
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
CORPORATE GOVERNANCE

Funding Circle Holdings plc | Annual Report and Accounts 2024
131
1. Material accounting policies continued
Discontinued operations and deconsolidation 
When the Group intends to sell assets or Business 
Units, IFRS 5 Non-current Assets Held for Sale and 
Discontinued Operations, is applied. An asset or group 
of assets is treated as a discontinued operation if: 
• it is available for immediate sale in its present condition; 
• the sale is highly probable, with management 
committed to a plan to sell the asset and an active 
programme to locate a buyer initiated; and 
• the sale is expected to be completed within 1 year of 
classification as held for sale. 
Where these criteria are met, the assets in the disposal 
group are measured at the lower of fair value less cost 
to sell and their carrying value at the point they are 
considered to meet the criteria. The results from the 
discontinued operations are presented separately in the 
consolidated statement of comprehensive income with 
the comparative year restated on a like-for-like basis. 
Where a Business Unit of the Group is held as a 
discontinued operation with the intention of selling it, 
it will remain consolidated for as long as the criteria for 
control as defined by IFRS 10 Consolidated Financial 
Statements, are met. All three of these criteria must be 
met in order to control an entity: 
• power over the investee; 
• exposure, or rights, to variable returns from its 
involvement with the investee; and 
• the ability to use its power over the investee to affect 
the amount of the investor’s returns. 
While an agreement might be signed to sell the 
operation, if the Group continues to meet the criteria 
for control between signing and closing the transaction, 
deconsolidation will only occur on closing once the 
criteria are no longer met. 
Share buybacks 
Shares purchased and cancelled by the Group as part 
of the share buyback programme reduce the equity 
of the Group, but are anti-dilutive and return value to 
shareholders when calculating earnings per share. The 
nominal cost of the shares purchased and cancelled is 
treated as a reduction in share capital with an offsetting 
increase in the capital redemption reserve. The capital 
redemption reserve is a non-distributable reserve 
which can be used to pay up new shares allotted as 
fully paid bonus shares. The cost of the share purchase 
inclusive of stamp duty and broker fees is debited to 
retained earnings. 
Cashback credit card accounting 
Cashback offered on products issued by the Group is 
considered to fall under IFRS 15 where it is contractually 
linked to card spend where an interchange fee is 
generated at the point of spend. Where the cashback 
reward to the borrower is cash settled or netted against 
an outstanding balance due from the customer, it is 
treated as a reduction in the transaction price under 
IFRS 15 and there is no ongoing performance obligation 
beyond the card transaction with interchange fee income 
recognised net of the cashback granted. The cashback 
rewards programme does not currently offer borrowers 
the option to exchange their cashback reward for other 
non-cash goods or services. Where borrowers do not 
repay the full balance due on their card and choose to 
revolve an element of it, interest income is recognised 
under IFRS 9 on the interest charged. 
Summary of existing accounting policies 
Basis of consolidation 
Where the Group has control over an investee, it is 
classified as a subsidiary. The Group controls an investee 
if all three of the following elements are present: power 
over the investee, exposure to variable returns from the 
investee, and the ability of the investor to use its power 
to affect those variable returns. Control is reassessed 
whenever facts and circumstances indicate that there 
may be a change in any of these elements of control. 
Structured entities are entities that are designed so 
that their activities are not governed by voting rights. 
In assessing whether the Group has power over such 
entities, the Group considers factors such as the purpose 
and design of the entity, its practical ability to direct 
the relevant activities of the entity, the nature of the 
relationship with the entity, and the size of its exposure 
to the variability of returns of the entity. 
The consolidated financial statements present the results 
of the Company and its subsidiaries as if they formed a 
single entity. Intercompany transactions and balances 
between Group companies are therefore eliminated in full. 
The Group applies the acquisition method to account 
for business combinations. In the consolidated balance 
sheet, the acquiree’s identifiable assets, liabilities and 
contingent liabilities are initially recognised at their fair 
values at the acquisition date. Acquisition-related costs 
are recognised in profit or loss as incurred. The results 
of acquired operations are included in the consolidated 
statement of comprehensive income from the date on 
which control is obtained. They are deconsolidated from 
the date on which control ceases. 
Foreign currency translation 
Transactions entered into by Group entities in a currency 
other than the currency of the primary economic environment 
in which they operate (their “functional currency”) are 
recorded at the rates ruling when the transactions occur. 
Foreign currency monetary assets and liabilities are 
translated at the prevailing rate at the reporting date. 
Exchange differences arising on the retranslation of 
unsettled monetary assets and liabilities are recognised 
immediately in profit or loss.
CORPORATE GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
STRATEGIC REPORT

Funding Circle Holdings plc | Annual Report and Accounts 2024
132
Notes forming part of the consolidated financial statements continued
for the year ended 31 December 2024
1. Material accounting policies continued
Foreign currency translation continued
On disposal of a foreign operation, the cumulative 
exchange differences recognised in the foreign exchange 
reserve relating to that operation up to the date of 
disposal are transferred to the consolidated statement 
of comprehensive income as part of the profit or loss 
on disposal. 
Presentation currency 
These consolidated financial statements are presented in 
GBP sterling, which is the Group’s presentation currency. 
All assets and liabilities of overseas operations, including 
goodwill arising on the acquisition of those operations, 
are translated at the prevailing rate at the reporting date. 
Income and expense items are translated at the average 
exchange rates for the year, unless exchange rates 
fluctuate significantly during that year, in which case 
the exchange rates at the date of transactions are used. 
Exchange differences arising are recognised in other 
comprehensive income and accumulated in equity. 
Goodwill and fair value adjustments arising on the 
acquisition of a foreign entity are treated as assets 
and liabilities of the foreign entity and translated at 
the prevailing rate at the reporting date. 
Segment reporting 
Operating segments are reported in the manner consistent 
with the internal reporting provided to the chief operating 
decision maker (“CODM”). The CODM, which is the function 
responsible for allocating resources and assessing 
performance of the operating segments, has been 
identified as the Executive Committee (“ExCo”), formerly 
known as the Global Leadership Team (“GLT”), that 
makes strategic decisions. For each identified operating 
segment, the Group has disclosed information for the key 
performance indicators that are assessed internally to 
review and steer performance in the Strategic Report. 
Transactions between segments are on an arm’s 
length basis in a manner similar to transactions with 
third parties. 
Exceptional items 
Exceptional items are the items of income or expense 
that the Group considers are material, one-off in nature 
and of such significance that they merit separate 
presentation in order to aid the reader’s understanding 
of the Group’s financial performance. Such items would 
include profits or losses on disposal of businesses, 
transaction costs, acquisitions and disposals, major 
restructuring programmes, significant goodwill or other 
asset impairments, and other particularly significant or 
unusual items. 
Income recognition 
Fee income is recognised in line with IFRS 15 which provides 
a single, principles-based five-step model to be applied 
to all contracts with customers: 
1) identify the contract with the customer; 
2) identify the performance obligations in the contract; 
3) determine the transaction price; 
4)  allocate the transaction price to the performance 
obligations in the contracts, on a relative stand-alone 
selling price basis; and 
5)  recognise income when (or as) the entity satisfies 
its performance obligation. 
Fee income earned for the arrangement of loans is 
classified as transaction fees. The contract signed by 
the borrower and related terms are clearly identifiable. 
The performance obligation in the contract is considered 
to be the funding of the loan through the platform and 
the transaction price is clearly stated in the borrower’s 
contract. Fees are recognised immediately once loans 
are fully funded and after the loans are accepted by the 
borrowers. At this point the performance obligation has 
been met, there are no clawback provisions and the fee 
is recognised. Such fees are automatically deducted from 
the amount borrowed. 
Fee income earned from referrals to partner institutions 
is classified as transaction fees. There are contracts in 
place with partner institutions with clearly identifiable 
terms. The performance obligation in the contract 
is considered to be the referral by the Group and 
subsequent funding of the referred loan by the partner 
institution and the transaction price is clearly stated in 
the referral agreement. Fees are recognised once the 
referred loan has been funded by the partner institution 
and accepted by the referred borrower. At this point, the 
performance obligation has been met and there are no 
significant clawback provisions. 
Fee income earned from servicing third party loans is 
classified as servicing fees and is a cost of the investor, 
except in the case of the first year of servicing fees 
related to CBILS loans, where the government paid 
the cost. It comprises an annualised fee representing 
a percentage of outstanding principal. The contractual 
basis for the servicing fee and transaction price is based 
on the terms and conditions agreed by investors to the 
lending platform. The performance obligation is servicing 
the loans and allocating repayments of the loan parts to 
the respective lenders. The transaction price is allocated 
as a percentage of the outstanding principal balance, 
representing the outstanding performance obligation. 
Fees are recognised on a monthly basis upon repayment 
of loan parts. Due to the conditions of the loans, there 
are no partially completed contracts at the balance sheet 
date and no advance payments from customers. 
Fee income earned from interchange fees from 
FlexiPay card and Cashback credit card is classified as 
a transaction fee. Foreign exchange fees earned from 
FlexiPay card are classified as other fees and are a cost 
to the FlexiPay card borrower. A contract is in place with 
the card provider who remits the fee revenues to the 
Group. Card fees are recognised immediately at the point 
of transaction as at this point the performance obligation 
STRATEGIC REPORT
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
CORPORATE GOVERNANCE

Funding Circle Holdings plc | Annual Report and Accounts 2024
133
1. Material accounting policies continued
Income recognition continued
has been met. Borrowers using their card will “flip” the 
balance into a FlexiPay loan repayable over three months 
and for a fee. The fee incurred by borrowers who flip the 
card balance into a loan is recognised under IFRS 9 from 
the point of the flip over the life of the loan under the 
effective interest rate method and is recognised under 
interest income. 
Other fees includes income from collections charges 
levied on the successful recovery of defaulted loans. 
These are recognised as services are performed or 
performance obligations are met. It also includes 
performance-related fees related to the loans held by 
certain institutional investors. 
Net income includes the following elements under 
which the recognition criteria of IFRS 9 and not IFRS 15 
are applied: 
Interest income includes: 
• interest income recognised on assets held at amortised 
cost under the effective interest rate method including 
fees incurred on FlexiPay drawdowns and FlexiPay card 
“flipped” balances, and interest charged on Cashback 
credit card drawn balances and interest income on 
corporate cash and client monies held. It also includes 
interest income on money market funds held at fair 
value through profit and loss. 
Investment income includes: 
• interest income from SME loans and investments in 
trusts that the Group holds on balance sheet. 
Fair value gains/losses includes: 
• gains/losses from changes in the fair value of financial 
assets and liabilities held on balance sheet. 
Cost of funds includes: 
• interest payable on funds borrowed to finance the 
issuing of lines of credit. 
Net income recorded in the financial statements is 
generated in the UK, Germany and the Netherlands. All 
fees are recognised and measured based on the above 
income recognition policy. 
Administrative expenses 
Administrative expenses are recognised as an expense in 
the statement of comprehensive income in the period in 
which they are incurred on an accruals basis. 
Share-based payments 
The Group operates a number of equity-settled 
share-based compensation plans, under which the Group 
receives services from employees as consideration for 
equity instruments (options and shares) of the Company. 
The fair value of the employee services received in 
exchange for the grant of the options and shares is 
recognised as an expense. The total amount to be expensed 
is determined by reference to the fair value of the options 
and shares granted: 
• including any market performance conditions 
(for example, an entity’s share price); 
• excluding the impact of any service and non-market 
performance vesting conditions (for example, net 
income, earnings per share and remaining an employee 
of the Group over a specified time period); and 
• including the impact of any non-vesting conditions 
(for example, the requirement for employees to save). 
Non-market vesting conditions are included in 
assumptions about the number of options and shares that 
are expected to vest. The total expense is recognised 
over the vesting period, which is the period over which 
all of the specified vesting conditions are to be satisfied. 
At the end of each reporting period, the Group revises 
its estimate of the number of options and shares that 
are expected to vest based on the non-market vesting 
conditions. It recognises the impact of the revision to 
original estimates, if any, in the income statement, with 
a corresponding adjustment to equity. 
When the options are exercised, the Company issues 
new shares or utilises shares that have been purchased 
in the market. The proceeds received net of any directly 
attributable transaction costs are credited to share 
capital (nominal value) and share premium when the 
options are exercised. The original fair value of the 
amount exercised is transferred from the share option 
reserve to the accumulated losses reserve. 
The grant by the Company of options and shares over 
its equity instruments to the employees of subsidiary 
undertakings in the Group is treated as a capital 
contribution. The fair value of employee services 
received, measured by reference to the grant date 
fair value, is recognised over the vesting period as an 
increase in investment in subsidiary undertakings, with 
a corresponding credit to equity in the Parent entity 
(the “Company”) accounts. 
Pension obligations 
The Group operates a defined contribution pension 
scheme for employees in the UK and the US. The 
schemes are pension plans under which the Group pays 
fixed contributions into a separate entity. The Group 
has no legal or constructive obligations to pay further 
contributions if the fund does not hold sufficient assets 
to pay all employees the benefits relating to employee 
service in the current and prior years. Contributions 
payable to the Group’s pension scheme are charged to 
the statement of comprehensive income in the year to 
which they relate. The Group has no further payment 
obligations once the contributions have been paid.
CORPORATE GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
STRATEGIC REPORT

Funding Circle Holdings plc | Annual Report and Accounts 2024
134
Notes forming part of the consolidated financial statements continued
for the year ended 31 December 2024
1. Material accounting policies continued
Current and deferred tax 
The tax expense for the year comprises current and 
deferred tax. Current tax is provided at amounts expected 
to be paid (or recovered) using the tax rates and laws 
that have been enacted or substantively enacted by the 
balance sheet date in the countries where the Company 
and its subsidiaries operate and generate taxable income. 
Management periodically evaluates positions taken in tax 
returns with respect to situations in which applicable tax 
regulation is subject to interpretation. 
The Group has established transfer pricing policies and 
there are mechanisms in place that ensure subsidiaries 
are remunerated appropriately on an arm’s length basis 
for services provided. It establishes provisions, where 
appropriate, based on amounts expected to be paid to 
the tax authorities. 
Deferred tax assets for unused tax losses, tax credits and 
deductible temporary differences are recognised to the 
extent that it is probable that future taxable profit will be 
available against which the temporary differences can 
be utilised. 
Deferred tax assets are recognised on deductible 
temporary differences arising from investments in 
subsidiaries, associates and joint arrangements only to 
the extent that it is probable the temporary difference will 
reverse in the future and there is sufficient taxable profit 
available against which the temporary difference can 
be utilised. 
Deferred tax liabilities are provided on taxable temporary 
differences arising from investments in subsidiaries, 
associates and joint arrangements, except for any 
deferred tax liability where the timing of the reversal of 
the temporary difference is controlled by the Group and it 
is probable that the temporary difference will not reverse 
in the foreseeable future. 
Deferred tax assets and liabilities are offset when there 
is a legally enforceable right to offset current tax assets 
against current tax liabilities and when the deferred tax 
assets and liabilities relate to income taxes levied by the 
same taxation authority on either the same taxable entity 
or different taxable entities and there is an intention to 
settle the balances on a net basis. 
Deferred income tax is provided in full, using the liability 
method, on temporary differences arising between the 
tax bases of assets and liabilities and their carrying 
amounts in the financial statements. However, deferred 
tax is not accounted for if it arises from initial recognition 
of an asset or liability in a transaction other than a 
business combination that at the time of the transaction 
affects neither accounting nor taxable profit or loss. 
Deferred tax is determined using tax rates and laws 
that have been enacted or substantively enacted at the 
year-end date and are expected to apply when the related 
deferred tax asset is realised or the deferred tax liability is 
settled. Deferred tax balances are not discounted. 
Dividends 
Dividends are recognised when they become legally 
payable, in accordance with the Companies Act 2006. 
Intangible assets 
Intangible assets with finite useful lives are amortised 
on a straight-line basis over their estimated useful lives. 
Useful lives and amortisation methods are reviewed 
at the end of each annual reporting period, or more 
frequently when there is an indication that the intangible 
asset may be impaired, with the effect of any changes 
accounted for on a prospective basis. Amortisation 
commences when the intangible asset is available for 
use. The residual value of intangible assets is assumed 
to be zero. 
Computer software licences 
Acquired computer software licences are capitalised on 
the basis of the costs incurred to acquire and bring to 
use the specific software. These costs are amortised 
over the licence period, which is up to five years as at 
31 December 2024. 
Capitalised development costs 
Costs associated with maintaining computer software 
programs are recognised as an expense as incurred. 
Development costs that are directly attributable 
to the design, build and testing of identifiable and 
unique software products controlled by the Group are 
recognised as intangible assets when the following 
criteria are met: 
• it is technically feasible to complete the build of the 
platform products so that they will be available for use; 
• management intends to complete the build of the 
platform products for use within the Group; 
• there is an ability to use the platform products; 
• it can be demonstrated how the platform products will 
generate probable future economic benefits; 
• adequate technical, financial and other resources to 
complete the development and to use the platform 
products are available; and 
• the expenditure attributable to the platform products 
during its development can be reliably measured. 
Directly attributable costs that are capitalised as part of 
the software product include the software development 
employee and contractor costs. The capitalisation 
of employee costs is based on the amount of time 
spent on specific projects which meet the criteria as 
a proportion of their total time, and this proportion 
of their salary-related costs is attributed to the 
applicable projects. 
Other development expenditure that does not meet 
these criteria is recognised as an expense as incurred. 
Development costs previously recognised as an expense 
are not recognised as an asset in a subsequent period. 
STRATEGIC REPORT
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
CORPORATE GOVERNANCE

Funding Circle Holdings plc | Annual Report and Accounts 2024
135
1. Material accounting policies continued
Intangible assets continued
Capitalised development costs continued
Capitalised development costs are recorded as intangible 
assets and amortised from the point at which the asset 
is ready for use over their estimated useful lives, ranging 
from three to five years. 
Other intangibles 
Other intangibles relate to the technology platform 
and customer relationship (representing fees due 
on contracted loans expected to be realised in the 
foreseeable future) acquired on a business combination. 
These costs are amortised over their estimated useful 
lives, which do not exceed three years. 
Tangible fixed assets 
Tangible fixed assets are stated at cost less depreciation 
and any provision for impairment. Depreciation is provided 
on all tangible fixed assets, at rates calculated to write off 
the cost less estimated residual value of each asset on a 
straight-line basis over its expected useful life, as follows: 
Computer equipment 
1–3 years 
Furniture and fixtures 
3–5 years 
Leasehold improvements that qualify for recognition 
as an asset are measured at cost and are presented as 
part of property, plant and equipment in the non-current 
assets section on the balance sheet. Depreciation 
on leasehold improvements is calculated using the 
straight-line method over the lease term. 
Impairment of tangible and intangible assets 
Intangible assets that have an indefinite useful life or 
intangible assets not ready to use are not subject to 
amortisation and are tested annually for impairment. 
Assets that are subject to amortisation are reviewed 
for impairment whenever events or changes in 
circumstances indicate that the carrying amount may not 
be recoverable. An impairment loss is recognised for the 
amount by which the asset’s carrying amount exceeds its 
recoverable amount. 
Recoverable amount is the higher of fair value less 
costs to sell and value in use. In assessing value in use, 
the estimated future cash flows are discounted to their 
present value using a pre-tax discount rate that reflects 
current market assessments of the time value of money 
and the risks specific to the asset for which the estimates 
of future cash flows have not been adjusted. 
If the recoverable amount of an asset (or CGU) is 
estimated to be less than its carrying amount, the 
carrying amount of the asset (or CGU) is reduced to its 
recoverable amount. An impairment loss is recognised 
immediately in the statement of comprehensive income. 
A previously recognised impairment loss is reversed 
only if there has been a change in the estimates used to 
determine the asset’s recoverable amount since the last 
impairment loss was recognised. If this was the case, 
the carrying amount of the asset (or CGU) is increased 
to the revised estimate of its recoverable amount, but 
so that the increased carrying amount does not exceed 
the carrying amount that would have been determined 
had no impairment loss been recognised for the asset (or 
CGU) in prior years. A reversal of an impairment loss is 
recognised immediately in profit or loss. 
Leases 
At inception of a contract, the Group assesses whether 
or not a contract is, or contains, a lease. A contract is, 
or contains, a lease if the contract conveys the right 
to control the use of an identified asset for a period 
of time in exchange for consideration. When a lease 
is recognised in a contract the Group recognises a 
right-of-use asset and a lease liability at the lease 
commencement date. 
Right-of-use assets are initially measured at cost, 
comprising the initial measurement of the lease liability, 
less any lease incentives. Subsequently, right-of-use 
assets are measured at cost, less any accumulated 
depreciation and any accumulated impairment losses, 
and are adjusted for certain remeasurements of the lease 
liability. Depreciation is calculated on a straight-line basis 
over the length of the lease. 
Liabilities arising from a lease are initially measured on 
a present value basis. Lease liabilities include the net 
present value of the following lease payments: 
• fixed payments less any lease incentives receivable; 
• variable lease payments based on an index or a 
rate, initially measured using the index or rate at the 
commencement date; and 
• amounts expected to be payable by the Group under 
residual value guarantee. 
The lease payments are discounted using the interest 
rate implicit in the lease. If that rate cannot be readily 
determined, the Group’s incremental borrowing rate is 
used, which is the rate that the Group would have to 
pay to borrow the funds necessary to obtain an asset 
of similar value to the right-of-use asset in a similar 
economic environment with similar terms, security 
and conditions. 
To determine the incremental borrowing rate, the Group: 
• where possible, uses recent third party financing 
received by the individual lessee as a starting point, 
adjusted to reflect changes in financing conditions 
since third party financing was received; 
• uses an approach taking the risk-free interest rate 
adjusted for credit risk for leases held by Funding Circle 
Holdings plc; and 
• makes adjustments specific to the lease for term, 
country and currency.
CORPORATE GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
STRATEGIC REPORT

Funding Circle Holdings plc | Annual Report and Accounts 2024
136
Notes forming part of the consolidated financial statements continued
for the year ended 31 December 2024
1. Material accounting policies continued
Leases continued
Subsequently, the lease liability is measured by 
increasing the carrying amount to reflect interest on 
the lease liability and reducing it by the lease payments 
made. The lease liability and right-of-use asset are 
remeasured when there is a lease modification. 
Lease payments are allocated between principal and 
finance cost. The finance cost is charged to profit or 
loss over the lease period so as to produce a constant 
periodic rate of interest on the remaining balance of the 
liability for each period. 
The Group is exposed to potential future increases in 
variable lease payments based on an index or rate, which 
are not included in the lease liability until they take effect. 
When adjustments to lease payments based on an index 
or rate take effect, the lease liability is reassessed and 
adjusted against the right-of-use asset. 
Extension and termination options are included in a 
number of property leases in the Group. Management 
considers the facts and circumstances that may create 
an economic incentive to exercise an extension or 
termination option in order to determine whether the 
lease term should include or exclude such options. 
Extension or termination options are only included 
within the lease term if they are reasonably certain to 
be exercised in the case of extension options and not 
exercised in the case of termination options. 
Considerations include: 
• if leasehold improvements are expected to have 
significant value at the end of the lease term; 
• expected costs or business disruption as a result of 
replacing a lease; and 
• significant penalties incurred in order to terminate. 
Lease terms are reassessed if the option is exercised or if 
a significant event occurs which impacts the assessment 
of reasonable certainty. 
The Group applies the short-term lease recognition 
exemption to its short-term leases of machinery and 
equipment (i.e. those leases that have a lease term of 
12 months or less from the commencement date and do 
not contain a purchase option). It also applies the lease 
of low value assets recognition exemption to leases of 
office equipment that are considered of low value. Lease 
payments on short-term leases and leases of low value 
assets are recognised as expenses on a straight-line 
basis over the lease term. 
When the Group is an intermediate lessor, entering into a 
sublease, it accounts for the head lease and the sublease 
separately. The sublease is classified as a finance or 
operating lease by reference to the right-of-use asset 
arising from the head lease. Rental income from operating 
leases is recognised on a straight-line basis over the 
lease term and the Group retains the right-of-use asset 
deriving from the head lease and the lease liability on the 
balance sheet. 
Amounts due from lessees under finance leases are 
recognised as receivables equivalent to the Group’s 
net investment in the lease and the right-of-use asset 
from the head lease is derecognised. Any difference 
resulting from the derecognition of the right-of-use 
asset and recognition of the net investment in the 
sublease is recognised in the consolidated statement of 
comprehensive income. The head lease liability remains 
on the balance sheet and interest expense continues to 
be recognised, while interest income is recognised from 
the sublease. 
Consolidation of special purpose vehicles (“SPVs”) 
Subsidiaries are those entities, including structured 
vehicles, over which the Group has control. The Group 
controls an entity when it is exposed, or has rights, to 
variable returns from its involvement with the entity and 
has the ability to affect those returns through its power 
over the investee. The Group has power over an entity 
when it has existing rights that give it the current ability 
to direct the activities that most significantly affect the 
entity’s returns. Power may be determined on the basis 
of voting rights or, in the case of structured entities, other 
contractual arrangements. 
The Group assesses whether it controls SPVs and the 
requirement to consolidate them under the criteria of 
IFRS 10. Control is determined to exist if the Group has 
the power to direct the activities of each entity (for 
example, managing the performance of the underlying 
assets and raising debt on those assets which is used to 
fund the Group) and uses this control to obtain a variable 
return (for example, retaining the residual risk on the 
assets). Structures that do not meet these criteria are not 
treated as subsidiaries and the assets are derecognised 
when the rights to the cash flows have ended. 
Where the Group manages the administration of its 
securitised assets and is exposed to the risks and 
rewards of the underlying assets through its continued 
investment or where the Group does not retain a direct 
ownership interest in an SPE, but the Directors have 
determined that the Group controls those entities 
based on the criteria of IFRS 10, they are treated as 
subsidiaries and are consolidated. See note 29 for details 
of these entities. 
Investment in associates 
An associate is an entity over which the Group has 
significant influence. Significant influence is the power to 
participate in the financial and operating policy decisions 
of the investee, but is not control or joint control over 
those policies. The considerations made in determining 
significant influence or joint control are similar to those 
necessary to determine control over subsidiaries. The 
Group’s investment in its associate is accounted for using 
the equity method. 
STRATEGIC REPORT
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
CORPORATE GOVERNANCE

Funding Circle Holdings plc | Annual Report and Accounts 2024
137
1. Material accounting policies continued
Investment in associates continued
Under the equity method of accounting, the investments 
are initially recognised at cost. This is adjusted thereafter 
to recognise the Group’s share of the post-acquisition 
profits or losses of the investee in the consolidated 
statement of comprehensive income. The Group’s share 
of movements in other comprehensive income of the 
investee is recognised in other comprehensive income. 
Dividends received or receivable from associates are 
recognised as a reduction in the carrying amount of 
the investment. 
When the Group’s share of losses in an equity-accounted 
investment equals or exceeds its interest in the entity, 
including any other unsecured long-term receivables, the 
Group does not recognise further losses, unless it has 
incurred obligations or made payments on behalf of the 
other entity. 
Unrealised gains on transactions between the Group and 
its associates are eliminated to the extent of the Group’s 
interest in these entities. Unrealised losses are also 
eliminated unless the transaction provides evidence of an 
impairment of the asset transferred. 
After application of the equity method, the Group 
determines whether it is necessary to recognise an 
impairment loss on its investment in its associate. At 
each reporting date, the Group determines whether 
there is an indication that the investment in the associate 
is impaired. If there is such an indication, the Group 
calculates the amount of impairment as the difference 
between the recoverable amount of the associate and its 
carrying value, and then recognises the loss within the 
statement of comprehensive income. 
Upon loss of significant influence over the associate, 
the Group measures and recognises any retained 
investment at its fair value. Any difference between the 
carrying amount of the associate upon loss of significant 
influence or joint control and the fair value of the retained 
investment and proceeds from disposal is recognised in 
profit or loss. 
Financial instruments 
Financial assets 
The Group determines the classification of its financial 
assets at initial recognition. The requirements of IFRS 
9 for classification and subsequent measurement are 
applied, which require financial assets to be classified 
based on the Group’s business model for managing the 
asset and the contractual cash flow characteristics of 
the asset: 
• financial assets are measured at amortised cost if 
they are held within a business model, the objective 
of which is to hold financial assets in order to collect 
contractual cash flows, and their contractual cash flows 
represent solely payments of principal and interest; 
• financial assets are measured at fair value through 
other comprehensive income (“FVTOCI”) if they are 
held within the business model defined as ”held to 
collect and sell”, the objective of which is achieved 
by both collecting contractual cash flows and selling 
financial assets, and their contractual cash flows 
represent solely payments of principal and interest; and 
• financial assets that do not meet the criteria to be 
amortised cost or FVTOCI are measured at fair value 
through profit or loss (“FVTPL”). In addition, the 
Group may, at initial recognition, designate a financial 
asset as measured at FVTPL if doing so eliminates or 
significantly reduces an accounting mismatch. 
When financial assets are recognised initially, they are 
measured at fair value, plus, in the case of investments 
not at fair value through profit or loss, directly attributable 
transaction costs. The purchase of any credit-impaired 
assets is also at fair value after any impairment. 
Except for certain investments in SME loans as described 
below, the Group does not recognise on its balance sheet 
loans arranged between borrowers and investors as it is 
not a principal party to the contracts and is not exposed 
to the risks and rewards of these loans. 
With the exception of investment in trusts and co-
investments and SME loans held at fair value through 
profit and loss, all financial assets are held to collect 
contractual cash flows. 
The four types of SME loans held are as follows: 
i) SME loans held at fair value through profit and loss 
During the securitisation programmes previously run 
by the Group, SME loans were originated in leveraged 
warehouse vehicles and subsequently sold into 
securitisation SPVs. By 31 December 2023 the warehouse 
vehicles had been repaid and the securitisation vehicles 
unwound with the loans of the vehicles purchased and 
directly held by subsidiaries of the Group and remaining 
bond liabilities were repaid. These SME loans have been 
classified as financial assets at fair value through profit 
or loss because all such loans are acquired principally 
for selling in the short-term and the collection of interest 
is incidental. Additionally this category includes loans 
temporarily funded by the Group which are classified as 
financial assets at fair value through profit or loss and 
are held with the intention of selling on to investors. They 
are initially measured at fair value on the balance sheet 
with the subsequent measurement at fair value with all 
gains and losses being recognised in the consolidated 
statement of comprehensive income.
CORPORATE GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
STRATEGIC REPORT

Funding Circle Holdings plc | Annual Report and Accounts 2024
138
Notes forming part of the consolidated financial statements continued
for the year ended 31 December 2024
1. Material accounting policies continued
Financial instruments continued
Financial assets continued
ii) SME loans held at amortised cost 
The Group had originated PPP loans using the SBA’s 
PPPLF facility and these were held on balance sheet. 
Additionally, the Group holds investments in certain SME 
business loans as a result of commercial arrangements 
with institutional investors and in certain circumstances 
the Group also buys back loans from investors. 
These loans are included in SME loans held at amortised 
cost (see note 12) and are classified as amortised cost 
(as they are held solely to collect principal and interest 
payments) and are initially recognised at fair value 
and subsequently measured at amortised cost less 
provision for impairment. PPP loans were fully guaranteed 
by the SBA. 
iii) Lines of credit 
Lending through the FlexiPay product is recognised on 
the balance sheet within lines of credit. This represents 
the drawn amount of the facilities, net of ECL. The 
contractual cash flows represent solely payments of 
principal and interest (“SPPI”) and the business model 
under which they are held is in order to collect the 
contractual cash flows resulting in the lines of credit 
being measured initially at fair value and subsequently 
at amortised cost. The origination fee associated with 
FlexiPay is recognised under IFRS 9 within interest 
income at the effective interest rate in the consolidated 
statement of comprehensive income and is recognised 
over the expected life of the drawdown. 
The FlexiPay lines of credit are held net of expected 
credit loss allowances under IFRS 9, the methodology 
and definitions of which align to the Group accounting 
policy on impairment of financial assets held at amortised 
cost with the exception of being assessed at the available 
line of credit level, estimating the utilisation of the line of 
credit to the estimated point of default and are detailed 
further within note 16. Additionally, the Group assesses 
the expected credit loss allowance in relation to undrawn 
lines of credit, estimating the probability of default, loss 
given default and exposure at default in relation to these 
lines of credit were they to be drawn. This undrawn 
portion of the loss allowance is recognised within other 
liabilities in note 15. 
iv) Investment in trusts and co-investments 
The Group holds a minority beneficial ownership in 
trusts set up to fund CBILS, RLS and commercial loans 
with the majority of the beneficial ownership held by 
institutional investors. The SME loans are originated by 
Group subsidiaries, Funding Circle Focal Point Lending 
Limited for CBILS and Funding Circle Eclipse Lending 
Limited or Funding Circle Polaris Lending Limited for RLS 
and commercial loans, which retain legal title to the loans. 
These entities hold this legal title on trust on behalf of the 
majority investors who substantially retain the economic 
benefits the CBILS, RLS and commercial loans generate 
and therefore the trusts and the assets held within, 
including the SME loans, are not consolidated. 
The Group assesses whether it controls the trust 
structure under the criteria of IFRS 10. Control is 
determined to exist if the Group has the power to direct 
the activities of entities and structures and uses this 
control to obtain a variable return, to which it is exposed 
to the majority of the variability. As the Group’s holding is 
small compared to the majority investor and pari passu, 
the Group is not exposed to the majority of the variability 
in the cash flows of the trust, and it is not considered to 
control the trust structures, so they are not consolidated 
by the Group. 
Investments in trusts are classified at fair value through 
profit and loss. They are initially recognised at fair value 
on the balance sheet with the subsequent measurement 
at fair value with all gains and losses being recognised in 
the consolidated statement of comprehensive income. 
The Group recognises transaction fee income on 
origination of loans within the trust and service fee 
income on the assets within the trust, eliminating its 
proportional ownership share of the service fees. A 
scheme lender fee is charged in relation to the origination 
of CBILS and RLS loans and investment income is 
recognised in relation to returns on the investment. 
Other financial assets 
Financial assets recognised in the balance sheet as 
trade and other receivables are classified as amortised 
cost. They are recognised initially at fair value and 
subsequently measured at amortised cost less provision 
for impairment. 
Net investments in sublease receivables are recognised 
as other receivables representing the net present 
value of the lease payment receivable. Interest is 
recognised within other costs in the statement of 
comprehensive income. 
Cash and cash equivalents are classified as amortised 
cost with the exception of money market funds that 
are classified as FVTPL. Cash and cash equivalents 
include cash in hand, deposits held at call with banks, 
money market funds and other short-term highly liquid 
investments with original maturities of three months or 
less. The carrying amount of these assets approximates 
to their fair value.
STRATEGIC REPORT
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
CORPORATE GOVERNANCE

Funding Circle Holdings plc | Annual Report and Accounts 2024
139
1. Material accounting policies continued
Financial instruments continued
Other financial assets continued
Impairment of financial assets held at amortised cost 
The Group applies the impairment requirements of 
IFRS 9. The IFRS 9 impairment model requires a three-
stage approach: 
• Stage 1 includes financial instruments that have not 
had a significant increase in credit risk since initial 
recognition or that have low credit risk at the reporting 
date. For these assets, 12-month expected credit 
losses (“ECLs”) (that is, expected losses arising from 
the risk of default in the next 12 months) are recognised 
and interest income is calculated on the gross carrying 
amount of the asset (that is, without deduction for 
credit allowance). 
• Stage 2 includes financial instruments that have had a 
significant increase in credit risk since initial recognition 
(unless they have low credit risk at the reporting date) 
but are not credit-impaired. For these assets, lifetime 
ECLs (that is, expected losses arising from the risk of 
default over the life of the financial instrument) are 
recognised, and interest income is still calculated on 
the gross carrying amount of the asset. The Group 
assumes there has been a significant increase in credit 
risk if outstanding amounts on the financial assets 
exceed 30 days past due, in line with the rebuttable 
presumption per IFRS 9, or if a line of credit is late, or 
has been frozen due to an identified increase in risk 
such as becoming late on a third party debt at which 
point the assets are considered to be stage 2. 
• Stage 3 consists of financial assets that are credit- impaired, 
which is when one or more events that have a detrimental 
impact on the estimated future cash flows of the financial 
asset have occurred. For these assets, lifetime ECLs 
are also recognised, but interest income is calculated 
on the net carrying amount (that is, net of the ECL 
allowance). The Group defines a default, classified as 
stage 3, as an asset with any outstanding amounts 
exceeding a 90-day due date, which reflects the point 
at which the asset is considered to be defaulted. An 
account that is deemed to be fraudulent (i.e. third party 
application fraud) is written off at point of identification. 
• In some circumstances where assets are bought 
back by the Group, the financial asset associated with 
the purchase meets the definition of purchased or 
originated credit-impaired (“POCI”), and impairment 
is therefore based on lifetime ECLs. 
The Group assesses on a forward-looking basis the 
expected credit losses associated with its financial assets 
carried at amortised cost and recognises a loss allowance 
for such losses at each reporting date. The measurement 
of ECLs reflects: 
• an unbiased and probability-weighted amount 
that is determined by evaluating a range of 
possible outcomes; 
• the time value of money; and 
• reasonable and supportable information that is 
available without undue cost or effort at the reporting 
date about past events, current conditions and 
forecasts of future economic conditions. 
If in a subsequent period the amount of the impairment 
loss decreases and the decrease can be related 
objectively to an event occurring after the impairment 
was recognised, the previously recognised impairment 
loss is reversed, to the extent that the carrying value 
of the asset does not exceed its amortised cost at 
the reversal date. Any subsequent reversal of an 
impairment loss is recognised in the statement of 
comprehensive income. 
Derecognition of financial assets 
Financial assets are derecognised only when the 
contractual rights to the cash flows from the financial 
assets expire or the Group has either transferred the 
contractual right to receive the cash flows from that 
asset, or has assumed an obligation to pay those cash 
flows to one or more recipients. 
The Group derecognises a transferred financial asset 
if it transfers substantially all the risks and rewards 
of ownership. 
Financial liabilities 
Financial liabilities included in trade and other payables 
are recognised initially at fair value and subsequently at 
amortised cost. The fair value of a non-interest-bearing 
liability is its discounted repayment amount. If the due 
date of the liability is less than one year, discounting 
is omitted. 
A financial liability is derecognised when the obligation 
under the liability is discharged or cancelled or expires. 
Bank borrowings 
Bank borrowings (drawdowns under the credit facilities) 
are recognised initially at fair value, being their issue 
proceeds net of transaction costs incurred. These 
instruments are subsequently measured at amortised 
cost using the effective interest rate method. 
CORPORATE GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
STRATEGIC REPORT

Funding Circle Holdings plc | Annual Report and Accounts 2024
140
Notes forming part of the consolidated financial statements continued
for the year ended 31 December 2024
1. Material accounting policies continued
Provisions 
Provisions are recognised when the Group has a present 
obligation (legal or constructive) as a result of a past 
event; it is probable that the Group will be required to 
settle that obligation and a reliable estimate can be made 
of the amount of the obligation. 
Loan repurchases 
Loan repurchase contracts issued by the Group are 
those contracts that require a payment to be made to 
reimburse the holder for a loss it incurs because the 
specified debtor fails to make a payment when due in 
accordance with the terms of a debt instrument. Loan 
repurchase contracts are recognised initially as a liability 
at fair value, adjusted for transaction costs that are 
directly attributable to the issuance of the contract. The 
liability is subsequently measured at the higher of the 
best estimate of the expenditure required to settle the 
present obligation at the reporting date and the amount 
recognised less cumulative amortisation. The expected 
credit loss model is used to measure and recognise the 
financial liability. 
Share capital 
Ordinary shares are classified as equity where their terms 
include no contractual obligation to transfer cash or 
another financial asset to another entity. 
Earnings/(loss) per share 
The Group presents basic and diluted earnings/(losses) 
per share (“EPS”) for its ordinary shares. Basic and 
diluted EPS are calculated by dividing the profit/(loss) 
attributable to ordinary shareholders by the weighted 
average number of ordinary shares outstanding during 
the year excluding shares held as own shares in the 
Company’s Employee Benefit Trusts. 
For diluted earnings per share, the weighted average 
number of ordinary shares in issue is adjusted to 
assume conversion of all dilutive potential ordinary 
shares. The dilutive potential ordinary shares include 
those share options granted to employees under the 
Group’s share-based compensation schemes which do 
not have an exercise price or where the exercise price 
is less than the average market price of the Company’s 
ordinary shares during the year. 
Shares held by the Employee Benefit Trust and Share 
Incentive Plan Trust 
The Company has established an offshore Employee 
Benefit Trust (“EBT”) and an onshore Share Incentive Plan 
(“SIP”) Trust. 
The EBT and SIP Trust provide for the issue of shares to 
Group employees principally under share option schemes 
and SIP respectively. The Group has control of the EBT and 
SIP Trust and therefore consolidates the Trusts in the Group 
financial statements. Since 2022, the Trustee of the EBT 
has purchased the Company’s shares in the market in order 
to satisfy the exercise of employee share option schemes. 
Shares which are purchased are recognised at cost 
and are treated as a deduction to shareholders’ equity. 
No gain or loss is recognised in the income statement 
on the purchase or utilisation of equity shares. 
Reserves 
Foreign exchange reserve 
The foreign exchange reserve represents the cumulative 
foreign currency translation movement on the assets and 
liabilities of the Group’s international operations at year-
end exchange rates and on the profit and loss items from 
average exchange rates to year-end exchange rates. 
Share premium 
Proceeds received in excess of the nominal value 
of shares issued, or on the market value of shares 
exercised in excess of the exercise price net of any 
transaction costs. 
Share options reserve 
The share options reserve represents the cumulative 
charges to income under IFRS 2 Share-based Payments 
on all share options and schemes granted, net of share 
option exercises. The costs are transferred to retained 
earnings when options are exercised. 
2. Critical accounting judgements and key sources of 
estimation uncertainty 
The preparation of the consolidated financial statements 
requires the Group to make estimates and judgements 
that affect the application of policies and reported 
amounts. Critical judgements represent key decisions 
made by management in the application of the Group 
accounting policies. Where a significant risk of 
materially different outcomes exists due to management 
assumptions or sources of estimation uncertainty, this will 
represent a key source of estimation uncertainty. 
Estimates and judgements are continually evaluated and 
are based on experience and other factors, including 
expectations of future events that are believed to be 
reasonable under the circumstances. Although these 
estimates are based on management’s best knowledge 
of the amount, event or actions, actual results ultimately 
may differ from those estimates. 
The significant judgements and estimates applied by the 
Group in the financial statements have been applied on 
a consistent basis with the financial statements for the 
comparative year to 31 December 2023.
STRATEGIC REPORT
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
CORPORATE GOVERNANCE

Funding Circle Holdings plc | Annual Report and Accounts 2024
141
2. Critical accounting judgements and key sources of 
estimation uncertainty continued
Critical judgements 
Loans originated through the platform 
The Group originates SME loans through its platform 
which have been funded primarily by banks, asset 
managers, other institutional investors, funds, national 
entities, retail investors or by usage of its own capital. 
Judgement is required to determine whether these 
loans should be recognised on the Group’s balance 
sheet. Where the Group, its subsidiaries or SPVs which 
it consolidates have legal and beneficial ownership to 
the title of those SME loans, they are recognised on the 
Group’s balance sheet. Where this is not the case, the 
loans are not recognised at the point of origination. 
Recognition of deferred tax 
Under IAS 12, a deferred tax asset should be recognised for 
all deductible temporary differences and tax losses to the 
extent that it is probable that taxable profit will be available 
against which the deductible temporary difference or tax 
losses can be utilised. While the Board-approved forecasts 
project the UK to be in a taxable profit position for the year 
ended 31 December 2025 and beyond, there are risks to 
achieving this forecast and as a result it is not considered 
highly probable. Management has used its judgement in 
determining whether there is sufficient certainty to recognise 
a deferred tax asset. The European Securities and Markets 
Authority (“ESMA”) has previously issued guidance relating 
to the recognition of deferred tax assets in response to 
companies recognising assets too early only to subsequently 
write them off. One of the key indicators suggested by ESMA 
for the recognition of deferred tax is whether taxable profit 
is being recognised from which an entity has begun to offset 
losses. This is not yet the case for the UK business for a 
sustained period and management has determined not to 
recognise a deferred tax asset as a result. Had management 
determined a different level of certainty regarding the 
taxable profits of the UK for the year end and beyond, 
then a deferred tax asset may have been recognised. 
Key sources of estimation uncertainty 
The following are the key sources of estimation 
uncertainty that the Directors have identified in the 
process of applying the Group’s accounting policies 
and have the most significant effect on the amounts 
recognised in the financial statements. 
Expected credit loss impairment of FlexiPay lines of 
credit (note 16) 
At 31 December 2024, the Group held £110.0 million 
of drawn FlexiPay lines of credit and £278.7 million of 
undrawn lines of credit, gross of expected credit loss 
impairment allowances. 
While other financial assets of the Group are held at 
amortised cost, the FlexiPay lines of credit are the most 
sensitive to estimation uncertainty due to the higher 
balance outstanding and more limited historical data. 
An expected credit loss impairment allowance is held against 
the lines of credit of £15.6 million (£12.9 million related to 
drawn lines of credit and £2.7 million related to undrawn). 
The Group estimates the expected credit loss allowance 
following IFRS 9 through modelling the exposure at 
default based on observed trends related to the overall 
line of credit facility and the proportion drawn at the time 
of default. The probability of default is estimated utilising 
observed trends and combining these with forward-
looking information including different macroeconomic 
scenarios which are probability weighted. The loss given 
default is driven by assumptions regarding the level of 
recoveries collected after defaults occur. 
The area most sensitive to estimation uncertainty is 
the probability of default (“PD”) related to stage 1 lines 
of credit which is based on actual experience and the 
probability weighting of the forward-looking scenarios 
utilised. Currently a baseline scenario, upside scenario 
and downside scenario are utilised which are probability 
weighted 60% baseline, 10% upside and 30% downside, 
which provide a blended stage 1 probability of default 
of 3.6%. It is also noted that the downside scenario has 
peak unemployment of 6.9% in December 2027 and 
upside scenario has a trough unemployment of 3.6% from 
September 2026 relative to 4.4% in December 2024. Given 
the stage 1 PD is based on 12 month expected credit losses, 
the respective peak and trough of these scenarios has a low 
impact on the stage 1 ECL as at 31 December 2024 given 
the time horizon to reaching the respective peak and trough. 
If 100% probability weighting was to be applied to the 
upside scenario and the lowest point of the upside 
scenario unemployment forecast was solely applied for 
calculating the PD, the weighted PD related to stage 1 
lines of credit would decrease by 60 bps to 3.0% and 
the expected credit loss impairment provision would 
decrease by £0.8 million (£0.4 million on drawn lines of 
credit and £0.4 million on undrawn lines of credit). 
If a 100% probability weighting was to be applied to the 
downside scenario and the highest point of the downside 
scenario unemployment forecast was solely applied for 
calculating the PD, the weighted PD related to stage 1 
lines of credit would increase by 120 bps to 4.8% and the 
expected credit loss impairment would increase by £1.8 
million (£0.9 million on drawn lines of credit and £0.9 
million on undrawn lines of credit). It is considered that 
the above sensitivities represent the range of reasonably 
possible outcomes in relation to the probability of default 
on stage 1 FlexiPay lines of credit. 
The loss given default (“LGD”) of the expected credit loss 
impairment allowance is estimated based on observation 
of the blended portfolio recoveries to date on defaulted 
lines of credit projected out into the future using a 84.4% 
LGD. While the LGD expectation is based on the trajectory 
of recoveries to date, the lifetime LGD may differ from the 
estimated amount. A  plus or minus 500 bps increase/decrease in 
the estimated lifetime LGD would increase/decrease the 
expected credit loss impairment allowance by £0.9 million/
(£0.9 million). It is considered that the above sensitivities 
represent the range of reasonably possible outcomes in 
relation to the LGD on FlexiPay lines of credit.
 
CORPORATE GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
STRATEGIC REPORT

Funding Circle Holdings plc | Annual Report and Accounts 2024
142
Notes forming part of the consolidated financial statements continued
for the year ended 31 December 2024
3. Discontinued operations 
The Group announced on 7 March 2024 its intention to divest of the US business. As of this date, the US business 
was considered to form a disposal group and was reclassified as a discontinued operation. An agreement was signed 
on 24 June 2024 to sell the business to iBusiness Funding, LLC and the transaction completed as of 1 July 2024. As a 
result, Group retained control of the US business until 1 July 2024, at which point it was deconsolidated. 
The current and comparative loss for the year from discontinued operations, segmental results, cash flows from 
discontinued operations and component elements of the gain on disposal are detailed below. 
Discontinued operations 
Note 
Before 
exceptional 
items 
Exceptional 
items 
31 December 
2024 
£m 
31 December 
2023 
£m 
Transaction fees
10.3
—
10.3
23.4 
Servicing fees 
2.1
—
2.1
3.4 
Interest income
0.7
—
0.7
1.3 
Other fees
0.2
—
0.2
0.6 
Operating income 
13.3
—
13.3
28.7 
Investment income
0.7
—
0.7
4.4 
Investment expense
—
—
—
(0.6) 
Net investment income
0.7
—
0.7
3.8 
Total income
14.0
—
14.0
32.5 
Fair value gains
2.2
—
2.2
5.6 
Net income
16.2
—
16.2
38.1 
People costs
(16.0)
1.7
(14.3)
(28.9) 
Marketing costs
(3.7)
—
(3.7)
(11.3) 
Depreciation, amortisation, impairment 
and modification gains/(losses)
10, 11
(0.3)
—
(0.3)
(10.3) 
(Charge)/credit for expected credit losses
15, 16
(0.1)
—
(0.1)
0.1 
Other costs
(6.2)
—
(6.2)
(11.0) 
Operating expenses
(26.3)
1.7
(24.6)
(61.4) 
Realised FX recycled from foreign currency 
translation
—
8.7
8.7
— 
Gain on disposal of US business
—
8.1
8.1
— 
(Loss)/profit before taxation
(10.1)
18.5
8.4
(23.3) 
Income tax
8
(0.1)
—
(0.1)
(6.8) 
(Loss)/profit for the year from 
discontinued operations
(10.2)
18.5
8.3
(30.1) 
Other comprehensive income/(expense) 
Exchange differences on translation of foreign 
operations – discontinued operations 
19
(0.2)
(8.7)
(8.9)
(2.7) 
Total comprehensive (expense)/income for the 
year attributable to owners of the Parent 
(10.4)
9.8
(0.6)
(32.8) 
Earnings per share 
Basic and diluted (loss)/earnings per share 
from discontinued operations
9
(3.0)p
2.4p
(8.7)p 
Basic and diluted (loss)/earnings per share 
from discontinued operations 
9
(3.0)p
2.2p
(8.7)p
STRATEGIC REPORT
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
CORPORATE GOVERNANCE

Funding Circle Holdings plc | Annual Report and Accounts 2024
143
3. Discontinued operations continued
Segmental Adjusted EBITDA from discontinued operations 
31 December 
2024 
£m 
31 December 
2023 
£m 
Adjusted EBITDA
(8.7)
(10.6) 
Discount unwind on lease liabilities
(0.2)
(0.4) 
Depreciation, amortisation, impairment and modification gains/(losses)
(0.3)
(10.3) 
Exceptional items
18.5
— 
Share-based payments and social security costs
(1.0)
(1.8) 
Foreign exchange gains/(losses)
0.1
(0.2) 
Profit/(loss) before tax
8.4
(23.3) 
Cash flow 
31 December 
2024 
£m 
31 December 
2023 
£m 
Cash and cash equivalents at the beginning of the year
22.3
13.8 
Net cash outflow from operating activities
(8.6)
(12.3) 
Net cash (outflow)/inflow from investing activities
(13.3)
64.8 
Net cash outflow from financing activities
(0.6)
(43.2) 
Net (decrease)/increase in cash generated
(0.2)
23.1 
Effect of foreign exchange rate changes
0.2
(0.8) 
Cash and cash equivalents at the end of the year
—
22.3 
Details of the sale of the US business (exceptional items): 
£m 
Consideration received: 
Cash consideration at prevailing exchange rate
32.6 
Net assets disposed on (including cash and cash equivalents of £23.1 million)
(22.2) 
Gross gain on sale
10.4 
Direct transaction costs for legal, advisory and other costs
(2.3) 
Net impact of (early vesting)/lapsing US share options
1.7 
Other disposal related costs
(0.6) 
Gain on sale 
9.8 
Reclassification of foreign currency translation reserve
8.7 
Total gain as a result of disposal after reclassification of foreign currency translation reserve
18.5 
4. Exceptional items 
The Group reflects its underlying financial results in the “before exceptional items” column of the consolidated 
statement of comprehensive income in order to provide a clear and consistent view of trading performance. 
As part of its ongoing commitment to profitability, the Group launched a redundancy and cost efficiency programme 
during the year. This process will result in a simpler, leaner and better positioned UK-focused operation. This resulted 
in redundancy costs of £2.3 million and impairment of capitalised development spend intangible assets of £0.3 million 
which were treated as exceptional items. 
The Group disposed of its investment in the US business on 1 July 2024, as detailed in note 3.
CORPORATE GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
STRATEGIC REPORT

Funding Circle Holdings plc | Annual Report and Accounts 2024
144
Notes forming part of the consolidated financial statements continued
for the year ended 31 December 2024
5. Segmental information 
IFRS 8 Operating Segments requires the Group to determine its operating segments based on information which is 
used internally for decision making. Based on the internal reporting information and management structures within the 
Group, it has been determined that there are two continuing business and one discontinued US business operating 
segments. Reporting on this basis is reviewed by the Executive Committee (“ExCo”), formerly known as the Global 
Leadership Team (“GLT”), which is the chief operating decision maker (“CODM”). The ExCo is made up of the Executive 
Directors and other senior management and is responsible for the strategic decision making of the Group. 
The Other segment historically included the Group’s Term Loans businesses in Germany and the Netherlands. The 
Other segment has been presented within UK Term Loans for the year ended 31 December 2024 on the basis it is no 
longer individually material. The comparative year to 31 December 2023 has not been re-presented as it is immaterial. 
The ExCo measures the performance of each segment primarily by reference to profit before tax. Additionally, the 
ExCo utilises a non-GAAP measure, Adjusted EBITDA, which is defined as profit/loss for the year before finance costs 
(being the discount unwind on lease liabilities), taxation, depreciation, amortisation and impairments (“AEBITDA”), 
and additionally excludes share-based payment charges and associated social security costs, foreign exchange and 
exceptional items. AEBITDA is a measure of Group performance as it allows better comparability of the underlying 
performance of the business. The segment reporting, including AEBITDA, excludes the impact of the Group’s transfer 
pricing arrangements as this is not information presented to, or used by, the CODM in decision making or the allocation 
of resources. 
31 December 2024 Note 1 
31 December 20231 
Continuing operations 
Continuing operations 
United Kingdom
Total
United Kingdom
Other
Total 
Term Loans 
£m 
FlexiPay 
£m 
Total 
£m 
Term Loans 
£m 
FlexiPay 
£m 
Term Loans 
£m 
Total 
£m 
Transaction fees
84.7
0.6
85.3
65.2
0.1
—
65.3 
Servicing fees
37.5
—
37.5
38.8
—
0.2
39.0 
Interest income
8.3
22.6
30.9
7.5
7.8
0.1
15.4 
Other fees
5.1
0.1
5.2
6.3
—
0.1
6.4 
Operating income
135.6
23.3
158.9
117.8
7.9
0.4
126.1 
Net investment income
2.8
—
2.8
3.6
—
—
3.6 
Total income
138.4
23.3
161.7
121.4
7.9
0.4
129.7 
Fair value gains
4.2
—
4.2
3.1
—
—
3.1 
Cost of funds
—
(5.8)
(5.8)
—
(2.7)
—
(2.7) 
Net income
142.6
17.5
160.1
124.5
5.2
0.4
130.1 
Adjusted EBITDA
37.0
(12.5)
24.5
21.3
(14.4)
(0.2)
6.7 
Discount unwind on lease liabilities
(0.6)
—
(0.6)
(0.2)
—
—
(0.2) 
Depreciation, amortisation, 
impairment and modification 
(gains/losses)
 
(11.4)
(1.8)
(13.2)
(11.3)
(1.3)
—
(12.6) 
Share-based payments and social 
security costs
(6.5)
(1.3)
(7.8)
(3.3)
(0.5)
—
(3.8) 
Exceptional items
(2.3)
(0.3)
(2.6)
—
—
—
— 
Foreign exchange gains
0.5
—
0.5
—
—
—
— 
Profit/(loss) before tax
16.7
(15.9)
0.8
6.5
(16.2)
(0.2)
(9.9) 
1.  The segmental results of the US business are not presented above and are presented within note 3 – discontinued operations.
STRATEGIC REPORT
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
CORPORATE GOVERNANCE

Funding Circle Holdings plc | Annual Report and Accounts 2024
145
6. Operating expenses 
Note 
Before 
exceptional 
items 
£m 
Exceptional 
items 1 
£m 
31 December 
2024 
£m 
31 December 
2023 
£m 
Continuing operations 
Depreciation
11
3.0
—
3.0
3.5 
Amortisation and impairment
4, 10
10.6
0.3
10.9
9.1 
Modification gains
11
(0.4)
—
(0.4)
— 
Rental income and other recharges
—
—
—
(0.2) 
Employment costs (including contractors) 
7
68.1
2.3
70.4
65.5 
Marketing costs – (excluding employment costs)
45.6
—
45.6
37.1 
Data and technology
7.2
—
7.2
6.8 
Expected credit loss impairment charge
16, 27
8.6
—
8.6
4.5 
Other expenses
14.0
—
14.0
13.7 
Total operating expenses from continuing 
operations 
156.7
2.6
159.3
140.0 
1. See note 4 for details on exceptional items. 
Auditors’ remuneration 
31 December 
2024 
£m 
31 December 
2023 
£m 
Audit fees 
Continuing operations 
–  Fees payable to the Company’s auditors for the audit of the Parent Company and consolidated 
financial statements
0.4
0.5 
–  Fees payable to the Company’s auditors and its associates for the statutory audit of the 
financial statements of subsidiaries of the Company 
0.5
0.5 
Total audit fees
0.9
1.0 
Non-audit service fees 
– Audit-related assurance services
0.3
0.3 
– Other assurance services
0.1
0.1 
Total non-audit service fees
0.4
0.4
CORPORATE GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
STRATEGIC REPORT

Funding Circle Holdings plc | Annual Report and Accounts 2024
146
Notes forming part of the consolidated financial statements continued
for the year ended 31 December 2024
7. Employees 
The average monthly number of employees (including Directors) during the year was: 
2024 
Number 
2023 
Number 
Continuing operations 
Term Loans
628
666 
FlexiPay
88
81 
Other
5
9 
Total continuing operations
721
756 
Discontinued operations1 
US
106
203 
Total discontinued operations
106
203 
Total
827
959 
In addition to the employees above, the average monthly number of contractors during the year was 80 (2023: 115), 
of which 13 (2023: 26) related to the US1. 
Note 1.  Average monthly numbers are calculated over 12 months and for the 2024 US discontinued operations includes 6 months following the sale of the US business 
where the employee number was nil. 
Employment costs (including Directors’ emoluments) during the year were: 
Continuing operations 
31 December 2024 
31 December 
2023 
Before 
exceptional 
items 
£m 
Exceptional 
items 1 
£m 
Total 
£m 
Total 
£m 
Wages and salaries
56.0
—
56.0
55.6 
Social security costs
6.3
—
6.3
6.0 
Pension costs
2.1
—
2.1
2.1 
Share-based payments
7.8
—
7.8
3.8 
Exceptional costs
—
2.3
2.3
— 
 
72.2
2.3
74.5
67.5 
Contractor costs
4.9
—
4.9
7.2 
Less: capitalised development costs
(9.0)
—
(9.0)
(9.2) 
Employment costs net of capitalised development costs
68.1
2.3
70.4
65.5 
1. See note 4 for details of exceptional items.
STRATEGIC REPORT
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
CORPORATE GOVERNANCE

Funding Circle Holdings plc | Annual Report and Accounts 2024
147
8. Income tax charge/(credit) 
The Group is subject to all taxes applicable to a commercial company in its countries of operation. The UK (losses)/
profits of the Company are subject to UK income tax at the standard corporation tax rate of 25% (23.5% is applied to 
the table below for 2023 as a blended rate for the year, as the increase in the statutory corporation tax rate to 25% was 
effective from 1 April 2023). 
 
31 December 
2024 
£m 
31 December 
2023 
£m 
Current tax 
Continuing operations 
UK 
Current tax on profits/(losses) for the year
0.5
0.3 
Adjustment in respect of prior years
—
(2.0) 
 
0.5
(1.7) 
Other 
 
 
Current tax on (losses)/profits for the year
—
— 
Adjustment in respect of prior years
—
— 
 
—
— 
Total current tax charge/(credit) from continuing operations
0.5
(1.7) 
Discontinued operations 
 
 
US 
 
 
Current tax on (losses)/profits for the year
0.1
0.3 
Adjustment in respect of prior years
—
(0.1) 
Total current tax charge from discontinued operations
0.1
0.2 
Total current tax charge/(credit)
0.6
(1.5) 
Deferred tax 
 
 
Continuing operations 
UK 
Deferred tax on profits/(losses) for the year
—
— 
Adjustments in respect of prior years
—
— 
—
— 
Other 
Deferred tax on (losses)/profits for the year
—
— 
Adjustments in respect of prior years
—
— 
—
— 
Total deferred tax charge/(credit) from continuing operations
—
— 
Discontinued operations 
US 
Deferred tax on (losses)/profits for the year
—
6.6 
Adjustments in respect of prior years
—
— 
Total deferred tax charge from discontinued operations
—
6.6 
Total deferred tax charge
—
6.6 
Total tax charge
0.6
5.1 
The above current tax charge/(credit) represents the expected tax on the Research and Development Expenditure 
Credit (“RDEC”) receivable for 2024 and US state taxes from 1 January 2024 to the date of disposal of the US business.
CORPORATE GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
STRATEGIC REPORT

Funding Circle Holdings plc | Annual Report and Accounts 2024
148
Notes forming part of the consolidated financial statements continued
for the year ended 31 December 2024
8. Income tax charge/(credit) continued
In the prior year, the tax charge represents the tax liability on the Group’s taxable profit, including state taxes, and the 
amount of tax deducted from the RDEC receivable for 2023. 
Based on the Group’s current financial projections, the estimate of the deferred tax asset in respect of the losses 
arising in the UK was £nil at 31 December 2024 (31 December 2023: £nil). 
The US business at 31 December 2024 is represented as discontinued operations. 
The Group charge/(credit) for the year can be reconciled to the profit/(loss) before tax shown per the consolidated 
statement of comprehensive income as follows. 
Factors affecting the tax charge/(credit) for the year 
31 December 
2024 
£m 
31 December 
2023 
£m 
Profit/(loss) before taxation for the Group
9.2
(33.2) 
Taxation on profit/(loss) at 25.0% (2023: 23.5%)
2.3
(7.8) 
Effects of: 
 
Research and development
0.4
0.3 
Effect of foreign tax rates
0.1
0.3 
Non-taxable/non-deductible expenses
0.3
0.7 
Unrecognised timing differences
(0.1)
1.7 
Unrecognised tax losses accumulated
1.1
5.6 
Adjustment in respect of prior years
—
(2.1) 
Deferred tax assets derecognised
—
6.6 
Impairment charge
(3.5)
(0.2) 
Total tax charge
0.6
5.1 
Total tax charge/(credit) from continuing operations
0.5
(1.7) 
Total tax charge from discontinued operations
0.1
6.8 
There was no tax charge/(credit) in the current or prior year related to exchange differences on translation of foreign 
operations in other comprehensive income or the recycling of these into profit and loss. 
The Group is taxed at different rates depending on the country in which the profits arise. 
The key applicable tax rates for 2024 include the UK 25%, and the US 21%. The effective tax rate for the year was 
4.87% (2023: negative 15.4%). 
31 December 
2024 
£m 
31 December 
2023 
£m 
Property, plant and equipment
—
(1.5) 
Carry forward losses (UK)
—
1.5 
Carry forward losses (US)
—
— 
Recognised deferred tax
—
— 
Unrecognised deferred tax 
31 December 
2024 
£m 
31 December 
2023 
£m 
Property, plant and equipment
6.9
22.8 
Carry forward losses
125.0
183.4 
Deferred stock options
22.5
20.5 
US R&D credit
—
2.2 
US fair value adjustments
—
40.7 
Other
0.2
0.4 
Unrecognised deferred tax Note 1 
154.6
270.0 
1. Balances presented in the table above are gross timing differences and are not tax effected.
STRATEGIC REPORT
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
CORPORATE GOVERNANCE

Funding Circle Holdings plc | Annual Report and Accounts 2024
149
8. Income tax charge/(credit) continued
Unrecognised deferred tax continued
Based on the temporary differences, there are total unrecognised deferred tax assets of £38.7 million (2023: £62.2 million). 
In addition, there is an unrecognised deferred tax asset in relation to R&D expenditure credit set-off amounts of £2.0 million 
(2023: £1.7 million).
The Group has unrelieved tax losses of £125.0 million (2023: £183.4 million) that are available for offset against future 
taxable profits. 
Factors affecting the tax charge in future years
Factors that may affect the Group’s future tax charge include the geographic location of the Group’s earnings 
(including changes in transfer pricing arrangements), the tax rates in those locations, changes in tax legislation and the 
use of brought-forward tax losses. The calculation of the Group’s total tax charge involves a degree of estimation and 
judgement with respect to the recognition of any deferred tax asset.
9. Earnings/(loss) per share
Basic earnings/(loss) per share amounts are calculated by dividing the profit/(loss) for the year attributable to ordinary 
equity holders of the Company by the weighted average number of ordinary shares outstanding during the year.
For diluted earnings/(loss) per share, the weighted average number of ordinary shares in issue is adjusted to assume 
conversion of all dilutive potential ordinary shares. The dilutive potential ordinary shares include those share options 
granted to employees under the Group’s share-based compensation schemes which do not have an exercise price or 
where the exercise price is less than the average market price of the Company’s ordinary shares during the year.
Where loss per share is presented, there is no difference in the weighted average number of shares used in the 
calculation of basic and diluted loss per share as the effect of all potentially dilutive shares outstanding was anti-dilutive.
The following table reflects the profit/(loss) and share data used in the basic and diluted earnings/(loss) per 
share computations:
31 December 
2024 
Total 
£m
31 December 
2024  
Before 
exceptional 
items 
£m
31 December  
2023 
£m
Profit/(loss) for the year from continuing operations
0.3
2.9
(8.2)
Basic weighted average number of ordinary shares in issue (million)
342.4
342.4
344.8
Basic earnings/(loss) per share from continuing operations
0.1p
0.8p
(2.4)p
Profit/(loss) for the year from continuing operations
0.3
2.9
(8.2)
Diluted weighted average number of ordinary shares in issue (million)
382.2
382.2
344.8
Diluted earnings/(loss) per share from continuing operations
0.1p
0.8p
(2.4)p
31 December 
2024 
Total 
£m
31 December 
2024 
Before 
exceptional 
items 
£m
31 December 
2023 
Total 
£m
Profit/(loss) for the year from discontinued operations
8.3
(10.2)
(30.1)
Basic weighted average number of ordinary shares in issue (million)
342.4
342.4
344.8
Basic earnings/(loss) per share from discontinued operations
2.4p
(3.0)p
(8.7)p
Profit/(loss)for the year from discontinued operations
8.3
(10.2)
(30.1)
Diluted weighted average number of ordinary shares in issue (million)
382.2
342.4
344.8
Diluted earnings/(loss) per share from discontinued operations
2.2p
(3.0)p
(8.7)p
CORPORATE GOVERNANCE
STRATEGIC REPORT
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

Funding Circle Holdings plc | Annual Report and Accounts 2024
150
Notes forming part of the consolidated financial statements continued
for the year ended 31 December 2024
10. Intangible assets
Capitalised 
development 
costs 
£m
Computer 
software 
£m
Other 
intangibles 
£m
Total 
£m
Cost
At 1 January 2023
54.8
0.8
1.2
56.8
Exchange differences
(0.8)
—
—
(0.8)
Additions
11.3
0.2
—
11.5
Disposals
(4.1)
(0.6)
—
(4.7)
At 31 December 2023
61.2
0.4
1.2
62.8
At 1 January 2024
61.2
0.4
1.2
62.8
Exchange differences
0.2
—
(0.1)
0.1
Additions
9.0
—
—
9.0
Disposals
(4.4)
(0.3)
—
(4.7)
De-recognition of assets of discontinued operations
(15.7)
—
—
(15.7)
At 31 December 2024
50.3
0.1
1.1
51.5
Accumulated amortisation
 
 
 
 
At 1 January 2023
26.8
0.6
1.2
28.6
Exchange differences
(0.5)
0.1
—
(0.4)
Charge for the year
12.3
0.1
—
12.4
Impairment
3.9
—
—
3.9
Disposals
(4.1)
(0.6)
—
(4.7)
At 31 December 2023
38.4
0.2
1.2
39.8
At 1 January 2024
38.4
0.2
1.2
39.8
Exchange differences
0.1
—
(0.1)
—
Charge for the year
9.7
0.1
—
9.8
Impairment (exceptional item)
0.3
—
—
0.3
Impairment
0.7
0.1
—
0.8
Disposals
(4.4)
(0.3)
—
(4.7)
De-recognition of assets of discontinued operations
(15.7)
—
—
(15.7)
At 31 December 2024
29.1
0.1
1.1
30.3
Carrying amount
 
 
 
 
At 31 December 2024
21.2
—
—
21.2
At 31 December 2023
22.8
0.2
—
23.0
During the year ended 31 December 2024 £0.3 million (2023: £nil) of intangible assets were impaired in the FlexiPay 
Business Unit related to projects discontinued as a result of the simplification of the Group. These were treated as 
an exceptional item (see note 4). A further £0.8 million of intangibles were impaired in 2024 related to capitalised 
development spend and software no longer in use. In the prior year intangible assets of £3.9 million predominantly 
related to the US business were fully impaired. This was as a result of the annual impairment review assessment of 
each cash-generating unit. 
STRATEGIC REPORT
CORPORATE GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

Funding Circle Holdings plc | Annual Report and Accounts 2024
151
11. Property, plant and equipment, right-of-use assets and lease liabilities
The Group has right-of-use assets which comprise property leases held by the Group. Information about leases for 
which the Group is a lessee is presented below.
Analysis of property, plant and equipment between owned and leased assets
31 December 
2024 
£m
31 December 
2023 
£m
Property, plant and equipment (owned)
2.9
1.7
Right-of-use assets
6.7
3.3
9.6
5.0
Reconciliation of amount recognised in the balance sheet
Leasehold 
improvements 
£m
Computer 
equipment 
£m
Furniture and  
fixtures 
£m
Right-of-use 
assets 
(property) 
£m
Total 
£m
Cost 
At 1 January 2023
5.2
3.0
2.1
32.7
43.0
Disposals
—
(1.1)
—
—
(1.1)
Additions  Note 1 
—
0.7
—
0.2
0.9
Exchange differences
—
—
—
(0.6)
(0.6)
At 31 December 2023
5.2
2.6
2.1
32.3
42.2
At 1 January 2024
5.2
2.6
2.1
32.3
42.2
Disposals
(3.7)
(0.4)
(0.7)
(9.6)
(14.4)
Lease modification
—
—
—
5.7
5.7
Additions  Note 1 
2.3
0.5
0.1
—
2.9
Exchange differences and other non-cash 
movements
(0.4)
—
—
0.1
(0.3)
Derecognition of assets of discontinued operations
(0.2)
(1.0)
(0.7)
(10.2)
(12.1)
At 31 December 2024
3.2
1.7
0.8
18.3
24.0
Accumulated depreciation 
 
 
 
 
 
At 1 January 2023
3.9
1.9
1.8
25.4
33.0
Disposals
—
(1.1)
—
—
(1.1)
Charge for the year
0.7
0.8
0.1
2.7
4.3
Impairment
—
0.1
0.1
1.3
1.5
Exchange differences
(0.1)
—
—
(0.4)
(0.5)
At 31 December 2023
4.5
1.7
2.0
29.0
37.2
At 1 January 2024
4.5
1.7
2.0
29.0
37.2
Disposals
(3.7)
(0.4)
(0.7)
(9.6)
(14.4)
Charge for the year
0.5
0.6
0.1
2.0
3.2
Impairment
—
0.1
—
—
0.1
Exchange differences
—
—
—
0.1
0.1
Derecognition of assets of discontinued operations
(0.2)
(1.0)
(0.7)
(9.9)
(11.8)
At 31 December 2024
1.1
1.0
0.7
11.6
14.4
Carrying amount
 
 
 
 
 
At 31 December 2024
2.1
0.7
0.1
6.7
9.6
At 31 December 2023
0.7
0.9
0.1
3.3
5.0
Note 1.  Leasehold improvement and right-of-use asset additions in the year are non-cash in nature.
CORPORATE GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
STRATEGIC REPORT

Funding Circle Holdings plc | Annual Report and Accounts 2024
152
Notes forming part of the consolidated financial statements continued
for the year ended 31 December 2024
11. Property, plant and equipment, right-of-use assets and lease liabilities continued
Reconciliation of amount recognised in the balance sheet continued
In February 2024, the Group signed an amendment to shorten the lease term on one of the UK office floors to 
30 June 2024 and extend the term on the other floor. The modification of the lease which was shortened resulted 
in a net modification gain of £0.4 million (with a £1.1 million reduction in lease liability and £0.7 million reduction in 
right-of-use asset), and the lease liability and right of use asset net of accumulated depreciation were derecognised at 
30 June 2024. The extension of the term on the other floor resulted in an increase to the lease liability of £6.4 million 
and right of use asset of £6.4 million before depreciation. Leasehold improvement additions associated with re-fitting 
the retained floor totalled £1.5 million.
Certain right-of-use assets related to the US San Francisco office had been sublet under an operating sublease. Due 
to a further weakening of the San Francisco commercial property market, the estimated cash flows on the sublet no 
longer support the carrying value of the asset. As a result, an impairment of £1.3 million was recognised in the previous 
year ended 31 December 2023.
Property, plant and equipment of £0.1 million (2023: £0.2 million) related to the US business was fully impaired 
in the year.
Lease liabilities
Amounts recognised on the balance sheet were as follows:
31 December 
2024 
£m
31 December  
2023  
£m
Current
1.8
7.2
Non-current
5.8
5.4
Total
7.6
12.6
Amounts recognised in the statement of comprehensive income were as follows:
Continuing operations
31 December 
2024
 
£m
31 December 
2023  
£m
Depreciation charge of right-of-use assets (property)
1.9
2.1
Gain on modification of lease liability
(0.4)
—
Interest expense (included in operating expenses)
0.6
0.2
The total cash outflow for leases (excluding short-term and low value leases) in 2024 was £3.6 million (2023: £7.2 million). 
A maturity analysis illustrating the undiscounted contractual cash flows of lease liabilities is included within the liquidity 
risk disclosure within note 16.
As at 31 December 2024, the potential future undiscounted cash outflows that have not been included in the lease 
liability due to lack of reasonable certainty the lease extension options might be exercised, amounted to £8.8 million 
(2023: £nil).
STRATEGIC REPORT
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
CORPORATE GOVERNANCE

Funding Circle Holdings plc | Annual Report and Accounts 2024
153
12. SME loans and lines of credit
31 December 
2024  
£m
31 December 
2023 
£m
Non-current
SME loans – amortised cost
1.4
5.6
Investment in trusts and co-investments – FVTPL
17.8
25.2
Total non-current
19.2
30.8
Current
SME loans – amortised cost
0.7
1.1
Lines of credit – amortised cost Note 1 
97.1
50.0
SME loans – FVTPL
1.2
18.6
Total current
99.0
69.7
Total
118.2
100.5
1. Included in Lines of credit are £7.2 million related to Cashback credit card balances net of ECL impairment.
13. Trade and other receivables
31 December 
2024  
£m
31 December 
2023 
£m
Other receivables
—
1.4
Non-current trade and other receivables
—
1.4
Trade receivables
0.4
0.4
Other receivables
4.2
2.7
Tax-related receivables
4.8
4.6
Prepayments 
4.7
5.2
Accrued income
5.8
5.3
Rent and other deposits
0.9
2.2
Current trade and other receivables
20.8
20.4
20.8
21.8
The maximum exposure to credit risk at the reporting date is the carrying value of each class of receivables 
described earlier.
No trade receivables were overdue or impaired.
Included in rent and other deposits are £0.9 million of rental deposits (2023: £1.6 million) in respect of the Group’s 
property leases which expire over the next five years.
The Directors consider that the carrying amount of trade and other receivables approximates to their fair value.
14. Trade and other payables
31 December 
2024 
£m
31 December 
2023 
£m
Trade payables
1.8
2.4
Other taxes and social security costs
7.0
4.2
Other creditors Note 1 
6.5
32.6
Accruals and deferred income
12.5
15.1
 
27.8
54.3
1.  Other creditors includes £4.4 million (2023: £30.7 million) due to the British Business Bank (BBB) primarily related to scheme lender fees collected from investors 
associated with government-guaranteed products. 
The Directors consider that the carrying amount of trade and other payables approximates to their fair value.
CORPORATE GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
STRATEGIC REPORT

Funding Circle Holdings plc | Annual Report and Accounts 2024
154
Notes forming part of the consolidated financial statements continued
for the year ended 31 December 2024
15. Provisions and other liabilities
Dilapidation 
£m
Loan 
repurchase 
£m
Restructuring  Note 1 
£m
ECL on 
undrawn 
lines of credit 
and other Note 2 
£m
Total 
£m
At 1 January 2023 
1.1
0.5
—
0.5
2.1
Additional provision/liability
—
0.2
—
1.2
1.4
Amount utilised
—
(0.4)
—
(0.3)
(0.7)
Amount reversed
—
(0.2)
—
—
(0.2)
At 31 December 2023
1.1
0.1
—
1.4
2.6
Additional provision/liability
—
—
2.3
2.2
4.5
Amount utilised
(0.3)
(0.1)
(2.3)
—
(2.7)
Amount reversed
(0.2)
—
—
—
(0.2)
At 31 December 2024
0.6
—
—
3.6
4.2
1. The restructuring provision relates to the simplification and streamlining of the Group and has been treated as an exceptional item. See note 4.
2. ECL on undrawn lines of credit and other provisions includes provisions for operational buybacks of £0.9 million and £2.7 million (2023: £1.4 million) of expected 
credit loss impairment allowance related to undrawn FlexiPay lines of credit. See notes 16 and 27.
31 December 
2024 
£m
31 December 
2023 
£m
Current provisions and other liabilities
3.6
1.5
Non-current provisions and other liabilities
0.6
1.1
 
4.2
2.6
The dilapidation provision represents an estimated cost for dismantling the customisation of offices and restoring 
the leasehold premises to its original state at the end of the tenancy period. The provision is expected to be 
utilised by 2030.
16. Financial risk management 
The Board of Directors has overall responsibility for the establishment and oversight of the Group’s risk 
management framework. 
The risk management policies are established to identify and analyse the risks faced by the Group, to set appropriate 
risk limits and controls and to monitor risks and ensure any limits are adhered to. The Group’s activities are reviewed 
regularly and potential risks are considered. 
Risk factors
The Group has exposure to the following risks from its use of financial instruments:
	
• credit risk;
	
• liquidity risk; and
	
• market risk (including foreign exchange risk, interest rate risk and other price risk).
STRATEGIC REPORT
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
CORPORATE GOVERNANCE

Funding Circle Holdings plc | Annual Report and Accounts 2024
155
16. Financial risk management continued
Principal financial instruments
The principal financial instruments used by the Group, from which financial instrument risk arises, are as follows:
	
• SME loans;
	
• investments in trusts and co-investments;
	
• lines of credit;
	
• trade and other receivables;
	
• cash and cash equivalents;
	
• trade and other payables;
	
• bank borrowings;
	
• lease liabilities; and
	
• loan repurchase liabilities.
Categorisation of financial assets and financial liabilities
The tables show the carrying amounts of financial assets and financial liabilities by category of financial instrument as 
at 31 December 2024:
31 December 2024
31 December 2023
Fair value 
through
 profit 
and loss 
£m
Amortised  
cost 
£m
Other 
£m
Total 
£m
Fair value 
through
 profit 
and loss  
£m
Amortised 
cost 
£m
Other 
£m
Total 
£m
Assets
SME loans held at amortised 
cost
—
2.1
—
2.1
—
6.7
—
6.7
SME loans held at fair value 
through profit and loss
1.2
—
—
1.2
18.6
—
—
18.6
Lines of credit
—
97.1
—
97.1
—
50.0
—
50.0
Investment in trusts and 
co-investments
17.8
—
—
17.8
25.2
—
—
25.2
Trade and other receivables
0.6
10.7
—
11.3
0.8
11.2
—
12.0
Cash and cash equivalents
136.3
51.3
—
187.6
150.1
71.3
—
221.4
155.9
161.2
—
317.1
194.7
139.2
—
333.9
Liabilities
Trade and other payables
—
(8.3)
—
(8.3)
—
(35.0)
—
(35.0)
Loan repurchase liability
—
—
—
—
—
—
(0.1)
(0.1)
Bank borrowings
—
(101.9)
—
(101.9)
—
(56.9)
—
(56.9)
Lease liabilities
—
(7.6)
—
(7.6)
—
(12.6)
—
(12.6)
—
(117.8)
—
(117.8)
—
(104.5)
(0.1)
(104.6)
Financial instruments measured at amortised cost
Financial instruments measured at amortised cost, rather than fair value, include cash and cash equivalents, trade and 
other receivables, SME loans held at amortised cost, FlexiPay lines of credit, bank borrowings, lease liabilities and trade 
and other payables. Due to their nature, the carrying value of each of the above financial instruments approximates to 
their fair value.
CORPORATE GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
STRATEGIC REPORT
 

Funding Circle Holdings plc | Annual Report and Accounts 2024
156
Notes forming part of the consolidated financial statements continued
for the year ended 31 December 2024
16. Financial risk management continued
Other financial instruments
Loan repurchase liabilities are measured at the amount of loss allowance determined under IFRS 9.
Financial instruments measured at fair value 
IFRS 13 requires certain disclosures which require the classification of financial assets and financial liabilities measured 
at fair value using a fair value hierarchy that reflects the significance of the inputs used in making the fair value 
measurement. 
Disclosure of fair value measurements by level is according to the following fair value measurement hierarchy:
	
• level 1 inputs are quoted prices (unadjusted) in active markets for identical assets or liabilities that the entity can 
access at the measurement date;
	
• level 2 inputs are inputs other than quoted prices included within level 1 that are observable for the assets or 
liabilities, either directly or indirectly; and 
	
• level 3 inputs are unobservable inputs for the assets or liabilities.
The fair value of financial instruments that are not traded in an active market (for example, investments in SME loans) 
is determined by using valuation techniques. These valuation techniques maximise the use of observable market data 
where it is available and rely as little as possible on entity-specific estimates. If all significant inputs required to fair 
value an instrument are observable, the instrument is included in level 2. If one or more of the significant inputs are 
not based on observable market data, the instrument is included in level 3. An assessment that the level applied to 
financial instruments is appropriate and whether a transfer between levels is required is undertaken at the end of each 
accounting period. There were no transfers between levels during the year or prior year.
The Finance department of the Group performs the valuations of items required for financial reporting purposes, 
including level 3 fair values. This team reports to the Chief Financial Officer (“CFO”). Discussions of valuation processes 
and results are held regularly at Balance Sheet Management and Impairment and Valuation Committees along with 
regular updates provided to the Audit Committee.
Fair value measurement using
31 December 2024
31 December 2023
Quoted 
prices 
in active 
markets 
(level 1) 
£m
Significant 
observable 
inputs 
(level 2) 
£m
Significant 
unobservable
 
inputs 
(level 3) 
£m
Quoted 
prices 
in active 
markets 
(level 1) 
£m
Significant 
observable 
inputs 
(level 2) 
£m
Significant 
unobservable 
inputs 
(level 3) 
£m
Financial assets 
SME loans held at fair value through profit 
and loss
—
—
1.2
—
—
18.6
Trade and other receivables
0.6
—
—
0.8
—
—
Investment in trusts and co-investments
—
—
17.8
—
—
25.2
Cash and cash equivalents
136.3
—
—
150.1
—
—
 
136.9
—
19.0
150.9
—
43.8
The fair value of all SME loans held at fair value has been estimated by discounting future cash flows of the loans 
using discount rates that reflect the changes in market interest rates and observed market conditions at the reporting 
date. The estimated fair value and carrying amount of the SME loans held at fair value through profit and loss was 
£1.2 million at 31 December 2024 (2023: £18.6 million).
Investment in trusts and co-investments represents the Group’s investment in the trusts and other vehicles used 
to fund CBILS, RLS, GGS and certain commercial loans and is measured at fair value through profit and loss. The 
government-owned British Business Bank will guarantee up to 80% of the balance of CBILS loans in the event of default 
(and between 70% and 80% of RLS loans and 70% for GGS loans). The estimated fair value and carrying amount of the 
investment in trusts and co-investments was £17.8 million at 31 December 2024 (2023: £25.2 million).
The most relevant significant unobservable inputs relate to the default rate estimate and discount rates applied to the 
fair value calculation. However, it was determined that the reasonably possible range of outcomes from these inputs 
into the estimates are not material to the accounts.
STRATEGIC REPORT
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
CORPORATE GOVERNANCE

Funding Circle Holdings plc | Annual Report and Accounts 2024
157
16. Financial risk management continued
Financial instruments measured at fair value continued
Since 31 December 2023, the assumptions related to estimating fair value have been marginally updated. The 
expected stress in defaults due to the macro environment of inflationary cost pressures experienced by SMEs and their 
customers in the year did not materialise to the extent expected as base rates peaked, plateaued and began to fall 
and borrowers remained largely resilient. This has led to some favourable observed performance with lower defaults 
and stable recoveries relative to expectations on many of the portfolios particularly the legacy SME loans (securitised) 
in the US prior to their sale along with the US business. The expectation of a macro stress is now expected to be 
less pronounced but last longer. This has led to a lower lifetime cumulative default expectation and a higher relative 
estimation of fair value compared to the carrying value of the loans than at 31 December 2023. However, due to the 
amortising nature of these loans and the sale of the US loans, there is less sensitivity to default assumptions given 
the lower relative remaining value on the book year on year.
During the year, certain warehouses invested in trusts in which Funding Circle is a minority co-investor sold their loan 
assets to a third party and Funding Circle partially re-invested alongside the purchaser. As a result of the transaction, 
the net cash flows from the investment were realised sooner and a net fair value gain of £2.2 million was recognised 
through fair value gains in the consolidated statement of comprehensive income. The cash flows related to the transaction 
are presented net within “Cash receipts from investment in trusts and co-investments” in the statement of cash flows, 
reflecting the net settlement of the realisation and re-investment.
There has additionally been decreases in discount rates used to discount the estimated cash flows in the year, primarily 
driven by decreases in the risk free rate, due to central bank interest rates falling and expectations of rate cuts priced 
into swaps. Many of the investments in leveraged investment in trust structures have experienced a reduction in discount 
rates due to de-leveraging of the vehicles as senior lenders debt has been paid down. The repayment of senior debt 
and the passage of time has additionally led to fair value gains as a result of the discount unwind as projected future 
cash flows of the investments which tend to be backloaded in the structure become are nearer in time to the balance 
sheet date. This, in turn, has led to a higher relative estimation of fair value in the year.
The result of the various factors outlined above is a £6.4 million net fair value gain during the year (of which £2.2 million 
relates to discontinued operations) primarily driven by favourable performance of legacy securitisation loans relative to 
expectations of stressed performance over the year; however, as these loans continue to amortise they are expected 
to become less sensitive to estimation uncertainty.
Sensitivities to unobservable assumptions in the valuation of SME loans and money market funds within cash and cash 
equivalents are not disclosed as reasonably possible changes in the current assumptions inclusive of default rates, 
discount rates and recovery rates would not be expected to result in material changes in the carrying values.
Fair value movements on SME loans held at fair value through profit and loss and investments in trusts and co-investments 
are recognised through the profit and loss account in fair value gains/(losses).
A reconciliation of the movement in level 3 financial instruments is shown as follows:
SME loans 
held at fair 
value through 
profit and loss 
£m
Investment in 
trusts and 
co-investments 
£m
Balance as at 1 January 2023
69.1
28.7
Additions
11.9
1.8
Repayments
(37.6)
(6.6)
Disposal
(30.4)
—
Net gain on the change in fair value of financial instruments at fair value through profit or loss
7.4
1.3
Foreign exchange loss
(1.8)
—
Balance as at 31 December 2023
18.6
25.2
Additions
—
4.1
Repayments
(13.5)
(14.6)
Net gain on the change in fair value of financial instruments at fair value through profit or loss
2.6
3.8
Other non-cash movements
(0.7)
—
Disposal of discontinued operations
(5.8)
(0.7)
Balance as at 31 December 2024
1.2
17.8
CORPORATE GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
STRATEGIC REPORT

Funding Circle Holdings plc | Annual Report and Accounts 2024
158
Notes forming part of the consolidated financial statements continued
for the year ended 31 December 2024
16. Financial risk management continued
Financial risk factors
Credit risk
Credit risk is the risk of financial loss to the Group if a customer or counterparty to a financial instrument fails to meet 
its contractual obligations, and arises principally from the Group’s receivables from customers and cash and cash 
equivalents held at banks.
The Group’s maximum exposure to credit risk by class of financial asset is as follows:
31 December 
2024 
£m
31 December 
2023  
£m
Non-current
SME loans held at amortised cost
1.4
5.6
Investment in trusts and co-investments
17.8
25.2
Trade and other receivables:
– Other receivables
—
1.4
Current
SME loans held at amortised cost
0.7
1.1
SME loans held at fair value through profit and loss
1.2
18.6
Lines of credit
97.1
50.0
Trade and other receivables:
– Trade receivables
0.4
0.4
– Other receivables
4.2
2.7
– Accrued income
5.8
 5.3
– Rent and other deposits
0.9
2.2
Cash and cash equivalents
187.6
221.4
Total gross credit risk exposure
317.1
333.9
Less bank borrowings Note 1 
(101.9)
(56.9)
Total net credit risk exposure
215.2
277.0
1.  Included within bank borrowings are £nil (2023: £2.2 million) in relation to drawdowns on the PPPLF and £101.9 million (2023: £54.7 million) 
related to the FlexiPay warehouse. 
In addition, the Group was subject to certain financial guarantees in its legacy European operations which it had issued 
to buy back loans. The Group’s maximum exposure to credit risk on these financial guarantees were every eligible loan 
required to be bought back would be £nil (2023: £0.4 million).
An expected credit loss allowance related to undrawn lines of credit on the FlexiPay product of £2.7 million 
(2023: £1.4 million) is held within provisions and other liabilities. The Group’s maximum exposure to credit risk on the 
undrawn lines of credit if they were all to be fully drawn would be £278.7 million (2023: £157.3 million). The Group has 
the ability to freeze, reduce or withdraw lines of credit as a way of managing associated credit risk.
Credit risk associates with SME loans held at amortised cost and lines of credit
Under IFRS 9, the Group is required to provide for loans measured at amortised cost under the expected credit loss 
(“ECL”) model. The impairment related to each loan is based on the ECLs associated with the probability of default of 
that loan in the next 12 months unless there has been a significant increase in credit risk of that loan since origination. 
The below factors are used in estimating the impairment:
STRATEGIC REPORT
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
CORPORATE GOVERNANCE

Funding Circle Holdings plc | Annual Report and Accounts 2024
159
16. Financial risk management continued
Financial risk factors continued
Credit risk continued
Credit risk associates with SME loans held at amortised cost and lines of credit continued
Factor
Description
Probability of 
Default (“PD”)
The Group has developed PD models tailored to each Term Loan or line of credit product to assess the 
likelihood of default within the next 12 months and over the lifetime. The models estimate PD based on the 
latest payment behaviour of the customers and observed historical trends. The PD model also includes an 
estimate of the future macroeconomic effect.
Exposure at 
Default (“EAD”) 
The Group has developed an EAD model for line of credit products to assess the likely exposure at default. 
The model calculates estimates of EAD based upon the latest payment behaviour of the customer, the credit 
limit utilisation, and applying a credit conversion factor approach.
Loss Given 
Default (“LGD”)
The Group has developed LGD models tailored to each Term Loan or line of credit product to assess the likely 
financial loss given an account defaults. The models calculate estimates of LGD based on historical data on 
observed recoveries against defaulted accounts.
Discount rate
The Group uses account-level effective interest rate which is calculated based on line of credit amount or 
loan amount, interest and fees, expected repayments including pre-payments and term.
Significant increase in credit risk: The Group assumes there has been a significant increase in credit risk if the loan or 
line of credit is overdue, or if the line of credit has been frozen due to identification of risk from sources such as bureau 
data indicating they have become overdue on a third party debt for example, or if the borrower is late on another FC 
product. A backstop is applied for any outstanding amounts on the loan investment exceed 30 days, in line with the 
rebuttable presumption per IFRS 9.
Forecast period: We estimate PD, EAD and LGD for the duration of the lifetime of the Term Loan or line of credit. Term 
Loans utilise the contractual term of the Term Loan. For lines of credit, the duration of the lifetime is estimated to be 
five years.
Definition of default: The Group defines a default, classified within non-performing, as a loan investment with any 
outstanding amounts exceeding a 90-day due date, which reflects the point at which the loan is considered to be 
credit-impaired. In some circumstances where loans are bought back by the Group, the financial asset associated with 
the purchase meets the definition of purchased or originated credit-impaired (“POCI”); this element of the impairment 
is therefore based on lifetime ECLs.
Lines of credit utilises the same default definition and probability of default under IFRS 9; however, they are assessed 
based on 12-month probability of default at the overall available line of credit level, estimating the expected utilisation 
of the line of credit at the estimated point of default. The expected credit loss impairment associated with undrawn 
lines of credit is disclosed within other liabilities in note 15 and in note 27.
SME loans held at amortised cost included PPP loans funded by the use of the PPPLF. The loans were guaranteed by 
the US government in the event of default and the loans were anticipated to be forgiven. At the point of default and 
subsequent collection of the guarantee or point of forgiveness, the loan and the respective borrowings under the 
PPPLF were extinguished. SME loans held at amortised cost also include loans which have been bought back from 
investors with the intention of collecting contractual cash flows. 
Lines of credit comprises £97.1 million (2023: £50.0 million) of drawn amounts through the FlexiPay product net of 
expected credit loss impairment.
The gross principal value of SME loans held at amortised cost is £11.3 million (2023: £21.4 million) and drawn lines 
of credit is £110.0 million (2023: £55.4 million), totalling £121.3 million (2023: £76.8 million), and an allowance for 
expected credit losses of £9.2 million (2023: £14.7 million) and £12.9 million (2023: £5.4 million) respectively, totalling 
£22.1 million (2023: £20.1 million), is held against these loans and drawn lines of credit as detailed below.
An impairment charge of £7.0 million (2023: impairment charge of £3.3 million) was recognised through the statement 
of comprehensive income in the year to 31 December 2024 within (provision)/credit for expected credit losses in the 
income statement related to drawn lines of credit and SME loans held at amortised cost.
CORPORATE GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
STRATEGIC REPORT

Funding Circle Holdings plc | Annual Report and Accounts 2024
160
Notes forming part of the consolidated financial statements continued
for the year ended 31 December 2024
16. Financial risk management continued
Financial risk factors continued
Credit risk continued
Credit risk associates with SME loans held at amortised cost and lines of credit continued
Additionally, an expected credit loss impairment charge was recognised relating to undrawn FlexiPay lines of credit of 
£1.3 million (31 December 2023: £1.1 million) and an expected credit loss impairment charge of £nil (31 December 2023: 
credit of £0.4 million) related to the loan repurchase liability and an expected credit loss impairment charge related to 
operational buybacks of £0.4 million (2023: £nil) were recognised as detailed in notes 15 and 27.
The Group bands each loan investment at origination using an internal risk rating and assesses credit losses on a 
collective portfolio basis by product. Credit risk grades are not reported to management on an ongoing basis and the 
only borrower specific information that is produced and used is past due status. There is no significant concentration 
of credit risk to specific industries or geographical regions.
Reconciliation of opening to closing ECL
Stage 1 
Performing: 
12-month ECL 
£m
Stage 2 
Underperforming: 
Lifetime ECL 
£m
Stage 3 
Non-performing: 
Lifetime ECL 
£m
POCI: 
Lifetime ECL 
£m
Total 
£m
At 1 January 2023
1.1
0.3
0.9
14.1
16.4
Impairment against new lending and purchased assets
12.6
0.1
0.1
0.6
13.4
Exchange differences
—
—
—
(0.5)
(0.5)
Impairment against loans transferred between 
stages
(0.3)
0.5
2.5
—
2.7
Loans repaid
(10.5)
—
(0.2)
(0.9)
(11.6)
Change in probability of default or loss given 
default assumptions
(1.3)
0.1
0.4
0.5
(0.3)
At 31 December 2023
1.6
1.0
3.7
13.8
20.1
Impairment against new lending and purchased assets
12.7
—
—
—
12.7
Exchange differences
—
—
(0.1)
(0.3)
(0.4)
Impairment against loans transferred between 
stages
(0.2)
3.9
7.1
—
10.8
Loans repaid
(11.2)
(3.3)
(0.4)
(0.7)
(15.6)
Impairment provision derecognised related to 
written off loans
—
—
—
(0.3)
(0.3)
Change in probability of default or loss given 
default assumptions
(0.1)
(0.2)
(0.8)
0.6
(0.5)
Derecognition of impairment associated with assets 
of discontinued operations
—
—
(0.1)
(4.6)
(4.7)
At 31 December 2024
2.8
1.4
9.4
8.5
22.1
STRATEGIC REPORT
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
CORPORATE GOVERNANCE

Funding Circle Holdings plc | Annual Report and Accounts 2024
161
16. Financial risk management continued
Financial risk factors continued
Credit risk continued
Credit risk associates with SME loans held at amortised cost and lines of credit continued
Expected credit 
loss coverage 
%
Basis for 
recognition of 
expected credit 
loss impairment
Gross lines 
of credit and 
SME loans held 
at amortised 
cost 
£m
Provision for 
expected 
credit loss 
£m
Net carrying 
amount 
£m
As at 31 December 2023
Stage 1 – Performing
2.9
12-month ECL
55.8
(1.6)
54.2
Stage 2 – Underperforming
50.0
Lifetime ECL
2.0
(1.0)
1.0
Stage 3 – Non-performing
86.0
Lifetime ECL
4.3
(3.7)
0.6
POCI (90+ days overdue)
93.9
Lifetime ECL
14.7
(13.8)
0.9
 
Total
76.8
(20.1)
56.7
As at 31 December 2024
Stage 1 – Performing
2.8
12-month ECL
99.1
(2.8)
96.3
Stage 2 – Underperforming
43.8
Lifetime ECL
3.2
(1.4)
1.8
Stage 3 – Non-performing
90.4
Lifetime ECL
10.4
(9.4)
1.0
POCI
98.8
Lifetime ECL
8.6
(8.5)
0.1
 
Total
121.3
(22.1)
99.2
Of which is drawn FlexiPay lines of credit
Expected credit 
loss coverage 
%
Basis for 
recognition of 
expected credit 
loss impairment
Gross lines 
of credit 
£m
Provision for 
expected 
credit loss 
£m
Net carrying 
amount 
£m
As at 31 December 2023
Stage 1 – Performing
2.8
12-month ECL
50.3
(1.4)
48.9
Stage 2 – Underperforming
52.6
Lifetime ECL
1.9
(1.0)
0.9
Stage 3 – Non-performing
93.8
Lifetime ECL
3.2
(3.0)
0.2
POCI
—
Lifetime ECL
—
—
—
 
Total
55.4
(5.4)
50.0
As at 31 December 2024
Stage 1 – Performing
2.8
12-month ECL
97.0
(2.7)
94.3
Stage 2 – Underperforming 
43.8
Lifetime ECL
3.2
(1.4)
1.8
Stage 3 – Non-performing
89.8
Lifetime ECL
9.8
(8.8)
1.0
POCI 
—
Lifetime ECL
—
—
—
 
Total
110.0
(12.9)
97.1
The risk and finance functions of the Group monitor the performance of the FlexiPay lines of credit and SME loans held 
at amortised cost and calculate the ECL estimate required for financial reporting purposes. These teams report to the 
Chief Financial Officer (“CFO”) and Chief Risk Officer (“CRO”). Discussions of estimates processes and results are held 
regularly at Balance Sheet Management and Impairment and Valuation Committee meetings along with regular updates 
provided to the Audit Committee.
Forward-looking information and scenarios: The allowance for expected credit losses required estimation to assess 
individual loans or when applying statistical models for collective assessments based on the Group’s past experience of 
historical delinquencies and loss trends, as well as forward-looking information in the form of macroeconomic scenarios 
governed by an impairment committee, which considers macroeconomic forecasts such as changes in interest rates, 
GDP and inflation which are considered for incorporation into scenarios and probability weighted. These scenarios are 
utilised to derive a default stress multiplier in the unstressed PD projections established from historical experience.
CORPORATE GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
STRATEGIC REPORT

Funding Circle Holdings plc | Annual Report and Accounts 2024
162
Notes forming part of the consolidated financial statements continued
for the year ended 31 December 2024
16. Financial risk management continued
Financial risk factors continued
Credit risk continued
Credit risk associates with SME loans held at amortised cost and lines of credit continued
Key changes to scenarios used in 2024: During the year, the business moved away from using macroeconomic 
scenarios derived from US macroeconomic data (primarily GDP which correlated well to US charge off rates) toward 
a focus on the UK macro economic data aligning with the disposal of the US business. 
UK-specific forecast data was obtained from a third party economics provider for three scenarios; a baseline, upside 
and downside scenario. A number of data points were obtained and considered by Funding Circle including GDP, 
real estate prices, unemployment rates, among others, however unemployment held the strongest correlation to 
UK insolvency rates and was determined to be more suitable under statistical modelling techniques. As a result 
unemployment was used as a single factor forecast input for determining scenarios utilised for PD stress multipliers. 
The scenarios used were as follows:
Macroeconomic drivers 
(average for the forecast year)
 
ECL scenarios
2025 
%
2026 
%
2027 
%
2028 
%
2029 
%
Unemployment rate %
Upside
3.97
3.65
3.62
3.63
3.64
Base case
4.40
4.31
4.18
4.06
4.00
Downside
5.15
5.98
6.71
6.71
6.48
A sensitivity to these assumptions on the estimated ECL is disclosed within note 2.
The nature of the stress forecasts was lower than those used in the previous year where there was a shift away 
from shorter, sharper stress forecast expectations associated with sharp inflation and supply chain issues to a more 
“traditional” gradual but longer lasting stress. In combination with this more muted stress multiplier derived from the 
scenarios FC shifted its benchmark weighting from 70% baseline, 20% downside, 10% upside from FY 2023 to 60% 
baseline, 30% downside and 10% upside in 2024 because in Funding Circle’s judgement the more subtle downside 
impact is more probable than the higher stress used under the prior year’s scenarios having considered possible weightings. 
Credit risk associated with other financial assets:
SME loans held at fair value through profit and loss relate to the underlying pool of SME loans from the legacy 
warehouses and SPVs that have since been purchased or novated into other Funding Circle entities, but remain held 
at FVTPL with the business model of holding the loans for sale. Additionally loans originated by the Group with the 
intention of selling onwards are included in this category.
Trade receivables represent the invoiced amounts in respect of servicing fees due from institutional investors. 
The risk of financial loss is deemed minimal because the counterparties are well established financial institutions.
Ongoing credit evaluation is performed on the financial condition of other receivables and, where appropriate, 
a provision for expected credit losses is recorded in the financial statements.
Other receivables include net investment in subleases of offices representing the present value of future sublease 
payments receivable. Where appropriate, impairment is recorded where the receivable is in doubt.
Individual risk limits for banks and financial institutions are set by the Group with reference to external rating agencies. 
The Group’s treasury policy has set limits and quantities that the Group must remain within. No credit or counterparty 
limits were exceeded during the year. The Group’s cash and cash equivalents split by S&P counterparty rating were 
A/A minus rated: £51.4 million (2023: £71.3 million), A+ or better rated: £136.3 million (2023: £150.1 million) and below 
A-rated: £nil (2023: £nil).
STRATEGIC REPORT
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
CORPORATE GOVERNANCE

Funding Circle Holdings plc | Annual Report and Accounts 2024
163
16. Financial risk management continued
Financial risk factors continued 
Liquidity risk 
Liquidity risk is the risk that the Group will not be able to meet its financial obligations as they fall due. The Group’s 
approach to managing liquidity is to ensure, as far as possible, that it will always have sufficient financial resources 
to meet its liabilities when due, under both normal and stressed conditions, without incurring unacceptable losses or 
risking damage to the Group’s position.
The Group’s liquidity position is monitored and reviewed on an ongoing basis by the Directors. 
The amounts disclosed in the following tables are the contractual undiscounted cash flows. The liquidity requirements 
of bank borrowings are met from cash flows generated by investment in FlexiPay lines of credit.
The maturity analysis of financial instruments at 31 December 2024 and 31 December 2023 is as follows: 
At 31 December 2024
Less than 
3 months 
£m
Between 
3 months and 
1 year 
£m
Between 1 
and 5 years 
£m
Over 
5 years 
£m
Total 
undiscounted 
cash flows 
£m
Impact of 
discounting  
£m
Carrying 
amount 
£m
Financial liabilities
Trade and other 
payables
(8.3)
—
—
—
(8.3)
—
(8.3)
Bank borrowings
—
(101.9)
—
—
(101.9)
—
(101.9)
Loan repurchase 
liability Note 1 
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
Lease liabilities
(0.5)
(1.4)
(7.4)
—
(9.3)
1.7
(7.6)
(8.8)
(103.3)
(7.4)
—
(119.5)
1.7
(117.8)
At 31 December 2023
Less than 
3 months 
£m
Between 
3 months and 
1 year 
£m
Between 1 
and 5 years 
£m
Over 
5 years 
£m
Total 
undiscounted 
cash flows 
£m
Impact of 
discounting Note 2 
£m
Carrying 
amount 
£m
Financial liabilities
Trade and other 
payables
(34.8)
—
(0.2)
—
(35.0)
—
(35.0)
Bank borrowings
—
(54.7)
(2.2)
—
(56.9)
—
(56.9)
Loan repurchase 
liability Note 1 
(0.1)
—
—
—
(0.1)
—
(0.1)
Lease liabilities
(1.8)
(5.5)
(5.9)
—
(13.2)
0.6
(12.6)
(36.7)
(60.2)
(8.3)
—
(105.2)
0.6
(104.6)
1. Financial guarantees provided for in the loan repurchase liability are allocated to the earliest period in which the guarantee could possibly be called.
Bank borrowings comprise the drawn balance on a committed lending facility in the FlexiPay warehouse of £101.9 million 
(2023: £54.7 million) at a floating rate of interest based on SONIA plus a margin. They previously also comprised of 
drawn amounts in the US of $2.8 million in 2023 on the PPP Liquidity Facility available from the Federal Reserve Bank 
at a fixed interest rate of 0.35%. 
Market risk
Market risk is the risk that the fair value of future cash flows of a financial instrument will fluctuate because of changes 
in market prices. The Group’s market risk arises from open positions in interest-bearing assets and liabilities, to the 
extent that these are exposed to general and specific market movements. 
a) Other price risk
The fair value of the SME loans which are held at fair value through profit and loss can fluctuate depending on market 
pricing of relative interest rates and credit risk. This is reflected in the discount rate used to derive a valuation for the 
loan assets. The discount rates used in the valuation of the assets measured at fair value through profit and loss are 
not considered to be a material source of estimation uncertainty and a sensitivity analysis has not been disclosed.
CORPORATE GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
STRATEGIC REPORT

Funding Circle Holdings plc | Annual Report and Accounts 2024
164
Notes forming part of the consolidated financial statements continued
for the year ended 31 December 2024
16. Financial risk management continued
Financial risk factors continued
Market risk continued
b) Interest rate risk
The Group is exposed to interest rate risk in relation to financial liabilities through drawn committed borrowing facilities 
and on financial assets through investment in SME loans. 
Non-trading interest rate risk
The Group’s interest risk on financial instruments is limited to interest receivable on loan note investments, cash and 
cash equivalent balances and interest on bonds and bank borrowings. The maturities of financial instruments subject 
to interest rate risk are as follows:
Less than 3 months
Between 3 months and 1 year
Between 1 and 5 years
At 31 December
2024 
£m
2023 
£m
2024 
£m
2023 
£m
2024 
£m
2023 
£m
Fixed rate
SME loans at amortised cost
0.2
1.1
0.1
0.6
1.8
5.0
Investment in trusts and 
co-investments
 
—
—
—
—
17.8
25.2
Lines of credit
49.8
50.0
47.3
—
—
—
SME loans fair value through profit 
and loss Note 1 
0.7
0.6
—
13.5
0.5
4.5
Bank borrowings Note 2 
—
—
—
—
—
(2.2)
Floating rate
Cash and cash equivalents
187.6
221.4
—
—
—
—
Bank borrowings Note 2 
—
—
(101.9)
(54.7)
—
—
238.3
273.1
(54.5)
(40.6)
20.1
32.5
1. The SME loans held at fair value through profit and loss are classified as current on the balance sheet, reflecting that the position is held to sell. The above table 
represents the contractual maturities.
Note 2.  In the comparative year ended 31 December 2023, the fixed rate bank borrowings and SME loans held at amortised cost included the Group’s drawing of the PPP 
Liquidity Facility in the US in order to fund PPP loan originations. These were classified as non-current on the balance sheet, and the above table represents the 
contractual maturities, although the PPP loans could have been forgiven by the SBA and the associated liability could have been repaid from the proceeds within 
12 months of the balance sheet date. The floating rate bank borrowings represent the facility in the FlexiPay warehouse used to originate lines of credit.
There are no financial assets or liabilities with a maturity of over five years.
Interest rate risk sensitivity analysis – non-trading interest (fixed rate)
Interest on SME loans and on the PPPLF borrowings (in the US) was fixed until the maturity of the investment and is not 
impacted by market rate changes. All remaining US bond liabilities were repaid during the year to 31 December 2023 
and all other US SME loan assets sold in the year ended 31 December 2024. The level of future interest rate receivable 
would be similar to that received in the year and the impact of movements in interest rates on the value of the assets is 
considered immaterial to the Group’s overall performance for the year.
STRATEGIC REPORT
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
CORPORATE GOVERNANCE

Funding Circle Holdings plc | Annual Report and Accounts 2024
165
16. Financial risk management continued
Financial risk factors continued
Market risk continued
b) Interest rate risk continued
Interest rate risk sensitivity analysis – non-trading interest (floating rate)
Interest on cash and cash equivalent balances is subject to movements in base rates. The Directors monitor interest 
rate risk and note that base rates are anticipated to decrease in the near term. A 100bps decrease in annualised 
interest rates applied to cash and cash equivalent balances FC holds in interest bearing accounts at 31 December 2024 
would decrease interest income by £5.1 million.
Interest on bank borrowings related to the FlexiPay lines of credit are subject to movements in the Sterling Overnight 
Index Average Rate (“SONIA”). The Group has partially protected itself through the use of an interest rate cap with a 
strike price of 6.5% and a notional amount that increases in line with the projected drawdowns on the senior borrowing 
facility. The fair value of the interest rate cap is not material to the Group.
If SONIA were to increase by 100 bps, based on the drawn balance at 31 December 2024, the annualised interest 
expense recognised in borrowing costs would increase by £1.0 million (2023: £0.5 million) (including any impact of the 
interest rate cap). Additionally, while the fees charged on FlexiPay lines of credit are fixed for the duration of individual 
drawdowns, due to the short-term and revolving nature of the product, the Group can reprice the fees charged on 
drawdowns at short notice in order to manage interest rate risk of the floating rate borrowings. Interest charged on 
Cashback credit card balances outstanding is regularly updated to align with prevailing market rates of interest and are 
also short-term in nature. As a result there is not considered to be significant interest rate risk.
Some of the Group’s investment in trusts are through warehouse vehicles where the Group is a minority equity investor. 
The senior borrowing facilities utilised in these vehicles receive interest on borrowings in priority to payments to the 
equity investors at SONIA plus a margin. As a result of the increase in SONIA since the inception of these vehicles, 
the increased borrowing costs have reduced the expected cash returns to the equity investors of the investment 
held at fair value through profit and loss. The impact is recognised in fair value gains and losses in the statement of 
comprehensive income. Some, but not all of the vehicles, had interest rate caps or interest rate swaps within their 
structures which can mitigate the impact of future rate rises. The remaining leveraged warehouse vehicles, which 
previously did not hold hedging instruments, entered into cap or swap agreements during the year ended 31 December 
2024 and 2023.
The fair value of investments in trusts and co-investments are no longer considered to be sensitive to further increases 
in SONIA or the projected SONIA rates as a result of hedging in place.
c) Sensitivity analysis
IFRS 7 requires disclosure of sensitivity analysis for each type of market risk to which the entity is exposed at the report 
date showing how profit or loss and equity would have been affected by changing the relevant risk variables that were 
reasonably possible at that date. 
As discussed above, the Group does not have significant exposure to price or cash flow risk and therefore no 
sensitivity analysis for those risks has been disclosed.
d) Foreign exchange risk
The Group operated internationally and is exposed to foreign exchange risk arising from various currency exposures, 
primarily with respect to the US dollar, the UK pound sterling and the euro. Foreign exchange risk arises from future 
commercial transactions, recognised assets and liabilities and net investments in foreign operations.
The Group’s policy is, where possible, to allow Group entities to settle liabilities denominated in their functional 
currency with the cash generated from their own operations in that currency. Where Group entities have liabilities 
denominated in a currency other than their functional currency (and have insufficient reserves of that currency to settle 
them), cash already denominated in that currency will, where possible, be transferred from elsewhere within the Group.
Apart from these particular cash flows, the Group aims to fund expenses and investments in the respective currency  
and to manage foreign exchange risk at a local level by matching the currency in which income is generated and 
expenses are incurred.
 
The Group had certain investments in foreign operations, whose net assets are exposed to foreign currency 
translation risk. 
CORPORATE GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
STRATEGIC REPORT

Funding Circle Holdings plc | Annual Report and Accounts 2024
166
Notes forming part of the consolidated financial statements continued
for the year ended 31 December 2024
16. Financial risk management continued
Financial risk factors continued
Market risk continued
d) Foreign exchange risk continued
The table below sets out the Group’s currency exposures from financial assets and liabilities held by Group companies 
in currencies other than their functional currencies and resulting in exchange movements in the income statement and 
balance sheet.
31 December 2024
31 December 2023
USD 
£m
GBP 
£m
EUR 
£m
Total 
£m
USD 
£m
GBP 
£m
EUR 
£m
Total 
£m
Cash and cash 
equivalents
—
—
— 
—
0.2
—
—
0.2
Intra-group assets
—
—
0.1
0.1
—
—
0.2
0.2
Intra-group 
liabilities
—
—
(0.5)
(0.5)
(45.5)
—
(0.3)
(45.8)
The Group assessed the sensitivity to a 10% depreciation and 10% appreciation in pound sterling against the relevant 
foreign currencies. While 5% is the sensitivity rate used when reporting foreign currency risk internally to senior 
management personnel, in light of recent fluctuations in foreign exchange rates, 10% represents management’s 
current assessment of a reasonably possible change in foreign exchange rates. The sensitivity analysis to the income 
statement includes only outstanding foreign currency-denominated monetary items and adjusts their translation at 
the year end for a 10% change in foreign currency rates. The sensitivity analysis illustrates the impact on the foreign 
currency translation reserve within equity of the retranslation of quasi-equity loans to foreign operations within the 
Group and net investment in foreign operations of the Group. 
The Group’s sensitivity to fluctuations in foreign currencies is related to the US dollar and euro amounts held in the 
Parent Company. The impact of a 10% change in foreign currency rates is as follows:
Appreciation in pound sterling
Depreciation in pound sterling
At 31 December
Income 
statement 
2024 
£m
Equity 
2024 
£m
Income 
statement 
2023 
£m
Equity 
2024 
£m
Income 
statement 
2024 
£m
Equity 
2024 
£m
Income 
statement 
2023 
£m
Equity 
2024 
£m
US dollars
—
—
—
(3.0)
—
—
—
3.7
Euros
—
(1.0)
—
0.9
—
0.8
—
(1.1)
 
—
(1.0)
—
(2.1)
—
0.8
—
2.6
Impairment of net investment in subleases: 
Certain right-of-use assets related to the US San Francisco office were sublet under a financing sublease and were 
represented as net investments in subleases within other receivables. Due to a reduction in market values since 
inception of the sublet, the estimated cash flows expected on expiry of the existing sublet and expectations of further 
sublet were lower and as a result an impairment of £0.8 million was recognised in the prior year ended 31 December 2023. 
The impairment is disclosed in the consolidated statement of comprehensive income within depreciation, amortisation 
and impairment.
Capital management
The Group considers its capital to comprise its ordinary share capital, share premium, foreign exchange reserve, share 
options reserve and retained earnings. Quantitative detail is shown in the consolidated statement of changes in equity.
The Directors’ objective when managing capital is to safeguard the Group’s ability to continue as a going concern in 
order to provide returns for the shareholders and benefits for other stakeholders and to maintain an optimal capital 
structure to reduce the cost of capital.
The Directors monitor a number of KPIs at both the Group and individual subsidiary level on a monthly basis. As part of 
the budgetary process, targets are set with respect to operating expenses in order to effectively manage the activities 
of the Group. Performance is reviewed on a regular basis and appropriate actions are taken as required. These internal 
measures indicate the performance of the business against budget/forecast and confirm whether the Group has 
adequate resources to meet its working capital requirements.
STRATEGIC REPORT
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
CORPORATE GOVERNANCE
 
 

Funding Circle Holdings plc | Annual Report and Accounts 2024
167
16. Financial risk management continued
Capital management continued
The Group is subject to externally imposed capital requirements by the Financial Conduct Authority but these are lower 
than internally set requirements. During the year, the Group complied with all externally imposed requirements.
17. Share capital
31 December 
2024 
Number
31 December 
2024 
£
31 December 
2023 
Number
31 December 
2023 
£
Called up, allotted and fully paid
Ordinary shares of £0.001 at beginning of the year
361,303,143
361,303
361,303,143
361,303
Share buybacks
(33,367,364)
(33,367)
—
—
Ordinary shares of £0.001 at end of the year
327,935,779
327,936
361,303,143
361,303
No ordinary shares were issued in 2024 or 2023 in connection with employee share schemes.
The share capital reduced by £0.1 million in the year (2023: £nil) as a result of share buybacks and cancellations.
Included in the total number of ordinary shares outstanding are 8,038,483 (2023: 16,614,054) shares held by the 
Group’s Employee Benefit Trust, which includes 7,897,659 shares (2023: 16,473,230) that were purchased (nil purchased 
(2023: 3,290,000) and 8,575,571 (2023: 3,288,009) utilised to satisfy employee share option plans) and 4,051,362 
(2023: 5,428,551) shares held by the Group’s Share Incentive Plan Trust.
18. Share premium account
2024 
£m
2023 
£m
At 1 January
293.1
293.1
Exercise of options – proceeds received
0.5
—
Capital reduction
(293.5)
—
At 31 December
0.1
293.1
On 12 December 2024, the Group completed a capital reduction exercise under section 641 of the Companies Act 
2006. As a result, the entire share premium balance at that date of £293,486,755 was cancelled and created an 
accumulated profit within the Group’s profit and loss account and now constitutes a distributable reserve.
19. Foreign exchange reserve
£m
At 1 January 2023
16.9
Exchange difference on translating the net assets of foreign operations
(2.7)
At 31 December 2023
14.2
Exchange difference on translating the net assets of foreign operations
(0.2)
Reclassification to profit and loss on disposal of discontinued operations
(8.7)
At 31 December 2024
5.3
Exchange differences relating to the translation of the net assets of the Group’s subsidiaries from their functional 
currency into the Company’s functional currency are recognised directly in the foreign exchange reserves within equity.
CORPORATE GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
STRATEGIC REPORT

Funding Circle Holdings plc | Annual Report and Accounts 2024
168
Notes forming part of the consolidated financial statements continued
for the year ended 31 December 2024
20. (Accumulated losses)/retained earnings
£m
At 1 January 2023
(48.6)
Transfer of share option costs
3.8
Purchase of own shares
(1.8)
Loss for the year
(38.3)
At 31 December 2023
(84.9)
Transfer of share option costs
6.6
Buyback and cancellation of own shares
(33.6)
Capital reduction
293.5
Loss for the year
8.6
At 31 December 2024
190.2
The transfer of share option costs is in relation to the exercise of share options during the year and their associated 
costs in the share options reserve which are transferred to (accumulated losses)/retained earnings.
During the year ended 31 December 2024, £nil (2023: £1.8 million) of ordinary shares were purchased by the EBT 
for the purposes of satisfying employee share option plans. The number of shares purchased was nil and the average 
purchase price was £nil (2023: 3.3 million and £0.53). All shares have a nominal value of £0.001.
The Group commenced a share buyback programme in March 2024 to buy and cancel up to £25 million of shares in 
order to return value to shareholders. The nominal cost of the shares cancelled reduces the Group’s share capital 
with an equal increase in the capital redemption reserve. The full cost of the buyback inclusive of stamp duty and 
broker fees is debited to retained earnings. This programme was completed on 15 October 2024 with the purchase 
of 27,308,339 ordinary shares, and the programme was extended to up to a further £25 million of shares. In the year 
to 31 December 2024, 33.5 million shares were purchased for consideration of £33.7 million inclusive of fees and 
expenses under the programme representing 9.3% of the called up share capital. 0.2 million of the purchased shares 
were pending cancellation as at 31 December 2024.
On 12 December 2024, the Group completed a capital reduction exercise under section 641 of the Companies Act 
2006. As a result, the entire share premium balance at that date of £293,486,755 was cancelled and created an 
accumulated profit within the Group’s profit and loss account and now constitutes a distributable reserve.
21. Share-based payment
The Company operates share schemes for all employees of the Group. The terms of the main current schemes from 
which the Group’s employees benefit are set out below.
Post-IPO employee share plans
Since the Company’s admission on the London Stock Exchange, the Company has operated a discretionary 
share-based Long-Term Incentive Plan (“LTIP”). In November 2020, the Company introduced a Share Incentive Plan 
(“SIP”) approved by HMRC, which includes partnership shares and matching shares. This plan is now only relevant for 
UK-based employees.
The main features of the LTIP and SIP are set out below.
Post-IPO – LTIP
Form of LTIP Awards
The Board grants awards in the form of restricted stock units at no cost or options to acquire shares at no cost  
(a nil-cost option).
Performance conditions
LTIP Awards are not currently subject to performance conditions with the exception of LTIP Awards granted to 
Executive Directors which are subject to performance conditions. Refer to the Remuneration Report for further details.
Any performance condition may be amended or substituted if one or more events occur which cause the Board to 
reasonably consider that an amended or substituted performance condition would be more appropriate and would not 
be materially less difficult to satisfy than originally intended.
STRATEGIC REPORT
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
CORPORATE GOVERNANCE

Funding Circle Holdings plc | Annual Report and Accounts 2024
169
21. Share-based payment continued
Post-IPO employee share plans continued
Post-IPO – LTIP continued
CORPORATE GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
STRATEGIC REPORT
Vesting and release of LTIP Awards 
LTIP Awards granted to employees, excluding Executive Directors, currently vest subject to continued service only 
(“Time-Based Vesting”) in accordance with a vesting schedule set at grant. 
LTIP Awards granted to Executive Directors vest at the end of three years subject to achievement of performance 
conditions. Further details are shown in the Remuneration Report. 
The Board may determine at grant that an LTIP Award is subject to an additional holding period following vesting 
(a “Holding Period”). LTIP Options will be exercisable from the date of vesting or, if applicable, the end of the Holding 
Period until the tenth anniversary of the grant date, or such earlier date as the Board determines. 
Cessation of employment 
LTIP Options may normally be exercised to the extent vested for a period of six months after ceasing employment or 
12 months after death (or such other period as the Board may determine). 
Post-IPO – SIP 
Form of SIP Awards 
The Board grants awards in the form of partnership shares and matching shares. 
Performance conditions 
There are no performance conditions attached to partnership shares and matching shares. 
Free shares 
Until 2022 under the SIP, all UK employees were eligible to receive up to a maximum of £3,600, or 10% of annual salary 
if less, of free shares per tax year. Free shares were awarded annually with a forfeiture period of two years and a 
holding period of three years. 
Matching shares 
UK employees are invited to buy partnership shares from pre-tax salary with a maximum investment in each tax year 
of £1,800, or 10% of annual salary if less. Partnership shares are purchased every month. Employees can withdraw 
partnership shares from the SIP at any time although there are tax advantages if the shares are retained in the SIP for 
at least three years. 
Up to 2022 participants were awarded one matching share for every one partnership share they purchased, and from 
2023 this was increased to two matching shares for every partnership share purchased. There are tax advantages to 
participants if the matching shares are retained in the SIP for at least three years. 
Whilst employed by the Company, a participant will forfeit a corresponding number of matching shares if they choose 
to transfer partnership shares out of the SIP within three years of the date of purchase. 
Under normal circumstances, if a participant leaves the Company before the second anniversary of the date of award, 
they will forfeit their matching shares. If they leave between two and three years of the date of award, they retain 
their matching shares but those shares must be removed from the SIP and any tax advantages are lost. If a participant 
leaves under special circumstances, they will retain all of their matching shares, regardless of how long they have been 
held in the SIP. 
Pre-IPO employee share plans 
EMI Options 
Prior to June 2014, the Company issued options to UK subsidiary undertakings’ employees under the EMI Options 
Scheme. Since then, the Company is not eligible to issue under the scheme. 
Unapproved Options 
The Company had an Unapproved Options Scheme for all employees of the Group. In accordance with standard 
vesting terms, the full award vested four years after the vesting start date, with 25% vesting on the first anniversary of 
the vesting date and 6.25% every three months thereafter. If the options remain unexercised after a period of ten years 
from the date of grant, the options expire. 

Funding Circle Holdings plc | Annual Report and Accounts 2024
170
Notes forming part of the consolidated financial statements continued
for the year ended 31 December 2024
21. Share-based payment continued
Pre-IPO employee share plans continued
STRATEGIC REPORT
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
CORPORATE GOVERNANCE
US Options Scheme 2 
Options granted under the US Options Scheme 2 are Unapproved Options granted to US employees as either 
non-qualifying options or incentive stock options. The US Options Scheme 2 has the same vesting period as 
Unapproved Options. If the options remain unexercised after a period of ten years from the date of grant, the options 
expire. Unvested options are forfeited if the employee leaves the Group before the options vest. New grants under this 
scheme ceased in 2018 upon IPO. 
All share-based incentives are subject to service conditions. Such conditions are not taken into account in the fair 
value of the service received. The fair value of services received in return for share-based incentives is measured 
by reference to the fair value of share-based incentives granted. The estimate of the fair value of the share-based 
incentives is measured using market prices. When market prices do not exist for shares or rights to shares with similar 
characteristics, fair value is determined by using a valuation technique (either the Monte Carlo or Black-Scholes pricing 
model as is most appropriate for each scheme). 
Charge for the year 
Included in operating expenses of the Group is a charge for share-based payments and associated social security 
costs of £7.8 million (2023: £3.8 million) that arises from transactions accounted for as equity-settled share-based 
payment transactions from continuing operations and £1.0 million (2023: £1.8 million) from discontinued operations. 
Additionally, an exceptional credit of £1.7 million (2023: £nil) is included within discontinued operations relating to 
lapses of share-based payments on the sale of the US business. 
Movements in share plans 
Details of movements in the share schemes during the year are as follows: 
EMI Options 
Unapproved 
Options 
Free shares 
and matching 
shares
LTIP Awards 
US Options 
Schemes
Total 
Number and WAEP Note 1 
Number and WAEP
Number and WAEP
Number and WAEP
Number and WAEP
Number and WAEP 
Number
£m
Number
£m
Number
£m
Number 
£m
Number
£m
Number
£m 
Outstanding 
at 1 January 
2023
141,300 0.026 5,009,896 0.314 4,833,226 
— 
19,860,718 
— 2,816,272 
0.431
32,661,412 0.097 
Granted 
during the 
year
—
—
—
—
653,742
— 
21,443,472 
—
—
—
22,097,214
— 
Exercised 
during the 
year
(96,000) 0.027 (386,367) 0.143
(383,116) 
—
(2,971,351) —
(3,034) 0.516 
(3,839,868) 0.014 
Forfeited 
during the 
year
—
—
(938) 0.440
(711,218) 
— 
(4,792,300) 
—
(40,888) 0.522 
(5,545,344) 0.004 
Outstanding 
at 31 
December 
2023
45,300 0.024 4,622,591 
0.328 4,392,634 
— 33,540,539 
— 2,772,350 
0.429
45,373,414 0.068

 
Funding Circle Holdings plc | Annual Report and Accounts 2024
171
21. Share-based payment continued
Movements in share plans continued
CORPORATE GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
STRATEGIC REPORT
EMI Options 
Unapproved 
Options 
Free shares 
and matching 
shares
LTIP Awards 
US Options 
Schemes
Total 
Number and WAEP Note 1 
Number and WAEP
Number and WAEP
Number and WAEP
Number and WAEP
Number and WAEP 
Number
£m
Number
£m
Number
£m
Number 
£m
Number
£m
Number
£m 
Outstanding 
at 1 January 
2024
45,300 
0.024 4,622,591 
0.328 4,392,634 
— 33,540,539 
— 2,772,350 0.429
45,373,414 0.068 
Granted 
during the 
year
—
—
—
—
469,010
—
12,313,814 
—
—
—
12,782,824
— 
Exercised 
during the 
year
(45,300) 0.024 
(951,535) 0.360 
(826,552) 
— 
(6,733,720) —
(741,224) 0.294
(9,298,331) 0.061 
Forfeited 
during the 
year
—
—
(141) 0.440
(717,480) 
— 
(13,159,091) 
—
(16,093) 0.245 
(13,892,805)
— 
Outstanding 
at 31 
December 
2024
—
— 3,670,915 
0.319 
3,317,612
— 
25,961,542 
— 2,015,033 0.480 
34,965,102 0.072 
1. Weighted average exercise price. 
The following table summarises information about the share awards outstanding at 31 December 2024: 
Range of 
exercise 
prices 
EMI Options 
Unapproved 
Options 
Free shares 
and matching 
shares
LTIP Awards 
US Options 
Schemes
Total 
Number and WARCL1 
Number and WARCL 
Number and WARCL Number and WARCL 
Number and WARCL
Number and WARCL 
Number
Years
Number
Years
Number Years
Number
Years
Number
Years
Number
Years 
£0–£0.008
—
— 2,190,017
3.4 3,317,612
— 25,961,542 8.0
—
—
31,469,171
6.8 
£0.009– 
£0.176
—
—
2,033
—
—
—
— 
—
—
—
2,033
— 
£0.177– 
£0.471
—
— 1,110,227
2.6
—
—
— 
— 1,417,650
0.9
2,527,877
1.7 
£0.472– 
£1.75
—
— 
368,638
3.4
—
—
— 
— 
597,383
3.4
966,021
3.4 
—
— 3,670,915
3.2 
3,317,612
— 
25,961,542 8.0 2,015,033
1.7 
34,965,102
6.4 
1. Weighted average remaining contractual life.

Funding Circle Holdings plc | Annual Report and Accounts 2024
172
Notes forming part of the consolidated financial statements continued
for the year ended 31 December 2024
21. Share-based payment continued
Movements in share plans continued
STRATEGIC REPORT
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
CORPORATE GOVERNANCE
The following table summarises information about the share awards outstanding at 31 December 2023: 
Range of 
exercise 
prices 
EMI Options 
Unapproved 
Options 
Free shares 
and matching 
shares
LTIP Awards 
US Options 
Schemes
Total 
Number and WARCL1 
Number and WARCL
Number and WARCL 
Number and WARCL 
Number and WARCL
Number and WARCL 
Number
Years
Number
Years
Number Years
Number Years
Number
Years
Number 
Years 
£0–£0.008
—
— 
2,190,017
4.4 4,392,634 
— 
33,540,539 8.4
—
—
40,123,190
7.3 
£0.009– 
£0.176
45,300
0.4
18,438
1.1
—
—
— 
—
24,302
0.4
88,040
0.5 
£0.177– 
£0.471
—
— 2,045,498
3.2
—
—
— 
— 2,150,665
1.8
4,196,163
2.4 
£0.472– 
£1.75
—
—
368,638
4.5
—
—
— 
— 
597,383
4.5
966,021
4.5 
45,300
0.4 
4,622,591
3.8 
4,392,634
— 
33,540,539 8.4 2,772,350
2.3
45,373,414
6.7 
1. Weighted average remaining contractual life. 
Unapproved Options Scheme 
There have been no Unapproved Options granted since IPO in 2018. The weighted average fair values of options 
granted under the Unapproved Options Scheme and the US Options Scheme ranged between £0.73 and £1.80 per 
option respectively in the previous year. These values were determined using the Black-Scholes valuation model. 
The significant inputs into the model are as follows: 
Unapproved Options Scheme 
31 December 
2019 
Share price (various times during the year)
£1.89 
Exercise price
£nil–£0.44 
Expected life
4 years 
Expected volatility
48% 
Risk-free interest rate (between)
0.93%–1.02% 
Dividend yield
Nil 
Forward exchange rate – US Options (between)
0.769 
LTIP Awards 
Since all LTIP Awards were made post-IPO, the Company has used its share price at grant date as the fair value of the 
LTIP Awards granted during the year to employees. 
Free shares and matching shares 
The Company has used its share price at grant date as the fair value of free shares and matching shares granted during 
the year to employees. 

Funding Circle Holdings plc | Annual Report and Accounts 2024
173
 
CORPORATE GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
STRATEGIC REPORT
22. Notes to the consolidated statement of cash flows 
Cash outflow from operating activities 
31 December 
2024 
£m 
31 December 
2023 
£m 
Profit/(loss) before taxation 
Continuing operations
0.8
(9.9) 
Discontinued operations
8.4
(23.3) 
Total operations 
9.2
(33.2) 
Adjustments for: 
Depreciation of property, plant and equipment
3.2
4.3 
Amortisation of intangible assets
9.8
12.4 
Modification gain
(0.4)
— 
Impairment of property, plant and equipment, intangible assets, ROU assets and investment in 
sublease
0.9
6.2 
Impairment of intangibles (exceptional item)
0.3
— 
Interest payable
0.8
0.6 
Non-cash employee benefits expense – share-based payments and associated 
social security costs
8.1
5.6 
Fair value adjustments
(6.4)
(8.7) 
Movement in loan repurchase liability
(0.1)
(0.4) 
Movement in other provisions
1.7
0.9 
Share of gains of associates
—
(0.1) 
ECL impairment
8.7
4.4 
Profit on sale of the US subsidiary (exceptional item)
(9.8)
— 
Recycling of foreign exchange reserve on sale of subsidiary (exceptional item)
(8.7)
— 
Other non-cash movements
(0.2)
0.7 
Changes in working capital 
Movement in trade and other receivables
(3.1)
(13.5) 
Movement in trade and other payables
(26.6)
34.7 
Tax paid
(0.1)
(0.6) 
Originations of lines of credit
(467.0)
(230.4) 
Cash receipts from lines of credit
412.3
191.5 
Net cash outflow from operating activities
(67.4)
(25.6) 
Cash and cash equivalents 
31 December 
2024 
£m 
31 December 
2023 
£m 
Cash and cash equivalents
187.6
221.4 
The cash and cash equivalents balance is made up of cash and money market funds. The carrying amount of 
these assets is approximately equal to their fair value. Included within cash and cash equivalents above is a total of 
£37.1 million (2023: £51.8 million) in cash which is restricted in use. Of this, £nil (2023: £1.1 million) is restricted in use 
in the event of rental payment defaults and is therefore restricted in its use. £5.0 million (2023: £31.1 million) of cash is 
held which is restricted in use to repaying investors in CBILS and RLS loans and paying CBILS and RLS-related costs 
to the UK government. A further £32.1 million (2023: £19.6 million) of cash is held which is restricted for use in the 
FlexiPay warehouse. 
At 31 December 2024, money market funds totalled £136.3 million (2023: £150.1 million).

Funding Circle Holdings plc | Annual Report and Accounts 2024
174
Notes forming part of the consolidated financial statements continued
for the year ended 31 December 2024
22. Notes to the consolidated statement of cash flows continued
STRATEGIC REPORT
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
CORPORATE GOVERNANCE
Analysis of changes in liabilities from financing activities 
1 January 
2023 
£m 
Cash flow 
£m 
Exchange 
movements 
£m 
Other non-cash 
movements 
£m 
31 December 
2023 
£m 
Bank borrowings
(22.6)
(34.9)
0.6
—
(56.9) 
Bonds
(23.7)
23.4
0.6
(0.3)
— 
Lease liabilities
(19.8)
7.2
0.6
(0.6)
(12.6) 
Liabilities from financing activities
(66.1)
(4.3)
1.8
(0.9)
(69.5) 
1 January 
2024 
£m 
Cash flow 
£m 
Exchange 
movements 
£m 
Other non-cash 
movements 
£m 
Derecognition 
of liabilities 
related to 
discontinued 
operations 
£m 
31 December 
2024 
£m 
Bank borrowings
(56.9)
(46.6)
—
—
1.6
(101.9) 
Lease liabilities
(12.6)
3.6
(0.3)
(5.8)
7.5
(7.6) 
Liabilities from financing activities
(69.5)
(43.0)
(0.3)
(5.8)
9.1
(109.5) 
23. Operating lease arrangements 
As disclosed in notes 1 and 11, leases of low value items or short-term leases continue to be treated as 
operating leases. 
31 December 
2024 
£m 
31 December 
2023 
£m 
Lease payments under operating leases recognised as an expense in the year Note 1 
0.2
0.4 
1. The current and comparative lease expense relates to discontinued operations. 
At the balance sheet date, the Group had outstanding commitments for future minimum lease payments under non-
cancellable operating leases of £0.1 million (2023: £0.3 million). 
Operating lease payments represent payments for lease assets that are individually considered low value. 
24. Dividends per share 
No ordinary dividends were declared or paid in the current or previous financial years.

Funding Circle Holdings plc | Annual Report and Accounts 2024
175
CORPORATE GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
STRATEGIC REPORT
25. Related party transactions 
Balances and transactions between the Company and its subsidiaries, which are related parties, have been eliminated 
on consolidation and are not disclosed in this note. 
Compensation of key management personnel 
Key management personnel are those persons having authority and responsibility for planning, directing and 
controlling the activities of the Group. The Group’s key management personnel comprises the Executive Committee 
(“ExCo”), formerly known as the Global Leadership Team (“GLT”), which is made up of the Executive Directors and other 
senior management, as defined in note 5, as the chief operating decision maker (“CODM”) and the Non-Executive 
Directors of the Group. 
31 December 
2024 
£m 
31 December 
2023 
£m 
Salaries and short-term benefits
5.0 
4.8 
Equity-based compensation
1.3 
2.0 
Post-employment benefits
0.1 
0.1 
6.4 
6.9 
Further details on Directors’ remuneration are disclosed in the Remuneration Report in the Corporate Governance 
section of the Annual Report and Accounts on pages 101 to 111. 
Transactions with other related parties 
During the year, the Group received capital redemptions of £0.9 million (2023: £1.1 million) and received dividends of 
£nil (2023: £0.1 million) from entities accounted for as associates. 
During the year, the Group received service fees from loans held by Throgmorton Lending Designated Activity 
Company of £0.1 million (2023: £0.3 million). This entity is a subsidiary of the Group’s associate, as detailed in note 29. 
26. Ultimate controlling party 
In the opinion of the Directors, the Group does not have a single ultimate controlling party. 
27. Contingent liabilities and commitments 
As part of the ongoing business, the Group has operational requirements with its investors. At any point in time, 
it is possible that a particular investor may expect the Group to purchase their loan in the event of a breach of 
representation or warranty, operational errors or control issues or where agreed eligibility criteria have not been 
complied with. Where a loan is purchased it is presented within SME loans held at amortised cost on the face of the 
consolidated balance sheet and held at amortised cost under IFRS 9. 
In common with other businesses, the Group is involved from time to time in disputes in the ordinary course of 
business. There are no active cases expected to have a material adverse financial impact on the Group. 
The Group has commitments related to undrawn amounts on issued FlexiPay lines of credit. At 31 December 2024, 
there were undrawn commitments of £278.7 million (2023: £157.3 million). An expected credit loss impairment 
allowance is held within other provisions by the Group of £2.7 million (2023: £1.4 million) in relation to the estimated 
credit losses the Group may be exposed to on these undrawn lines of credit. 
28. Subsequent events 
There have been no subsequent events since the balance sheet date.

 
Funding Circle Holdings plc | Annual Report and Accounts 2024
176
Notes forming part of the consolidated financial statements continued
for the year ended 31 December 2024
 
 
STRATEGIC REPORT
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
CORPORATE GOVERNANCE
29. Interests in other entities 
Investments in subsidiaries 
The Group had the following subsidiaries, all of which have been included in these consolidated financial statements. 
The proportion of the voting rights in subsidiary undertakings held directly by the Company does not differ from the 
proportion of ordinary shares held. 
Subsidiary undertakings 
Place of 
incorporation
 and principal
 place of
 business 
Proportion of
 ownership 
interest 
Directly/
indirectly 
held
Registered office address 
Funding Circle Ltd
UK
100%
Directly
71 Queen Victoria Street, London EC4V 4AY 
Funding Circle BB Limited
UK
100%
Indirectly
71 Queen Victoria Street, London EC4V 4AY 
Funding Circle Eclipse Lending Limited
UK
100%
Indirectly
71 Queen Victoria Street, London EC4V 4AY 
Funding Circle Focal Point Lending 
Limited 
UK
100%
Indirectly
71 Queen Victoria Street, London EC4V 4AY 
Funding Circle Global Partners Limited
UK
100%
Directly
71 Queen Victoria Street, London EC4V 4AY 
Funding Circle Trustee Limited
UK
100%
Indirectly
71 Queen Victoria Street, London EC4V 4AY 
Made To Do More Limited 
UK
100%
Indirectly
71 Queen Victoria Street, London EC4V 4AY 
Funding Circle Horizon Lending Limited
UK
100%
Indirectly
71 Queen Victoria Street, London EC4V 4AY 
Funding Circle Polaris Lending Limited
UK
100%
Indirectly
71 Queen Victoria Street, London EC4V 4AY 
Funding Circle CE GmbH
Germany
100%
Directly
Rheinstraße 11, 14513 Teltow 
Funding Circle Deutschland GmbH
Germany
100%
Indirectly
Rheinstraße 11, 14513 Teltow 
Funding Circle Connect GmbH
Germany
100%
Indirectly
Rheinstraße 11, 14513 Teltow 
FC Forderungsmanagement GmbH
Germany
100%
Indirectly
Rheinstraße 11, 14513 Teltow 
Funding Circle Nederland B.V.
Netherlands
100%
Indirectly
71 Queen Victoria Street, London EC4V 4AY 
Subsidiary undertakings disposed 
of in the year 
Funding Circle USA, Inc. Note 1 
USA
100%
Directly 707 17th Street, Suite 2200 Denver, CO 80202 
Funding Circle Notes Program, LLC Note 1 
USA
100%
Indirectly 707 17th Street, Suite 2200 Denver, CO 80202 
FC Marketplace, LLC Note 1 
USA
100%
Indirectly 707 17th Street, Suite 2200 Denver, CO 80202 
Funding Circle Investor Funds, LLC Note 1 
USA
100%
Indirectly 707 17th Street, Suite 2200 Denver, CO 80202 
FC Depositor US LLC Note 1 
USA
100%
Indirectly 707 17th Street, Suite 2200 Denver, CO 80202 
FC Capital US III LLC Note 1 
USA
100%
Indirectly 707 17th Street, Suite 2200 Denver, CO 80202 
FC SBA Lending LLC Note 1 
USA
100%
Indirectly 707 17th Street, Suite 2200 Denver, CO 80202 
1. All US subsidiaries were disposed of on 1 July 2024. 
Investments in associates 
Set out below are the associates of the Group as at 31 December 2024 which, in the opinion of the Directors, are 
material to the Group. The entities listed below have share capital consisting solely of ordinary shares, which are held 
directly by the Group. The country of incorporation or registration is also their principal place of business, and the 
proportion of ownership interest is the same as the proportion of voting rights held. 
Associate entity name 
Place of 
incorporation 
Proportion of
 ownership 
interest 
Directly/
indirectly 
held
Registered office address 
Funding Circle UK SME Direct 
Lending Fund Note 1 
Ireland
8%
Indirectly 70, Sir John Rogerson’s Quay, Dublin 2, Ireland 
1. Private sub-fund held via the Funding Circle ICAV, an Irish collective asset-management vehicle constituted as an umbrella fund with registered office address 
of 70, Sir John Rogerson’s Quay, Dublin 2, Ireland.

Funding Circle Holdings plc | Annual Report and Accounts 2024
177
29. Interests in other entities continued 
Investments in associates continued 
 
CORPORATE GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
STRATEGIC REPORT
The associates outlined above directly hold investments in subsidiary entities as detailed below, which are considered 
to be related parties of the Group. 
Other related party name 
Place of 
incorporation
Relationship 
Proportion of
 ownership 
interest 
Directly/
indirectly 
held
Registered office address 
Throgmorton Lending Designated 
Activity Company 
Ireland
Subsidiary 
of associate 
100%
Indirectly
70, Sir John Rogerson’s Quay,
 Dublin 2, Ireland 
The tables below provide summarised financial information for those associates that are material to the Group. 
The information disclosed reflects the amounts presented in the financial statements of the relevant associates and 
not Funding Circle Holdings plc’s share of those amounts. They have been amended to reflect adjustments made 
by the entity when using the equity method, including modifications for differences in accounting policy. While the 
Group holds less than 20% ownership in Funding Circle UK SME Direct Lending Fund I, the Group considers that it 
has significant influence over the entity through representation on its Board and so continues to account for it as an 
associate instead of a trade investment. 
The associates are sub-funds which invest in SME loans, and the Group is exposed to default and prepayment risk 
with respect to the performance of the underlying loans in the associates, to the extent that the share of profit from 
associates may diminish. The table below illustrates the Group’s maximum exposure to the investment in associates 
which represents the value on the Group balance sheet. The value of the investment is derived from net asset value 
statements from the sub-funds; however, being private, these are not from observable market data, and therefore the 
fair value is considered to be aligned to the carrying value. 
Summarised balance sheet (Group’s share) 
Funding Circle 
UK SME Direct 
Lending Fund I 
31 December 
2024 
£m 
Funding Circle 
UK SME Direct 
Lending Fund I 
31 December 
2023 
£m 
Non-current assets
0.4
1.2 
Current assets 
0.2
0.3 
Current liabilities
—
— 
Non-current liabilities
—
— 
Net assets
0.6
1.5 
Reconciliation of associates’ total shareholders’ equity to carrying amount in Funding Circle Holdings plc’s 
consolidated financial statements 
Funding Circle 
UK SME Direct 
Lending Fund I 
31 December 
2024 
£m 
Funding Circle 
UK SME Direct 
Lending Fund I 
31 December 
2023 
£m 
Opening net assets as at 1 January
18.3
32.5 
Profit for the year
0.4
1.1 
Exchange differences
—
— 
Other comprehensive income
—
— 
Capital redemptions in the year
(11.1)
(13.8) 
Dividends paid in the year
(0.4)
(1.5) 
Closing net assets as at 31 December 
7.2
18.3 
Group’s share in %
8.3%
8.3% 
Group’s share of net assets as at 31 December
0.6
1.5 
Accounting policy alignment
—
— 
Group’s carrying amount
0.6
1.5

Funding Circle Holdings plc | Annual Report and Accounts 2024
178
Notes forming part of the consolidated financial statements continued
for the year ended 31 December 2024
STRATEGIC REPORT
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
CORPORATE GOVERNANCE
29. Interests in other entities continued 
Reconciliation of associates’ total shareholders’ equity to carrying amount in Funding Circle Holdings plc’s 
consolidated financial statements continued 
Summarised statement of comprehensive income (Group’s share) 
Funding Circle 
UK SME Direct 
Lending Fund I 
31 December 
2024 
£m 
Funding Circle 
UK SME Direct 
Lending Fund I 
31 December 
2023 
£m 
Gross income
0.1
0.2 
Profit for the year
—
0.1 
Other comprehensive income
—
— 
Total comprehensive income
—
0.1 
Dividends received from associates
—
0.1 
Capital redemptions received from associates
0.9
1.1 
Interest in other entities 
Stichting Derdengelden Funding Circle is not a direct or indirect subsidiary of Funding Circle Holdings plc but is an 
independent special purpose foundation which is required in the Netherlands to safeguard borrower and investor funds 
and is consolidated as it is controlled by the Group. The registered office address is Atrium, Strawinskylaan 3075, 
4th Floor, 1077 ZX Amsterdam. 
The Funding Circle Holdings Employee Benefit Trust was established on 14 September 2018. The purpose of the trust 
is to facilitate the acquisition of shares in the Company by, or for the benefit of, existing and future employees of the 
Company and Group subsidiaries and is consolidated as it is controlled by the Group. 
Consolidated structured entities: Small Business Origination Loan Trust 2019-3 DAC, Great Trinity Lending 1 DAC, 
Small Business Lending Trust 2019-A, Small Business Lending Grantor Trust 2019-A, Small Business Lending Trust 
2020-A and Small Business Lending Grantor Trust 2020-A were consolidated structured warehouse and securitisation 
entities which either hold SME loan assets in a warehouse or hold the portfolio of SME loans and issued bonds after 
securitisation has occurred. 
Kanaloa 2 Limited (“K2”) is a consolidated UK leveraged SPV warehouse that has been set up with the intention of 
funding FlexiPay lines of credit through the use of a senior lending facility. 
The entities are, or were, bankruptcy remote special purpose vehicles and as such there is no requirement for the 
Group to provide financial support to the entities. The entities’ activities are not governed by voting rights and the 
Group has assessed that it has power over the entities based on the purpose and design of the entity and ability to 
direct the relevant activities of the entity, the nature of the relationship with the entity and the size of its exposure to 
the variability of the returns from each entity.

Funding Circle Holdings plc | Annual Report and Accounts 2024
179
29. Interests in other entities continued 
Interest in other entities continued 
CORPORATE GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
STRATEGIC REPORT
As explained in note 16, the Group experiences credit risk in relation to the SME loan assets and FlexiPay lines of credit 
net of bank borrowings, and interest rate risk in relation to the warehouse loan facilities which is partially mitigated 
through the use of derivative financial instruments. 
The principal activities of the Group’s most significant subsidiary undertakings are set out below. These are considered 
significant in the context of the Group’s business, results and financial position. 
Subsidiary undertakings
Principal activity 
Funding Circle Ltd
Acts as facilitator and performs intermediary services in respect of all loans made through the 
Funding Circle platform in the UK and FlexiPay lines of credit. 
Funding Circle USA, Inc.
The US operating subsidiary of Funding Circle. Acts as the administrator of the Funding Circle 
platform in the US. This was disposed of on 1 July 2024. 
FC Marketplace, LLC
Acts as originator and servicer of all loans made through the Funding Circle platform in the US. 
FC Marketplace, LLC sells each loan it originates, on a servicing retained basis, to third party 
institutional investors or to affiliates (e.g. Funding Circle Notes Program, LLC) on an arm’s 
length basis. This was disposed of on 1 July 2024. 
Funding Circle execs 
Program, LLC 
A special purpose bankruptcy remote entity which issues loan payment dependent debt 
securities to accredited investors. It uses the proceeds to purchase a specific corresponding 
loan made through the Funding Circle platform from FC Marketplace, LLC. The entity retains 
the contractual rights to receive the cash flows from the loan assets it has purchased, but has 
assumed a contractual obligation to pay those cash flows to the holders of the debt securities. 
The eligibility criteria have been met to derecognise the loan assets and associated issued 
debt securities as a pass-through arrangement under IFRS 9. This was disposed of on 
1 July 2024. 
Funding Circle Focal Point 
Lending Limited 
Subsidiary via which CBILS loans are originated and which holds legal title to loans which are 
held via trust structures for the beneficial ownership of institutional investors. 
Funding Circle Eclipse 
Lending Limited 
Subsidiary via which RLS loans are originated and which holds legal title to loans which are 
held via trust structures for the beneficial ownership of institutional investors. 
Funding Circle Polaris 
Lending Limited 
Subsidiary via which RLS and GGS loans are originated and which holds legal title to loans 
which are held via trust structures for the beneficial ownership of institutional investors. 
Funding Circle Deutschland 
GmbH 
Operated the Funding Circle platform in Germany and services loans. 
Funding Circle Nederland B.V. Operated the Funding Circle platform in the Netherlands and services loans.

Funding Circle Holdings plc | Annual Report and Accounts 2024
180
STRATEGIC REPORT
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
CORPORATE GOVERNANCE
Company balance sheet
as at 31 December 2024 
Note 
31 December 
2024 
£m 
31 December 
2023 
£m 
Non-current assets 
Investments in subsidiary undertakings
5
258.2
310.6
258.2
310.6 
Current assets
Loans due from subsidiary undertakings
7
0.1
0.1 
Trade and other receivables 
6
0.6
0.4 
Cash and cash equivalents
2, 11
97.2
48.2
97.9
48.7 
Total assets
356.1
359.3 
Current liabilities
Trade and other payables
8
2.4
1.8 
Total liabilities
2.4
1.8 
Equity
Share capital
9
0.3
0.4 
Share premium account
9
0.1
293.1 
Share options reserve
20.6
24.0 
Retained earnings
10
332.7
40.0 
Total equity
353.7
357.5 
Total equity and liabilities
356.1
359.3 
The Company’s profit for the year was £26.2 million (2023: loss of £28.7 million). 
The financial statements on pages 180 to 192 were approved by the Board and authorised for issue on 6 March 2025. 
They were signed on behalf of the Board by: 
Tony Nicol 
Director 
Company registration number 07123934 
The notes on pages 183 to 192 form part of these financial statements.

Funding Circle Holdings plc | Annual Report and Accounts 2024
181
 
 
CORPORATE GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
STRATEGIC REPORT
Company statement of changes in equity
for the year ended 31 December 2024
Note 
Share 
capital 
£m 
Share premium 
account 
£m 
Share options 
reserve 
£m 
Retained 
earnings 
£m 
Total 
equity 
£m 
Balance at 1 January 2023
0.4
293.1
22.2
66.7
382.4 
Loss and total comprehensive expense for 
the year
10
—
—
—
(28.7)
(28.7) 
Transactions with owners 
Transfer of share option costs
—
—
(3.8)
3.8
— 
Purchase of own shares
—
—
—
(1.8)
(1.8) 
Employee share schemes 
– value of employee services
—
—
5.6
—
5.6 
Balance at 31 December 2023
0.4
293.1
24.0
40.0
357.5 
Profit and total comprehensive income for 
the year
10
—
—
—
26.2
26.2 
Transactions with owners 
Transfer of share option costs
—
—
(6.6)
6.6
— 
Issue of share capital/exercise of share 
options
9
—
0.5
—
—
0.5 
Buyback and cancellation of own shares
1, 10
(0.1)
—
—
(33.6)
(33.7) 
Capital reduction
1, 10
—
(293.5)
—
293.5
— 
Employee share schemes 
– value of employee services
—
—
3.2
—
3.2 
Balance at 31 December 2024
0.3
0.1
20.6
332.7
353.7 
The notes on pages 183 to 192 form part of these financial statements.

Funding Circle Holdings plc | Annual Report and Accounts 2024
182
STRATEGIC REPORT
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
CORPORATE GOVERNANCE
Company statement of cash flows
for the year ended 31 December 2024
Note 
31 December 
2024 
£m 
31 December 
2023 
£m 
Net cash inflow/(outflow) from operating activities
11
1.0
(1.1) 
Investing activities
Loans advanced to subsidiary undertakings
7
—
(7.8) 
Repayment of loans and receivables from subsidiary undertakings
12
49.8
7.8 
Capital redemptions from subsidiary undertakings
5
0.8
1.0 
Proceeds from the sale of subsidiary
5
32.6
— 
Direct selling costs associated with sale of subsidiary
5
(2.0)
— 
Net cash inflow from investing activities
81.2
1.0 
Financing activities
Proceeds on the issue of shares from the exercise of share options
0.5
— 
Purchase of own shares
—
(1.8) 
Share buyback
(33.7)
— 
Net cash outflow from financing activities
(33.2)
(1.8) 
Net increase/(decrease) in cash and cash equivalents
49.0
(1.9) 
Cash and cash equivalents at the beginning of the year
48.2
50.1 
Cash and cash equivalents at the end of the year
11
97.2
48.2 
The notes on pages 183 to 192 form part of these financial statements.

Funding Circle Holdings plc | Annual Report and Accounts 2024
183
CORPORATE GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
STRATEGIC REPORT
Notes forming part of the Company financial statements 
for the year ended 31 December 2024 
1. Material accounting policies
The separate financial statements of the Company are 
presented as required by the Companies Act 2006. As 
permitted by that Act, the separate financial statements 
have been prepared in accordance with UK-adopted 
International Accounting Standards and with the 
requirements of the Companies Act 2006 as applicable 
to companies reporting under those standards. The 
Company is a public company limited by shares and 
registered, incorporated and domiciled in the United 
Kingdom. The address of its registered office is given 
on page 198.
The financial statements have been prepared on 
the historical cost basis except for certain financial 
instruments that are carried at fair value through profit 
and loss (“FVTPL”). The material accounting policies 
adopted are the same as those set out in note 1 to the 
consolidated financial statements except as noted below. 
These policies have been consistently applied to all the 
years presented, unless otherwise stated. 
The principal activities of the Company and the nature of 
the Company’s operations are as a holding company for a 
facilitator of finance for SMEs. 
As permitted by the exemption in section 408 of the 
Companies Act 2006, the profit and loss account of the 
Company is not presented as part of these financial 
statements. The Company made a comprehensive profit 
for the year of £26.2 million (2023: comprehensive loss of 
£28.7 million). 
The financial statements are prepared on a going concern 
basis as the Directors are satisfied that the Company has 
the resources to continue in business for the foreseeable 
future (which has been taken as 15 months from the date 
of approval of the financial statements to 30 June 2026). 
See going concern statement on pages 64 and 128. 
Significant changes in the current reporting year 
Sale of investment in subsidiary US business 
As was previously announced in the 31 December 2023 
financial results, the Company sought to divest of the US 
business. A competitive bid process was undertaken with 
interested parties and a sale agreement was signed on 24 
June 2024 to sell the business to iBusiness Funding, LLC 
and completion occurred on 1 July 2024. The Company 
recognised a gain on sale of £25.9 million which is treated 
as an exceptional item. Further details related to the sale 
can be found in note 5. 
Launch of share buyback programme 
As was previously announced, the Company commenced 
a share buyback programme in March 2024 to buy and 
cancel up to £25 million of shares in order to return 
value to shareholders. This programme was completed 
on 15 October 2024 with the purchase of 27,308,339 
ordinary shares, and the programme was extended to 
up to a further £25 million of shares. The nominal cost 
of the shares cancelled reduces the Company’s share 
capital with an equal increase in the capital redemption 
reserve. The full cost of the buyback inclusive of stamp 
duty and broker fees is debited to retained earnings. In 
the year to 31 December 2024, 33.5 million shares were 
purchased for consideration of £33.7 million inclusive of 
fees and expenses under the programme representing 
10.3% of the called up share capital as at 31 December 
2024. 0.2 million of the purchased shares were pending 
cancellation as at 31 December 2024. 
Capital reduction 
In November 2024 shareholders approved a capital 
reduction at a general meeting held by the Company, 
being the cancellation of the entire amount standing 
to credit the Company’s share premium account. The 
capital reduction process was completed in December 
2024 and resulted in the reclassification of the share 
premium into retained earnings by £293.5 million. This 
increased the distributable reserves of the Company to 
help facilitate ongoing capital actions and return of value 
to shareholders. 
Summary of existing accounting policies 
Investments in subsidiaries 
Investments in subsidiaries are stated at cost less, where 
appropriate, provisions for impairment (see note 5 for 
further details). 
Critical accounting judgements and key sources of 
estimation uncertainty 
The preparation of financial statements requires the 
Company to make estimates and judgements that 
affect the application of policies and reported amounts. 
Where a significant risk of materially different outcomes 
exists due to management assumptions or sources of 
estimation uncertainty, this will represent a key source 
of estimation uncertainty. Estimates and judgements are 
continually evaluated and are based on experience and 
other factors, including expectations of future events that 
are believed to be reasonable under the circumstances. 
Although these estimates are based on management’s 
best knowledge of the amount, event or actions, actual 
results ultimately may differ from those estimates. There 
were no critical accounting judgements or key sources 
of estimation uncertainty in the year ended 31 December 
2024. In the prior year ended 31 December 2023 the 
impairment of investment in subsidiaries was considered 
a key source of estimation uncertainty particularly with 
regards to the US business. Due to the sale of the US 
business, the source of estimation uncertainty has 
been removed. The Company assessed the remaining 
investments in subsidiaries for any indicators of 
impairment and determined there were none for the 
year ended 31 December 2024.

Funding Circle Holdings plc | Annual Report and Accounts 2024
184
Notes forming part of the Company financial statements continued
for the year ended 31 December 2024
2. Financial risk management
The Board of Directors has overall responsibility for the establishment and oversight of the Company’s risk 
management framework. 
The risk management policies are established to identify and analyse the risks faced by the Company, to set 
appropriate risk limits and controls, and to monitor risks and ensure any limits are adhered to. The Company’s activities 
are reviewed regularly and potential risks are considered. 
Risk factors
The Company has exposure to the following risks from its use of financial instruments:
• credit risk;
• liquidity risk;
• market risk (including currency risk, interest rate risk and other price risk); and
• foreign exchange risk.
Principal financial instruments
The principal financial assets and liabilities of the Company, from which financial instrument risk arises, are as follows:
• loans due from related undertakings;
• trade and other receivables; 
• cash and cash equivalents; and
• trade and other payables.
Categorisation of financial assets and financial liabilities
The table shows the carrying amounts and fair values of financial assets and financial liabilities by category as at 
31 December 2024:
Carried at amortised cost
Carried at fair value
Carrying 
amount 
£m
Fair value 
£m
Level 1-
Based on 
market 
derived data 
£m
Based on 
individual 
valuation 
parameters 
£m
Assets 
Loans due from related undertakings
0.1
0.1
—
—
Trade and other receivables
0.5
0.5
—
—
Cash and cash equivalents
0.9
0.9
96.3
—
1.5
1.5
96.3
—
Liabilities 
 
 
 
 
Trade and other payables
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
IFRS 13 requires certain disclosures which require the classification of financial assets and financial liabilities 
measured at fair value using a fair value hierarchy that reflects the significance of the inputs used in making the fair 
value measurement. 
Disclosure of fair value measurements by level is according to the following fair value measurement hierarchy:
• level 1 inputs are quoted prices (unadjusted) in active markets for identical assets or liabilities that the entity can 
access at the measurement date;
• level 2 inputs are inputs other than quoted prices included within level 1 that are observable for the assets or 
liabilities, either directly or indirectly; and 
• level 3 inputs are unobservable inputs for the assets or liabilities.
The Company’s financial assets measured at fair value are all categorised as level 1 in both the current year and 
prior year.
STRATEGIC REPORT
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
CORPORATE GOVERNANCE

Funding Circle Holdings plc | Annual Report and Accounts 2024
185
2. Financial risk management continued
Categorisation of financial assets and financial liabilities continued
The table shows the carrying amounts and fair values of financial assets and financial liabilities by category as at 
31 December 2023:
Carried at amortised cost
Carried at fair value
Carrying 
amount 
£m
Fair value 
£m
Level 1-
Based on 
market 
derived data 
£m
Based on 
individual 
valuation 
parameters 
£m
Assets 
Loans due from related undertakings
0.1
0.1
—
—
Trade and other receivables
0.2
0.2
—
—
Cash and cash equivalents
1.2
1.2
47.0
—
1.5
1.5
47.0
—
Liabilities 
 
 
 
 
Trade and other payables
(0.2)
(0.2)
—
—
(0.2)
(0.2)
—
—
Financial instruments measured at amortised cost
Due to the short-term nature of the financial assets and liabilities measured at amortised cost, the carrying value 
approximates their fair value. 
The fair value of financial assets held at fair value, comprising cash and cash equivalents, approximates their carrying 
value. Credit risk is mitigated as cash and cash equivalents are held with reputable institutions.
Financial risk factors
Credit risk
Credit risk is the risk of financial loss to the Company if a customer or counterparty to a financial asset fails to meet its 
contractual obligations, and arises principally from the Company’s receivables from related undertakings and cash and 
cash equivalents held at banks.
The Company’s maximum exposure to credit risk by class of financial asset is as follows:
31 December 
2024 
£m
31 December 
2023 
£m
Current
 
 
Loans due from related undertakings
0.1
0.1
Trade and other receivables:
 
 
– Amounts due from related undertakings
0.1
—
– Accrued interest
0.4
0.2
Cash and cash equivalents
97.2
48.2
CORPORATE GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
STRATEGIC REPORT

Funding Circle Holdings plc | Annual Report and Accounts 2024
186
Notes forming part of the Company financial statements continued
for the year ended 31 December 2024
2. Financial risk management continued
Financial risk factors continued
Liquidity risk 
Liquidity risk is the risk that the Company will not be able to meet its financial obligations as they fall due. The 
Company’s approach to managing liquidity is to ensure, as far as possible, that it will always have sufficient liquidity 
to meet its liabilities when due, under both normal and stressed conditions, without incurring unacceptable losses or 
risking damage to the Company’s position. 
The Company’s liquidity position is monitored and reviewed on an ongoing basis by the Directors.
The amounts disclosed in the below tables are the contractual undiscounted cash flows. 
The maturity analysis of financial assets and liabilities at 31 December 2024 and 31 December 2023 is as follows:
At 31 December 2024
Less than 
3 months 
£m
Between 
3 months and 
1 year 
£m
Between 1 
and 5 years 
£m
Over 
5 years 
£m
Financial assets
Trade and other receivables
0.5
—
—
—
Cash and cash equivalents
97.2
—
—
—
Loans due from related undertakings
0.1
—
—
—
97.8
—
—
—
Financial liabilities
 
 
 
 
Trade and other payables
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
At 31 December 2023
Less than 
3 months 
£m
Between 
3 months and 
1 year 
£m
Between 1 
and 5 years 
£m
Over 
5 years 
£m
Financial assets
Trade and other receivables
0.2
—
—
—
Cash and cash equivalents
48.2
—
—
—
Loans due from related undertakings
0.1
—
—
—
48.5
—
—
—
Financial liabilities
 
 
 
 
Trade and other payables
(0.2)
—
—
—
(0.2)
—
—
—
STRATEGIC REPORT
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
CORPORATE GOVERNANCE

Funding Circle Holdings plc | Annual Report and Accounts 2024
187
2. Financial risk management continued
Financial risk factors continued
Market risk
Market risk is the risk that the fair value of future cash flows of a financial instrument will fluctuate because of changes 
in market prices. The Company’s market risk arises from open positions in interest-bearing assets and liabilities, to the 
extent that these are exposed to general and specific market movements. 
a) Other price risk
The Company is not exposed to other price risk with respect to financial instruments as it does not hold any marketable 
equity securities. 
b) Cash flow and fair value interest rate risk
Interest on cash and cash equivalent balances is subject to movements in base rates. The Directors monitor interest 
rate risk and note that rates are expected fall in the near term. A 200 bps decrease in base rates could decrease the 
annual interest earned by c.£2.0 million (2023: 200 bps decrease and c.£1.0 million).
c) Sensitivity analysis
IFRS 7 requires disclosure of sensitivity analysis for each type of market risk to which the entity is exposed at the 
reporting date showing how profit or loss and equity would have been affected by changing the relevant risk variables 
that were reasonably possible at that date.
As discussed above, the Company does not have significant exposure to interest rate risk, cash flow risk or other price 
risk and therefore no sensitivity analysis for those risks has been disclosed.
d) Foreign exchange risk
The Company has certain investments in foreign operations, whose net assets are exposed to foreign currency 
translation risk. Foreign exchange risk is disclosed in note 16 to the consolidated financial statements.
Capital management 
The Company considers its capital to comprise equity share capital, share premium, share options reserve and 
retained earnings.
The Directors’ objective when managing capital is to safeguard the Company’s ability to continue as a going concern 
in order to provide returns for the shareholders and benefits for other stakeholders.
The Company is not subject to any externally imposed capital requirements.
The Directors monitor a number of KPIs at both the Company and subsidiary level on a monthly basis. As part of the 
budgetary process, targets are set with respect to operating expenses in order to effectively manage the activities of 
the Company. Performance is reviewed on a regular basis and appropriate actions are taken as required. These internal 
measures indicate the performance of the business against budget/forecast and confirm whether the Company has 
adequate resources to meet its working capital requirements.
Decisions related to capital allocation are discussed and monitored by the Board who considers the balance of 
returning value to shareholders while maintaining sufficient capital thresholds to ensure liquidity and to ensure 
sustainable growth of the Group’s business. The Company has taken measures to ensure sufficient distributable 
reserves are available to support capital activities, including the filing of Interim accounts and undertaking a capital 
reduction process in 2024. Distributable reserves are monitored regularly to ensure programmes such as the share 
buyback programme are supportable.
3. Company profit/(loss) for the year
The Company made a comprehensive profit for the year of £26.2 million (2023: comprehensive loss of £28.7 million).
4. Employees
The Company had no employees during the current or prior year other than Directors who numbered eight 
(2023: eight). The Company did not operate any pension schemes during the current or preceding year. Directors 
received emoluments in respect of their services to the Company during the year of £1.9 million (2023: £1.9 million). 
For further information, see the Remuneration Report on page 103.
CORPORATE GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
STRATEGIC REPORT

Funding Circle Holdings plc | Annual Report and Accounts 2024
188
Notes forming part of the Company financial statements continued
for the year ended 31 December 2024
5. Investments in subsidiary undertakings
2024 
£m
2023 
£m
Balance at 1 January
310.6
333.3
Capital contribution regarding employee services in subsidiaries
2.6
5.4
Capital additions
—
—
Return of capital
(50.6)
(1.0)
Disposal of investment in subsidiary
(4.4)
—
Impairment
—
(27.1)
Balance at 31 December
258.2
310.6
Investments in subsidiary undertakings, which are listed in note 29 of the Group financial statements, are all stated at 
cost less any provision for impairment.
Year ended 31 December 2024:
Subsidiary investment
Opening 
investment 
balance 
£m
Capital 
contribution/
(redemption) 
regarding 
employee 
services 
£m
Capital 
allocation 
£m
Return of 
capital 
£m
Impairment 
in year 
£m
Disposal 
of 
investment 
£m
Closing 
investment 
balance 
£m
Dividends 
recognised 
in year 
£m
Funding Circle UK
254.7
3.5
—
—
—
—
258.2
—
Funding Circle Global Partners 
Limited
0.8
—
—
(0.8)
—
—
—
1.0
Funding Circle USA, Inc.
55.1
(0.9)
—
(49.8)
—
(4.4)
—
—
Funding Circle CE
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
Total
310.6
2.6
—
(50.6)
—
(4.4)
258.2
1.0
Year ended 31 December 2023:
Subsidiary investment
Opening 
investment 
balance 
£m
Capital 
contribution 
regarding 
employee 
services 
£m
Capital 
allocation 
£m
Return of 
capital 
£m
Impairment 
in year 
£m
Disposal 
of 
investment 
£m
Closing 
investment 
balance 
£m
Dividends 
recognised 
in year 
£m
Funding Circle UK
251.0
3.7
—
—
—
—
254.7
—
Funding Circle Global Partners 
Limited
1.8
—
—
(1.0)
—
—
0.8
—
Funding Circle USA, Inc.
80.5
1.7
—
—
(27.1)
—
55.1
—
Funding Circle CE
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
Total
333.3
5.4
—
(1.0)
(27.1)
—
310.6
—
During the year ended 31 December 2024 the Company sold its investment in the US business for cash consideration 
of £32.6 million relative to a carrying value of £4.4 million. Associated selling costs and related costs of disposal were 
£2.3 million, resulting in a net gain on disposal of £25.9 million treated as being exceptional in nature.
STRATEGIC REPORT
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
CORPORATE GOVERNANCE

Funding Circle Holdings plc | Annual Report and Accounts 2024
189
5. Investments in subsidiary undertakings continued
During the year the Company received £0.8 million cash capital redemptions (2023: £1.0 million) and £1.0 million cash 
dividends (2023: £nil) from Funding Circle Global Partners Limited. The Company received £49.8 million non-cash 
capital redemptions (2023: £nil) from Funding Circle USA, Inc. in exchange for a receivable from Funding Circle Ltd.
In addition to the above, the Company recognised a capital contribution of £2.6 million (2023: £5.4 million) representing 
the service cost for the employees of its subsidiaries, under the Company’s share option schemes. 
During the year ended 31 December 2024, the Company identified impairment of £nil (2023: impairment of £27.1 million) 
in relation to the Company’s investment in Funding Circle USA, Inc. Refer to note 1: Key sources of estimation uncertainty.
The cumulative amount of impairment losses in relation to investment in subsidiaries is £80.2 million 
(2023: £217.9 million). The reduction in the year of £137.7 million related to subsidiaries disposed of in 2024.
Details of the sale of the US subsidiary investment:
£m
Consideration received:
Cash consideration at prevailing exchange rate
32.6
Carrying value of investment disposed of
(4.4)
Gross gain on sale
28.2
Direct transaction costs for legal, advisory and other costs
(2.3)
Other disposal related costs
(2.3)
Gain on sale 
25.9
6. Trade and other receivables
31 December 
2024 
£m
31 December 
2023 
£m
Amounts due from related undertakings
0.1
—
Prepayments
0.1
0.2
Accrued income
0.4
0.2
0.6
0.4
The Directors consider that the carrying amount of trade and other receivables is approximately equal to their 
fair value.
CORPORATE GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
STRATEGIC REPORT

Funding Circle Holdings plc | Annual Report and Accounts 2024
190
Notes forming part of the Company financial statements continued
for the year ended 31 December 2024
7. Loans due from subsidiary undertakings
31 December 
2024 
£m
31 December 
2023 
£m
Stichting Derdengelden Funding Circle
0.1
0.1
Current portion
0.1
0.1
Amount due from Group undertakings
Group undertaking
Facility 
size and 
type
Term
Expiry
31 December 2024
31 December 2023
Drawn in 
year 
£m
Repaid 
in year 
£m
Interest 
recognised 
in year  Note 1 
£m
Drawn 
balance 
at the 
balance 
sheet 
date 
£m
Drawn 
in 
year 
£m
Repaid 
in year  Note 1 
£m
Interest 
recognised 
in year 
£m
Drawn 
balance 
at the 
balance 
sheet 
date 
£m
Stichting 
Derdengelden 
Funding Circle
Loan facility 
€0.1 million
Undefined
None but 
repayable 
on demand
—
—
—
0.1
—
—
—
0.1
Funding Circle 
Ltd
Loan facility 
 £20.0 million
5 years
5 August  
 2025
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
Funding Circle 
CE GmbH
Revolving 
 credit facility 
€2.0 million
5 years
18 July 
 2024
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
Funding Circle 
USA, Inc. Note 2 
Term loan 
 facility £7.7 
million
5 years 13 January 
2025
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
Funding Circle 
USA, Inc. Note 2 
Revolving 
 credit facility 
 $3.0 million
5 years 27 January 
 2025
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
Funding Circle 
USA, Inc. Note 2 
Revolving 
 credit facility 
 £10.0 million
5 years 21 January 
 2026
—
—
—
—
7.8
(7.8)
—
—
Note 1.  All drawn balances on loan facilities bear interest at 3.5% above the base rate of the Bank of England (except Stichting Derdengelden Funding Circle which is 4% 
above the base rate) and is repayable with the principal amount at the end of the facilities term.
2. All loans to Funding Circle USA,Inc. were terminated prior to the sale of the subsidiary business in 2024.
8. Trade and other payables
31 December 
2024 
£m
31 December 
2023 
£m
Accruals 
1.3
1.2
Taxes and social security costs
1.1
0.4
Other creditors
—
0.2
Amounts due to related undertakings
—
— 
2.4
1.8
The Directors consider that the carrying amount of trade and other payables approximates to their fair value.
9. Share capital and share premium account
The movement on these items is disclosed in notes 17 and 18 to the consolidated financial statements.
STRATEGIC REPORT
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
CORPORATE GOVERNANCE

Funding Circle Holdings plc | Annual Report and Accounts 2024
191
10. Retained earnings
£m
At 1 January 2023
66.7
Transfer of share option costs
3.8
Purchase of own shares
(1.8)
Loss for the year
(28.7)
At 31 December 2023
40.0
Transfer of share option costs
6.6
Buyback and cancellation of own shares
(33.6)
Capital reduction
293.5
Profit for the year
26.2
At 31 December 2024
332.7
11. Notes to the Company statement of cash flows
Cash inflow/(outflow) from operating activities
Year ended 
31 December 
2024 
£m
Year ended 
31 December 
2023 
£m
Profit/(loss) before taxation
26.2
(28.7)
Adjustments for:
Non-cash employee benefits expense – share-based payments
1.4
—
Impairment charge
—
27.1
Net proceeds from sale of US subsidiary (see note 5)
(25.9)
—
Other non-cash movements
—
0.1
Changes in working capital
Movement in trade and other receivables
(0.3)
0.1
Movement in trade and other payables
(0.4)
0.3
Net cash inflow/(outflow) from operating activities
1.0
(1.1)
Cash and cash equivalents
2024 
£m
2023 
£m
Balance at 1 January
48.2
50.1
Cash flow
49.0
(1.9)
Balance at 31 December
97.2
48.2
These comprise cash held by the Company, short-term bank deposits with an original maturity of three months or 
less and money market funds. The carrying amount of cash balances approximates their fair value. As at 31 December 
2024, money market funds totalled £96.3 million (2023: £47.0 million).
CORPORATE GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
STRATEGIC REPORT

Funding Circle Holdings plc | Annual Report and Accounts 2024
192
Notes forming part of the Company financial statements continued
for the year ended 31 December 2024
12. Related parties
Amounts owed by related parties
Amounts owed to related parties
31 December 
2024 
£m
31 December 
2023 
£m
31 December 
2024 
£m
31 December 
2023 
£m
Short-term payables/receivables
Funding Circle Ltd
0.1
—
—
—
Intercompany loans
Stichting Derdengelden Funding Circle
0.1
0.1
—
—
 
0.2
0.1
—
—
During the year, the Company made payment of expenses for amounts of £0.1 million (2023: received payment of 
expenses for amounts of £0.5 million) from Funding Circle Ltd.
During the year, the Company received a return of capital of £0.8 million (2023: £1.0 million) from Funding Circle Global 
Partners Limited and dividends of £1.0 million (2023: £nil).
During the year, Funding Circle USA, Inc. made a non-cash return of capital to the Company of £49.8 million in 
exchange for the assignment of the subsidiary’s intercompany receivable from Funding Circle Ltd. The intercompany 
balance was subsequently cash settled by Funding Circle Ltd during the same year in full.
As at the year end, the Company was owed a cumulative amount of £0.1 million (2023: £0.1 million) from loans with 
Stichting Derdengelden Funding Circle. 
See note 14 in relation to remuneration of key management personnel.
13. Parent Company guarantee – exemption from audit for subsidiary companies
The following UK entities, all of which are 100% owned by the Group, are not subject to an audit by virtue of section 
479A of the Companies Act 2006 relating to subsidiary companies: 
Company
Registration number
Funding Circle BB Limited
12593368
Funding Circle Eclipse Lending Limited
12570773
Funding Circle Focal Point Lending Limited
12407296
Funding Circle Global Partners Limited
10554628
Funding Circle Polaris Lending Limited
13216286
Funding Circle Trustee Limited
07239092
The Company will guarantee the debts and liabilities of the above UK subsidiary undertakings at the balance sheet 
date in accordance with section 479C of the Companies Act 2006. The Company has assessed the probability of loss 
under the guarantee as remote.
The Company will guarantee the debt and liabilities of the European subsidiary Funding Circle CE GmbH and therefore 
meets the requirements of section 264(3) HGB and the entity is not subject to audit by virtue of this guarantee. The 
Company has assessed the probability of loss under the guarantee as remote.
The following UK entities, which are 100% owned by the Group, are exempt from the requirement to prepare accounts 
by virtue of section 394A and section 448A of the Companies Act 2006 relating to the individual accounts of dormant 
subsidiaries: 
Company
Registration number
Funding Circle Horizon Lending Limited
13451185
Made To Do More Limited
10575978
14. Remuneration of key management personnel
The remuneration of key management personnel is disclosed in note 25 to the consolidated financial statements.
15. Ultimate controlling party
In the opinion of the Directors, the Group does not have a single ultimate controlling party.
STRATEGIC REPORT
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
CORPORATE GOVERNANCE

Funding Circle Holdings plc | Annual Report and Accounts 2024
193
Alternative performance measures
The Group uses a number of alternative performance measures (“APMs”) within its financial reporting. These measures 
are not defined under the requirements of IFRS and may not be comparable with the APMs of other companies. 
The Group believes these APMs provide stakeholders with additional useful information in providing alternative 
interpretations of the underlying performance of the business and how it is managed and are used by the Directors 
and management for performance analysis and reporting. These APMs should be viewed as supplemental to, but not 
as a substitute for, measures presented in the financial statements which are prepared in accordance with IFRS.
APM
Closest equivalent IFRS 
measure
Adjustments to reconcile to 
IFRS measure
Definition
Income statement
Adjusted EBITDA
EBITDA, while not 
defined under IFRS, is a 
widely accepted profit 
measure.
Refer to note 5.
Profit for the year before finance costs (being 
the discount unwind on lease liabilities), taxation, 
depreciation and amortisation and impairment 
(“AEBITDA”) and additionally excludes share-based 
payment charges and associated social security 
costs, foreign exchange and exceptional items.
Net investment 
income
Net income.
Refer to Finance Review. Net investment income represents investment 
income less investment expense.
Cash flow
Free cash flow
Cash generated from 
operating activities.
Refer to Finance Review. Net cash flows from operating activities less the cost 
of purchasing intangible assets, property, plant and 
equipment, lease payments and interest received. It 
excludes the warehouse and securitisation financing 
and funding cash flows and excludes cash flows on 
drawdowns and repayment of FlexiPay lines of credit.
CORPORATE GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
STRATEGIC REPORT

Funding Circle Holdings plc | Annual Report and Accounts 2024
194
Glossary
Term
Definition
Amortisation
In lending terms, the process by which the outstanding balance on a loan reduces through repayments 
made by the borrower, until the loan is fully repaid. Not to be confused with the general accounting 
term relating to the equivalent form of depreciation for intangible assets.
BBB
British Business Bank. A state-owned economic development bank established by the UK government. 
Its aim is to increase the supply of credit to small and medium-sized enterprises as well as providing 
business advice services. The BBB has administered all the recent government-backed loan schemes 
in the UK on behalf of the Secretary of State for Business, Energy & Industrial Strategy.
Balances under 
management
Includes LuM and drawn lines of credit balances along with Cashback credit card spend balances. It 
excludes defaulted balances and excludes unallocated cash collections. It is a measure of the balances 
serviced by the Group at a point in time.
BBLS
Bounce Back Loan Scheme. A UK government-backed low fixed interest loan scheme intended to 
support businesses through the Covid-19 pandemic. The scheme facilitated loans of a maximum of 
£50,000 for up to six years, and these were 100% backed by a government guarantee for the lender. 
The borrower always remained fully liable for the debt. All Funding Circle loans under BBLS were to 
existing non-government-guaranteed lending customers and Group total lending under the scheme 
amounted to c.£35 million.
Beta testing 
(“beta”)
The second phase of testing a new product using real customers in a live but restricted environment.
Borrowers
Actual or prospective borrowers participating on the Group’s lending platform.
Cashback credit 
card
Cashback credit card refers to Funding Circle’s business credit card offering launched in H2 2024. 
Cardholders can spend earning cashback of 2% for an introductory period before reducing to 1% 
thereafter.
Capital Markets
A functional division within Funding Circle that deals with all relations and activities associated with 
institutional investors.
CBILS
Coronavirus Business Interruption Loan Scheme. UK government-backed loan scheme intended to 
provide support for SMEs (up to £45 million annual turnover) through the Covid-19 pandemic. The 
scheme facilitated loans from £1,000 to £5 million for up to six years, with the first 12 months of interest 
charges, and lender levied fees covered by the government. The loans were initially 80% backed by 
government guarantee for the lender, reducing later to 70%, but the borrower always remained fully 
liable for the debt. CBILS closed to new applications on 31 March 2021. Funding Circle was the third 
largest approver through the scheme among 90 accredited providers, facilitating c.£3 billion of loans. 
Transaction fee yields on CBILS loans were fixed at 4.75%.
Circlers 
A term used by the Group to refer to its employees.
Cohorts
A term used to denote loan groupings. Loan cohorts are determined by their year of origination. 
Investor cohorts denote loan groupings according to the loan funding institution.
Company
When capitalised, “Company” refers to Funding Circle Holdings plc.
Credit bureau 
(“bureau”)
A company that collects information relating to credit ratings of companies and/or individuals and 
makes this available to other financial institutions.
Credit extended
This includes Term Loan Originations and FlexiPay line of credit and Cashback credit card transactions. 
It is a measure of the volume of new transactions and lending to SMEs over a period of time.
Credit model
A mathematical model used to estimate the probability for a customer to default on a loan.
Default
A term used to describe loans where the customer has failed to repay a loan in accordance with the 
terms of the agreement. Loans are placed into default when it is deemed likely the customer can no 
longer meet the terms of the scheduled loan repayments (e.g. due to company liquidations and 
insolvencies) or when the borrower has consistently failed to pay in accordance with the terms and it 
has not been possible to arrange an alternative repayment schedule. A default affects the credit score 
of the borrower.
Delinquencies
A term used to describe loans where the borrower is late making payment(s). This need not affect a 
customer’s credit score if the borrower is able to agree and meet a revised schedule for repayments.
STRATEGIC REPORT
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
CORPORATE GOVERNANCE

Funding Circle Holdings plc | Annual Report and Accounts 2024
195
Term
Definition
Developing Markets 
(“Other Term 
Loans”)
The name formerly used for the primary reporting segment for the Group subsequently referred 
to as “Other Loans” and now reported within the UK Term Loans segment on the basis of materiality, 
consisting of operations in Germany, the Netherlands and Spain (all of which the Group has now 
exited and are in wind down).
EBT 
Employee Benefit Trust. A trust under which shares in the Company are held on behalf of 
the employees.
Employee 
engagement score/
index
Employee engagement is a function of the relationship between the Group and its employees. We 
measure this through surveys designed to help understand and improve the workplace and culture so 
that our employees feel more connected and dedicated to the Group goals and values. 
ERMF
Enterprise Risk Management Framework.
FCA
Financial Conduct Authority. The UK institution responsible for regulating financial institutions.
FlexiPay
FlexiPay is Funding Circle’s line of credit product that allows businesses to make purchases and then 
spread the cost over between three and twelve months, paying back in three equal monthly 
instalments. It’s designed to satisfy the working capital needs of SME businesses and is currently 
available in the UK.
FlexiPay card
FlexiPay card is another way for customers to use their FlexiPay line of credit, helping them to pay for 
everyday business expenses and make purchases.
Forward flow 
agreements
Agreements made between Funding Circle and institutional investors that indicate the lending funds 
they intend to provide for borrowers. Agreements generally stipulate the key lending terms, target 
borrower metrics, total funds earmarked for lending and the period over which they will be deployed.
FVTPL
Fair Value Through Profit or Loss. A term used to describe those securities where the business model 
under which these investments are held by the Group remains for these to be sold; and hence the fair 
value of these investments is reported through the P&L.
Government-
backed loan 
schemes
A term used to describe the various schemes deployed by governments to support their economies 
through economic shocks, most recently the Covid-19 pandemic. These include CBILS, BBLS and RLS 
in the UK and PPP in the US (see definitions). Invariably, government-backed loan schemes have 
conferred various advantages to either or both the institutional investors and the borrowers making 
them more attractive products compared to normal commercial lending. Lenders and lending platforms 
normally require formal accreditation to be able to provide the loans under these schemes.
Growth guarantee 
scheme (“GGS”)
Growth Guarantee scheme. A UK government-backed loan scheme and successor to RLS with similar 
terms (see below).The government provided lenders under the scheme with 70% guarantees against 
the outstanding balance of the facility after normal recovery processes. The borrower always remains 
fully liable for the debt.
IFRS
International Financial Reporting Standards, as adopted by the European Union.
Institutional 
investors 
Actual or prospective institutional investors participating on the Group’s platform who provide the 
funds to lend to SME borrowers, and who also take the credit risk associated with the loans.
Invested capital
Investment in Funding Circle lending products the Group has strategically made and retains on its 
balance sheet net of related borrowing liabilities. Invested capital can be monetised if liquidity 
needs arise.
LuM
Loans under Management. The total value of outstanding principal and interest to borrowers; includes 
amounts that are overdue (delinquencies), but not loans that have defaulted and excludes unallocated 
cash collections.
LTIP
Long-term Incentive Plan. A scheme used to reward employees.
Marketplace
A term used to describe our referral of borrowers (who fall outside our credit risk or service capability) 
to specialist lenders who can meet their needs. Funding Circle generally receives a fee for 
such referrals.
Ninth-generation
We use generational factors at Funding Circle to describe the number of fundamental enhancements/
revisions that have been made to the credit modelling used to determine borrower creditworthiness for 
lending. In the UK we are currently using a ninth generation credit model. 
CORPORATE GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
STRATEGIC REPORT

Funding Circle Holdings plc | Annual Report and Accounts 2024
196
Term
Definition
NPS
Net Promoter Score. An index ranging from minus 100 to +100 that measures the willingness of customers to 
recommend a company’s products or services to others. The more positive the score, the more likely a 
customer is to recommend the service.
Origination
A term used to describe the process of a loan taken out by a borrower.
Peer-to-peer 
lending
Peer-to-peer lending. A legacy service that facilitated retail investments in loans to SME businesses on a 
retail platform. Funding Circle paused P2P lending in April 2020, and in March 2022 the Group confirmed 
that it would permanently close the retail platform for new investments. Some legacy historical P2P 
lending remains on the Group balance sheet, but this will reduce to £nil as the loans continue to amortise.
PPP
Paycheck Protection Program. A US government, SBA-backed loan scheme to help SMEs keep their 
workforces employed during the Covid-19 pandemic. Borrowers were able to apply for forgiveness on 
these loans where they could prove that the proceeds have been spent on payroll costs and other 
eligible expenses. The scheme closed to new business on 31 May 2021. Accounting for PPP loans 
differed to normal loans with transaction fees spread over the expected life of the loans under IFRS 9 
(as the loans had to be held on balance sheet at amortised cost until forgiven), and with no servicing 
fees earned on PPP loans. The PPP loans were deconsolidated with the sale of the US business in 2024.
PPPLF
The Paycheck Protection Program Liquidity Facility. The name of the funding facility used by the US 
government for PPP loans. 
RLS
Recovery Loan Scheme. A UK government-backed loan scheme to help businesses recover from the 
effects of Covid-19. To date, there have been three different RLS schemes, designed to support access 
to finance for UK businesses as they looked to invest and grow. Term Loans of up to £2 million and six 
months have been available through the scheme at improved commercial terms. The government 
provided lenders under the scheme with 70% guarantees against the outstanding balance of the 
facility after normal recovery processes. The borrower always remains fully liable for the debt.
SBA
Small Business Administration. A US governmental institution established in 1953 to help SMEs succeed 
by providing counselling, capital, contracting expertise, information resources and a voice for SMEs.
Securitisation
The process by which multiple loans are pooled and packaged into interest-bearing securities (bonds). 
Horizontal securitisation denotes the packaging of loans into cohorts ranked according to risk 
potential: from the lowest risk, lowest reward, first receiver of loan yield, to the highest risk, highest 
reward bearer of first losses and receiver of surplus yield on the loans. In terms of existing horizontal 
securitisations on the Group balance sheet, Funding Circle temporarily holds the residual tranches 
with the intention to sell once seasoned. 
Vertical securitisation denotes a packaging of loans where all investors take their share of the yield 
across the entire pool of loans. In terms of existing vertical securitisations on the Group balance sheet, 
Funding Circle was required by regulation to retain a 5% equal participation in all classes of bonds issued.
Segment 
The principal reporting segments of our operations, representing the divisional structure through 
which the business is currently managed. Namely UK Term Loans, and FlexiPay being the continuing 
operations segments and US Term Loans being the discontinued operation segment, presented 
separately in discontinued operations. The Other segment historically included the Group’s Term Loans 
businesses in Germany and the Netherlands. The Other segment has been presented within UK Term 
Loans for the year ended 31 December 2024 on the basis it is no longer individually material. See note 
5 of the financial statements.
Servicing yield
The ratio of the servicing fee (the fee charged to institutional investors for managing their loans) to the 
amortised loan balance. Typically, the servicing yield is between 1% and 1.25% pa of the loan balance.
SME
Small and medium-sized enterprises. A term used in the UK to represent smaller businesses.
SONIA
Sterling Overnight Index Average. A UK interest rate benchmark that came in as a replacement for 
LIBOR (London Interbank Offer Rate).
SPV
Special Purpose Vehicle. A subsidiary created by a company to isolate a financial risk. The Group has 
held a number of SPVs housing securitised loans.
TAM
Total Addressable Market. An estimation of the total potential market value for which Funding Circle 
can compete. 
Unrestricted cash
A term used to describe the cash on the balance sheet that is available for use by Funding Circle. This 
excludes cash balances being held on behalf of third parties, like governments and bondholders.
Warehousing
A process whereby loans that have been issued to borrowers are pooled into a holding warehouse with 
the intention that these are ultimately being held for packaging and reselling to a third party investor.
Glossary continued
STRATEGIC REPORT
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
CORPORATE GOVERNANCE

Funding Circle Holdings plc | Annual Report and Accounts 2024
197
Shareholder information
Receiving shareholder information by email:
You can opt to receive shareholder information from 
us by email rather than by post. We will then email 
you whenever we add shareholder communications 
to the Company website. To set this up, please visit 
www.shareview.co.uk and register for electronic 
communications (“e-comms”).
If you subsequently wish to change this instruction or 
revert to receiving documents or information by post, you 
can do so by contacting the Company’s registrars at the 
address shown in the Company information opposite. You 
can also change your communication method back to 
post by logging in to your Shareview account and going 
to “update my communication preferences” within the 
“Quick links” section.
Registrar
The Company’s registrar is Equiniti Limited.
Equiniti provides a range of services to shareholders.
Extensive information including many 
answers to frequently asked questions can 
be found online.
Use the QR code to register for FREE or 
visit www.shareview.co.uk
Equiniti’s registered address is:
Highdown House, Yeoman Way, Worthing, 
West Sussex, BN99 3HH
Tel*: +44 (0) 371 384 2030
No te * Lines are open from 8.30am to 5.30pm, UK time Monday to Friday 
(excluding public holidays in England and Wales).
Please use the country code when dialling from 
outside the UK.
Shareholder enquiries
If you have any queries relating to your shareholding, 
dividend payments or lost share certificates, or if any 
of your details change, please contact the Company’s 
registrars by visiting www.shareview.co.uk or by using 
the telephone number above. 
Annual shareholder calendar
Final results announced 
6 March 2025
Annual Report published April 2025
Annual General Meeting 
15 May 2025
Interim Report
As part of our e-comms programme, we have decided 
not to produce a printed copy of our Interim Report. 
We will instead publish the report on our website. It is 
expected that this year’s report will be available on our 
website in September.
Cautionary statement
Certain statements included in our 2024 Annual 
Report, or incorporated by reference to it, may 
constitute “forward-looking statements” in respect 
of the Group’s operations, performance, prospects 
and/or financial condition.
Forward-looking statements involve known and 
unknown risks and uncertainties because they 
are beyond the Group’s control and are based 
on current beliefs and expectations about future 
events about the Group and the industry in which 
the Group operates.
No assurance can be given that such future results 
will be achieved; actual events or results may differ 
materially as a result of risks and uncertainties 
facing the Group. If the assumptions on which 
the Group bases its forward-looking statements 
change, actual results may differ from those 
expressed in such statements. The forward-
looking statements contained in this report reflect 
knowledge and information available at the date 
of this Annual Report and the Group undertakes 
no obligation to update these forward-looking 
statements except as required by law.
This report does not constitute or form part of any 
offer or invitation to sell, or any solicitation of any 
offer to purchase, any shares or other securities in 
the Company, and nothing in this report should be 
construed as a profit forecast.
CORPORATE GOVERNANCE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
STRATEGIC REPORT

Funding Circle Holdings plc | Annual Report and Accounts 2024
198
Company information
Directors
Executive Directors
L Jacobs (Chief Executive Officer)
T Nicol (Chief Financial Officer)
Non-Executive Directors
A D Learoyd (Chair)
K Stannard (Incoming Chair)
G Gopalan
H W Nelis
N A Rimer
H Beck
Company Secretary
L K Vernall
Independent statutory auditors
PricewaterhouseCoopers LLP
7 More London Riverside 
London SE1 2RT
Bankers
Barclays Bank UK plc
1 Churchill Place 
London E14 5HP
Registrars
Equiniti Limited
Aspect House 
Spencer Road 
Lancing 
West Sussex BN99 6DA
Brokers
Investec
30 Gresham Street 
London EC2V 7QN
Deutsche Numis
The London Stock Exchange Building 
10 Paternoster Square 
London EC4M 7LT
Registered office
71 Queen Victoria Street 
London EC4V 4AY
Registered number
07123934
STRATEGIC REPORT
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
CORPORATE GOVERNANCE

www.carbonbalancedpaper.com 
CBP029705
Funding Circle Holdings plc’s commitment to environmental issues is reflected 
in this Annual Report, which has been printed on Amadeus Silk, an FSC® 
certified material.
This document was printed by Pureprint Group using its environmental print 
technology, with 99% of dry waste diverted from landfill, minimising the impact 
of printing on the environment. The printer is a CarbonNeutral® company.
Both the printer and the paper mill are registered to ISO 14001.
Produced by 
desingportfolio 

Funding Circle Holdings plc
71 Queen Victoria Street 
London 
EC4V 4AY
corporate.fundingcircle.com

Funding Circle Holdings plc Annual Report and Accounts 2024